Lucent Technologies Security Camera Release 6 User Manual

®
DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server  
Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets  
555-230-112  
Comcode 108215526  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copyright 1998, Lucent Technologies  
All Rights Reserved  
See the preface of this document.  
Printed in U.S.A.  
Ordering Information  
Notice  
Call:  
Lucent Technologies Publications Center  
Voice 1 800 457-1235 International Voice 317 361-5353  
Fax 1 800 457-1764 International Fax 317 322-6699  
Lucent Technologies BCS Publications Center  
2855 N. Franklin Road  
Indianapolis, IN 46219  
Document No. 555-230-112  
Comcode 108215526  
Every effort was made to ensure that the information in this book was  
complete and accurate at the time of printing. However, information is  
subject to change.  
Write:  
Order:  
Your Responsibility for Your System’s Security  
Toll fraud is the unauthorized use of your telecommunications system  
by an unauthorized party, for example, persons other than your com-  
pany’s employees, agents, subcontractors, or persons working on your  
Issue 5, May 1998  
company’s behalf. Note that there may be a risk of toll fraud associated For additional documents, refer to the section in “About This Docu-  
with your telecommunications system and, if toll fraud occurs, it can  
result in substantial additional charges for your telecommunications  
services.  
ment” entitled “Related Resources.”  
You can be placed on a standing order list for this and other documents  
you may need. Standing order will enable you to automatically receive  
updated versions of individual documents or document sets, billed to  
account information that you provide. For more information on stand-  
ing orders, or to be put on a list to receive future issues of this docu-  
ment, contact the Lucent Technologies Publications Center.  
You and your system manager are responsible for the security of your  
system, such as programming and configuring your equipment to pre-  
vent unauthorized use. The system manager is also responsible for  
reading all installation, instruction, and system administration docu-  
ments provided with this product in order to fully understand the fea-  
tures that can introduce risk of toll fraud and the steps that can be taken European Union Declaration of Conformity  
to reduce that risk. Lucent Technologies does not warrant that this  
product is immune from or will prevent unauthorized use of com-  
The “CE” mark affixed to the DEFINITY® equipment described in  
this book indicates that the equipment conforms to the following Euro-  
mon-carrier telecommunication services or facilities accessed through pean Union (EU) Directives:  
or connected to it. Lucent Technologies will not be responsible for any  
charges that result from such unauthorized use.  
Electromagnetic Compatibility (89/336/EEC)  
Low Voltage (73/23/EEC)  
Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (TTE) i-CTR3 BRI  
and i-CTR4 PRI  
Lucent Technologies Fraud Intervention  
If you suspect that you are being victimized by toll fraud and you need For more information on standards compliance, contact your local dis-  
technical support or assistance, call Technical Service Center Toll  
Fraud Intervention Hotline at 1 800 643-2353.  
tributor.  
Comments  
Federal Communications Commission Statement  
To comment on this document, return the comment card at the front of  
the document.  
Part 15: Class A Statement. This equipment has been tested and  
found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant  
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide rea-  
Acknowledgment  
sonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is This document was prepared by Product Documentation Development,  
operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates,  
uses, and can radiate radio-frequency energy and, if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interfer-  
ence to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a resi-  
user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
Lucent Technologies, Denver, CO.  
Part 68: Network Registration Number. This equipment is registered  
with the FCC in accordance with Part 68 of the FCC Rules. It is identi-  
fied by FCC registration number AS593M-13283-MF-E. Refer to  
“Federal Communications Commission Statement” in “About This  
Book” for more information regarding Part 68.  
Canadian Department of Communications (DOC)  
Interference Information  
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits for radio  
noise emissions set out in the radio interference regulations of the  
Canadian Department of Communications.  
Le Présent Appareil Nomérique n’émet pas de bruits radioélectriques  
dépassant les limites applicables aux appareils numériques de la class  
A préscrites dans le reglement sur le brouillage radioélectrique édicté  
par le ministére des Communications du Canada.  
Trademarks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Contents  
Page iii  
About This Book  
viii  
ix  
Organization  
How to Comment on This Book  
Related Books  
ix  
x
How to Order Books  
x
Trademarks  
xi  
Standards Compliance  
LASER Product  
xii  
xiii  
xiii  
xv  
xv  
xv  
xvi  
Electromagnetic Compatibility Standards  
Where to Call for Technical Support  
Anti-Static Protection  
Security Issues  
Federal Communications Commission Statement  
1
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Unpack and Inspect Cabinets  
Check Customer’s Order  
Correcting Shipping Errors  
Install System Cabinets  
1-1  
1-1  
1-2  
1-2  
1-3  
Connect Remote Power Off Cable and  
Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet  
1-28  
1-29  
1-34  
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Earthquake Protection Installation  
2
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Equipment Room Hardware  
Main Distribution Frame  
2-1  
2-1  
2-4  
Installation RDeoqwuniloreadmfreonmtsWww.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Searc2h-A5nd Download.  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Contents  
Page iv  
Install Equipment and Cables  
Install Cable Slack Managers  
Install Sneak Fuse Panels  
2-6  
2-12  
2-13  
2-16  
2-26  
2-28  
2-33  
2-39  
2-40  
2-45  
2-49  
Cable Installation  
Install Coupled Bonding Conductor  
Station Wiring Design  
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Layout  
Voice and Data Terminals  
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and Administration  
Create a Provisioning Plan  
3
Activate System  
3-1  
Install Management Terminal  
Activate the System  
3-2  
3-7  
Screens and Commands  
3-10  
3-11  
3-12  
3-17  
3-18  
3-19  
3-23  
3-29  
3-29  
3-30  
3-30  
3-31  
3-32  
System Administration  
Set Country Options  
Circuit Pack Administration  
Set System Maintenance Parameters  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
Reboot High Reliability System  
Administer Attendant Console  
Save Translations  
Add Translations  
Installation Completion  
DEFINITY AUDIX Power Procedures  
4
Test the System  
4-1  
4-2  
4-3  
4-4  
4-5  
4-6  
Check System Status for Each Cabinet  
Check Circuit Pack Configuration  
Test TDM Bus in PPN  
Test Tone-Clock Circuit Packs  
Test SPE Duplication Memory Shadowing Link  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Contents  
Page v  
Element Interchange  
4-7  
Test Expansion Interface Circuit Packs  
Test TDM for each EPN  
4-8  
4-9  
Test Tone-Clock for each EPN  
Test Tone-Clock Interchange for each EPN  
Test Expansion Interface Exchange for Each EPN  
System Test Completion  
4-10  
4-10  
4-11  
4-12  
4-13  
LED Indicators  
5
Other Equipment  
5-1  
Analog Station or 2-Wire Digital Station Example  
Analog Tie Trunk Example  
Digital Tie Trunk Example  
5-5  
5-6  
5-7  
DS1 Tie Trunk Example  
5-8  
Auxiliary Connector Outputs  
Three-Pair and Four-Pair Modularity  
Adjunct Power Connections  
Attendant Console  
5-10  
5-13  
5-14  
5-16  
5-16  
5-17  
26B1 Selector Console  
Connect External Alarm Indicators  
Connect Power Distribution Unit External Alarm Wires 5-19  
Remote Network Interface  
5-22  
5-23  
5-30  
5-30  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
Off-Premises Station Wiring  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones 5-36  
External Ringing  
5-44  
5-44  
5-45  
5-54  
5-57  
5-61  
5-64  
Queue Warning Indicator  
1145B Power Supply  
1151A Power Supply  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
Multi-point Adapters  
Add Circuit Packs  
List of CircuDiotwPnalocadksfrom Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Searc5h-A6n5d Download.  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Contents  
Page vi  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
Add CO, FX, WATS, and PCOL  
Add DID Trunks  
5-70  
5-85  
5-86  
Add Tie Trunks  
5-87  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
5-89  
Add Code Calling Access  
Add Speech Synthesis  
5-93  
5-93  
Add Pooled Modem  
5-93  
Add External Modem to EPN  
Add External Modem to PPN  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
Add Multiple Announcement  
Add ISDN — PRI  
5-94  
5-95  
5-96  
5-106  
5-110  
5-113  
5-117  
5-121  
5-124  
5-131  
5-143  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
Add ISDN—BRI  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
6
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Make Test Calls  
6-1  
6-2  
6-2  
6-3  
6-3  
6-3  
6-4  
Test 302C Attendant Console  
Test External Ringing  
Test Queue Warning Indicator  
Test Integrated Announcement  
Test Music-on-Hold  
Element Interchange  
6-5  
6-6  
6-7  
6-8  
6-9  
Test Terminating Trunk Transmission  
Test Stratum 3 Clock  
Perform Complete System Test  
Activate and Test Alarm Origination Feature  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Contents  
Page vii  
A
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
LASER Product  
A-1  
A-2  
Fiber Optic Requirements  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
Cleaning Fiber Optic Cables  
Labels for Fiber Optic Cables  
Making Changes at an LIU or Shelf  
Routing Fiber Optic Cables  
A-2  
A-6  
A-16  
A-16  
A-17  
A-18  
B
Option Switch Settings  
B-1  
B-2  
External Modem Option Settings  
Printer Option Settings  
B-5  
Call Detail Recording Option Settings  
B-8  
C
D
E
References  
E-1  
E-1  
E-5  
E-9  
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
Call Center Documents  
Documents on CD-ROM  
GL Glossary and Abbreviations  
IN Index  
GL-1  
IN-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Page viii  
About This Book  
This book provides procedures and information for installing and initially testing  
®
the DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Multi-Carrier Cabinets.  
This document covers information related to DEFINITY ECS Release 6. For  
details about changes for Release 6, refer to DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6.1, Change Description.  
The following conventions describe the systems referred to in this book.  
The word system, is a general term and includes references to the  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server  
DEFINITY Systems are called: Release 5, Release 5r, Release 6, and  
Release 6r  
All occurrences of Release 5r, and Release 6r are called Release 6r  
unless a specific configuration is required to differentiate between product  
offerings  
Information in this book is applicable for Release 5 through Release 6  
unless otherwise specified  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server is abbreviated DEFINITY  
ECS  
This book describes installation and wiring including:  
1. Placing and interconnecting the various cabinets and adjuncts.  
2. Wiring from the telephone network interface to and including the 25-pair  
cables that connect directly to the system.  
3. The main equipment room main distribution frame and the associated  
cabling to the system and/or 8-pin information outlets (modular wall jacks).  
4. Testing of the completed installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Organization  
Page ix  
This issue replaces all previous issues of DEFINITY Communications System  
Generic 1 and Generic 3 Installation and Test, 555-204-104.  
NOTE:  
This book is being modified for international translation. This means some  
illustrations contain numbers instead of descriptive text. In the future, all  
illustrations will contain numbers.  
Organization  
This book contains the following chapters:  
Chapter 1, ‘‘Install and Connect Cabinets’’ How to install the cabinets,  
connect power, and connect the cabinets together.  
Chapter 2, ‘‘Install Telecommunications Cabling’’ How to install cabling  
between the system and the Main Distribution Frame.  
Chapter 3, ‘‘Install Management Terminal and Activate System’’ How to install  
the management terminal and how to activate and initialize the system.  
Chapter 4, ‘‘Test the System’’ How to initially test the system.  
Chapter 5, ‘‘Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment’’How to install  
and wire telephones and other equipment to the system.  
Chapter 6, ‘‘Test Telephones and Other Equipment’’ How to test the  
equipment installed in Chapter 5.  
How to Comment on This Book  
Lucent Technologies welcomes your feedback. Please fill out the reader  
comment card at the front of this book and return it. Your comments are of great  
value and help improve our documentation.  
If the reader comment card is missing, fax your comments to 1-303-538-1741 or  
to your Lucent Technologies representative, and mention this document’s name  
and number, DEFINITY Enterprise Communication Server Release 6 Installation  
and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets, 555-230-112.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Related Books  
Page x  
Related Books  
The following books are useful for system-related information:  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 System  
Description Pocket Reference, 555-230-211  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for  
R6r, 555-230-126  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for  
R6vs/si, 555-230-127  
AT&T Network and Data Connectivity Reference, 555-025-201  
BCS Products Security Handbook, 555-025-600  
DEFINITY Wireless Business System Users Guide, 555-232-105  
DEFINITY Wireless Business System Installation and Test Guide,  
555-232-102  
DEFINITY Wireless Business Systems System Interface, 555-232-108  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Installation and  
Test for Single-Carrier Cabinets, 555-230-894  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration  
and Feature Description, 555-230-522  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Upgrades and  
Additions for R6vs/si, 555-230-120  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Upgrades and  
Additions for R6r, 555-230-121  
Switch Administration for DEFINITY AUDIX, 585-300-509  
How to Order Books  
In addition to this book, other description, installation and test, maintenance, and  
administration books are available. A complete list of DEFINITY books is  
provided in the Business Communications System Publications Catalog,  
555-000-010.  
This book and any other DEFINITY books can be ordered directly from the  
Lucent Technologies Business Communications System Publications Fulfillment  
Center at 1-317-322-6791 or toll free at 1-800-457-1235.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Trademarks  
Page xi  
Trademarks  
This document contains references to the following Lucent Technologies  
trademarked products:  
®
ACCUNET  
®
AUDIX  
®
Callmaster  
®
CallVisor  
®
CONVERSANT  
®
DEFINITY  
FORUM  
®
LGX  
®
MEGACOM  
®
SYSTIMAX  
TRANSTALK  
The following products are trademarked by their appropriate vendor:  
®
Audichron is a registered trademark of Audichron Company  
®
Music Mate is a registered trademark of Harris Corporation  
®
PagePac is a registered trademark of Harris Corporation, Dracon  
Division  
®
SHOCKWATCH is a registered trademark of Media Recovery,  
Incorporated  
®
Styrofoam is a registered trademark of Styrofoam Corporation  
®
TILTWATCH is a registered trademark of Media Recovery, Incorporated  
®
VELCRO is a registered trademark of VELCRO U.S.A. Incorporated  
®
Zone Mate is a registered trademark of Harris Corporation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Standards Compliance  
Page xii  
Standards Compliance  
The equipment presented in this book complies with the following (as  
appropriate):  
ITU-T (Formerly CCITT)  
ECMA  
ETSI  
IPNS  
DPNSS  
National ISDN-1  
National ISDN-2  
ISO-9000  
ANSI  
FCC Part 15 and Part 68  
EN55022  
EN50081  
EN50082  
CISPR22  
Australia AS3548 (AS/NZ3548)  
Australia TS 001 (AS/NZS3260)  
IEC 825  
IEC 950  
UL 1459  
UL 1950  
CSA C22.2 Number 225  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
LASER Product  
Page xiii  
LASER Product  
The DEFINITY ECS may contain a Class 1 LASER device if single-mode fiber  
optic cable is connected to a remote Expansion Port Network (EPN). The LASER  
device operates within the following parameters:  
Power Output: -5 dBm  
Wavelength: 1310 nm  
Mode Field Diameter: 8.8 microns  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  
IEC 825 1993  
!
CAUTION:  
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Electromagnetic Compatibility  
Standards  
This product complies with and conforms to the following:  
Limits and Methods of Measurements of Radio Interference  
Characteristics of Information Technology Equipment, EN55022  
(CISPR22), 1993  
EN50082-1, European Generic Immunity Standard  
FCC Part 15  
Australia AS3548  
NOTE:  
The system conforms to Class A (industrial) equipment. Voice terminals  
meet Class B requirements.  
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) IEC 1000-4-2  
Radiated radio frequency field IEC 1000-4-3  
Electrical Fast Transient IEC 1000-4-4  
Lightning effects IEC 1000-4-5  
Conducted radio frequency IEC 1000-4-6  
Mains frequency magnetic field IEC 1000-4-8  
Low frequency mains disturbance  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Electromagnetic Compatibility Standards  
Page xiv  
The system conforms to the following:  
Electromagnetic compatibility General Immunity Standard, part 1;  
residential, commercial, light industry, EN50082-1, CENELEC, 1991  
Issue 1 (1984) and Issue 2 (1992), Electrostatic discharge immunity  
requirements (EN55024, Part 2) IEC 1000-4-2  
Radiated radio frequency field immunity requirements IEC 1000-4-3  
Electrical fast transient/burst immunity requirements IEC 1000-4-4  
European Union Standards  
Lucent Technologies Business Communications Systems declares that the  
DEFINITY equipment specified in this book bearing the Conformité Europeénne  
(CE) mark conforms to the European Union Electromagnetic Compatibility  
Directives.  
The CE mark indicates conformance to the European Union Electromagnetic  
Compatibility Directive (89/336/EEC) Low Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC) and  
Telecommunication Terminal Equipment (TTE) Directive (91/263/EEC) and with  
i-CTR3 Basic Rate Interface (BRI) and i-CTR4 Primary Rate Interface (PRI) as  
applicable. The CE mark is applied to the following Release 6 products:  
Global AC powered Multi-Carrier Cabinet (MCC)  
DC powered Multi-Carrier Cabinet (MCC) with 25 Hz ring generator  
AC powered Single-Carrier Cabinet (SCC) with 25 Hz ring generator  
AC powered Compact Single-Carrier Cabinet (CSCC) with 25 Hz ring  
generator  
Enhanced DC Power System  
Compact Modular Cabinet (CMC) with 25 Hz ring generator  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Where to Call for Technical Support  
Page xv  
Where to Call for Technical Support  
Use the following telephone numbers for the region in which the system is being  
installed:  
Telephone Number  
Streamlined Implementation (for missing equipment)  
USA/Canada Technical Service Center  
1-800-772-5409  
1-800-248-1234  
1-800-248-1111  
Technical Service Center (INADS Database  
Administration)  
Asia/Pacific Regional Support Center  
Western Europe/South Africa/Middle East  
Business Communications Europe  
Eastern/Central Europe  
65-872-8686  
441-252-774-800  
441-252-391-789  
361-345-4334  
ITAC  
1-303-804-3777  
1-303-804-3778  
1-800-225-7585  
1-800-643-2353  
1-800-242-2121  
1-800-822-9009  
Latin/Central America & Caribbean  
DEFINITY Helpline  
Lucent Technologies Toll Fraud Intervention  
Lucent Technologies Technical Service Center  
Lucent Technologies Corporate Security  
Anti-Static Protection  
!
CAUTION:  
When handling circuit packs or any components of a DEFINITY System,  
always wear an authorized wrist ground strap. Connect the strap to an  
approved ground such as an unpainted metal surface on the DEFINITY  
System.  
Security Issues  
To ensure the greatest security possible for customers, Lucent Technologies  
offers services that can reduce toll-fraud liabilities. Contact your Lucent  
Technologies representative for more security information.  
Login security is an attribute of the DEFINITY ECS software. Existing passwords  
expire 24 hours after installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Federal Communications Commission Statement  
Page xvi  
Federal Communications Commission  
Statement  
Part 68: Statement  
Part 68: Answer-Supervision Signaling. Allowing this equipment to be operated in  
a manner that does not provide proper answer-supervision signaling is in  
violation of Part 68 rules. This equipment returns answer-supervision signals to  
the public switched network when:  
Answered by the called station  
Answered by the attendant  
Routed to a recorded announcement that can be administered by the CPE  
user  
This equipment returns answer-supervision signals on all DID calls forwarded  
back to the public switched telephone network. Permissible exceptions are:  
A call is unanswered  
A busy tone is received  
A reorder tone is received  
Lucent Technologies attests that this registered equipment is capable of  
providing users access to interstate providers of operator services through the  
use of access codes. Modification of this equipment by call aggregators to block  
access dialing codes is a violation of the Telephone Operator Consumers Act of  
1990.  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC Rules. On the rear of this  
equipment is a label that contains, among other information, the FCC registration  
number and ringer equivalence number (REN) for this equipment. If requested,  
this information must be provided to the telephone company.  
The REN is used to determine the quantity of devices which may be connected  
to the telephone line. Excessive RENs on the telephone line may result in devices  
not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most, but not all areas, the sum of  
RENs should not exceed 5.0. To be certain of the number of devices that may be  
connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact the local telephone  
company.  
NOTE:  
REN is not required for some types of analog or digital facilities.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
About This Book  
Federal Communications Commission Statement  
Page xvii  
Means of Connection  
Connection of this equipment to the telephone network is shown in the following  
table (U.S. only).  
SOC/REN/  
Manufacturers Port Identifier  
FIC Code  
A.S. Code  
Network Jacks  
Off/On Premises Station  
OL13C  
9.0F  
RJ2GX, RJ21X,  
RJ11C  
DID Trunk  
02RV2-T  
02GS2  
0.0B  
0.3A  
3.0A  
9.0F  
6.0F  
6.0F  
6.0F  
RJ2GX, RJ21X  
RJ21X  
CO Trunk  
CO Trunk  
02LS2  
RJ21X  
Tie Trunk  
TL31M  
RJ2GX  
1.544 Digital Interface  
1.544 Digital Interface  
120A2 Channel Service Unit  
04DU9-B,C  
04DU9-BN,KN  
04DU9-DN  
RJ48C, RJ48M  
RJ48C, RJ48M  
RJ48C  
®
If the terminal equipment (DEFINITY System) causes harm to the telephone  
network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that temporary  
discontinuance of service may be required. But if advance notice is not practical,  
the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, you  
will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe it is  
necessary.  
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment,  
operations or procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this  
happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to  
make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If trouble is experienced with this equipment, for repair or warranty information,  
please contact the Technical Service Center at 1-800-242-2121. If the equipment  
is causing harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may request  
that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.  
It is recommended that repairs be performed by Lucent Technologies certified  
technicians.  
The equipment cannot be used on public coin phone service provided by the  
telephone company. Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs.  
Contact the state public utility commission, public service commission or  
corporation commission for information.  
This equipment, if it uses a telephone receiver, is hearing aid compatible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Unpack and Inspect Cabinets  
1
Page 1-1  
1
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
This chapter discusses installation of Multi-Carrier Cabinets only. For information  
on Single-Carrier Cabinets, refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server  
Release 5 Installation and Test for Single-Carrier Cabinets.  
Floor plans and equipment layouts for typical system installations are provided in  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 System Description  
Pocket Reference.  
Unpack and Inspect Cabinets  
Perform these steps for all cabinets.  
!
DANGER:  
A cabinet may weigh as much as 800 lbs (363 kg) and may be top heavy.  
Use extreme caution.  
1. Check the status of the SHOCKWATCH and/or TILTWATCH indicators on  
the container. If the container has been shaken or tilted beyond  
specifications, the indicators are red, indicating potential damage. Report  
any damage according to local shipping instructions.  
!
DANGER:  
Take care to avoid injury while cutting and removing the 2 metal bands.  
2. Unpack the cabinet and remove all packing material.  
3. Move the cabinets into their proper positions.  
4. Do not adjust the leveling feet at this time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Check Customer’s Order  
Page 1-2  
Unpack and Inspect Auxiliary Cabinet  
The Auxiliary cabinet is normally positioned adjacent to the PPN cabinet or the  
EPN cabinet, if provided.  
1. Unpack the cabinets as outlined on the previous page.  
2. Remove the lower rear panel from the Auxiliary cabinet. Install the lower  
rear panel when the installation is completed.  
Unpack and Inspect Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet  
1. Check the status of the SHOCKWATCH and/or TILTWATCH indicators on  
the cardboard container. If the container has been jarred or tilted beyond  
specifications, the indicators are red, indicating possible damage.  
2. Remove all packing material.  
3. Remove front door and rear screw-on panels from the cabinet.  
4. Inspect the cabinet for damage. Report any damage per local  
instructions.  
Check Customers Order  
1. Check the customer’s order and the shipping packing lists to confirm all  
equipment is present. If any equipment is missing, report the information  
to your Lucent Technologies representative.  
2. Ensure all circuit packs are fully inserted into the proper slots according to  
the Customer Service Document (CSD). Report any discrepancies in  
circuit pack type or quantity to your Lucent Technologies representative.  
3. Check the system adjuncts for damage and report all damage according  
to local shipping instructions.  
Correcting Shipping Errors  
1. Red-tag all defective equipment and over-shipped equipment and return  
per the nearest Material Stocking Location (MSL) instructions. For  
international customers, contact your order service agent.  
2. Direct all short-shipped reports to the nearest MSL. Contact the  
appropriate location for specific instructions. For Streamlined  
Implementation in the United States, call 1-800-772-5409.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Install System Cabinets  
1
Page 1-3  
Install System Cabinets  
Check the location of the AC power receptacles in the equipment room. The  
receptacles must be on a separately fused circuit not controlled by a wall switch.  
They must be located within 10 feet (3 m) of the cabinet and outside the Main  
Distribution Frame (MDF) area.  
Position the PPN Cabinet  
1. If the system is supplied with cable ductwork, space the cabinets on 32  
inch (81.3 cm) centers +-1/8 inch (0.3 cm), they must be level, and must  
be square with respect to each other.  
2. If the system is supplied with cable slack managers, place the cabinets far  
enough from the connection field to lay down the 32 inch (81.3 cm) slack  
managers and to provide a little extra room for the cables to access the  
cable slack managers.  
3. If earthquake protection is required, skip to ‘‘Earthquake Protection  
Installation’’ on page 1-34.  
4. If earthquake protection is not required, level the cabinets and adjust and  
lock the cabinet stabilizing bolts to keep the cabinet from moving.  
5. At the bottom of the cabinet, install hole plugs (provided with cabinet) in  
the holes previously occupied by the 4 carriage bolts.  
Position the EPN Cabinets  
Each EPN cabinet is normally positioned adjacent to the PPN cabinet but may be  
located remotely in a different room or a different building.  
1. The procedure for installing an EPN cabinet is the same as for the PPN  
cabinet.  
2. If earthquake protection is required, skip to ‘‘Earthquake Protection  
Installation’’ on page 1-34.  
3. If earthquake protection is not required, level the cabinets and adjust and  
lock the cabinet stabilizing bolts to keep the cabinets from moving.  
NOTE:  
To install a new EPN cabinet to an existing system, refer to DEFINTY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Upgrades and  
Additions for R6r.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Install System Cabinets  
1
Page 1-4  
Position the Auxiliary Cabinet (Optional)  
1. Position the Auxiliary cabinet next to the PPN cabinet (or EPN cabinet, if  
installed). The location of equipment inside the Auxiliary cabinet is  
specified in the Customer Service Document (CSD).  
2. If earthquake protection is required, skip to ‘‘Earthquake Protection  
Installation’’ on page 1-34. Return to this section when finished.  
3. If earthquake protection is not required, level the cabinets and adjust and  
lock the cabinet stabilizing bolts to keep the cabinet from moving.  
Install Auxiliary Cabinet Equipment  
The Auxiliary cabinet allows for carrier, 23-inch (58.4 cm) rack, or panel  
mounting of hardware. The following equipment is furnished with the cabinet.  
Fuse panel Distributes -48 VDC power to fused cabinet circuits  
Power receptacle strip Provides switched and unswitched 120 VAC  
receptacles  
DC connector block Required when Auxiliary cabinet is powered by an  
external DC source  
AC to DC power supply Converts AC power provided by the AC power  
strip switched outlet to the required DC voltage  
1. Install equipment inside the cabinet as specified in the CSD. The following  
optional equipment can be installed:  
Audichron H9040 Wake-Up Announcement System  
909A/B Universal Coupler  
7400 Series Data Modules  
Z77A Multiple Data Mounting  
Fan Assembly Requires 120 volt AC power  
COMSPHERE 3000-series modems  
External Channel Service Unit (CSU) 1 is required for each T1  
carrier link  
PagePac Paging System 3 models are available. All PagePac  
models require 120 VAC power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Install System Cabinets  
1
Page 1-5  
Model 15A Announcement System See Table 1-1 for PEC codes.  
Table 1-1. Model 15A Announcement Equipment  
PEC Code  
PEC 63240  
PEC 63241  
PEC 63242  
PEC 63243  
PEC 63246  
Description  
1 chassis and 1 BLD1 circuit pack  
1 BLD1 circuit pack  
1 chassis and 1 BLD2 circuit pack  
1 BLD2 circuit pack  
1 remote record module  
The BLD1 circuit pack provides 8 channels with up to 20 seconds of  
recording time on each channel. The BLD2 circuit pack provides 8  
channels with up to 40 seconds of recording time on each channel. Each  
chassis can be populated with any combination of 2 BLD circuit packs.  
The Model 15A Announcement System is FCC registered and does not  
require a voice coupler.  
2. If earthquake protection is required, skip to ‘‘Earthquake Protection  
Installation’’ on page 1-34.  
Install and Position Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet  
Check the location of the AC power receptacle. The receptacle must be on a  
separately fused circuit that is not controlled by a wall switch. It must be located  
within 10 feet (3 m) of the cabinet and should be located outside the MDF area.  
1. Position the clock cabinet in the designated location.  
2. If earthquake protection is required, skip to ‘‘Earthquake Protection  
Installation’’ on page 1-34.  
3. If earthquake protection is not required, level the cabinets and adjust and  
lock the cabinet stabilizing bolts to keep the cabinet from moving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-6  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
Power Requirements  
Tab le 1-2 shows the power requirements.  
Table 1-2. DEFINITY System Power Requirements  
Maximum DEFINITY UL Rating Label Power Capacity  
Vac In  
208  
Iac In  
24  
Max W In  
3245  
BTU/Hr  
11071.26  
11177.71  
10645.44  
240  
21  
3276  
120  
40  
3120  
J58890CE-1, J58890CE-2, and J58890CH-1  
The following procedures apply to the AC-powered PPN and EPN cabinets.  
Either of the following power sources can supply 60 Hz power to the AC load in  
Release 5 and later systems:  
Single-phase, 4-wire, 120/240 VAC supplying 240 VAC. This source has 2  
hot wires, 1 ground wire, and 1 neutral wire (J58890CE).  
3-phase, 4-wire, 120/208 VAC supplying 208 VAC. This source has 2 hot  
wires, 1 ground wire, and 1 neutral wire (J58890CE).  
Single-phase, 3-wire, 208 or 240 VAC. This source has 2 hot wires and 1  
ground wire (J58890CH).  
Either of the following power sources can supply 50 Hz power to the AC load in  
Release 5 and later systems:  
Non-United States 4-wire, Y, 220/380 VAC. This source has 3 hot wires, 1  
neutral wire, and 1 ground wire.  
Non-United States Delta, 3-wire, 220 or 240 VAC. This source has 3 wires.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-7  
Tab le 1-3 describes the power sources and required AC input power.  
Table 1-3. AC Power Sources and Plug Type  
Power Distribution  
Unit  
Power Sources  
Power Input  
AC power distribution Single phase 120 VAC 120 VAC, 60 Hz NEMA  
(J58890CE-1 and  
J58890CE-2)  
with neutral  
5-50R  
Multi-Carrier Cabinet  
Single phase 240 VAC 208/240 VAC, 60 Hz NEMA  
with neutral, or single  
phase of 3-phase, 208  
VAC with neutral  
L14-30R  
AC power distribution Single Phase 176-264  
200-240 Volts, 50-60 Hz  
NEMA L6-30R. Installations  
outside the United States  
require a receptacle  
(J58890CH-1)  
VAC  
Multi-Carrier Cabinet  
suitable for use in the  
country of installation.  
NOTE:  
The type of power required is shown on the cabinet’s rear door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-8  
!
CAUTION:  
The equipment room AC power and ground wiring must be performed by a  
qualified electrician. Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server  
Release 6 System Description Pocket Reference, for site requirement  
information.  
!
!
CAUTION:  
The power circuit must be dedicated to the system and must not be shared  
with other equipment and must not be controlled by a wall switch. The AC  
receptacle should not be located under the MDF.  
CAUTION:  
System grounding must comply with the general rules for grounding  
contained in Article 250 of the National Electrical Code (NEC), National Fire  
Protection Agency (NFPA) 70, or the applicable electric code in the country  
containing the equipment. For more information, refer to ‘‘Approved  
Grounds’’ on page 1-23.  
Connect Ground to AC-Powered System  
(J58890CE)  
Grounding is relatively simple for an AC-powered system. Basically, the cabinets  
connect to the single-point ground terminal block located at either the AC load  
center or to a separate single-point ground block wired to the AC load center (or  
optional AC protector cabinet).  
The approved ground wire must be a green (or green with yellow stripe), 6  
AWG (#40) (16 mm ), copper, stranded wire.  
2
Bond all approved grounds at the single-point ground to form a single  
grounding electrode system.  
AC Load Center is 50 Feet (15.2 m) or Less from  
Cabinet  
2
1. At the bottom rear of the PPN cabinet, connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm )  
CABINET GROUND wire to the cabinet ground terminal block. See Figure  
1-1.  
2. Route the CABINET GROUND wire to the single-point ground block at the  
AC load center and connect.  
3. At the bottom rear of the first EPN cabinet (if provided), connect a 6 AWG  
2
(#40) (16 mm ) CABINET GROUND wire to the cabinet ground terminal  
block.  
4. Route the CABINET GROUND wire to the single-point ground block at the  
AC lDooawdnlocaednfrtoemr Wanwdw.cSoomnanneucalts..com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-9  
NOTE:  
If the EPN cabinet is located remote from the PPN cabinet (in a  
separate room or building), connect the CABINET GROUND wire to  
an approved ground.  
7
3
3
3
5
2
6
1
2
4
4
4
widmgrnd LJK 092697  
Figure Notes  
1. PPN Cabinet  
5. AC Load Center  
Single-Point Ground  
2. EPN Cabinet (if Installed)  
6. Less than 50 Wire Feet  
(15.2 m)  
2
3. 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) CABINET GROUND  
Wire  
2
7. 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm )  
4. Cabinet Ground Terminal Block  
Ground Wire to CBC  
Figure 1-1. Typical Cabinet Ground Location  
5. Repeat connecting each EPN cabinet to the single-point ground block.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-10  
2
6. At the AC load center, connect a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire to the  
single-point ground block. This ground wire will later be tie-wrapped to the  
trunk cables and connected to the Coupled Bonding Conductor (CBC)  
ground block at the MDF.  
AC Load Center is More Than 50 Feet (15.2 m)  
from Cabinet  
1. Mount the single-point ground block to any surface between the MCC  
cabinets and the AC load center single-point ground. The single-point  
ground block must be mounted to a non-metallic surface.  
2
2. At the bottom rear of the PPN cabinet, connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm )  
CABINET GROUND wire to the cabinet ground block. See Figure 1-2.  
3. Route the wire to the single-point ground block and connect.  
2
4. At the first EPN cabinet (if provided), connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm )  
CABINET GROUND wire to the cabinet ground terminal block.  
5. Route the CABINET GROUND wire to the single-point ground block and  
connect.  
NOTE:  
If the EPN cabinet is located remote from the PPN cabinet (in a  
separate room or building), route the EPN CABINET GROUND wire  
to an approved ground.  
6. Repeat connecting each EPN cabinet to the single-point ground block.  
2
7. Connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) ground wire to an unused terminal on  
the single-point ground block.  
8. Route the ground wire to the AC load center ground and connect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-11  
5
6
4
7
3
3
3
1
2
2
8
8
8
widfspgb KLC 100297  
Figure Notes  
2
1. PPN Cabinet  
5. 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) Ground Wire  
6. AC Load Center Single-Point Ground  
2. EPN Cabinet (if Installed)  
2
3. 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) CABINET 7. Over 50 Feet (15.2 m)  
GROUND Wire  
8. Cabinet Ground Terminal Block  
4. Single-Point Ground Block  
Figure 1-2. Typical Cabinet Grounding Wiring Diagram  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-12  
Connect Battery Leads (J58890CH-1)  
Figure 1-3 shows a typical optional small battery holdover assembly. These  
assemblies may ship with the battery leads disconnected to prevent the batteries  
from discharging.  
1. Plug the battery connector into the -48 VDC Batteries connector on the  
rear of the J58890CH-1 Power Distribution Unit.  
Battery  
connector  
psdfbatb RPY 061797  
Figure 1-3. Typical Small Battery Assembly  
!
CAUTION:  
Power is present in the cabinet even if the AC power cable is unplugged.  
Turn off the main circuit breaker on the front of the power distribution unit  
when procedures require ALL power to be removed from the cabinet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-13  
Figure Notes  
2
1. Connect small battery holdover cable (or  
7. 1/0 AWG (50 mm ) 50 feet  
(15.2 m) cable to large  
battery cabinet. For  
temperature sensor cable from large battery  
cabinet) to J20  
cables greater than 50  
feet (15.2 m), contact your  
Lucent Technologies  
representative.  
2. Carrier Circuit Breakers  
3. Ground Terminal Block  
4. Connect large battery holdover cable here  
8. Ground Terminal Block  
2
5. -48 VDC Return - 1/0 AWG (50 mm ) cable  
9. To AC load center or  
approved single-point  
ground block  
2
6. -48 VDC - 1/0 AWG (50 mm ) cable  
Figure 1-4. Power Distribution Unit (J58890CH)  
2. Be sure the main power to the power distribution unit is OFF.  
3. At the power distribution unit, set all carrier circuit breakers OFF.  
Small Battery Holdover  
1. Connect the small battery holdover cable to J20. See Figure 1-4.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-14  
Large Battery Holdover  
When using large battery holdover, 1 battery cabinet is required for every system  
cabinet requiring holdover. The 24-cell battery cabinet must have a float voltage  
of 54.2 VDC.  
1. Connect the -48 VDC cable to the large battery connector. See Figure 1-4.  
2. Connect the -48 VDC RETURN cable to the ground terminal block.  
3. Connect the temperature sensor cable, from the battery cabinet, to J20.  
NOTE:  
An adapter cable may be required when connecting the temperature  
sensor cable to the J58890CH unit. See Table 1-4.  
Table 1-4. Temperature Sensor Cable Adapter Cables  
H600-476 Adapter Cable  
Usage  
Group 1 (G1)  
24-cell customer-provided battery  
24-cell Lucent Technologies battery  
Group 3 (G3) (included  
with battery cabinet)  
Connect Shorting Cable to J58890CE-2  
!
CAUTION:  
For a cabinet with a battery charger, read the caution label on the 397C  
battery charger before disconnecting batteries.  
Some cabinets contain a J58890CE-2 AC Power Distribution Unit without an  
optional battery charger. Install the shorting cable only when a battery charger is  
not installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect AC Power and Ground  
1
Page 1-15  
Figure Notes  
1. Shorting Cable (H600-442-G1) (If  
2. J11  
Battery Charger is Not Installed)  
Figure 1-5. Shorting Cable Installation  
1. Set the circuit breakers on the power distribution unit OFF. See Figure 1-5.  
2. At the rear of the cabinet, insert the shorting cable (H600-442-G1) into  
J11. The cable is keyed so it can fit only 1 way.  
Connect AC Power  
1. Set the main circuit breakers on the power distribution unit OFF.  
2. Connect cabinet AC line cords to the AC power receptacles.  
3. Do not power up the system at this time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-16  
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Power Distribution Unit (J58890CH-1 Only)  
Rectifier Modules and Battery Interface Unit  
Each rectifier module operates as an integral part of a complete power system  
with battery backup. The modules operate in a redundant, high reliability mode to  
provide -48 VDC at 850 Watts to a common power bus.  
The Battery Interface Unit (BIU) controls the rectifier modules, manages the  
batteries, and reports the status of system power. The BIU provides the Remote  
Power Off (RPO) option and battery alarm interfaces for internal and external  
alarms.  
Figure Notes  
1. Install Battery Interface Unit into Slot 1  
2. Install Rectifier Modules into Slots 2-5  
3. Rectifier Module 3 (in Slot 4)  
4. Test Points  
5. Main Circuit Breakers  
Figure 1-6.DowRnelocatdiffiroemr MWwowd.SuolmeaInnuasltsa.clolmat.iAollnManuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-17  
1. Install the BU3200A Battery Interface Unit (comcode 107781502) in the  
first slot of the power distribution unit. See Figure 1-6.  
NOTE:  
The BIU and the rectifier modules are keyed and can only install 1  
way.  
2. Install the first 2 RM0850HA100 Rectifier Modules (comcode 107793796)  
into the second and third slots of the power distribution unit.  
3. If 2 to 3 carriers are installed in the system, install a third rectifier module  
(N+1).  
4. If 4 to 5 carriers are installed in the system, install a fourth rectifier module.  
5. The fifth rectifier module slot is reserved for future system growth.  
Connect Power  
1. Have a qualified electrician connect and route wires from the AC load  
center to the dedicated electrical outlet for the power distribution unit.  
Connect PPN Cabinet Ground  
2
1. Connect 1 end of a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire to the ground terminal  
block on the rear of the cabinet. See Figure 1-4.  
2. Route the wire to the Coupled Bonding Conductor (CBC), or to an  
approved ground, and connect.  
2
3. Connect 1 end of a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) CABINET GROUND wire to the  
ground terminal block at the rear of the cabinet.  
4. Route the CABINET GROUND wire to the AC load center single-point  
ground block and connect.  
Connect EPN Cabinet Ground(s)  
2
1. Connect 1 end of a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) CABINET GROUND wire to the  
ground terminal block at the bottom rear of the EPN cabinet. See Figure  
1-2.  
2. Route the CABINET GROUND wire to the AC load center single-point  
ground and connect.  
3. Connect each remaining EPN cabinet to the AC load center single-point  
ground.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-18  
DC Power and Ground (J58890CF Only)  
Figure 1-7 shows a typical power and ground layout for a DC-powered cabinet.  
The size of the wire required for the -48 volt DC and -48 volt return must ensure  
the -48 volt DC supplied by the battery plant is maintained between -42.5 and  
-54.2 volts DC at all times for proper operation and to prevent hardware damage.  
This procedure applies to both PPN and EPN cabinets.  
Figure 1-7. Typical Power and Ground for a DC-Powered Cabinet  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-19  
Connect DC Power and Ground  
The grounding methods for the DC-powered system are more complex than that  
of an AC-powered system. The following installation procedures refer to Figure  
1-7. The numbers 1-8 in Figure 1-7 match the following subsections 1-8. Other  
figures may be referenced as required.  
!
CAUTION:  
Grounding of the system shall comply with the general rules for grounding  
contained in Article 250 of the National Electrical Code, NFPA 70. For more  
information, refer to ‘‘Approved Grounds’’ on page 1-23.  
1. Install Coupled Bonding Conductor Wires  
This is a conductor that connects to the single-point ground block and run  
adjacent to pairs in an associated cable. The mutual coupling between the CBC  
and the pairs reduces potential differences in terminating equipment. The  
2
conductor consists of a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire terminated at the CBC  
ground terminal bar at the Main Distribution Frame (MDF).  
2
1. At the DC Power Cabinet, connect a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) ground wire to  
the Ground Discharge Bar. See Figure 1-7.  
2
2. Route the 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) ground wire to the CBC ground terminal  
bar at the MDF. Be sure a minimum of 12 inches (30.5 cm) spacing is  
maintained between the CBC and other power and ground leads.  
3. Tie wrap the ground wire to the inside wiring cable.  
NOTE:  
The ground wires are connected to the CBC as instructed in Chapter 2,  
‘‘Install Telecommunications Cabling’’.  
2. Connect DC Battery and Power Cabinet  
Grounds  
2
1. Measure and cut a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire (comcode 846110971)  
long enough to reach between the ground connection terminal in the DC  
Battery Cabinet and the Ground Discharge Bar in the DC Power Cabinet.  
See Figure 1-7.  
2. Crimp terminal lugs on each end of the wire. Terminal lugs are furnished  
as part of D-181895, Kit of Parts (comcode 105434559).  
3. At the DC Power Cabinet, connect the wire to the Ground Discharge Bar.  
4. Route the wire through 1 of the holes in the side of the cabinets and  
terminate it on the Ground Connection Terminal in the DC Battery Cabinet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-20  
3. DC Power Cabinet Approved Ground  
1. At the DC Power Cabinet, connect a 1 AWG (#70) (44 mm ) ground wire to  
the Ground Discharge Bar. See Figure 1-7.  
2. Route the ground wire out of the cabinet and terminate it on the approved  
ground. The approved ground must be identified with a grounding tag  
(FORM 15657NR or equivalent). See ‘‘Approved Grounds’’ on page 1-23.  
4. Connect Main AC Supply to DC Power Cabinet  
1. Have a qualified electrician connect AC power leads to the rectifiers in the  
DC Power Cabinet. Each rectifier should have its own branch circuit.  
Terminate the leads on the AC INPUT terminal block of each rectifier.  
2. Ensure the associated circuit breakers at the AC power panel are OFF.  
5. Connect Ground Wires for DC-Powered  
Systems  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not connect any ground wires from an EPN cabinet to another EPN  
cabinet or to a PPN cabinet. All ground wires must be terminated at the  
single-point ground block at the main AC supply (AC mains).  
2
1. Connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire to the PPN cabinet ground terminal  
block.  
2. Route the wire to the AC mains single-point ground block and connect.  
2
3. Connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire to each EPN’s cabinet ground  
terminal block.  
4. Route the wire(s) to the AC mains single-point ground block and connect.  
6. Turn Circuit Breakers Off  
The main circuit breaker on a DC-powered PPN/EPN cabinet is located on the  
front of the power distribution unit. The circuit breakers on the rear of the power  
distribution unit control the individual carriers. See Figure 1-4 for the location of  
the carrier breakers.  
1. Set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
2. Set the carrier circuit breakers to OFF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-21  
7. Connect DC Power to PPN and EPN Cabinets  
1. Be sure the main circuit breaker is OFF.  
2
2. Measure and cut a piece of 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire long enough to  
reach from the DC Power Cabinet to the PPN cabinet.  
3. At the DC Power Cabinet, connect the -48 volt DC wire to the DC OUTPUT  
circuit breaker. See Figure 1-7. Connect the -48 volt RTN (return) wire to  
the ground discharge bar.  
4. Route the wires out of the cabinet, through the hole in the lower rear cover,  
and to the PPN cabinet.  
5. Connect the -48 volt DC wire to the -48VDC terminal on the J58890CF  
Power Distribution Unit.  
6. Connect the -48 volt RTN wire to the -48RTN terminal on the J58890CF  
Power Distribution Unit terminal block.  
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 6 for each EPN and Auxiliary cabinet in the  
system.  
8. Connect DC Battery Cabinet to DC Power  
Cabinet  
!
CAUTION:  
When using battery backup, each cabinet in the system must have a  
dedicated battery backup. The battery backup power cannot be shared  
between cabinets.  
1. Set the main circuit breaker on the DC Battery Cabinet and the DC Power  
Cabinet to OFF.  
2
2. Measure and cut a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire long enough to reach from  
the DC Battery Cabinet’s -48 Volt DC terminal to a DC OUTPUT circuit  
breaker on the DC Power Cabinet.  
3. At the DC Battery Cabinet, connect the -48 volt DC wire to the -48 VDC  
connector. Connect the -48 volt RTN wire to the ground connection  
terminal.  
4. Route the wires out of the cabinet through the hole in the lower rear cover  
and to the DC Power Cabinet.  
5. At the DC Power Cabinet, terminate the -48 volt DC wire on a DC OUTPUT  
circuit breaker. Terminate the -48 volt RTN (return) wire on the ground  
discharge bar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground  
Page 1-22  
Mixed AC/DC Power and Ground  
Figure 1-8 shows a power and ground layout for a mixed AC/DC-powered  
cabinet configuration in the same equipment room with the PPN being DC  
powered and the EPN being AC powered. If a second EPN is part of the system,  
use the same basic connections shown in Figure 1-8.  
1/0 AWG (50 mm2) up  
to 50 feet (15.2 m) or  
engineered for less than 0.5  
voltage drop per conductor  
Approved  
To  
ground  
AC power  
source  
EPN  
cabinet  
PPN  
cabinet  
Ground  
discharge  
bar  
75A  
AC power cord  
-48V  
AC power-  
distribution  
unit  
System  
single-point  
ground  
-48V RTN  
-48V  
DC power supply  
Cabinet Ground Block  
To CBC terminal  
block at MDF  
cydfacdc RPY 021798  
Coupled Bonding Conductor  
Figure 1-8. Typical Power and Ground for a Mixed AC/DC-Powered Cabinet  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Approved Grounds  
1
Page 1-23  
Approved Grounds  
An approved ground is the closest acceptable medium for grounding the  
building entrance protector, entrance cable shield, or single-point ground of  
electronic telephony equipment. If more than 1 type of approved ground is  
available on the premises, the grounds must be bonded together as required in  
Section 250-81 of the National Electrical Code.  
Grounded Building Steel The metal frame of the building where it is  
effectively grounded by 1 of the following grounds: acceptable metallic water  
pipe, concrete encased ground, or a ground ring.  
Acceptable Water Pipe A metal underground water pipe, at least 1/2-inch  
(1.3 cm) in diameter, in direct contact with the earth for at least 10 feet (3 m). The  
pipe must be electrically continuous (or made electrically continuous by bonding  
around insulated joints, plastic pipe, or plastic water meters) to the point where  
the protector ground wire connects. A metallic underground water pipe must be  
supplemented by the metal frame of the building, a concrete encased ground, or  
a ground ring. If these grounds are not available, the water pipe ground can be  
supplemented by 1 of the following types of grounds:  
Other local metal underground systems or structures Local  
underground structures such as tanks and piping systems  
Rod and pipe electrodes A 5/8-inch (1.6 cm) solid rod or 3/4-inch (2  
cm) conduit or pipe electrode driven to a minimum depth of 8 feet (2.4 m).  
Plate electrodes Must have a minimum of 2 square feet  
(0.185 square m) of metallic surface exposed to the exterior soil  
Concrete Encased Ground An electrode encased by at least 2 inches  
(5.1 cm) of concrete and located within and near the bottom of a concrete  
foundation or footing in direct contact with the earth. The electrode must be at  
least 20 feet (6.1 m) of 1 or more steel reinforcing bars or rods 1/2-inch (1.3 cm)  
2
in diameter, or at least 20 feet (6.1 m) of bare, solid copper, 4 AWG (26 mm )  
wire.  
Ground Ring A buried ground that encircles a building or structure at a depth  
of at least 2.5 feet (0.76 m) below the earth’s surface. The ground ring must be at  
2
least 20 feet (6.1 m) of 2 AWG (35 mm ), bare, copper wire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Approved Grounds  
1
Page 1-24  
Approved Floor Grounds  
Approved floor grounds are those grounds on each floor of a high-rise building  
suitable for connection to the ground terminal in the riser closet and to the  
cabinet equipment single-point ground terminal. Approved floor grounds may  
include the following:  
Building steel  
The grounding conductor for the secondary side of the power transformer  
feeding the floor  
Metallic water pipes  
Power feed metallic conduit supplying panel boards on the floor  
A grounding point specifically provided in the building for the purpose  
!
WARNING:  
If the approved ground or approved floor ground can only be accessed  
inside a dedicated power equipment room, then connections to this ground  
should be made by a licensed electrician.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect Remote Power Off Cable and External Alarm Cable  
Page 1-25  
Connect Remote Power Off Cable and  
External Alarm Cable  
Figure 1-9 shows the location of the Remote Power Off (RPO) cable. The  
opposite end of the cable connects to the Emergency Power Off (EPO) switch  
located outside of the equipment room.  
Carrier  
circuit  
breakers  
Connect RPO  
cable here (J21)  
Connect external  
alarm cable here  
(J18)  
Pin 6 (-RPO)  
Pin 2 (+RPO)  
External  
alarm cable  
psdf002 CJL 081596  
Figure 1-9. Remote Power Off Cable Connections Part 1  
Even though the equipment room EPO switch disconnects main AC power to the  
equipment room, it cannot disconnect the battery power from the J58890CH. An  
auxiliary set of contacts inside the EPO are used for this function.  
1. Plug the RPO cable into the connector shown in Figure 1-9.  
2. Route the opposite end of the wires to the EPO switch. The opposite end  
of the RPO cable connects to the internal relay.  
NOTE:  
The EPO switch and the auxiliary contacts (inside the EPO switch  
assembly) are customer-provided.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect Remote Power Off Cable and External Alarm Cable  
Page 1-26  
!
CAUTION:  
The auxiliary contacts inside the EPO switch assembly must close when the  
switch is pressed. This contact closure energizes the relay inside the power  
distribution unit, causing the connection to the battery holdover assembly to  
open.  
Figure 1-10 shows the cabling from the auxiliary contacts inside the EPO switch  
assembly and how they connect to the internal relay.  
Power Distribution Unit  
TB3  
To Carriers  
A to E  
Shunt  
Relay  
(K1)  
Battery  
Cabinet  
Ground  
Terminal  
Bar  
RPO Cable  
TB1  
6
2
Auxiliary Contacts  
in EPO Switch  
0026_3 RBP 080196  
Figure 1-10. Remote Power Off Cable Connections Part 2  
1. Connect the RPO wires to the auxiliary contacts on the EPO switch. See  
Figure 1-10.  
NOTE:  
The EPO switch and the auxiliary contacts for the RPO connection  
are customer-supplied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
Connect External Alarm Cable  
1
Page 1-27  
Connect External Alarm Cable  
1. Plug the external alarm cable into the connector shown in Figure 1-9.  
2. Route the opposite end of the cable to the MDF. The alarm cable is  
connected to the MDF in Chapter 5, ‘‘Install and Wire Telephones and  
Other Equipment’’.  
Connect AC Power to Stratum 3 Clock  
Cabinet  
The clock cabinet requires a 120 VAC, 15 Amp receptacle. The green wire  
ground provided by the receptacle is sufficient. The clock cabinet does not  
require a ground connection back to the single-point ground.  
Check Commercial Power and Connect AC Power  
Before powering up the system, check the AC power using a KS-20599 digital  
voltmeter (DVM) (or equivalent).  
1. Set the DVM to the 250 volt range.  
2. Carefully measure the voltage between the hot and neutral side of the  
receptacle. The neutral wire is white, the hot wire is black.  
3. Verify the meter reads 106 to 128 VAC. If not, have a qualified electrician  
correct the problem.  
4. Measure the voltage between the neutral and ground side of the  
receptacle. The ground wire is green.  
5. Verify the meter reads 0 VAC. If not, have a qualified electrician correct the  
problem.  
6. Set all cabinet power modules OFF. Plug the AC power cable into the  
receptacle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Connect DC Power and Ground to Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet  
Page 1-28  
Connect DC Power and Ground to  
Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet  
1. Provide power for the clock cabinet from the same DC power plant as the  
DEFINITY System.  
2. Ground the clock cabinet to the DC power plant.  
Connect Clock Cabinet Grounding  
2
1. Measure and cut a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire long enough to reach from  
the clock cabinet to the ground discharge bar in the DC power plant.  
2. Insert 1 end of the wire into the ground lug on the clock cabinet and  
tighten the screw.  
3. Attach the lug to the receptacle cover. Be sure the lug and cabinet ground  
wires are connected to separate screws on the receptacle cover.  
4. Route the ground wire to the DC power plant and connect to DISCH GRD  
inside the cabinet.  
Connect Stratum 3 Clock DC Power  
1. Set the clock cabinet circuit breaker at the DC power plant OFF.  
2
2. At the clock cabinet, connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) ground wire to the  
-48V terminal on the terminal strip.  
2
3. At the clock cabinet, connect a 6 AWG (#40) (16 mm ) wire to the  
-48VRTN terminal on the terminal strip.  
4. Route the wires out of the cabinet and to the DC power plant.  
5. At the DC power plant, connect the -48V wire to the DC OUTPUT circuit  
breaker.  
6. At the DC power plant, connect the -48VRTN wire to the DISCH GRD bar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Page 1-29  
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Signals between the cabinets are carried by fiber optic cables. Lightwave  
transceivers provide the required fiber optic interface.  
The fiber optic cables from the DEFINITY System route to a Lightguide  
Interconnect Unit (LIU) or fiber optic shelf. Refer to Appendix A, ‘‘Connecting  
Fiber Optic Cables’’. Refer to this information for fiber optic equipment comcode  
numbers, connecting to LIUs or shelves, and routing through lightguide  
equipment.  
Use multi-mode fiber transceivers and multi-mode fiber optic cables between  
cabinets unless single-mode fiber is required (distance restrictions). Use metallic  
cables between carriers.  
!
CAUTION:  
The DEFINITY ECS may contain a Class 1 LASER device if single-mode  
fiber optic cable is connected to a remote Expansion Port Network (EPN).  
The LASER device operates within the following parameters:  
Maximum Power Output: -5 dBm  
Wavelength: 1310 nm  
Mode Field Diameter: 8.8 microns  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  
IEC 825 1993  
!
CAUTION:  
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Page 1-30  
Connect Fiber Optic Cables  
NOTE:  
Always use the Cable Running List that accompanies the system when  
installing fiber optic cables. The following procedure is a typical example of  
how to cable a system.  
If the cabinets are close together, the signal may go through a single, directly-  
connected fiber optic cable. If the cabinets are far apart, it may be easier to  
connect the cabinets through an LIU or fiber shelf.  
For each fiber indicated in the fiber optic Cable Running List:  
1. Install a lightwave transceiver on the cabinet connector at the position in  
the FROM column in the running list.  
2. Select a cable indicated by the CABLE CODE and LENGTH in the running  
list. Connect 1 of the fibers to each connector on the lightwave  
transceivers just installed. The fiber is numbered 1 or 2. The connector on  
the transceiver is labeled TX or RX. Keep track of which fiber connects to  
which transceiver connector. Label both ends of these cables.  
3. Route the fiber optic cables from the transceiver out of the cabinet. Secure  
the cables to the cable-tie rack. Keep the fiber optic cables clear of the  
heavier I/O cables.  
4. If the cabinet in the TO column in the running list is located remotely from  
the FROM cabinet, connect to the TO cabinet by way of the LIU.  
5. Install a lightwave transceiver on the cabinet connector at the position in  
the TO column in the running list.  
6. Route the cables from the FROM cabinet down into the cable trays of each  
EPN cabinet. Connect the cables to the lightwave transceiver just installed  
on the TO cabinet.  
7. Connect the fiber that comes from the TX connector of the FROM  
transceiver to the RX connector of the TO transceiver and vice versa.  
8. Route the cables through the cabinet and through cable organizers as  
provided. Secure the cables to the cable-tie rack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Page 1-31  
CSS-Connected System with 1 Switch Node  
Standard-Reliability  
Figure 1-11 shows typical fiber optic cabling between cabinets. The cable  
between the EI and SNI on the PPN is a pre-installed metallic cable (H600-278).  
1. If no running list is available, use the outer slots first in alternating order.  
Connect the first 2 SNI slots to 3 and 20 (the leftmost and rightmost of the  
unused slots). Next, use 4 and 19, and so forth.  
2. Add links to the EPNs in alternating order (20, 3, 19, 4, 18, 5, and so forth).  
Figure Notes  
1. Cabinet 1 (PPN with 1 Switch Node)  
2. Cabinet 2 through 16 (EPN)  
3. H600-278 Metallic Cable  
4. To other EPNs  
Figure 1-11. Standard Reliability CSS-Connected Release 6r with 1 Switch  
Node  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Page 1-32  
High-Reliability  
Figure 1-12 shows typical fiber optic cabling between cabinets. The cable  
between the EI and SNI on the PPN cabinet is a pre-installed metallic cable  
(H600-278).  
1. Connect the cables between the PPN cabinet and each EPN cabinet in an  
alternating port slot order: 3, 19; 4, 18; 5, 17; and so forth. Cabinet 1 is a  
Release 6r PPN with 1 Switch Node.  
Figure Notes  
1. Cabinet 1 (PPN with 1 Switch Node)  
2. Cabinet 2 through 15 (EPN)  
3. H600-278 Metallic Cable  
4. To other EPNs  
Figure 1-12. High-Reliability CSS-Connected with 1 Switch Node  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Fiber Optic Interconnect Cabling  
Page 1-33  
Critical Reliability  
Figure 1-13 shows typical fiber optic cabling between cabinets. The cable  
between port slots 1 and 2 on each switch node is a metallic cable (H600-278).  
1. Connect the 2 groups of 1 to 15 cables between the PPN and each EPN in  
an alternating port slot order: 20, 3; 19, 4; 18, 5; and so forth.  
Figure Notes  
1. Cabinet 1 (PPN with 1 Duplex Switch  
Node)  
3. H600-278 Metallic Cable  
4. To other EPNs  
2. Cabinet 2 through 16 (EPN)  
Figure 1-13. Critical-Reliability CSS-Connected with 1 Switch Node  
2. Both connections from each EPN must go to the same slot number. For  
example: EPN cabinet 2, 2A1 to 1E3 and cabinet 2, 2B2 to 1D3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Earthquake Protection Installation  
Page 1-34  
Earthquake Protection Installation  
Install Concrete Floor Mounting  
1. Position the cabinet in the exact position it is to occupy when the  
installation is complete.  
2. Insert a pencil or marker through the holes previously occupied by the  
carriage bolts (front and rear) in the bottom of the cabinet and mark the  
floor directly beneath each hole.  
3. Roll the cabinet out of the way and drill four 1/2-inch (1.27 cm) diameter  
holes about 1.5 inches (3.8 cm) deep at the locations marked in Step 2.  
4. Insert concrete floor anchors (STARR part number 3425) into the holes.  
5. Roll the cabinet back into place and align the cabinet holes over the  
concrete floor anchors.  
6. Adjust the leveling legs until the cabinet is level. See Figure 1-14.  
NOTE:  
If the system is supplied with cable ductwork, the cabinets must be  
level from front to rear and from side to side. They must be square  
with respect to each other to within ±1/8-inch (0.3 cm).  
7. Secure the cabinet to the floor with the 4 supplied 3/8-16 x 4.5-inch (11.4  
cm) bolts and four 3/8-inch flat washers.  
8. Repeat this procedure for each cabinet to be installed.  
Install Raised Computer Floor Mounting  
1. Position the cabinet in the exact position it is to occupy when the  
installation is complete.  
2. Insert a pencil or marker through the holes previously occupied by the  
carriage bolts (front and rear) in the bottom of the cabinets and mark the  
raised floor panels directly beneath each hole.  
3. Roll the cabinet out of the way and drill 4 holes 5/8-inch (1.6 cm) in  
diameter through the raised floor panels marked in Step 2.  
!
CAUTION:  
Take care while drilling the holes through the raised floor that the drill  
bit does not penetrate any cables below the floor that could cause  
damage to the cable or injury to the installer.  
4. Insert a long punch through the holes drilled in Step 3 and mark the  
concrete floor beneath the raised floor panels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Earthquake Protection Installation  
Page 1-35  
5. Remove the raised floor panels in which the holes were drilled.  
6. Using 1/2-inch (1.3 cm) anchor bits, drill a hole at each of the locations  
marked in Step 4. Stop drilling when the mark on the side of the bit  
reaches the floor level.  
7. Insert a concrete floor anchor (STARR part number 3425) into the hole until  
the mark on the bit reaches floor level again. Snap the top of the anchor bit  
off. Repeat for the remaining holes.  
3/8 inch  
flat washer  
Nut welded  
to frame  
4 inches  
(10.16 cm)  
Leveling  
foot  
3/8 - 16  
threaded rod  
raised  
floor  
variable  
height  
3/8 - 16  
Concrete floor  
anchor  
concrete  
subfloor  
cab_base CJL 052096  
Figure 1-14. Earthquake Mounting Raised Computer Floor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Connect Cabinets  
1
Earthquake Protection Installation  
Page 1-36  
8. A 3/8-16 threaded rod (part number 845557073) is used to secure the  
cabinet to each concrete floor anchor. See Figure 1-14.  
Measure the distance from 1 of the anchors to the bottom of the cabinet.  
Add 1/2-inch (1.3 cm) to this measurement to allow the rod to be threaded  
into the floor anchor. Add an additional 1/2-inch (1.3 cm) to allow the rod  
to protrude up through the bottom of the cabinet. For example: if the  
distance from the floor anchor to the bottom of the cabinet is 10 inches (25  
cm), cut the threaded rod 11 inches (27.9 cm) long.  
9. When all 4 threaded rods are cut, replace the raised floor panels removed  
in Step 5.  
10. Position the cabinet over the holes and adjust the leveling legs until the  
cabinet is level.  
NOTE:  
If the system is supplied with cable ductwork, the cabinets must be  
level from front to rear and from side to side. They must be square  
with respect to each other to within +-1/8-inch (0.3 cm).  
11. Insert the threaded rods through the cabinet bottom and thread into the  
concrete floor anchors.  
12. Place a 3/8-inch flat washer onto each rod. Thread a 3/8-16 hex nut onto  
each rod and tighten securely.  
13. Repeat this procedure for each cabinet to be installed (including the  
Auxiliary Cabinet and the Stratum 3 Clock Cabinet).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Equipment Room Hardware  
2
Page 2-1  
2
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Equipment Room Hardware  
SYSTIMAX 110-type hardware is used for the Main Distribution Frame (MDF).  
110-type hardware is available in 2 basic types: the 110A and 110P. The 110A  
requires less wall space than the 110P. The 110P includes horizontal and vertical  
cable troughs for managing cross-connect cables. The system connects to the  
MDF with the supplied B25A 25-pair cables.  
Refer to DEFINITY Communications System Generic 1 and Generic 3 Main  
Distribution Field Design, 555-230-630, for more information.  
Figure 2-1 shows the cross-connections for common circuit packs. Refer to the  
figure when cross-connecting wire pairs to the MDF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Equipment Room Hardware  
2
Page 2-2  
Figure 2-1.DowEnxloaamd pfrolme MWwDw.FSoCmoannunaelsc.ctoiomn. Asll Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Equipment Room Hardware  
2
Page 2-3  
Cross-Connect Fields  
Each MDF contains a trunk/auxiliary field and a distribution field. The  
trunk/auxiliary field contains 3 cross-connect areas:  
1. The green field terminates the network interface leads from the Central  
Office (CO) and provides the terminals to cross-connect the leads to the  
purple or yellow fields as required. A single row of the 110-type terminal  
block can terminate twenty-four 1-pair, eight 3-pair, or twelve 2-pair  
trunks.  
2. The purple field terminates the trunk circuits from the system with  
WP-90929, List 1 or 3 concentrator cables. Also, 25-pair cables can be  
used to terminate trunk circuits from the system with each trunk circuit  
pack connecting to one 25-pair row of the 110-type terminal block. Each  
terminal block row can terminate twenty-four 1-pair, eight 3-pair, or twelve  
2-pair trunks.  
3. The yellow field provides cross-connect terminals for all miscellaneous  
leads from the system, such as alarm monitors, emergency transfer relay  
power, and attendant console power. This field is used for emergency  
transfer wiring, paging equipment, music sources, and so forth.  
The distribution field contains 4 cross-connect areas:  
1. The purple field (port field) terminates 25-pair cables from the system.  
Each line circuit pack connects to one 25-pair row of the 110-type terminal  
block. One 25-pair cable is required for each line circuit pack.  
NOTE:  
This is the case except for the 16 port analog circuit pack and the  
MET circuit pack. The 16-port analog line circuit pack requires an  
adapter cable to connect from 1 connector on the system to 2  
25-pair connectors on a 110-type terminal block. Two MET circuit  
packs require a concentrator cable to connect from 2 connectors on  
the system to one 25-pair connector on a 110-type terminal block.  
2. The yellow field (auxiliary field) terminates all 25-pair cables from the  
auxiliary cabinet and adjunct equipment cabinets. The yellow field is  
located in the lower right-hand corner of the distribution field.  
3. The white field (station field) terminates the station wiring. The white field  
indicates 3-pair station circuits (8 circuits per 25-pair cable) routed  
through a satellite closet.  
4. The blue field (station field) also terminates station wiring. The blue field  
indicates 3- and/or 4-pair station circuits (8 or 6 circuits, respectively, per  
25-pair cable). The fourth pair, of the 4-pair station circuit provides adjunct  
power from the cross-connect field on an as-needed basis to terminals  
within 250 feet (76 m) (wire length) of the MDF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Main Distribution Frame  
2
Page 2-4  
Main Distribution Frame  
The MDF is located directly behind the system cabinet. Figure 2-2 shows a  
typical installation using 900-pair 110P-type terminal blocks.  
mccmdf KLC 060596  
Figure Notes  
1. Multi-Carrier Cabinet  
5. Station Distribution Field  
6. Port Distribution Field  
7. Trunk/Auxiliary Field  
2. Z113A Cable Slack Manager  
3. 25-Pair Cable to System Cabinet  
4. Station Cables  
Figure 2-2. Typical 110A-Type Terminal Blocks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Installation Requirements  
2
Page 2-5  
Installation Requirements  
Sneak Fuse Panels and Emergency Transfer Units  
Approximately 8 inches (20 cm) of horizontal wall space is required for each  
column of sneak fuse panels. Up to 25 connector pairs can be protected by each  
panel. Horizontal wall space must also be provided for emergency transfer units.  
110-Type Hardware  
The trunk/auxiliary field and the distribution field are mounted on the same wall.  
Each 110P-type terminal block is 8.5 inches (21.6 cm) wide. Vertical patch cord  
troughs are 5.31 inches (13.4 cm) wide and horizontal patch cord troughs are 23  
inches (58.4 cm) wide.  
Each 110A-type terminal block is 10.81 inches (27.4 cm) wide; however, no  
horizontal patch cord troughs are used and the blocks are shorter than  
110P-type terminal blocks. This allows the 110A-type terminal blocks to be  
stacked. Therefore, the 110A-type hardware requires less space than the  
110P-type hardware on a per-station basis.  
Cable Slack Manager  
A Cable Slack Manager is 32 inches (81.3 cm) wide. The quantity of which is  
determined by dividing the total length of the MDF in inches (cm) by 32 (81.3). A  
partial number of 0.4 or less should be rounded down, and a partial number of  
0.5 or more should be rounded up (for example: 2.4 = 2 cable slack managers  
and 2.5 = 3 cable slack managers).  
NOTE:  
Cable clamps are required in installations with cable slack managers. At  
the rear of the cabinets, on each rear ground plate, install 2 cable clamps  
using the screws provided. These clamps hold the 25-pair input/output or  
MDF cables in place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-6  
Install Equipment and Cables  
Hardware Installation  
The following procedures assume 1 system technician is performing the  
installation. Procedures are provided for installing the following:  
Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
Cable Slack Managers  
Sneak Fuse Panels  
Labels for the Main Distribution Frame  
Install the Main Distribution Frame  
The preferred MDF location is directly behind the system cabinets.  
Wall Mounting 110A-Type Terminal Blocks  
The 110A-type hardware can be stacked in almost any arrangement at any  
height or location on the wall. One arrangement is shown in Figure 2-3. The  
distance between the mounting screw holes on the terminal blocks is 10.81  
inches (27.4 cm). If a vertical patch cord trough is used, the distance between  
the mounting screw holes is 5.31 inches (13.3 cm).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-7  
r758420b MMR 031496  
Figure Notes  
1. 4 Feet (1.22 m)  
2. 6.6 Feet (2 m)  
6. 47.5 Inches (120.6 cm)  
7. Horizontal Line  
8. AC Power Strip  
9. Floor Line  
3. 7.68 Inches (19.5 cm)  
4. 7/8-Inch (2.22 cm)  
5. 5.31 Inches (13.5 cm)  
Figure 2-3. 110A-Type Terminal Blocks (300-Pair)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-8  
Wall Mounting 110P-Type Terminal Blocks  
The first terminal block of the trunk/auxiliary field is aligned with the left side of  
the system cabinet. See Figure 2-4. This arrangement allows for growth on the  
right side of the MDF.  
r758421b MMR 031496  
Figure Notes  
1. 4 Feet (1.22 m)  
6. 7/8-Inch (2.22 cm)  
7. 23 Inches (58.4 cm)  
8. 8 Feet (2.43 m)  
9. AC Power Strip  
10. Floor Line  
2. Horizontal Line  
3. 7.68 Inches (19.5 cm)  
4. 47.5 Inches (120.6 cm)  
5. 5.31 Inches (13.5 cm)  
Figure 2-4.Dow11nl0oPad-TfroympeWTwewr.SmominaanulaBlsl.coocmk.sAl(l9M0a0n-uPaalsiSr)earch And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-9  
1. If you are installing 300-pair terminal blocks, draw a level horizontal line on  
the wall 47.5 inches (1.2 m) above the floor. See Figure 2-3.  
If you are installing 900-pair terminal blocks, draw a level horizontal line on  
the wall 23 inches (58.4 cm) above the floor. See Figure 2-4.  
2. To mount the first trunk/auxiliary field terminal block, partially install 2  
3/4-inch #12 wood screws, 7-11/16 inches (19.5 cm) apart on the left side  
of the horizontal line on the wall.  
3. Slide the bottom terminal block feet onto the mounting screws and mark  
the upper mounting screw locations.  
4. Remove the terminal block and partially install the upper mounting  
screws.  
5. Place the terminal block on the mounting screws and tighten the screws.  
6. If installing a vertical patch cord trough, partially install the first screw for  
the patch cord trough, on the line, 7/8-inch (2.2 cm) to the right of the  
previous screw. Partially install the second mounting screw 5.31 inches  
(13.5 cm) to the right of the screw just installed. Repeat Steps 3, 4, and 5.  
7. If another trunk/auxiliary field terminal block is to be installed, partially  
install the first screw for the terminal block, on the line, 7/8-inch (2.2 cm) to  
the right of the previous screw. Partially install the second mounting screw  
7-11/16 inches (19.5 cm) to the right of the screw just installed. Repeat  
Steps 3, 4, and 5.  
8. If a horizontal patch cord trough is to be installed, install it, on the line,  
between the trunk/auxiliary field and the distribution field.  
9. To install the first distribution field terminal block, partially install 2 3/4-inch,  
#12 wood screws, 7-11/16 inches (19.5 cm) apart on the line, to the right  
of the vertical patch cord trough. Repeat Steps 3, 4, and 5.  
10. If installing another distribution field terminal block, partially install the first  
screw for the terminal block, on the line, 7/8-inch (2.2 cm) to the right of  
the previous screw. Partially install the second mounting screw 7-11/16  
inches (19.5 cm) to right of the screw just installed. Repeat Steps 3, 4, and  
5.  
11. If installing a vertical patch cord trough in the distribution field, repeat Step  
6.  
12. Repeat Steps 10 and 11 until all the terminal blocks and vertical patch  
cord troughs in the distribution field are installed.  
Frame Mounting 110P-Type Terminal Blocks  
The 900-pair 110P-type terminal blocks and the associated patch cord troughs  
can also be mounted on a free-standing, floor-mounted 1110A2 Apparatus  
Mounting Frame. See Figure 2-5.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-10  
r781401 LJK 040896  
Figure Notes:  
1. 1110C1 Apparatus Mounting  
4. 88.5 Inches (225 cm)  
5. 43.5 Inches (110.5 cm)  
2. 1110A2 Apparatus Mounting  
3. 76 Inches (193 cm)  
Figure 2-5. 1110A2 and 1110C1 Apparatus Mountings  
Each 1110A2 provides the space to mount 5 terminal blocks/patch cord troughs  
on each side of the frame. A cable support structure, apparatus mounting  
1110C1, mounts directly on top of the 1110A2 and provides support for all  
cables routed to and from the frame.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Equipment and Cables  
2
Page 2-11  
Apparatus Mounting Frame Ordering Information  
Code Number  
1110A2  
Description  
Comcode  
Apparatus Mounting Frame 104032495  
1110C1  
Cable Support Assembly  
End Dress Panel  
104175120  
104176268  
104176276  
104176284  
1110A1  
2110A1  
Top Dress Panel  
2110B1  
Bottom Dress Panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Cable Slack Managers  
2
Page 2-12  
Install Cable Slack Managers  
1. Place the Z113A Cable Slack Manager against the wall under the MDF.  
See Figure 2-6. Align the left side of the cable slack manager with the first  
terminal block of the trunk/auxiliary field.  
2. Place the next cable slack manager beside the previously installed unit.  
Align the tabs and interlocks and snap the units together.  
3. Repeat Step 2 until all cable slack managers are installed.  
NOTE:  
Nine 1/4-inch holes (0.63 cm) are provided in a cable slack manager  
base if earthquake mounting is required. If a base is mounted on an  
uneven floor, shims may be required for leveling and to assure  
proper fit of the covers.  
Holes are provided in the sides of the base for bolting cable slack  
manager together. Bolts and shims must be obtained locally.  
4. The system cables will route through the cable slack manager as shown.  
Complete cable routing is covered later in this chapter.  
cbdfflr CJL 102396  
Figure Notes:  
1. System Cabinet  
2. Cable Slack Manager  
3. Cable Clamp  
4. Spare Center Troughs  
5. Cabinet Trough for Port Cables  
Figure 2-6. Cable Routing Through Cable Slack Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Sneak Fuse Panels  
2
Page 2-13  
Cable clamps are required in installations with cable slack managers. At the rear  
of the cabinets, install 2 cable clamps using the screws provided. These clamps  
hold the 25-pair input/output or MDF cables in place. Figure 2-6 shows cable  
clamp placement and cable routing.  
Install Sneak Fuse Panels  
Sneak current protection is required between the incoming RJ21X or RJ2GX  
network interface and the system for both trunk and off-premise circuit packs.  
The Model 507B sneak current fuse panel, or equivalent, is recommended for  
sneak current protection. See Figure 2-7. The panel contains two 25-pair  
connectors, fuse removal tool, and fifty 220029 Sneak Fuses (and 2 spares).  
B25A connector cables connect the network interface to the sneak fuse panel.  
Also, 157B connecting blocks equipped with SCP-110 protectors can be used  
for sneak current protection.  
Table 2-1. Sneak Fuse Panel Ordering Information  
Description  
Comcode  
157B Connecting Block  
SCP-110 Protector  
403613003  
406948976  
107435091  
407216316  
507B Sneak Current Fuse Panel  
220029 Sneak Current Fuse  
NOTE:  
Sneak current protectors with a rating of 350 mA at 600 Volts must be UL  
listed for domestic installation and CSA certified for Canadian installation.  
The 507B includes 52 sneak fuses and 2 cables and can be ordered using  
PEC code 63210.  
The SCP-110 protectors are used with 110-type hardware and on the 507B  
Sneak Fuse Panel. The SCP-110 Protectors can be ordered separately and  
installed on the 157B connecting block. Fifty protectors are required per  
block.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Sneak Fuse Panels  
2
Page 2-14  
Sneak  
Current  
Protector  
507B  
sneak CJL 032096  
Figure Notes:  
1. Sneak Fuse Panel  
3. 25-Pair Female Connector (Out)  
2. 25-Pair Male Connector (In)  
4. 220029 Fuses (Inside Panel). Use  
Small Screwdriver to Pry Top Cover Off  
Figure 2-7. Model 507B Sneak Fuse Panel  
1. Locate the 507B near the network interface or the MDF.  
2. Hold the panel against the mounting surface and mark the mounting  
screw locations. Drill pilot holes at the marked locations and partially  
install a locally obtained #12 x 3/4-inch screw into the 2 bottom mounting  
slots.  
3. Slide the sneak fuse panel onto the mounting screws and tighten the  
screws securely.  
4. Install a locally obtained #12 x 3/4-inch screw into the top 2 mounting slots  
and tighten securely.  
5. Repeat the procedure for each sneak fuse panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Sneak Fuse Panels  
2
Page 2-15  
Tab le 2-2 is a pinout of the cable wiring and associated fuse numbers.  
Table 2-2. Sneak Fuse Connector Pinout  
Connector  
Pin  
Numbers  
Pair/Fuse  
Number  
26/1  
1
27/2  
2
28/3  
3
29/4  
4
30/5  
5
31/6  
6
32/7  
7
33/8  
8
34/9  
9
35/10  
36/11  
37/12  
38/13  
39/14  
40/15  
41/16  
42/17  
43/18  
44/19  
45/20  
46/21  
47/22  
48/23  
49/34  
50/25  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
6. Secure the top of each B25A cable with the captive screw on the  
connector.  
7. Secure the bottom of each cable with a supplied cable tie wrap.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-16  
Cable Installation  
Labels  
The purple port label shown in Figure 2-8 is installed on both ends of the 25-pair  
cables connecting to the trunk/auxiliary field and/or distribution field.  
The top blue/yellow building and floor labels are for cables connecting from the  
equipment room to a site/satellite location on another floor or in another building.  
The yellow label is for auxiliary circuits connecting to the trunk/auxiliary field. The  
bottom blue/yellow label is for 25-pair cables connecting to site/satellite closets.  
1 A 2  
A
labels LJK 060396  
Figure Notes:  
1. Purple Label (Port Cable)  
3. Yellow Label (Auxiliary)  
2. Blue/Yellow Label (Building and  
Floor)  
4. Blue/Yellow Label (Site or Satellite)  
Figure 2-8. Equipment Room Cabling Labels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-17  
Tab le 2-3 details the label name and range of each label.  
Table 2-3. Equipment Room Labels  
Label Name  
Range  
Port Cable  
1A1-1A20, 1B1-1B20, 1C1-1C20,  
1D1-1D20, 1E1-1E20  
Building  
Field Identified  
Floor  
Field Identified  
Auxiliary Cable  
Site or Satellite  
Field Identified  
A-F and/or Field Identified  
Cable/Connector/Building Label Ordering Information  
Description  
Quantity  
Comcode  
201A Labels  
34 Sheets  
103969994  
Figure 2-9 shows the proper way to install a label on a 25-pair cable connector.  
Install the label near the rear of the connector so it is not obscured by the cabinet  
connector retainers. It can also be installed on the skin of the cable near the  
connector.  
Figure 2-9. Self-Stick Label on 25-Pair Cable Connector  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-18  
Cable Routing Guidelines  
General  
The following guidelines should be used when installing the equipment room  
cabling. Following these guidelines will maximize use of the cable slack  
managers and make future cabling additions and changes easier.  
Figure 2-10 and Figure 2-11 show typical cable routing from the cabinet to the  
top and bottom of the MDF, respectively.  
r758424b MMR 052996  
Figure Notes:  
1. Main Distribution Frame  
6. Cable Slack Manager Number 2  
7. Cable Slack Manager Number 3  
8. System Cabinet(s)  
2. AC Power Cord (AC-Powered  
Cabinets Only)  
3. Cable Slack Manager Number 1  
4. Trunk/Auxiliary Field  
9. To Building Cables  
2
10. 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) Wire to  
5. Station Distribution Field  
Coupled Bonding Conductor  
Figure 2-10. Cable Routing to Top Terminal Blocks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-19  
r758432b MMR 052996  
Figure Notes:  
1. Main Distribution Frame  
6. Cable Slack Manager Number 2  
7. Cable Slack Manager Number 3  
8. System Cabinet(s)  
2. AC Power Cord (AC-Powered  
Cabinets Only)  
3. Cable Slack Manager Number 1  
4. Trunk/Auxiliary Field  
9. Building Cables (Through Cable  
Trough)  
2
5. Station Distribution Field  
10. 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) Wire to  
Coupled Bonding Conductor  
Figure 2-11. Cable Routing to Bottom Terminal Blocks  
Route Cables to Main Distribution Frame  
The following guidelines should be followed when routing cables from the  
cabinet to the MDF.  
Each port cable is connected at the cabinet and then routed along the  
front trough of the cable slack manager to the connecting/terminal block  
where the cable is to be terminated.  
Enough slack must be left at the cabinet end of the cable to allow for  
proper dressing of the cables.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-20  
Route the cable from the cabinet to the wall. Place the cable beside 1 of  
the rows of columns in the cable slack manager.  
NOTE:  
Retainers mounted on the columns keep the cable from protruding  
above the top of the base of the cable slack manager.  
Determine the length of the cable required to reach from the cable slack  
manager to the assigned connecting/terminal block.  
The cable must be supported on the wall using “D” rings.  
Cable slack is stored by coiling the cable around the columns in the cable  
slack manager. The first run should always go across the full length of the  
5 columns in the cable slack manager.  
Connect the cable to the assigned connecting/terminal block.  
Avoid placing copper cables where they may bend or strain fiber optic  
cables.  
Install Control Carrier Outputs Cable  
A connector on the rear of the Control Carrier is labeled AUX. A 25-pair cable  
connects the AUX connector to a 110-type terminal block in the yellow field of  
the trunk/auxiliary field. The AUX connector outputs include the following:  
Alarm monitoring for the processor interface  
7 DC power (-48 VDC) sources for emergency transfer units  
3 DC power (-48 VDC) sources for remotely powering a total of 3 attendant  
consoles or executive voice terminal adjuncts  
The remote maintenance internal modem connection location  
Access to a relay contact is available to actuate a light, bell, or similar type  
customer-supplied device. The relay can be administered to make contact  
when a major, minor, or warning alarm condition occurs in the system  
Label Control Carrier Cable  
Place the appropriate AUX connector label on the assigned 110-type terminal  
block row. On the control carrier cable, place a yellow auxiliary label on the  
connectors at each end of the cable. Write “AUX” on each label.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-21  
Connect Control Carrier Outputs Cable  
Plug the connector cable in the AUX connector on the rear of the Control Carrier.  
Route the connector cable through the cable slack manager to the assigned  
110-type terminal block in the yellow field of the trunk/auxiliary field.  
Install Trunk Cables Among Network Interface,  
Sneak Fuse Panel, and Cabinet  
The 1-pair of Central Office (CO) trunks are installed by the network provider in  
the green field. Up to 24 pairs may be terminated on each row of the 110-type  
terminal block. Tie trunks also appear in the green field with up to eight 3-pair  
trunks terminated on each row of the 110-type terminal block.  
Select Concentrator Cables  
WP-90929, List 1 and 3 concentrator cables can be used to connect the cabinet  
to the 110-type terminal blocks in the purple field. The 1-pair patch cords/jumper  
wires are then run from the purple terminal block rows to the green terminal block  
rows in order to establish the correct 3-pair modularity.  
Connect Trunk Pairs Using Concentrator Cables  
Figure 2-12 shows trunk pairs connected to the cabinet with concentrator cables.  
To install the cables:  
1. Connect B25A cables between the network interface and sneak fuse  
panels.  
2. Connect A25D cables from the sneak fuse panels to the 110-type terminal  
block connectors in the green field.  
3. Connect patch cords/jumper wires from the terminal block in the green  
field to the associated terminal block in the purple field.  
4. Connect the single-fingered end of the concentrator cables to the  
110-type terminal block connectors in the purple field in Step 3.  
5. Connect the other end (2/3-fingered end) of the concentrator cables to the  
appropriate carrier slots. Equipped carrier slots are identified on the CSD.  
Mark the nomenclature strips above the carriers to identify the slots.  
6. Label connectors on each end of the cables that connect to the cabinet.  
7. Route the cables down the sides of the cabinet and store the excess  
cable slack in the cable slack manager as previously described.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-22  
NEW796 THC 031296  
Figure Notes:  
1. Trunk/Auxiliary Field  
7. RJ21X/RJ2GX Network Interface  
8. Sneak Fuse Panel  
2. To Control Carrier AUX Connector  
3. Concentrator Cable (WP90929, List 1) 9. B25A Cable  
4. Concentrator Cable (WP90929, List 3) 10. Central Office Trunks  
5. A25D (Male-to-Male) Cable  
6. Alternate Block/Rows  
11. System Cabinet  
Figure 2-12. Connect Trunk Pairs Using Concentrator Cables  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-23  
Connect Trunk Pairs to Cabinet Using Jumper  
Wires To Establish 3-Pair Modularity  
Figure 2-13 on page 2-23 and Figure 2-14 on page 2-24 show trunk pairs  
connected to the cabinet with jumper wires to establish 3-pair modularity.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16  
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
1
4
7
10 13 16 19 22  
1
4
7
10 13 16 19 22  
1
4 7 10 13 16 19 22  
r758425b MMR 031496  
Figure Notes:  
1. Green Field  
2. 1-Pair Jumpers  
3. Pairs  
4. Purple Field  
Figure 2-13. 3-Pair Modularity for Trunk Pairs for 1-Pair Trunks  
To connect the trunk pairs to the purple field:  
1. Connect B25A cables between the network interface and the sneak fuse  
panels. See Figure 2-13.  
2. Connect A25D/B25A cables from the sneak fuse panels to the 110-type  
terminal block-type connecting block connectors in the green field.  
3. Connect 1-pair patch cords/jumper wires from each 110-type terminal  
block row in the green field to the 110-type terminal block rows in the  
purple field for 1-pair Central Office (CO) trunks or in Figure 2-14 on page  
2-24 for 3-pair tie trunks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-24  
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12  
r758537b MMR 031496  
Figure Notes:  
1. Green Field  
2. 1-Pair Jumpers  
3. Pairs  
4. Purple Field  
Figure 2-14. 3-Pair Modularity for Trunk Pairs for 3-Pair Tie Trunks  
Install Cables Between Cabinet and MDF  
1. Install “D” rings on the wall between the cable slack manager and the  
terminal/connecting blocks mounted on the MDF.  
2. Install a self-adhesive port label on the back of each connector on the  
connector cable. Labels should be positioned so they are not covered by  
the cabinet connector retainers.  
3. At the rear of the cabinet, connect 1 end of the connector cable to the  
assigned connector.  
4. Route the cable down the rear of the cabinet, through the cable slack  
manager, and to the MDF.  
5. At the MDF, connect the other end of the cable to the assigned terminal/  
connecting block connector.  
6. Store the cable slack in the cable slack manager.  
7. RepDeoawtnSlotaedpfrsom2Wthwrwo.uSgomha6nuualns.tcilomal.lAcllaMbalneusalsaSreeairnchstAanldleDdo.wnload.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Cable Installation  
2
Page 2-25  
Install Connector Cables Between Auxiliary  
Cabinet and MDF  
Auxiliary equipment that connects to the MDF can be mounted inside the  
Auxiliary cabinet. The equipment connects to an ED-1E1443-10 (Group 1)  
intraconnection panel mounted in the cabinet. This intraconnection panel  
consists of a 110-type 100-pair wiring block. Auxiliary equipment is connected to  
the 110-type wiring block. The wiring block is pre-wired to four 25-pair female  
connectors mounted on the outside rear of the cabinet.  
1. Install “D” rings on the wall between the cable slack manager and the  
terminal/connecting blocks mounted on the MDF.  
2. Install a self-sticking port label on the rear of each connector on the B25A  
connector cable. See Figure 2-9 on page 2-17.  
NOTE:  
Labels should be positioned so they will not be obscured by the  
cabinet connector retainers.  
3. At the rear of the Auxiliary cabinet, connect 1 end of the connector cable  
to the assigned connector.  
4. Route the cable down the rear of the cabinet and through the cable slack  
manager to the MDF.  
5. At the MDF, connect the other end of the cable to the assigned  
terminal/connecting block connector.  
6. Store the excess cable in the cable slack manager.  
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 6 until all cables are installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Coupled Bonding Conductor  
2
Page 2-26  
Install Coupled Bonding Conductor  
The Coupled Bonding Conductor (CBC) connects to the single-point ground  
block and runs adjacent to pairs in an associated telecommunications cable.  
See Figure 2-15. The mutual coupling between the CBC and the wire pairs  
reduces potential differences in terminating equipment.  
2
The conductor consists of a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire tie-wrapped to the inside  
wiring cable and terminated at the CBC terminal bar at the MDF. Maintain a  
minimum of 12 inches (30.5 cm) spacing between the CBC and other power and  
ground leads.  
2
The 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire must be long enough to reach the  
telecommunications cables at the rear of the system cabinets, follow these  
cables to the MDF, and to terminate at the CBC.  
2
1. Cut a 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire long enough to reach from the system’s  
single-point ground block or DC power cabinet ground discharge bar to  
the MDF CBC block.  
2
2. Connect 1 end of the 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire to the single-point  
ground block (or ground discharge bar).  
3. Route the wire next to the 25-pair cables connecting to the trunk/auxiliary  
(purple) field.  
2
4. Tie wrap the 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire to the 25-pair cables.  
2
5. Connect the 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) wire to the MDF CBC ground block.  
6. Repeat the above steps for each CBC ground wire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Install Coupled Bonding Conductor  
2
Page 2-27  
cbc_gnd_1 PDH 062696  
Figure Notes:  
1. 25-Pair Tip & Ring Cables to  
8. To Network Cabinets  
Cabinets  
9. Battery Plant Ground Discharge Bar  
for Single-Point Ground  
2. Coupled Bonding Conductor (CBC)  
Terminal Block  
10. Cross-Connect Ground Block  
11. Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
3. Tie Wraps  
4. Cable Shield or Six Spare Pairs  
12. To Other Cross-Connect Ground  
Blocks  
5. Ground on Carbon Block Protector  
or Equivalent  
13. Approved Ground  
6. Trunk Cable to Network Interface  
14. Coupled Bonding Conductor (CBC)  
2
7. 10 AWG (#25) (6 mm ) Wire  
Figure 2-15. Coupled Bonding Conductor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Station Wiring Design  
2
Page 2-28  
Station Wiring Design  
The following hardware and cabling is used:  
Information outlets (modular wall jacks)  
Station Cables  
Closets  
— Site locations  
— Satellite locations  
Adapters  
Labels  
A brief description of each of the above listed items follows. Ordering information  
is not provided for station cables and information outlets.  
Information Outlets  
Information outlets are 8-pin modular wall jacks. Most of the outlets are wired with  
push-on connections. Information outlets are also available that connect to a  
double modular plug-ended 4-pair station cable routed from the MDF, a  
site/satellite location, or an adapter.  
Station Cables  
For clarity, a station cable is either a 25-pair cable, multiple 25-pair cable, or  
4-pair D-inside wire (DIW) run from the equipment room, site/satellite location, or  
adapter to the information outlets. The following station cables are available. See  
Figure 2-16.  
25-pair station cable Use between the equipment room and site/ satellite  
locations or adapters. Use an A25D cable (male to male) between the equipment  
room and satellite closet. Use a B25A cable between the equipment room and  
site closet or adapter.  
Multiple 25-pair station cable Use between the equipment room and  
site/satellite locations or adapters. This cable consists of individually sheathed  
25-pair cables with a factory-installed 25-pair connector on each end. Use a  
male to female cable to connect between the equipment room and site location  
or adapter. Use a male to male cable to connect between the equipment room  
and satellite location. Staggered-finger cables are recommended for all multiple  
25-pair station cables and are available in both double-ended and single-ended  
types.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Station Wiring Design  
2
Page 2-29  
Single modular plug-ended 4-pair station cable Use this cable between  
adapters and information outlets that require push-on connections. It can also be  
used when 4-pair station cables are field- terminated on the 110-type terminal  
blocks in the equipment room or satellite closet and modularly connected to  
information outlets. The station cables are available in the following lengths:  
— 10 feet (3.05 m)  
— 25 feet (7.62 m)  
— 50 feet (15.24 m)  
— 75 feet (22.86 m)  
— 100 feet (30.5 m)  
— 150 feet (45.72 m)  
— 200 feet (61 m)  
NOTE:  
If more than 200 feet (61 m) of 4-pair station cable is required, a  
451A in-line adapter (double-ended modular female connector) is  
attached to the cable and a second 4-pair cable of the required  
length is plugged into the adapter. See Figure 2-16.  
Double modular plug-ended 4-pair station cable Use this cable to provide  
nonstandard length runs between adapters and information outlets with push-on  
connections. It can also be used between adapters and modularly connected  
information outlets. It is available in the same lengths as the single modular  
plug-ended cable.  
Bulk Cable Same as the 25-pair cable or multiple 25-pair cable; however, the  
bulk cable is not equipped with connectors. Use this cable between the  
equipment room and satellite closets when both are equipped with punch-down  
type terminal/connecting blocks.  
4-pair station cable Use this cable when 4-pair station cables are to be  
field-terminated on the 110-type terminal blocks in the equipment room or  
satellite closet and the information outlets require push-on connections.  
451A Adapter Ordering Information  
Color  
Gray  
Ivory  
Comcode  
103942272  
103786240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Station Wiring Design  
2
Page 2-30  
1
2
5
3
4
5
crdfad1 CJL 101596  
Figure Notes:  
1. Station Cable  
2. Information Outlet  
4. 258A Adapter  
5. 4-Pair Station Cable  
3. 451A In-Line Adapter  
Figure 2-16. Example of Extending 4-Pair Station Cables  
Closets  
Site Locations  
Site locations are closets that provide a point in the station wiring for the  
administration of remote powering. Adapters are used at site locations to  
terminate the 25-pair station cables and provide connection points (modular  
jacks) for power adapters and 4-pair station cables.  
The 258A and BR2580A adapters plug into a 25-pair female cable connector.  
These adapters divide the 25-pair cable into six 4-pair (modular jack) circuits.  
See Figure 2-17.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Station Wiring Design  
2
Page 2-31  
1
2
3
4
4
crdfadp CJL 101596  
Figure Notes:  
1. BR2580A Adapter  
2. 258A Adapter  
3. 25-Pair Male Ribbon Connector  
4. 4-Pair Modular Jacks (8 Pins)  
Figure 2-17. 258A and BR2580A Adapters  
The 356A adapter plugs into a 25-pair female cable connector. See Figure 2-18.  
The 356A adapter divides the 25-pair cable into eight 3-pair circuits. Although  
the circuits are 3-pair, the adapters modular jacks will accept the 8-wide modular  
plug used on the 4-pair station cable.  
!
CAUTION:  
Adapters wired similarly to the 356A should not be used. Their jacks do not  
accept 4-pair plugs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Station Wiring Design  
2
Page 2-32  
1
2
crdf356 CJL 101296  
Figure Notes:  
1. 356A Adapter  
2. 4-Pair Modular Jacks (6 pins each,  
connected to 25-pair ribbon connector)  
Figure 2-18. 356A Adapter  
Use the ZD8AJ adapter to connect a Multi-button Electronic Telephone (MET)  
line cord to an information outlet. The adapter interchanges pairs 3 and 4 to  
correspond with the pair assignments for the telephone. The line cord plugs into  
the adapter, and then the adapter plugs into an information outlet.  
Adapter Ordering Information  
Description  
Comcode  
258A Adapter  
BR2580A Adapter  
356A Adapter  
400B Adapter  
400B2 Adapter  
ZD8AJ Adapter  
102605136  
403384720  
104158829  
103848859  
104152558  
103881421  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-33  
Satellite Locations  
Satellite locations are closets that provide an administration point (using  
cross-connect equipment) for station cables and where adjunct power may be  
applied. The station cable circuits from the equipment room MDF are 3-pair. At  
the satellite location, 4-pair circuits run to the information outlets. The hardware  
used is 110-type terminal blocks.  
Satellite Locations Using 110-Type Hardware  
Each terminal block has a 3-pair (white field) and a 4-pair (blue field) located on  
the same terminal block.  
The 110A-type terminal block that can be used is the 110AE1-75FT. It must be  
field-terminated to both the white and blue fields.  
The 300-pair 110P-type terminal blocks that can be used are:  
110PE1-300CT/FT 25-pair connector on the white field and  
field-terminated on the blue field  
110PE1-300FT Field-terminated on both the white and blue fields  
The 900-pair 110P-type terminal blocks that can be used are:  
110PE1-900CT/FT 25-pair connector on the white field and  
field-terminated on the blue field  
110PE1-900FT Field-terminated on both the white and blue fields  
Station Circuit Distribution from  
Equipment Room  
This section explains the station circuit distribution from the equipment room to  
the information outlets for new wiring installations. Example connection diagrams  
are provided to show the options for running and connecting the station cables.  
If most of the telephones/voice terminals that require remote powering are within  
250 feet (76.2 m) of the equipment room, 4-pair station circuits are run from the  
equipment room to the information outlets. If this is not the case, or if the  
customer requires 2-point administration, 3-pair station circuits are run from the  
equipment room to satellite locations. Then, the 4-pair station circuits are run  
from the satellite locations to the information outlets.  
A list of voice and data terminals that can be connected to the system is  
provided in Table 2-4 on page 2-40. A list of administration terminals that can be  
connected to the system is provided in Table 2-5 on page 2-44.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-34  
4-Pair Station Circuits  
Four-pair circuits can be run directly from an equipment room MDF to a 258A or  
BR2580A adapter as shown in Figure 2-19. The 4-pair station cables connect the  
adapter to the information outlets.  
1
2
3
7
6
4
8
8
10  
11  
12  
13  
9
12  
r764797a CJL 031396  
Figure Notes:  
1. Part of Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
2. 3-Pair Connecting Blocks  
3. 4-Pair Connecting Blocks  
4. Purple Field  
8. B25A Cable  
9. Connectorized (Staggered  
Finger) Multiple 25-Pair Cable  
10. 258A or BR2580A Adapter  
11. Information Outlet  
12. 4-Pair Circuit  
5. Blue Field  
6. Patch Cord or Cross-Connect Jumpers  
13. DIW Station Cable (D-Inside  
Wire)  
7. To System Cabinet (Three-Pair  
Modularity)  
Figure 2-19. 4-Pair Circuit Distribution and Connectivity  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-35  
The 4-pair station cables can be run directly from the equipment room to the  
information outlets if 4-pair terminal blocks are used in the distribution field. See  
Figure 2-20. The station cables must be field-terminated on the 110-type terminal  
blocks.  
2
1
5
2
4
3
r764798a CJL 030796  
Figure Notes:  
1. Station Side of MDF or Satellite  
Location  
3. Blue Field  
4. DIW Station Cable (D-Inside Wire)  
5. Information Outlet  
2. 4-Pair Circuit  
Figure 2-20. 4-Pair Run to Equipment Room or Satellite Location  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-36  
If 110-type terminal blocks are used with a modular plug-ended station cable, an  
adapter can be connected directly to the 110-type terminal block connectors.  
See Figure 2-21.  
1
9
3
2
8
11  
7
10  
5
6
4
r758532a CJL 031196  
Figure Notes:  
1. Part of MDF  
7. To System Cabinet (3 pair  
modularity)  
2. 3-Pair Connecting Blocks  
3. 4-Pair Connecting Blocks  
4. Purple Field  
8. A25D Cable  
9. 258A or BR2580A Adapter  
10. Information Outlet  
5. Patch Cord or Cross-Connect Jumpers  
6. Blue Field  
11. 4-Pair Circuit (DIW station  
cable (D-Inside Wire))  
Figure 2-21. 4-Pair Run to Equipment Room or Satellite Location  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-37  
3-Pair to 4-Pair Station Circuit Distribution  
Figure 2-22 shows the 3-pair circuit distribution from an equipment room MDF to  
a satellite location using 110-type hardware. Four-pair circuits are distributed  
from the satellite location to the information outlets.  
1
2
3
6
8
9
7
15  
3
4
2
10  
12  
13  
16  
14  
8
4
11  
Figure Notes:  
1. Part of MDF  
9. Connectorized (staggered finger)  
Multiple 25-Pair Cable  
2. 3-Pair Connecting Blocks  
3. Purple Field  
10. 4-Pair Connecting Blocks  
11. Blue Field  
4. White Field  
12. 258A or BR2580A Adapter  
13. Information Outlet  
5. Patch Cord or Cross-Connect  
Jumpers  
6. To System Cabinet (3 Pair Modularity) 14. 4-Pair Circuit [DIW Station Cable  
(D-Inside Wire)]  
7. A25D Cable (3-Pair Circuits)  
15. Part of Satellite Location  
8. B25A Cable  
16. 4-Pair Circuits (B25A Cable)  
Figure 2-22. 3-Pair to 4-Pair Satellite Location Connectivity  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Station Circuit Distribution from Equipment Room  
Page 2-38  
Three-pair circuits can also be run directly from the equipment room MDF to a  
356A adapter as shown in Figure 2-23. Four-pair station cables connect the  
adapter to the information outlets. Four-pair station cables can be run directly  
from a satellite location to the information outlets as previously described.  
1
2
2
9
8
7
10  
6
11  
12  
5
3
4
r758533a CJL 031196  
Figure Notes:  
1. Part of Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
2. 3-Pair Connecting Blocks  
3. Purple Field  
7. B25A Cable  
8. 3-Pair Circuits  
9. 356A Adapter  
10. Information Outlet  
4. Blue Field  
5. Patch Cord or Cross-Connect Jumpers 11. 3-Pair Circuit in 4-Pair Wire  
6. To System Cabinet (3-Pair Modularity)  
12. DIW Station Cable (D-Inside  
Wire)  
Figure 2-23. 3-Pair to 4-Pair Circuit Distribution and Connectivity  
NOTE:  
Bridged taps are not allowed on any part of the station wiring.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Layout  
2
Page 2-39  
Layout  
Locate Information Outlets  
The customer or marketing representative must provide floor plans showing the  
information outlet locations and types (flush- or surface-mounted) required. The  
floor plans must also show a complete overview of all conduit and cabling  
facilities in the building.  
Locate Satellites and Sites  
Use the following information when determining site, satellite, or adapter  
locations.  
a. Keep the number of locations to a minimum.  
b. To minimize the station wiring distances, centrally locate the  
sites/satellites, or adapters among the information outlets.  
c. Site/satellite locations must be easily accessible and contain AC-powered  
receptacles.  
Adapter Requirements  
One 258A/BR2580A adapter is required for each 25-pair station cable containing  
4-pair station circuits. One 356A adapter is required for each 25-pair station  
cable containing 3-pair station circuits.  
Hardware Requirements  
Hardware requirements are the same as for the equipment room.  
Sizing 4-Pair Station Cables  
Use the scale of the floor plan to determine the approximate length of the station  
cables required per the standard SYSTIMAX wiring concepts.  
Sizing 25-Pair and Multiple 25-Pair Station  
Cables  
Use the scale of the floor plan to determine the approximate length of each  
25-pair station cable. The cables must be selected and properly sized to make  
maximum use of the hardware at the equipment room or satellite location.  
Use 25-pair B25A cables to connect adapters directly to the MDF or satellite  
location. Staggered-finger cables, equipped with factory-installed 25-pair  
connectors at both ends, should be used when multiple 25-pair cables are used  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Voice and Data Terminals  
2
Page 2-40  
between the equipment room or satellite location and the adapters. B25A cables  
are required at the equipment room or satellite location to connect the  
staggered-finger cables to the 110-type terminal blocks.  
Use the following information to determine the cable size (cable pairs) required  
for either 3-pair or 4-pair circuits. Note the length and size on the floor plan to aid  
in the ordering and installation of the station cables.  
3-Pair Station Cable Circuits  
To determine the size of station cables containing 3-pair circuits, multiply the  
number of 3-pair circuits required at the satellite location by 3.5. Then, using the  
minimum size cable requirement, round up the cable size requirement to the next  
highest available cable bundle size. This will provide additional pairs for growth  
and compensate for every twenty-fifth pair in a cable that is not used.  
4-Pair Station Cable Circuits  
To determine the size of station cables containing 4-pair circuits, find out how  
many information outlets are served by the equipment room MDF or satellite  
location MDF. Multiply the number of information outlets by 4. Then, using the  
minimum size cable requirement, round up the cable size requirement to the next  
highest available cable bundle size.  
NOTE:  
This formula may not compensate for the unused twenty-fifth pair in all  
cases. If not, it must be allowed for.  
Voice and Data Terminals  
The system can connect to all DTE terminals and have RS-232 (or EIA-232) or  
DCP interfaces. Tab le 2-4 lists some of the terminals that can connect to the  
system. Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Table 2-4. Voice and Data Terminals  
Station Type  
Type  
Analog sets:  
Analog voice  
500, 2500, 7101A, 7103A, 7104A, 8110, DS1SA, and  
DS1FD  
1
Other Analog Ports , Wired Spare Ports, and Non-wired Analog voice  
Spare Ports  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Voice and Data Terminals  
2
Page 2-41  
Table 2-4. Voice and Data Terminals Continued  
Station Type  
Type  
10MET set — 10 buttons  
20MET set — 20 buttons  
30MET set — 30 buttons  
Voice  
Terminal — 510 BCT  
Terminal — 515 BCT  
Data  
602A1 Callmaster I  
603A1 Callmaster II  
603D1 Callmaster III  
603E1 Callmaster III  
606A1 Callmaster IV  
Data and voice  
Digital set — 6402  
Digital voice  
Digital set — 6408  
Digital set — 6408D  
Digital set — 6408D+  
Digital set — 6416D+  
Digital set — 6416D+w/XM24B expansion module  
Digital set — 6424D+  
Digital set — 6424D+w/XM24B expansion module  
Voice/data — 6538  
Data and voice  
Hybrid voice  
Hybrid set — 7303S  
Hybrid set — 7305S  
Hybrid set — 7309H  
Hybrid set — 7313H  
Hybrid set — 7314H  
Hybrid set — 7315H  
Hybrid set — 7316H  
Hybrid set — 7317H  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Voice and Data Terminals  
2
Page 2-42  
Table 2-4. Voice and Data Terminals Continued  
Station Type  
Type  
Digital set — 7401D/7401+  
Digital set — 7403D  
Digital voice  
Digital set — 7404D  
Digital set — 7404D w/display  
Digital set — 7405D  
Digital set — 7405D w/display  
Digital set — 7405D w/cov  
Digital set — 7406D  
Digital set — 7406D w/display  
Digital set — 7406+  
Digital set — 7406+ w/display  
Digital set — 7407D  
Digital set — 7407+  
Digital set — 7410D  
Digital set — 7410+  
Digital set — 7434D  
Digital set — 7434D w/display  
Digital set — 7434D w/call coverage module  
Digital set — 7444D  
Digital set — 8403B  
Digital voice  
Digital set — 8405B/B+  
Digital set — 8405D/D+  
Digital set — 8410B  
Digital set — 8410D  
Digital set — 8411B  
Digital set — 8411D  
Digital set — 8434 D  
Digital set — 8434 with XM24B Expansion Module  
Digital set — 9403B  
Digital set — 9410D  
Digital set — 9434D  
Basic attendant console (302A, 302B)  
Enhanced attendant console (302C)  
Attendant selector console (26B1)  
Data and voice  
BRI voice  
ISDN-BRI  
— 7505D  
— 7506D  
— 7507D  
— 8503D  
— 8510T w/display  
— 8520T w/display  
2
Voice  
Wireless 9601A  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Voice and Data Terminals  
2
Page 2-43  
Table 2-4. Voice and Data Terminals Continued  
Station Type  
Type  
3
ADJLK  
Voice  
ADX8D  
ADX16A  
ADX16D  
ASAI  
CP9530  
DIG800  
K2500  
MDC9000  
MDW9000  
PC  
4
VMI  
Voice  
4
VMIFD  
4
VMISA  
5
VRU  
VRUFD  
VRUSA  
WCBRI  
105TL  
1. Includes music-on-hold, recorded announcement, and loudspeaker paging.  
2. The radio controller supports 24 simultaneous calls and 2 wireless fixed bases.  
3. Needs ASAI interface and ASAI prop adjunct links turned on in “system-parameters  
customer options.”  
4. Turn on mode code in ”system-parameters customer options.”  
5. Needs DTMF turned on in “system-parameters customer options.”  
The following notes apply to the button and data module records in Table 2-4:  
Any DCP station (except 8400-series) can add a 7400B, requiring 1 data  
module record.  
A data module can be added to a 7403D or 7405D, requiring 1 data  
module record.  
A data module (ADM-T) can be added to a 7505D, 7506D, or 7507D,  
requiring 1 data module record.  
An ISDN-BRI endpoint record is required for each distinct ISDN-BRI  
endpoint. Thus each voice-only, data-only, or voice-data endpoint uses 1  
of these records.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Label the Main Distribution Frame  
2
Page 2-44  
Administration Terminals  
Tab le 2-5 lists the administration terminals that can be connected to the system.  
Table 2-5. Administration Terminals  
Administration Terminal  
Application  
510D  
Remote administration  
1
610D, 513, 610, 615, 715 BCT,  
4410, 4425, and VT220  
Management Terminal: administration and  
general purpose  
515 Business Communications  
Terminal (BCT)  
Remote administration, general purpose  
615 Management Terminal  
Management Terminal system  
administration and maintenance terminal  
715 BCS, 2900/715 BCS, and 715 Management Terminal system  
BCS-2 Management Terminal  
administration and maintenance terminal  
1. The keyboards and terminals are interchangeable when an adapter cable is used.  
NOTE:  
The 715 BCS (406803148 and 406803155), has a 6-pin mini-DIN keyboard  
connector. The 2900/715 BCS (4073113881 and 407313899), has a 6-pin  
RJ-11 keyboard jack located on the side of the terminal.  
Label the Main Distribution Frame  
Figure 2-24 shows the graphic symbols used on labels for the system,  
cross-connections, information outlets, and cables. The labels are color-coded to  
identify system wiring:  
Green To Central Office (CO)  
Purple To system ports  
Yellow To auxiliary equipment and miscellaneous system leads  
Blue To information outlets  
White From Main Distribution Frame to satellite locations (3-pair)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and Administration  
Page 2-45  
r758422i LJK 050996  
Figure Notes:  
1. Write Floor or Building Identification on  
Label  
5. Information Outlet  
6. Site/Satellite Closet  
7. Tie Circuit  
2. Cabinet  
3. Carrier  
4. Slot  
8. Floor  
9. Building  
Figure 2-24. Label Graphic Symbols and Nomenclature  
Each 110-type label identifies 2 rows on the 110-type terminal block. The upper  
half identifies the row above it and the lower half identifies the row below it. The  
labels are inserted into the clear plastic designation strips furnished with the  
110-type terminal blocks. The strip is snapped in place between the terminal  
block rows. Label code number 220A (comcode 103970000) contains all of the  
110-type labels.  
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and  
Administration  
Before starting the patch cord installation, obtain a copy of the Port Assignment  
Record forms from the customer or marketing representative. See Figure 2-25.  
These forms contain the port assignments and identify the extension numbers  
(Terminal No.) of the telephones/voice terminals. Enter the jack assignments at  
the equipment room and indicate if adjunct power is required and where it is  
provided (MDF, site/satellite closet, or information outlet).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and Administration  
Page 2-46  
PORT ASSIGNMENT RECORD  
CARRIER  
Page  
Extension  
Number  
Voice  
Terminal  
Voice  
Te rm in al  
Adjunct  
Bldg  
Flr  
Rm  
Slot  
Port Jack* Old New  
Type  
Color  
Module  
Power*  
User Name/Use  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
Slot  
13  
14  
CKT PK 15  
Type  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
* To be completed by installation technician  
r764787 PDH 071596  
Figure 2-25. Port Assignment Record Form  
When satellite locations are provided, enter the satellite letter designation (“A”  
through “F”) and the jack appearance in the equipment room on the form. Also,  
enter the floor designation and/or building designation if appropriate. For 1-point  
administration, this entry is all that is required.  
Labeling  
The white label identifying the terminal block row associated with circuits 17 to 24  
connects to an identically labeled terminal block row at the satellite closet. See  
Figure 2-26. This is always the case for either 1-point or 2-point administration.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and Administration  
Page 2-47  
crdf5pr CJL 103096  
Figure Notes:  
1. Equipment Room  
8. D-Inside Wire Cut Down to  
Connecting Block  
2. Satellite Location  
9. 258A Adapter  
10. Information Outlet  
11. Voice Terminal  
3. Work Location  
4. White Row on 110 Terminal Block  
5. Purple Row on 110 Terminal Block  
6. Blue Row on 110 Terminal Block  
7. Central Location for Terminals 1 through 6  
12. To Port Connector on Cabinet  
(Cabinet 1, Carrier A, Slot 03)  
Figure 2-26. Example 3-Pair Labeling to Information Outlet  
The satellite symbol must be installed at all connection points between the blue  
field and the information outlet. It must also be installed at the information outlet  
itself.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
2
Patch Cord/Jumper Installation and Administration  
Page 2-48  
Figure 2-27 shows an example labeling scheme for 4-pair circuits from the  
equipment room to the information outlets. The labeling scheme for 3-pair circuits  
from the MDF to a satellite location.  
crdf4pr CJL 102996  
Figure Notes:  
1. Equipment Room  
6. 258A Adapter  
2. To Central Location for Terminals 1 through 6 7. D-Inside Wire Cut Down  
to Connecting Block  
3. Blue Row on 110 Terminal Block  
8. Information Outlet  
4. Purple Row on 110 Terminal Block  
9. Voice Terminal  
5. To Port Connector on Cabinet (Cabinet 1,  
Carrier A, Slot 03)  
Figure 2-27. Example 4-Pair Labeling to Information Outlet  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Create a Provisioning Plan  
2
Page 2-49  
Create a Provisioning Plan  
Determine an appropriate available port circuit on the system for each telephone,  
trunk, and peripheral connection needed, and, in addition, plan for auxiliary  
power for Basic Rate Interface (BRI) and certain display sets.  
Create a Port Assignment Record to include the following. See Figure 2-25.  
Station or trunk type or feature/service  
Building location (floor/room/desk/information outlet)  
Extension number or trunk group and member number  
Port circuit location on the system for each endpoint (cabinet/carrier/  
slot/circuit)  
Route from equipment room through equipment closets to each endpoint  
Auxiliary power supply, if required  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Telecommunications Cabling  
Create a Provisioning Plan  
2
Page 2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
3
Page 3-1  
3
Install Management Terminal and  
Activate System  
3
This chapter contains procedures for installing the management terminal and  
bringing the system up to a “no red LEDs” state. This chapter details how to:  
Install Management Terminal  
Activate the System  
Power Up the System  
Screens and Commands  
System Administration  
Set Country Options  
Change Craft Password  
Set Date and Time  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
Set System Maintenance Parameters  
Save Translations  
Initiate DEFINITY AUDIX Power Procedures  
Register the System  
!
CAUTION:  
To prevent unnecessary trouble tickets, do not enable the system alarms  
(Alarm Origination feature) before completing all installation and  
administration procedures. This chapter describes basic system start-up  
procedures only and is not intended to identify all system alarms or error  
conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Install Management Terminal  
3
Page 3-2  
Install Management Terminal  
Locate the management terminal within 50 feet (15.2 m) of the system. It may be  
necessary to reduce the maximum distance limitation if higher gauge wire is  
used or if the capacitive load on the line is increased. In general, connect the  
terminal directly to the system with the shortest possible cable. For maintenance  
purposes, locate the terminal in the same equipment room as the system or in  
sight of the system.  
NOTE:  
The management terminal in Figure 3-1 is shown for illustration purposes  
only and does not represent a specific terminal type.  
Figure 3-1. Typical Management Terminal  
The following types of terminals can connect to a system:  
— 715 BCS  
— 2900/715 BCS  
— 715 BCS-2  
The following notes apply:  
This chapter emphasizes terminal installation in Release 6 and later  
systems.  
If the terminal supports a DC-powered system, install a 116A Isolator  
(comcode 106005242).  
Connect an optional printer using a locally obtained EIA cord. See  
AppDeonwdniloxaBd ,fromOWptwiown.SoSmwaintcuahls.Scoemtt.inAgll MsanfuoarlspSreinartcehrAonpdtDioonwnslowadit.ch settings.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Install Management Terminal  
3
Page 3-3  
Unpack and Inspect  
1. Unpack the terminal and inspect for damage. Report all damage  
according to local requirements.  
2. Remove and retain the installation and usage instructions from the carton.  
These instructions are needed to set up the terminal after it is installed.  
3. Set the terminal, keyboard, and all cables onto the equipment room table.  
Install a 715 BCS Terminal  
1. Plug the keyboard cable into the 6-pin mini-DIN jack on the rear of the  
terminal. See Callout 2 in Figure 3-2 on page 3-4.  
2. Plug the supplied 25-pin Data Terminal Equipment (DTE) cable into the P2  
port (center connector) on the rear of the terminal.  
Install a 2900/715 BCS Terminal  
1. Plug the keyboard cable into the 6-pin RJ-11 jack on the left side of the  
terminal. An adapter cable is available to convert a 6-pin mini DIN jack to  
an RJ-11 jack to allow a 715 BCS keyboard to be used (comcode  
847489895 or 847489903).  
2. Plug the supplied 25-pin Data Terminal Equipment (DTE) cable into the P2  
port (right side connector). See Callout 4 in Figure 3-2 on page 3-4.  
Install a 715 BCS-2 Terminal  
1. Plug the keyboard cable into the modular keyboard jack on the rear of the  
terminal. See Callout 5 in Figure 3-2. This is a unique cable and must be  
connected to the 715 BCS-2 only.  
2. Plug the supplied 25-pin Data Terminal Equipment (DTE) cable  
(H600-426) into the COM1 port (right side connector).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Install Management Terminal  
3
Page 3-4  
2
1
1
P2-DTE  
P1-DCE  
P1-DCE  
P2-DTE  
PAR  
AUX PORT  
MAIN PORT  
COM2  
COM1  
PARALLEL  
0069_0 RBP 072296  
Figure Notes  
1. Rear Panel of 715 BCS Terminal  
2. 6-Pin Mini DIN Connector  
3. Rear Panel of 2900/715 BCS Terminal  
4. P2-DTE Port  
5. Modular Keyboard Jack  
6. COM 1 Port  
7. Rear Panel of 715 BCS-2  
Ter min al  
Figure 3-2. Rear Panels on Management Terminals  
Connect to the System  
1. Route the 25-pin DTE cable from the terminal to the rear of the system.  
2. For Release 6si, connect the cable to the TERM connector. See Figure  
3-3. For Release 6r, connect the cable to the Terminal Active connector.  
See Figure 3-4.  
3. Plug the AC power cord into the AC receptacle on the terminal. Plug the  
opposite end of the power cord to the AC receptacle located at the bottom  
rear of the cabinet, or into the selected AC receptacle.  
4. Set the terminal power switch ON.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Install Management Terminal  
3
Page 3-5  
P2  
P1  
DATA  
DUPLICATION  
OPTION  
TERMINAL  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CLOCK AUX  
PROCESSOR COMMUNICATION  
INTERFACE  
EQUIPMENT TERMINAL  
0063_0 RBP 071096  
Figure 3-3. Management Terminal Connections for Release 6si  
Figure 3-4. Management Terminal Connections for Release 6r  
5. For a DC-powered system, install an EIA 116A Isolator (comcode  
106005242) in series between the DTE cable and the TERM or Terminal  
Active connector.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Install Management Terminal  
3
Page 3-6  
Remotely Connect Terminal  
A management terminal can be installed at some distance from the system.  
Typical remote connections are shown in Figure 3-5.  
Figure Notes  
1. Compact Modular Cabinet (Slot 1)  
2. DCE Connector (RS-232)  
7. Line Cord  
8. Remote Modem  
3. M25B (25-Pin-to-RS-232) Cable  
4. Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
9. DB9 to DB25 Converter (ED3-1-70,  
G115) (optional) to connect to PC  
10. Remote Management Terminal or  
PC  
5. Public Switched Telephone Network  
(PSTN)  
11. Remote Location  
6. 103A or Modular Wall Jack  
Figure 3-5. Typical Connections to Remote Devices  
1. Use Z3A2 Asynchronous Data Units (ADUs) and M25A cables on  
CDRU/CAS+, PMS, SAT PC, BCMS terminal, and Remote SAT.  
2. Use Z3A1 ADUs and M25B cables on System/Journal printers.  
3. A TN556 ISDN BRI circuit pack is used with the 7500 Data Module.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Activate the System  
3
Page 3-7  
Set Up Management Terminal  
Each management terminal requires a different setup procedure. Refer to the  
installation and usage instructions packed with the management terminal.  
Install Management Applications  
The PC-based Management Applications are installed according to the complete  
installation instructions provided in Management Applications Operations,  
585-229-202.  
Activate the System  
Instructions are provided to activate Release 6 and later systems. To activate a  
G3V4 and earlier system, refer to DEFINITY Communications System Generic 3  
Installation and Test, 555-230-104.  
NOTE:  
To prevent unnecessary trouble tickets, do not enable the system alarms  
(Alarm Origination feature) until all installation and administration  
procedures are completed.  
!
CAUTION:  
It may be necessary to reseat circuit packs. To prevent damage from static  
electricity, always wear an Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) wrist strap  
(comcode 900698226) when handling all system components.  
Install Translation Card (Release 6si in MCC  
Cabinet)  
If a Release 6r system is installed, skip this section.  
1. Insert the translation card into the TN777B Network Control circuit pack in  
the direction indicated by the arrow on the label.  
Power Up the System  
AC-Powered System  
1. Set the circuit breakers on the AC power panel to ON. If the system is high  
or critical reliability, power-up the EPN cabinet first, then the PPN cabinet.  
Always power up the PPN cabinet last.  
2. Set the cabinet circuit breakers to ON. This starts the system initialization  
and test. All red LEDs on the circuit packs go on and then off.  
3. SkipDtoown‘‘lVoaedriffryomMWewsws.aSgomeasnouanls.Tceormm. AinllaMla’’n.uals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Activate the System  
3
Page 3-8  
DC-Powered System  
1. At the DC Battery Cabinet (if installed), set the circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the DC Power Cabinet, set the circuit breaker(s) on the rectifiers ON.  
This starts the system initialization and test. Some red LEDs may be on but  
are turned off by other procedures in this chapter.  
3. If the system is high or critical reliability, power-up the EPN cabinet first,  
then the PPN cabinet. Always power up the PPN cabinet last.  
Verify Messages on Terminal  
1. After several minutes, verify all tests pass. Screen 3-1 displays the screen  
contents of a typical Release 6r system with 3 memory circuit packs. The  
Release 6si system screen is similar.  
NOTE:  
If any of the terminal messages indicate a test has failed or if the message  
spe down mode” is displayed, refer to DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r, or DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si, to  
clear the trouble.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Activate the System  
3
Page 3-9  
Screen 3-1. Typical Start-up Messages (Release 6r)  
2. About 2 minutes after REBOOT PERFORMEDdisplays, the screen displays:  
Login:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Screens and Commands  
3
Page 3-10  
Screens and Commands  
Screens  
The system is administered using screens displayed on the terminal. The  
screens are used to add, change, display, list data, and to remove system and  
telephone features. To access a screen, enter a valid system command in  
response to the Command: prompt.  
Commands  
System commands are standard words and phrases instructing the system to  
perform a specific function. The commands are arranged in a hierarchy of  
keywords; that is, enter 1 command to go to a different level. The commands  
contain three parts: ACTION, OBJECT, and QUALIFIER.  
ACTION is the first part of the command. When Command:appears on the  
screen. The ACTION specifies the operation desired. Examples include  
add, duplicate, change, remove, display, list, and save.  
OBJECT is the second part of the command and specifies the particular  
object to be administered. Typical entries are hunt-group, coverage  
path, and station.  
QUALIFIER is the last part of the command. It is 1 or more words or digits  
used to further identify or complete the OBJECT. For example, hunt group  
15 or station 3600, where 15 and 3600 are qualifiers.  
An example of the command line required to add a station with extension number  
1234 is add station 1234. In this example, add is the ACTION, station is the  
OBJECT, and 1234 is the QUALIFIER. In the command line, spaces are required  
between the ACTION, OBJECT, and QUALIFIER.  
To save time, enter enough letters for each part of the command to make it  
unique. For example, if you want to enter the command change  
system-parameters country-options, typing cha sys coun is acceptable.  
However, typing the entire command is always best.  
NOTE:  
The craft login may not be allowed to perform some of the steps needed to  
initialize the system. If access is denied to some of these procedures,  
contact your Lucent Technologies representative for assistance.  
Getting Help  
Use the Help key for a list of options and the Cancel key to back out of any  
command. Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description, for detailed procedures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
System Administration  
3
Page 3-11  
System Administration  
NOTE:  
An “init” login is required to perform the following. Contact the regional  
CSA (Customer Software Associate) to assign the Offer Category option.  
Maintenance capabilities to initialize the system and access to either an  
internal or external modem are the only command options available until  
the Offer Category option is set.  
Log in to the System  
1. Verify the screen displays: Login:  
2. Type craft and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays: password:  
4. Type crftpw and press Enter. For security reasons, the password does not  
display as it is typed. The system verifies a valid login and password name  
were entered. If an invalid login or password name was entered, the  
screen displays:  
login incorrect:  
In this case, repeat the procedure using the correct login and matching  
password.  
If the system recognizes the login and password name, the screen  
displays the software version.  
5. Verify the screen display is similar to:  
Terminal Type (513, 715, 4410, 4425, VT220): [513]  
6. Type the number of the management terminal and press Enter.  
7. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
NOTE:  
The following sections describe some of the procedures used to access  
and change certain options. These sections are not intended to replace or  
modify the instructions provided in DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set Country Options  
3
Page 3-12  
Set Country Options  
Certain country options need to be set to turn red failure indication LEDs off.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type change system-parameters country options and press Enter.  
A screen similar to Screen 3-2 is displayed on the terminal. The cursor is  
set on the Companding Modeline.  
Screen 3-2. Typical System Parameters Country-Options Screen  
3. The default companding mode is µ-Law. If the country uses A-Law  
companding, type A-Law.  
4. Press Enter when this information is correct.  
Other items eventually need to be entered on this screen, but this is all that  
must be done to turn the red alarm LEDs off. Refer to Table 3-1 for a list of  
the country codes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set Country Options  
3
Page 3-13  
Table 3-1. Country Codes  
Country  
USA  
Code  
1
Country  
Code  
12  
France  
Australia  
Japan  
2
Germany  
Czechoslovakia  
Russia  
13  
3
14  
15  
Italy  
4
The Netherlands  
Singapore  
Mexico  
5
Argentina  
Greece  
16  
6
17  
7
China  
18  
Belgium  
8
Hong Kong  
Thailand  
Macedonia  
19  
20  
Saudi Arabia  
United Kingdom  
Spain  
9
10  
11  
21  
5. If all red LEDs do not go off, reseat (unplug and reinsert) any  
purple-labeled circuit packs displaying red LEDs.  
!
CAUTION:  
To avoid a disk crash, never reset the DEFINITY AUDIX System  
without first shutting it down. Shut down the DEFINITY AUDIX System  
(and allow the disk to completely spin down) before unplugging the  
assembly. See ‘‘DEFINITY AUDIX Power Procedures’’ on page 3-32  
for the proper procedures.  
6. If the red LEDs still do not go off, refer to DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r, or to DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si.  
NOTE:  
Ignore the red alarm indication LED on the TN767 or TN464 DS1  
circuit pack until after the DS1 circuit pack is administered. Alarms  
will appear in the Alarm Log when power is applied to the system  
before all equipment connecting to port circuit packs is installed.  
Normally, some alarms will be logged when power is applied to the  
system, but should be resolved quickly. If no equipment is  
connected to the port circuit packs, alarms associated with these  
ports can take up to four hours to log, but will clear automatically  
after all equipment is installed and operating correctly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set Country Options  
3
Page 3-14  
Change Craft Password  
The password for the craft login must be changed by the installing technician to  
prevent unauthorized administration changes.  
!
CAUTION:  
After the password is changed, the new password must be safeguarded so  
no unauthorized administration changes can be made. This password  
MUST NOT BE REVEALED to the customer or to any unauthorized person.  
1. Login as craft and enter change password craft. Press Enter.  
Screen 3-3. Typical Change Password Screen  
2. Verify the Password Administration screen displays. See Screen 3-3. The  
cursor is positioned on Password for Login Making Change:  
3. Type the password for the craft login (assigned as crftpw when the system  
is shipped) and press Enter. The cursor is positioned on Login’s  
Password:.  
4. Enter the new password. Valid passwords consist of a combination of 4 to  
11 alpha or numeric characters. At least 1 letter and 1 number must be  
used in each password. Press Enter.  
5. The cursor is positioned on Reenter Login’s Password:. Type the  
new password again and press Enter.  
6. Verify the screen displays:  
command successfully completed  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set Country Options  
3
Page 3-15  
Set Date and Time  
1. Enter set time and press Enter.  
2. Verify the screen displays the Date and Time screen. See Screen 3-4. The  
cursor is positioned on the Day of the Week:field.  
Screen 3-4. Typical Date and Time Screen  
3. Type the day of the week in English (Sunday through Saturday). See Ta b l e  
3-2 for English day of the week names.  
Table 3-2. English Day of the Week Names  
Day Number  
Day Name  
Sunday  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Monday  
Tuesday  
Wednesday  
Thursday  
Friday  
Saturday  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set Country Options  
3
Page 3-16  
4. The cursor is positioned on the Month:field. Type the current month in  
English (January through December). See Table 3-3 for English month  
names. After the month is entered, press Tab to move to next field.  
Table 3-3. English Month Names  
Month Number Month Name  
1
January  
February  
March  
2
3
4
April  
5
May  
6
June  
7
July  
8
August  
September  
October  
November  
December  
9
10  
11  
12  
5. The cursor is positioned on the Day of the Month:field. Type the day  
of month (1 through 31) and press Ta b to move to the next field.  
6. The cursor is positioned on the Year:field. Type the current year and  
press TA B to move to the next field.  
7. The cursor is positioned on the Hour:field. Type the current hour for a  
24-hour clock. Press Ta b to move to the next field.  
8. The cursor is positioned on the Minute:field. Type current minute (0  
through 59). Seconds cannot be set.  
9. Press Enter when the information is correct.  
10. Type display time and press Enter to verify date/time data.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Circuit Pack Administration  
3
Page 3-17  
Circuit Pack Administration  
After the equipment is installed (including circuit packs), the circuit packs must  
be administered. Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release  
6 Administration and Feature Description for more information.  
The following information describes general administration information:  
Use the Circuit Packs form to administer circuit packs to carrier slots. The  
circuit packs must be installed (or assigned using the Circuit Packs form)  
before administering voice terminals, attendant consoles, or trunks.  
Each page of the form represents 1 carrier in the cabinet shown on the  
command line. For Release 6si, all carriers and slots appear even if they  
are not included in the hardware.  
It is not necessary to fill in the Circuit Packs form if the circuit packs are  
installed at the time of administration.  
Refer to DEFINITY Communications System Generic 3 Planning and  
Configuration, 555-230-601, for more information about circuit pack  
administration and port assignment records.  
For initial installation, assign circuit packs to slots using the hardware  
configuration layout record from the factory or Customer Services  
Organization. Do not arbitrarily assign circuit packs to slots.  
For Release 6r, if the carrier type administered on the Cabinet  
Administration form does not match the physical hardware, question  
marks (??) may display in the Code fields.  
When a circuit pack in a slot differs from what has been administered on  
the form, a “#” displays between the “Sfx” and “Name” fields.  
For Release 6r, the number of slot fields displayed represents  
administrable slots for the given carrier type. For Release 6si  
configurations, all slot fields are displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Set System Maintenance Parameters  
3
Set System Maintenance Parameters  
If the system does not contain a TN778 Packet Control circuit pack, skip this  
section and proceed to ‘‘Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)’’.  
1. Verify the terminal screen displays: Command:  
2. Type change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter. Verify  
the screen displayed is similar to Screen 3-5. The screen shows default  
values and the cursor is positioned on Product Identification:line.  
Screen 3-5. Typical System-Parameters Maintenance Screen  
!
CAUTION:  
To prevent unnecessary trouble tickets, do not enable the system  
alarms (Alarm Origination feature) until all installation and  
administration procedures are completed.  
3. Move the cursor by pressing Ta b to move down the screen from field to  
field and enter y in the Packet Bus Activated?field to indicate a  
TN778 circuit pack is installed. This is the only field needing change on  
this screen to turn the red LEDs off.  
4. Press Enter when the information is correct.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
3
Page 3-19  
Administer System Configurations  
(Release 6r)  
If a Release 6si is installed, skip to ‘‘Administer Attendant Console’’ on page 3-29.  
Change Customer Options  
The following features are part of the basic software package and do not need to  
be activated. They default to y(yes) on the Optional Features Form.  
Automatic Route Selection/Automatic Alternate Routing Partitioning  
Emergency Access to the Attendant  
Hospitality  
Service Observing  
An “init” password is required to modify customer options. Contact your regional  
CSA for the password.  
Use the following procedure to change the customer’s optional features.  
1. At the Command:prompt, enter the change system-parameters  
customer-options command. A display similar to Screen 3-6 appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
3
Page 3-20  
change system-parameters customer-options  
OPTIONAL FEATURES  
Page  
1 of  
4
Maximum Ports:  
14000  
G3 Version: V5  
y
Abbreviated Dialing Enhanced List? n  
CAS Main?  
A/D Grp/Sys List Dialing Start at 01?  
n
Cvg Of Calls Redirected Off-net?  
DCS (Basic)?  
n
y
Answer Supervision by Call Classifier? n  
y
ARS?  
DCS Call Coverage?  
n
y
ARS/AAR Partitioning? n  
ASAI Interface? n  
Emergency Access to Attendant?  
n
Extended Cvg/Fwd Admin?  
ASAI Proprietary Adjuncts Links? n  
External Device Alarm Admin? n  
n
ATMS? n  
Audible Message Waiting? n  
Authorization Codes? n  
Flexible Billing?  
Forced Entry of Account Codes? n  
n
Hospitality (Basic)?  
Hopitality (G3V3 Enhancements)? n  
Hopitality Parameter Reduction?  
CAS Branch?  
n
n
(NOTE: You must logoff & login to effect the permission changes.)  
Screen 3-6. Typical Customer-Options Form  
2. Enable the optional features purchased by the customer (as shown by  
PEC codes on the Customer Order).  
In Release 6 systems, a separate screen offers ASAI capability groups for  
selection in cases where the ASAI interface has been enabled. Change  
this screen in the same manner as Page 1 of the customer-options form.  
Change and Logoff Critical Reliability System  
If a critical reliability system is installed (1 with both processor and PNC  
duplicated), follow these steps. Otherwise, proceed to ‘‘Change Site-Data’’ on  
page 3-21.  
NOTE:  
Be sure PNC Duplicationwas set to y in the customer-options form.  
1. Log off and log back in as craft.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
3
Page 3-21  
Change Site-Data  
This form initializes the building, floor, and color data to make them available  
later in help messages that refer to site information.  
1. At the Command:prompt, enter the change site-data command.  
The first of 3 pages of site data appears:  
2. Enter optional names for the buildings or offices served by the system.  
3. Access the remaining site-data pages and fill them in appropriately.  
Change Cabinet 1  
1. Enter change cabinet 1. A screen similar to Screen 3-7 appears.  
2. Fill in the blanks as required by the location and nature of the cabinet. If  
the system is critical reliability, verify the Bfield is set to the processor  
option, the Dfield is set to the dup-sw-node option, and the Efield is set to  
the switch-node option.  
Screen 3-7. Typical Change Cabinet 1 Form  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer System Configurations (Release 6r)  
3
Page 3-22  
Add Cabinet 2 through N (Release 6r)  
1. Enter add cabinet <2-44>. See Screen 3-8.  
2. Fill in the blanks as required by the location and nature of the cabinet.  
Screen 3-8. Typical Add Cabinet Form  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-23  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r  
Only)  
Administer system fiber link configurations to match the hardware installed and  
according to the Fiber Optic Cable Running List.  
NOTE:  
Fiber link administration interacts with or depends upon other system  
features that must be administered before it.  
Fiber link administration creates translation data by identifying the endpoint pairs  
for each link. Endpoints can be:  
An Expansion Interface (EI) circuit pack  
A Switch Node Interface (SNI) circuit pack  
Circuit Pack Form  
After installing the equipment (including circuit packs), the circuit packs must be  
administered before the fiber link is administered. Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description for  
more information.  
The following information describes general circuit pack administration  
information:  
a. Use the Circuit Packs form to administer circuit packs to carrier slots.  
Install or administer the circuit packs (or assigned using the Circuit Packs  
form) before administering voice terminals, attendant consoles, or trunks.  
b. Each page of the form represents 1 carrier in the cabinet shown on the  
command line.  
c. Refer to DEFINITY Communications System Generic 3 Planning and  
Configuration, 555-230-601, for more information about circuit pack  
administration and port assignment records.  
d. For initial installation, assign circuit packs to slots using the hardware  
configuration layout record from the factory or Customer Services  
Organization. Do not arbitrarily assign circuit packs to slots.  
e. If the carrier type administered on the Cabinet Administration form does  
not match the physical hardware, question marks (??) may display in the  
Code fields.  
f. When a circuit pack in a slot differs from what has been administered on  
the form, a “#” displays between the “Sfx” and “Name” fields to indicate a  
conflict.  
g. For Release 6r, the number of slot fields displayed represents  
administrable slots for the given carrier type.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-24  
Administer Fiber Links on Simplex Systems  
1. Administer the TN570 Expansion Interface and the TN574 or TN1654 DS1  
Converter circuit packs. Enter the change circuit packs command and  
press Enter. See Screen 3-9.  
Screen 3-9. Circuit Packs Form  
2. Scroll through the pages on the form until the carrier containing the new  
circuit packs displays. Enter the circuit packs into the appropriate slot  
locations on the form. Press Enter when finished.  
3. Enter the list fiber command. All administered fiber connections display.  
4. If a previously used fiber link is to be reused, enter the add fiber  
<number> command. If this is a new fiber link, enter the add fiber next  
command. The Fiber Link Administration screen appears. Use this form to  
administer fiber links, each of which is identified by a fiber number.  
5. Enter y or n in the field Is one endpoint remoted via DS1  
Converter complex?and press Enter.  
6. Enter the location of the TN570 and the TN574 or TN1654 circuit pack for  
both ENDPOINT-1 and ENDPOINT-2.  
7. Scroll to page 2 of the form. Enter y as applicable, in each Facility  
Installed?field (A, B, C, and D).  
8. In the Bit Rate:field, enter either 1.544 (T1) or 2.048 (E1).  
9. Enter the idle code in the Idle Code MSB (1) . . . . LSB (8):  
field. The default value is 11101000. It is recommended that the default  
value be used unless it becomes absolutely necessary to change it. The  
“MSB” means Most Significant Bit, the “LSB” means Least Significant Bit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-25  
10. In the Line Coding: field, enter the line coding information. This  
information should match the line coding of the facility. For T1, example  
line coding is b8zs. For E1, example line coding is hdb3.  
NOTE:  
If this data is not correct, wideband errors (multimedia call handling)  
may occur.  
11. For T1 sites, refer to ‘‘T1 Installations Only’’. For E1 sites, refer to ‘‘E1  
Installations Only’’.  
T1 Installations Only  
a. The Framing Mode:field is display only and shows the hardware setting.  
b. The DS1CONV-1 Line Compensation:and the DS1CONV-2 Line  
Compensation:fields are display only and show the hardware setting.  
c. In the Facility A Circuit ID:field, enter an optional facility name  
that is unique to each facility (up to 40 alphanumeric characters). Press  
Enter.  
d. A display similar to the following appears after the fiber link administration  
is completed:  
RESET PORT-NETWORK 2 LEVEL 2 (COLD) PERFORMED.  
E1 Installations Only  
a. Enter y or n in the CRC?field. The “CRC” means Cyclic Redundancy  
Check. This is an error detection algorithm.  
b. The Line Termination:field is display only. A 75 (75 Ohms) or 120  
(120 Ohms) typically displays.  
c. In the Facility A Circuit ID:field, enter an optional facility name  
that is unique to each facility (up to 40 alphanumeric characters). Press  
Enter.  
d. A display similar to the following appears after the fiber link administration  
is completed:  
RESET PORT-NETWORK 2 LEVEL 2 (COLD) PERFORMED.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-26  
All Installations  
1. When the system reset is finished, enter the status port-network 2  
command. The Port Network Status screen appears. Verify that PNC  
Active is “up” and that the Service State is “in.”  
2. A Span LED, on the front of the DS1 Converter circuit pack, must be on for  
each active facility administered. For example, if Facility A and Facility B  
are administered, then the top 2 Span LEDs on the circuit pack must be on  
(yellow). The yellow LEDs are on only if no problems were encountered  
during the administration of hardware. Span LEDs associated with  
non-administered facilities (C and D, in this example) should be off.  
3. Perform a test call, if desired.  
Administer Fiber Links on Duplex Systems  
The PNC Duplication feature is enabled on the System-Parameters Customer-  
Options form and Operation of Duplication is enabled on the Duplication-Related  
System-Parameters form. All non-duplicated SNIs to SNI fiber links are  
automatically duplicated.  
When PNC Duplication is enabled on the System-Parameters Customer-Options  
form, the following administration forms change:  
Cabinet Form Additional fields appear to allow administration of switch  
nodes to A-PNC and B-PNC sides of the CSS. The B-PNC is the  
duplicated hardware for the A-PNC. Either the A-PNC or the B-PNC can  
provide full customized service. B-PNC cannot be used in a simplex PNC  
configuration. Pairing of switch nodes is also defined here.  
Fiber Link Administration Form Additional fields appear to allow  
administration of fiber links on the B-PNC side of the CSS. If an endpoint  
on the A-PNC side is administered as an SNI, its corresponding endpoint  
on the B-PNC side is determined (if switch nodes are paired in the cabinet  
form prior to this administration) and displayed. However, administration  
of the duplicate B-PNC link is not enforced until duplication is in full  
operation.  
Duplication-Related System-Parameters Form An additional field  
appears to enable operation of PNC duplication.  
1. Enter the change system-parameters customer-options command. On  
Page 2 of the form, set the PNC Duplication?field to y. Press Enter.  
2. Enter the change system-parameters duplication command. Change  
the Enable operation of PNC duplication?field to y. Press Enter.  
3. Enter the status pnc command. Verify the Duplicated ?field is yes.  
4. Enter the list fiber command. All administered fiber connections display.  
5. If a previously used fiber link is to be reused, enter the add fiber  
<number> command. If this is a new fiber link, enter add fiber next.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-27  
6. The Fiber Link Administration form appears. On Page 1, enter the Board  
Location: for ENDPOINT-1 and ENDPOINT-2. This is the cabinet,  
carrier, and slot that identifies the physical location of an SNI or EI circuit  
pack that is the first endpoint of the fiber link. Repeat for the remaining  
endpoints.  
7. The Board Typefield is display only and shows the type of circuit pack in  
Endpoint-1.  
8. In the DS1CONV Board Location: field, enter the cabinet, carrier, and  
slot that identifies the physical location of DS1 Converter circuit pack in  
the first endpoint of the duplicate fiber link. Endpoint-1’s duplicate along  
with Endpoint-2’s duplicate make up the duplicate fiber link called the  
B-PNC link.  
9. The DS1CONV Board Type: field is display only and shows the type of  
DS1 Converter circuit pack in Endpoint-1. The circuit pack type in  
Endpoint-1 (A-PNC) and Endpoint-1 (B-PNC) must be the same.  
10. In the Is one endpoint remoted via a DS1 Converter  
Complex?field, enter y to specify that a DS1 Converter complex is used  
to remote 1 endpoint. If a y is entered, administer the A-PNC DS1  
Converter Board Location on Page 1. The A-PNC DS1 Converter Board  
Type displays. Administer the A-PNC DS1 Converter (DS1CONV)  
Attributes on Page 2 of this form.  
11. On Page 2 of the form, enter the DS1 Converter Facilities information. In  
the Facility Installed?field, enter y for all installed facilities (A, B,  
C, and D).  
12. In the Bit Rate: field, enter 1.544 for T1 operation or 2.048 for E1  
operation.  
NOTE:  
One bit rate applies for all facilities within the same DS1 Converter  
complex. The Bit Rate:field displays only under Facility A.  
13. Enter the idle code in the Idle Code MSB (1) . . . . LSB (8):  
field. The default value is 11101000. It is recommended that the default  
value be used unless it becomes absolutely necessary to change it. The  
“MSB” means Most Significant Bit, the “LSB” means Least Significant Bit.  
14. In the Line Coding: field, enter the line coding information. This  
information should match the line coding of the facility. For T1, example  
line coding is b8zs. For E1, example line coding is hdb3. Scroll to Page 3  
and modify the fields as needed for the B-PNC.  
If this data is not correct, wideband errors (such as multimedia call  
handling) may occur.  
15. For T1 sites, refer to ‘‘T1 Installations Only’’. For E1 sites, refer to ‘‘E1  
Installations Only’’.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Administer Fiber Links (Release 6r Only)  
3
Page 3-28  
T1 Installations Only  
a. The Framing Mode:field is display only and shows the hardware setting.  
b. The DS1CONV-1 Line Compensation:and the DS1CONV-2 Line  
Compensation:fields are display only and show the hardware setting.  
c. In the Facility A Circuit ID:field, enter an optional facility name  
that is unique to each facility (up to 40 alphanumeric characters). Press  
Enter.  
d. A display similar to the following appears after the fiber link administration  
is completed:  
RESET PORT-NETWORK 2 LEVEL 2 (COLD) PERFORMED.  
E1 Installations Only  
a. Enter y or n in the CRC?field. The “CRC” means Cyclic Redundancy  
Check. This is an error detection algorithm.  
b. The Line Termination:field is display only. A 75 (75 Ohms) or 120  
(120 Ohms) typically displays.  
c. In the Facility A Circuit ID:field, enter an optional facility name  
that is unique to each facility (up to 40 alphanumeric characters). Press  
Enter.  
d. A display similar to the following appears after the fiber link administration  
is completed:  
RESET PORT-NETWORK 2 LEVEL 2 (COLD) PERFORMED.  
All Installations  
1. When the system reset is finished, enter the status port-network 2  
command. The Port Network Status screen appears. Verify that PNC  
Active is “up” and that the Service State is “in.”  
2. A Span LED, on the front of the DS1 Converter circuit pack, must be on for  
each active facility administered. For example, if Facility A and Facility B  
are administered, then the top 2 Span LEDs on the circuit pack must be on  
(yellow). The yellow LEDs are on only if no problems were encountered  
during the administration of hardware. Span LEDs associated with  
non-administered facilities (C and D, in this example) should be off.  
3. Perform a test call, if desired.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Reboot High Reliability System  
3
Page 3-29  
Reboot High Reliability System  
1. Enter reset system 4.  
2. When the login:prompt appears, login as craft.  
3. About eight minutes after booting and at the Command:prompt, enter the  
status spe command.  
4. Verify that handshake, shadowing,and refreshedare all shown to  
be either yesor on.  
Enable Duplication and Boot Critical Reliability  
System (Release 6r)  
1. Enter change system-parameters duplication.  
2. Make sure duplication of both SPE and PNC are enabled on the screen  
that follows the command. Confirm that a yis contained in both fields.  
3. Enter save translation.  
4. Enter reset system 4 to reboot the system.  
5. When login:appears on the screen, login as craft.  
6. About eight minutes after booting the system and at the Command:  
prompt, enter the status spe command.  
7. Verify that handshake, shadowing,and refreshedare all shown to  
be either yesor on.  
Administer Attendant Console  
1. Enter display system-parameters country-options and press Enter to  
verify the system’s companding mode for its local stations is set to the  
desired value (usually, A-Law for Europe and mu-Law for North America  
and Japan).  
2. If necessary, enter change terminal-parameters 603/302B1 and press  
Enter to change the default system-level parameters and audio levels for  
these terminals.  
NOTE:  
For information about changing the default parameters and audio  
levels, refer to DEFINITY Application Notes available through the  
International Technical Assistance Center (ITAC).  
3. Administer other forms listed under Attendant Console in DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Save Translations  
3
Page 3-30  
Save Translations  
Save Translations (Release 6si)  
For standard reliability systems, 1 translation card plus 1 backup is required. For  
high or critical reliability systems, 2 translation cards plus 2 backups are  
required.  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not attempt to save translations on the orange-labeled, 10 MB memory  
card. Use the white translation card.  
1. At the Command:prompt, enter save translation and press Enter.  
2. After several minutes, the Save Translation screen appears.  
3. Verify a “0” (zero) displays in the Error Code column for each SPE. A “0”  
indicates that the save translation completed successfully. If not, the save  
translation did not complete. Record the “error code number” and the  
“error message” and notify your Lucent Technologies representative.  
4. Remove the original card from the TN777B and replace with backup card.  
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the backup card(s).  
6. Remove the backup card and replace it with the original card.  
7. Label the backup card with the date and time of the backup and store it in  
a secure place.  
Save Translations (Release 6r)  
To copy the current system translations onto both disks:  
1. Enter the save translation command.  
2. Verify the save completes to both disks and returns a result code of “0”  
(zero).  
Add Translations  
1. Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description, to add new terminals.  
2. Enter the save translation command to merge these translations with the  
contents of disk or flash memory.  
3. If a standard reliability Release 6r system is installed, enter the backup  
disk incremental command. If a high or critical reliability Release 6r  
system is installed, enter the backup disk incremental both command.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
Installation Completion  
3
Page 3-31  
Installation Completion  
1. The system must now be tested for proper operation. See Chapter 4, ‘‘Te s t  
the System’’.  
2. After completion of the system tests, install the telephones and other  
equipment. See Chapter 5, ‘‘Install and Wire Telephones and Other  
Equipment’’.  
3. Administer the system by adding the customer data to match the wiring,  
telephones, and other equipment. See DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
4. After the system is administered, the telephones and other equipment are  
tested. See Chapter 6, ‘‘Test Telephones and Other Equipment’’. The  
Alarm Origination feature is then activated and tested.  
Logoff the System  
Log off the system to prevent unauthorized changes to data. To log off:  
1. Enter logoff at the Command:prompt.  
2. The login:prompt appears on the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install Management Terminal and Activate System  
DEFINITY AUDIX Power Procedures  
3
Page 3-32  
DEFINITY AUDIX Power Procedures  
Power Down the AUDIX System  
A yellow caution sticker on the system’s power unit notifies technicians to shut  
down the DEFINITY AUDIX System prior to powering down the system.  
1. Log into the AUDIX System as craft.  
2. Enter the reset system shutdown command. Press Enter once.  
NOTE:  
Do not press Enter again. This will force the AUDIX to shutdown  
immediately, dropping all active calls on the AUDIX.  
3. The “SHUTDOWN Completed” message appears when the AUDIX is  
successfully shutdown. This takes about 2 minutes.  
4. The AUDIX System can now be removed for service.  
Power Up the AUDIX System  
If the AUDIX was removed from the cabinet:  
1. Re-install the AUDIX and allow it to boot up automatically.  
2. Check for AUDIX System errors.  
If the AUDIX remained in the cabinet but power was removed from the  
cabinet:  
1. Power up the cabinet. The AUDIX reboots automatically.  
2. Check for AUDIX System errors.  
If the AUDIX remained in the cabinet and the cabinet was not powered  
down:  
1. At the AUDIX console, hold the crtl key and enter cc.  
2. Enter 5 at the prompt. In about 2 minutes, the AUDIX boots up.  
3. When the system initialization is complete, log in as craft.  
4. Check for AUDIX System errors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Page 4-1  
4
Test the System  
4
The following tests provide verification of the TDM bus cables and terminators,  
and fiber optic inter-cabinet cables. If a FAIL result code is seen or other  
problems are indicated, check these cables. If problems continue, refer to  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r or  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si.  
NOTE:  
Refer to ‘‘LED Indicators’’ on page 4-13 for information regarding the LED  
status indicators for the different circuit packs.  
1. The status of the system should be reviewed first.  
2. Test the tone-clock, TDM bus, and duplication link in the PPN.  
3. Test the Switch Node carrier (Release 6r only).  
4. Test Expansion Interface circuit packs, tone-clock circuit packs, TDM  
buses, and duplication in the EPNs.  
Circuit pack positions are usually given by cabinet, carrier, and slot. They may  
also be given by port.  
The term “cabinet” refers to 1 Multi-Carrier Cabinet making up 1 port network. A  
port network is defined as a group of cabinets connected together with one TDM  
bus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Check System Status for Each Cabinet  
Page 4-2  
Check System Status for Each Cabinet  
1. Verify the terminal screen displays: Command:  
2. Type status cabinet <1-44> and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays system status screens similar to Screen 4-1:  
Screen 4-1. Example System Status Screen for Cabinet 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Check Circuit Pack Configuration  
Page 4-3  
Check Circuit Pack Configuration  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type list configuration all and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays list configuration screens similar to the example  
shown below. Check the report on the screen with the equipment installed  
and make sure the software is communicating with each circuit pack  
(except power supply circuit packs). Wait until after the diagnostic tests  
later in this chapter before attempting to correct any problems.  
4. Note any circuit packs in the VINTAGEcolumn stating: BOARD NOT  
PRESENTor CONFLICT.  
Screen 4-2. Example System Configuration Screen  
NOTE:  
Under Assigned Ports, a “u” indicates unassigned ports and a number  
indicates the port has been translated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test TDM Bus in PPN  
Page 4-4  
Test TDM Bus in PPN  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test tdm port-network 1 and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays the results similar to Screen 4-3.  
Screen 4-3. Example Test Results for TDM Port Network 1  
4. If the result is FAILfor any test, check the connectors of the TDM bus  
cables in PPN 1.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test Tone-Clock Circuit Packs  
Page 4-5  
Test Tone-Clock Circuit Packs  
This test also detects problems with the TDM bus cables.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test tone-clock 1a and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays test results similar to Screen 4-4.  
Screen 4-4. Example Test Results for Tone-Clock 1A  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test SPE Duplication Memory Shadowing Link  
Page 4-6  
Test SPE Duplication Memory  
Shadowing Link  
For high and critical reliability systems only.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test shadow-link and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays test results similar to Screen 4-5.  
TEST RESULTS  
Port  
Maintenance Name Alt. Name Test No. Result  
SHDW-LNK 318 PASS  
Command successfully completed  
Error Code  
Screen 4-5. Example Test Results for SPE Duplication Memory Shadowing Link  
4. If result is FAILfor any test, check the inter-cabinet cables in the PPN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test Duplicated Switch Processing Element Interchange  
Page 4-7  
Test Duplicated Switch Processing  
Element Interchange  
For high and critical reliability systems only.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type status cabinet <1-44> and press Enter.  
3. Verify the screen displays test results similar to Screen 4-6.  
Screen 4-6. Example System Status Report for All Cabinets  
4. Note the MODEof SPE 1Aand 1B.  
5. Type refresh spe and press Enter.  
Command successfully completed should be displayed.  
6. Type reset system interchange and press Enter. This causes the terminal  
to log off.  
7. Log in as craft again. Remember to use the new password established for  
craft.  
8. Note the MODE for SPE 1Aand 1Bshould have changed from that noted  
in Step 4.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test Expansion Interface Circuit Packs  
Page 4-8  
Test Expansion Interface Circuit Packs  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test board <UUCCss> (where UUCCss is the cabinet, carrier, and  
slot for an expansion interface circuit pack in the system) and press Enter.  
Labels on the port network and carrier containing the board and the label  
on the strip under the board contain this information.  
NOTE:  
Circuit pack positions are usually given by cabinet, carrier (within  
cabinet), and slot (within carrier). They may also be given by port  
(within slot). The term “cabinet” refers to one Multi-Carrier Cabinet  
making up one port network. A port network is defined as a group of  
cabinets connected together with one TDM bus.  
3. Verify the screen displays test results similar to Screen 4-7. This example  
is for circuit pack 1C03.  
Screen 4-7. Example Test Board 1C03  
4. If any result is FAIL, check the connections for the associated fiber optic  
link.  
5. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for each circuit pack in the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test TDM for each EPN  
Page 4-9  
Test TDM for each EPN  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test tdm port-network 2 and press Enter.  
3. Verify a test results screen similar to Screen 4-8 is displayed.  
Screen 4-8. Example Test Results for TDM Port Network 2  
4. If result is FAILfor any test, check the connectors of the TDM bus cables  
in PPN 2.  
5. Repeat these steps for each EPN to check the TDM bus cables.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test Tone-Clock for each EPN  
Page 4-10  
Test Tone-Clock for each EPN  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type test tone-clock 2A (where 2A is the cabinet and carrier number for  
one of the Tone-Clocks installed) and press Enter.  
NOTE:  
Circuit pack positions are usually given by cabinet, carrier, and slot.  
They may also be given by port. The term “cabinet” refers to 1  
Multi-Carrier Cabinet making up one port network. A port network is  
defined as a group of cabinets connected together with 1 TDM bus.  
If any result is FAIL, check the associated TDM bus cables and  
intercabinet cables in the EPN.  
3. Repeat Step 2 for each installed Tone-Clock circuit pack.  
Test Tone-Clock Interchange for each  
EPN  
Critical reliability only.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type status system all-cabinets and press Enter. This displays the  
location of the Standby Tone-Clock.  
3. Type set tone-clock xxx (where xxx is the port network/carrier for the  
standby tone-clock). Press Enter.  
4. Type status system all-cabinets and press Enter.  
5. Verify the duplicated Tone-Clock is active using the information displayed  
on the screen.  
If any problems are indicated, check the TDM cables in the associated  
EPN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Test Expansion Interface Exchange for Each EPN  
Page 4-11  
Test Expansion Interface Exchange for  
Each EPN  
Critical reliability only.  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Enter status cabinet <1-44> and press Enter. This displays the standby  
expansion link (before changes are made). See Screen 4-9.  
status system all-cabinets  
SYSTEM STATUS CABINET 1  
SERVICE  
EMERGENCY  
TRANSFER  
1A  
SELECT  
SWITCH  
unavail  
auto-on  
CABINET  
TYPE  
MCC  
EXP-LINK  
01A01-02A01  
STATE  
in  
MODE  
standby  
active  
1B  
01B01-02B02  
in  
-
-
Command successfully completed  
Command:  
Screen 4-9. Example of System Status Before Expansion Link is Set  
3. Type set expansion-link xxxx (where xxxx is the either 1 of the cabinet,  
carrier, and port locations of the standby expansion link).  
4. Verify the screen displays:  
Command successfully completed  
Command:  
5. Enter status cabinet <1-44> and press Enter. See Screen 4-10.  
status system all-cabinets  
SYSTEM STATUS CABINET 1  
EMERGENCY  
TRANSFER  
1A  
SELECT  
SWITCH  
auto-on  
auto-on  
SERVICE  
STATE  
in  
CABINET  
TYPE  
MCC  
EXP-LINK  
01A01-02A01  
01B01-02B02  
MODE  
active  
standby  
1B  
in  
Screen 4-10. Example of System Status after Expansion Link is Set  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
4
Check Circuit Pack Configuration Again  
Page 4-12  
6. Verify the MODEs of the expansion links have changed.  
7. If any problems are indicated, check the TDM cables and the inter-  
cabinet cables in the associated EPN.  
Check Circuit Pack Configuration  
Again  
1. Verify the screen displays: Command:  
2. Type list configuration all and press Enter.  
3. Verify all circuit packs installed in the system are listed in the reports. Refer  
to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance  
for R6r, to resolve any discrepancies.  
System Test Completion  
Save Translations  
If any administration changes have been made, save and make a back up copy  
of the translations.  
Next Steps  
After the basic hardware is installed and tested, 3 more steps must be  
completed:  
1. Install the telephones and other equipment. See Chapter 5, ‘‘Install and  
Wire Telephones and Other Equipment’’.  
2. Administer the features, telephones, and other equipment according to  
customer data on the provisioning plan. The data for system and  
telephone features can be administered using DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
3. After the system is administered, test the telephones and other equipment  
using the procedures in Chapter 6, ‘‘Test Telephones and Other  
Equipment’’.  
NOTE:  
It may be more efficient to install each hardware component, administer it,  
and test it before going on to install another component.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
LED Indicators  
4
Page 4-13  
LED Indicators  
Refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for  
R6r for detailed alarm and LED descriptions. If a maintenance object begins to  
fail some periodic tests, the system generates an alarm. The system identifies 3  
levels of alarms:  
Major Alarms Failures that cause critical degradation of service and  
require immediate attention.  
Minor Alarms Failures that cause some degradation of service, but do  
not cause a critical portion of the system to be inoperable. This condition  
requires action, but its consequences are not immediate. Problems might  
be impaired service to a few trunks or stations or interfering with one  
feature across the entire system.  
Warning Alarms Failures that cause no significant degradation of  
service or failures in equipment external to the system. Warning alarms  
are not reported to the attendant console or INADS.  
Alarms are communicated to the system users and technicians by entries in the  
alarm log and the lighting of LEDs located on the attendant console, on all circuit  
packs, and, optionally, on customer-designated voice terminals.  
Attendant Console LEDs  
The console has 2 red LEDs, labeled “ALM” and “ACK”. The ALM LED lights  
steadily when there is a major or minor alarm at the system cabinet. The ACK  
LED lights steadily if the alarm has been successfully reported to INADS. If the  
system is unable to report the alarm to INADS, the LED flashes; this signals the  
attendant to call INADS and report the alarm.  
Terminal Alarm Notification  
Terminal Alarm Notification is an optional feature that displays several types of  
alarms on voice terminals with administered feature buttons or the attendant  
console. A maximum of 10 digital and/or hybrid voice terminals may be used.  
When an alarm occurs, the green status LED associated with the assigned  
button is in a steady state. The LED may be turned off by pressing the button  
associated with the LED. If the LED is off and the alarm has not been resolved by  
the time maintenance reschedules testing, the green status LED resumes its  
steady state.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
LED Indicators  
4
Page 4-14  
Circuit Pack LEDs  
Typically, each circuit pack has 3 LEDs on the front panel. Tab le 4-1 describes  
the red, green, and yellow LEDs and their meaning. Also see Figure 4-1.  
Table 4-1. Circuit Pack LEDs  
LED  
Color  
Status  
Description  
Red  
Alarm  
The system has detected a fault in this circuit pack. The alarm log  
should contain an on-board alarm. The red LED is also lit briefly  
when a circuit pack is inserted or reset. If the circuit pack passes its  
initialization tests, the LED goes out.  
Green  
Yellow  
Testing  
Busy  
The system is currently running tests on this circuit pack as part of  
background maintenance or demand testing. This LED is also lit  
during initialization tests when a circuit pack is inserted or reset.  
The circuit pack is currently in use by the system.  
Figure Notes  
1. Alarm LED (Red)  
2. Test LED (Green)  
3. Busy LED (Yellow)  
4. Latch Pin  
5. Locking Lever  
Figure 4-1. Circuit Pack LEDs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
LED Indicators  
4
Page 4-15  
DS1 Converter Circuit Pack LEDs  
Eleven LEDs provide an indication of the state of the TN1654 DS1 Converter  
circuit pack and the T1/E1 facilities. The top group has the standard red, green  
and yellow LEDs. The red LED indicates an alarm condition and the green LED  
indicates testing in progress. The 4 SPAN LEDs indicate the status of the T1/E1  
facilities. The four STATUS LEDs are currently unused and remain off.  
The yellow LED is used to indicate the state of the fiber interface, the fiber  
channel, the control channel, and the communications link to the SPE in the  
following manner and order of priority. See Table 4-2.  
Table 4-2. DS1 Converter Yellow LED Flashing States  
LED on  
LED off  
Condition  
0.1  
0.1  
Fiber out-of-frame or fiber loss of signal  
second  
second  
0.5  
second  
0.5  
second  
In frame, fiber channel down. The fiber channel communicating  
between the DS1 Converter and the other fiber endpoint (EI or  
SNI) is down.  
1
1
In frame, control channel down. The control channel between the  
2 DS1 Converters in the DS1 Converter complex is down.  
second  
second  
2
0.2  
second  
No response from SPE. The SPE is not acknowledging  
messages from the DS1 Converter or the communications link to  
the SPE is down.  
seconds  
solid on  
DS1 Converter active. This is the normal state for an active DS1  
Converter.  
solid off  
DS1 Converter standby. This is the normal state for a standby  
DS1 Converter in critical reliability systems (duplicated PNC).  
SPAN LEDs  
The 4 SPAN LEDs indicate the status of the 4 T1/E1 facilities. A SPAN LED is in  
one of the following states:  
1. Solid on yellow: Facility is operational and alarm free.  
2. Blinking yellow for 2 seconds, off 0.1 seconds: Facility is operational and  
alarm free AND is carrying the control channel (facility A or B only).  
3. Solid on red: Facility is alarmed.  
4. Solid off: Facility is not administered or has been busied out.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test the System  
LED Indicators  
4
Page 4-16  
Figure Notes  
1. Alarm LED (Red)  
2. Test LED (Green)  
3. Busy LED (Yellow)  
4. STATUS LEDs  
5. SPAN LEDs  
Figure 4-2. TN1654 DS1 Converter Circuit Pack LEDs  
LEDs on Standby Components  
In high and critical reliability systems, duplicated components on standby usually  
have the yellow LEDs off, with the following exceptions:  
The major, minor and warning alarm LEDs on the SYSAM circuit pack on  
the standby SPE do not give reliable indications. Note only LEDs on the  
active SYSAM circuit pack.  
The yellow LED blinks on and off when the standby processor circuit pack  
is up and standby maintenance is running.  
In high reliability systems with a Center Stage Switch, (duplicated SPE,  
simplex PNC), the standby Switch Node clock’s yellow LED is off. In  
critical reliability systems, the standby SNC is located on a separate  
carrier and normally remains lit.  
Yellow LEDs on power units on standby carriers normally remain lit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-1  
5
Install and Wire Telephones and  
Other Equipment  
5
The wiring procedures are the same for most telephones and other equipment.  
This chapter provides wiring examples of these similar installation procedures.  
These are examples only and actual wiring procedures may differ at each site.  
Wiring pinouts for circuit packs mentioned in this chapter are in the tables at the  
end of this chapter.  
Refer to Figure 5-1 for punch-down information for common circuit packs. The  
figure shows the colors of the punch-downs and is best viewed from CD-ROM or  
on-line.  
After installing the hardware, the data for the system and telephone features is  
administered. These procedures are provided in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-2  
Figure 5-1. Punch-dDoowwnnlsoafdofrroCmoWmwmw.SoonmaCniuraclsu.ciotmP.aAcllkMsanuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-3  
Telephone Connection Example  
The 302C Attendant Console is used as an example telephone connection. This  
is typical of the 603E, 84xx (4-wire), and 94xx telephones. The maximum cabling  
distance for a console powered from the cabinet is 350 feet (100 meters) using  
2
24 AWG (#5) (0.26 mm ) wire. The general steps to connect a telephone are:  
1. Choose a device to connect such as a 302C Attendant Console.  
2. Choose the port circuit pack, its carrier, slot number, and port; such as  
TN754B, cabinet 1, carrier C, slot 02, port 05.  
3. Install cross-connect jumpers to wire the pins on the terminal to the pins  
on the port circuit pack. See Figure 5-2. This example is for the TN754B  
Digital Line circuit pack.  
TXT5  
TXR5  
39  
14  
TXT 1  
TXR  
PXT  
PXR  
2
3
6
40  
15  
PXT5  
PXR5  
7
8
302cwire RBP 040596  
Figure Notes  
1. 302C Attendant Console  
3. -48 VDC (From Adjunct Power)  
4. Ground (From Adjunct Power)  
2. TN754B Digital Line Circuit Pack  
Figure 5-2. 302C to TN754B Wiring  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not use the 329A power unit for the attendant console. Use an 1151A,  
1151A2, 1145A, or MSP-1 power unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-4  
Connect Adjunct Power  
The attendant console requires -48 VDC adjunct power from pins 7 and 8 of the  
information outlet. Only 3 consoles can be powered by the cabinet from the AUX  
connector. Power the primary console from the cabinet so it has the same power  
failure backup as the system.  
1. For terminals needing adjunct power, wire -48 VDC and ground to  
appropriate pins on the terminal. See Figure 5-3. Use the 400B2 adapter  
when connecting local -48 VDC power to a modular plug.  
r749428 KLC 060396  
Figure Notes  
1. Flush-Mounted Information Outlet  
2. Surface-Mounted Information Outlet 5. To Telephone  
3. To Individual Power Unit 6. Destination Service Access Point  
(DSAP) Power Cord  
4. 400B2 Adapter  
Figure 5-3. 400B2 Adapter Connecting to a Modular Plug  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not use the 329A power unit for the attendant console. Use an 1151A,  
1151A2, 1145A, or MSP-1 power unit.  
Adjunct power can be provided from the equipment room or equipment closet  
with an 1145B power unit. See ‘‘1145B Power Supply’’ on page 5-45.  
Adjunct power can also be provided locally at the telephone or console with a  
1151A or 1D1o5w1nAlo2adpfroomweWrwuwn.Sito.mSaenueals1.c1om51. AAll MPaonwuaelsr SSeuaprcphlAyn’’doDnowpnalogaed. 5-54.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Analog Station or 2-Wire Digital Station Example  
5
Page 5-5  
Analog Station or 2-Wire Digital  
Station Example  
This example is typical of the 2-wire digital stations (603E, 84xx, 94xx, 302C),  
2-wire analog stations (500, 2500, 71xx), analog CO trunks, DID trunks, and  
external alarms.  
The wiring designations for this example are shown in Figure 5-4.  
T
2
3
28 T.3  
R.3  
R
03  
2500wire RBP 071996  
Figure Notes  
1. 2500-Type Analog Station  
2. TN2183 Analog Line Circuit Pack  
(Position 1C01)  
Figure 5-4. 2500-Type Analog Telephone Wiring  
1. Choose a peripheral to connect (such as an analog station or 2-wire digital  
station).  
2. Choose the port circuit pack, its carrier, slot number, and port. For  
example TN2183 Analog Line, cabinet 1, carrier C, slot 1, port 03.  
3. Install cross-connect jumpers to connect the pins from the analog station  
or 2-wire digital station to the appropriate pins on the port circuit pack.  
This pinout information is for the TN2183 Analog Line circuit pack.  
4. Administer on the management terminal. See DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description, for more details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Analog Tie Trunk Example  
5
Page 5-6  
Analog Tie Trunk Example  
This example shows how to connect analog tie trunk wiring from one DEFINITY  
System to another DEFINITY System.  
T. 1 26  
T.2  
29  
4
1
R.1  
R.2  
T1.1  
R1.1  
27  
2
30 T1.2  
R1.2  
5
E.1 28  
M.1  
31 E.2  
M.2  
3
6
tie_wire RBP 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. External Trunk or Adapter 2. TN760 Tie Trunk Circuit Pack (Position 1C05)  
Figure 5-5. Analog Tie Trunk Wiring  
1. Set the option switches on the port circuit pack (TN760) as described in  
Appendix B, ‘‘Option Switch Settings’’.  
2. Install cross-connect jumpers to connect the named pins from the tie trunk  
circuit pack to the appropriate leads on the external tie trunk. Names of  
the tie trunk leads must be determined from the manufacturer or supplier  
of the external trunk circuit. The example in Figure 5-5 shows a DEFINITY  
System tie trunk connected to a DEFINITY System tie trunk.  
3. Administer on the Trunk Group screen of the management terminal. See  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration  
and Feature Description for more details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Digital Tie Trunk Example  
5
Page 5-7  
Digital Tie Trunk Example  
This example shows how to connect digital tie trunk wiring from one DEFINITY  
System to another DEFINITY System. See Figure 5-6.  
Figure Notes  
1. External Trunk  
4. LO (Balanced Output Pair)  
2. TN464F Digital Trunk Circuit Pack 5. LI  
(Position 1C06)  
6. LI (Balanced Input Pair)  
3. LO  
Figure 5-6. Digital Tie Trunk Wiring  
1. Install cross-connect jumpers to connect the named pins from the digital  
trunk circuit pack to appropriate pins on the manufacturer’s or supplier’s  
external digital trunk.  
2. Set option switches on the port circuit pack (TN464F Digital Trunk)  
according to Appendix B, ‘‘Option Switch Settings’’.  
3. Administer on the DS1 and Trunk Group screens of the management  
terminal. See DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description for more details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
DS1 Tie Trunk Example  
5
Page 5-8  
DS1 Tie Trunk Example  
DS1 tie trunks provide a 1.544 Mbps digital data service between 2 collocated  
systems or between the system and a data network using T1 carrier facilities.  
DS1 tie trunk circuit packs provide connection capability to the DS1 facility.  
The following cables can be used to connect DS1 tie trunk circuit packs to DS1  
digital facilities:  
C6C connector cable (comcode 104307327) 50-foot (15.24 m)  
shielded cable equipped with a 50-pin male connector on 1 end and a  
15-pin male connector on the other end. Use this cable to connect a DS1  
tie trunk circuit pack to a Channel Service Unit (CSU).  
C6D connector cable (comcode 104307376) 50-foot (15.24 m)  
shielded cable equipped with a 50-pin male connector on each end. Use  
this cable to connect a DS1 tie trunks in collocated Single-Carrier  
Cabinets.  
C6E connector cable (comcode 104307434) 100-foot (30.48 m)  
shielded cable equipped with a 50-pin male connector on 1 end and a  
50-pin female connector on the other end. Use this cable as an  
“extension” cable between the DS1 tie trunk circuit pack and other  
connector cables.  
C6F connector cable (comcode 104307475) 50-foot (15.24 m)  
shielded cable equipped with a 50-pin male connector on 1 end and a  
3-inch (7.62 cm) stub on the other end. Use this cable to connect the DS1  
tie trunk circuit pack to channel multiplexers requiring hardwired  
connections. See Table 5-1 for a pinout of the C6F cable.  
Table 5-1. Pinout of C6F Cable  
Wire Color  
White/Green  
Green  
Lead Designation  
LI (High Side)  
LI  
Pin Number  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
White/Brown  
Brown  
LO  
LO (High Side)  
LBACK2  
White/Slate  
Slate  
LBACK1  
Collocated DS1 Tie Trunks  
Connection to 2 TN722B DS1 Tie Trunk circuit packs in collocated systems can  
include a C6D cable for distances up to 50 feet (15.24 m). For distances over 50  
feet (15.24 m) and up to 1310 Feet (399.3 m) maximum, use C6E cables.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
DS1 Tie Trunk Example  
5
Page 5-9  
DS1 Tie Trunks Using Channel Service Unit  
Figure 5-7 shows an example of the connections required to connect a DS1 tie  
trunk to an external T1 Channel Service Unit (CSU) or Integrated Channel Service  
Unit (ICSU). The ICSU is used to interface the DS1 tie trunks with the 1.544 Mbps  
digital facility.  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for maximum cabling  
distances.  
AUX PORT COM PORT  
MODEM  
NETWORK  
POWER  
DTE  
0012_1 RBP 062696  
Figure Notes  
1. To TN722B DS1 Tie Trunk Circuit  
Pack  
5. R (Ring)  
6. T1 (Tip 1)  
7. R1 (Ring 1)  
2. C6C Cable (For Distances Over 50  
Feet (15.24 m), Use C6E Cables)  
8. 1.544 Mbps Digital Service Interface  
9. To T1 Carrier  
3. CSU or ICSU (3150 Shown)  
4. T (Tip)  
Figure 5-7. Typical Connections to Channel Service Unit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Auxiliary Connector Outputs  
5
Page 5-10  
Auxiliary Connector Outputs  
The control carrier output cable pinouts are shown in Table 5-2. The control  
carrier AUX connector outputs include the following:  
Alarm monitoring for the auxiliary cabinet.  
Seven -48 VDC power sources for emergency transfer units.  
Three -48 VDC power sources for remotely powering 3 attendant consoles  
or telephone adjuncts.  
The remote management terminal interface trunk connection location.  
Access to a relay contact is available to actuate a customer-provided  
light, bell, or similar alarm device. Administer the system to make contact  
when a major, minor or warning alarm condition occurs in the system. The  
circuitry required for this feature is customer-provided. The device  
connected to the alarm leads must not exceed a rating of 30 VAC RMS or  
60 VDC at 0.75 Amps. See Tab l e 5 -2 for the pinouts for an external alarm.  
A 25-pair connector labeled AUX is provided on the rear of the control carrier.  
Connect a cable to this connector and route to a connecting block on the  
trunk/auxiliary field.  
Table 5-2. Auxiliary Lead Appearances at AUX Connector  
1,2  
Color  
Pin Number  
AUX Connector Outputs  
3
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
Major  
3
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
Minor  
W-G  
G-W  
28  
3
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
W-BR  
BR-W  
29  
4
W-S  
S-W  
30  
5
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
GRD  
R-G  
G-R  
33  
8
Not Connected  
R-BR  
BR-R  
34  
9
Not Connected  
Not Connected  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Auxiliary Connector Outputs  
5
Page 5-11  
Table 5-2. Auxiliary Lead Appearances at AUX Connector Continued  
1,2  
Color  
Pin Number  
AUX Connector Outputs  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
-48  
GND  
Emergency  
Transfer  
Relay  
BK-O  
O-BK  
37  
12  
-48  
GND  
BK-G  
G-BK  
38  
13  
-48  
GND  
Power  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
-48  
GND  
BK-S  
S-BK  
40  
15  
-48  
GND  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
41  
16  
-48  
GND  
Y-O  
O-Y  
42  
17  
-48  
GND  
Y-G  
G-Y  
43  
18  
Not Connected  
AUX Power  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
44  
19  
GND  
-48  
Y-S  
S-Y  
45  
20  
GND  
-48  
V-BL  
BL-V  
46  
21  
GND  
-48  
V-O  
O-V  
47  
22  
Not Connected  
3
V-G  
G-V  
48  
23  
Ext Alarm A  
Ext Alarm Return  
V-BR  
BR-V  
49  
24  
Not Connected  
V-S  
S-V  
50  
25  
INADS Tip  
INADS Ring  
1. Color designation is the main wire color followed by the color of the stripe.  
2. The following wire colors apply in Table 5-2:  
W
BL  
O
White  
Blue  
Orange  
Green  
Brown  
Slate (Grey)  
Red  
Black  
Yellow  
Violet  
G
BR  
S
R
BK  
Y
V
3. External alarm with signal incoming to system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Auxiliary Connector Outputs  
5
Page 5-12  
Tab le 5-3 provides port circuit pack and telephone pin designations.  
Table 5-3. Port Circuit Pack and Telephone Pin Designations  
8510T Basic  
4-wire;  
2-wire;  
Rate Interface  
Z3A1 & Z3A2  
302C, 8403,  
8410, 8411B/D,  
8434, 603E,  
9403, 9434  
302C, 8403, 8410, (BRI) (with  
Asynchronous  
Data Units  
(ADU), Data  
Modules  
Pin on  
Modular  
plug  
8411B/D, 8434,  
603E, 9403,  
9410, 9434  
adjunct  
speaker  
phone)  
Analog  
Station,  
Modem  
NT1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
TXT  
TXR  
PXT  
TXT  
TXR  
PXT  
T
TXT  
R
T
PXR  
T
R
PXT  
No  
Connection  
(4-pin  
R
PXR  
TXR  
PXR  
-48VDC  
GRD  
(-48VDC)  
GRD  
(-48VDC)  
GRD  
-48VDC  
GRD  
modular  
jack)  
TN2198  
2-wire  
Basic  
Rate  
Interface  
line  
TN2181 2-wire  
digital (16 port)  
TN2224 2-wire  
digital (24 port)  
TN2183  
Analog  
line (16  
port)  
TN556,  
ISDN-BRI  
Line  
Circuit  
Pack  
TN754 4-wire  
digital (8 port)  
TN726 Data Line  
PX  
TX  
private branch exchange transmitTTip (A)  
Terminal transmit Ring (B)  
R
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Three-Pair and Four-Pair Modularity  
5
Page 5-13  
Three-Pair and Four-Pair Modularity  
Figure 5-8 shows 3-pair and 4-pair modularity from the port circuit pack to the  
terminal pins at the information outlet (modular jack). Most terminals connect to  
an information outlet installed at the work location.  
Make the connections from the port circuit pack to the modular jacks. Then, plug  
the terminal into the modular jack.  
Figure Notes  
1. Port Circuit Pack  
4. Input to Information Outlet (4-Pair  
Modularity)  
2. System Cabinet Connector Pins  
(3-Pair Modularity)  
5. Adjunct Power  
3. Main Distribution Frame (MDF) Pins 6. Output From Information Outlet  
(3-Pair Modularity)  
(4-Pair Modularity)  
7. Voice Terminal  
Figure 5-8. 3-Pair and 4-Pair Modularity  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Adjunct Power Connections  
5
Page 5-14  
Adjunct Power Connections  
Figure 5-9 shows 3 typical connection locations for adjunct power. Adjunct  
power for station equipment may be supplied from the equipment room, satellite  
location, or the work location.  
4
adjunct_1 PDH 062696  
Figure Notes  
1. Typical Display Telephone  
9. 100P6A Patch Cord or Jumpers  
10. System Side of MDF  
2. Adjunct Power Supply (Such as 1151A or  
1151A2)  
11. 25-Pair Cable to System Cabinet  
Analog Line Circuit Pack  
3. 400B2 Adapter  
4. Information Outlet  
12. Equipment Room  
13. Satellite Location  
14. Work Location  
5. 4-Pair D-Inside Wire (DIW) Cable  
6. Satellite Site or Adapter Location  
7. 25-Pair D-Inside Wire (DIW) Cable  
8. Station Side of Main Distribution Frame  
15. Power From Bulk Power Source (Such  
as 1145B)  
Figure 5-9. Example Adjunct Power Connections  
For Figure 5-9, the following example is used:  
a. If 25 telephones connect to the system and all 25 telephones need  
adjunct power, install the adjunct power supply in the equipment room.  
b. If only 10 of the telephones need adjunct power, install the adjunct power  
supply at the satellite location.  
c. If only 1 telephone needs adjunct power, install the adjunct power supply  
at the work location.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Adjunct Power Connections  
5
Page 5-15  
Local and Phantom Power  
A console’s maximum distance from the system is limited. See Tab le 5-4.  
Table 5-4. Attendant Console Cabling Distances  
2
24 AWG Wire (0.26 mm )  
2
26 AWG Wire (0.14 mm )  
Enhanced Attendant  
Console (302C1)  
With Selector Console  
Phantom powered  
Locally powered  
Feet  
Meters  
Feet  
Meters  
800  
244  
500  
152  
5000  
1524  
3400  
1037  
Without Selector Console  
Phantom powered  
Locally powered  
1400  
5000  
427  
900  
274  
1524  
3400  
1037  
Auxiliary Power  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not use the 329A power unit for the attendant console.  
The non-essential functions of an attendant console and its optional selector  
console derive their power from an auxiliary power source. Up to 3 consoles can  
use system power from through the auxiliary cable located in the trunk/auxiliary  
field. Provide auxiliary power for a primary attendant console through this cable  
so the console remains fully operational during short power outages.  
NOTE:  
For a console to realize the longest nominal battery holdover, the console’s  
TN754B or TN413 Digital Line circuit pack should reside in an EPN’s  
expansion control carrier.  
An attendant console can also derive auxiliary power from either:  
Individual 1151A or 1151A2 power supply  
MSP-1 power supply  
258A-type adapters  
Bulk power supplies such as the 1145A1  
A console’s maximum distance from its auxiliary power source is:  
800 feet (244 m) for a 302A1  
350 feet (107 m) for a 301B1 and 302C1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Attendant Console  
5
Page 5-16  
Attendant Console  
1. Install the attendant console and connect the modular cord to the  
information outlet.  
2. Install labels per the attendant console form and display module form  
assignments.  
3. Install a TN754B or TN413 Digital Line circuit pack in the assigned carrier  
slot (if an additional circuit pack is required).  
4. Administer forms listed under “Attendant Console” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Hard-Wire Bridging  
Analog type hard-wire bridging is not allowed for 4-wire (only) DCP endpoints.  
This is because hard-wire bridging has no way of combining the digital output of  
2 bridged DCP sets. Also, bridged endpoints cause an added load that  
degrades the DCP signal. 2-wire DCP interfaces require twice the spectrum of  
4-wire interfaces.  
!
CAUTION:  
Bridging or paralleling these endpoints can cause electrical damage to the  
consoles or cause the circuit pack to remove power from the consoles.  
Dual Wiring of Two-Wire and Four-Wire  
Endpoints  
A 2-wire and 4-wire endpoint cannot be simultaneously wired to the same  
equipment location in an MDF, even though they connect to differently colored  
wire pairs. The system uses separate circuit packs to interface 2- and 4-wire  
endpoints, and none of these circuit packs are capable of interfacing both.  
26B1 Selector Console  
1. Connect the supplied 3-foot (0.9 m) D8AC cable to the modular jack on  
the bottom of the 26B1 Selector Console. Route the cable to the attendant  
console and connect to the DXS/BLF jack.  
2. Attach labels according to the attendant console form.  
3. Administer the console using DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connect External Alarm Indicators  
5
Page 5-17  
Connect External Alarm Indicators  
Alarm Input  
Alarms can be generated on adjunct equipment, sent to the DEFINITY System,  
and recorded and reported as “external alarms.” A typical major alarm input is  
from an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS).  
1. Connect 1 major and 1 minor alarm input pair to the trunk/auxiliary field  
from the AUX connector. See Table 5-5.  
Table 5-5. Alarm Inputs at AUX Connector  
Color  
AUX Connector  
White-Blue  
Blue-White  
White-Orange  
Orange-White  
AP1 (Pin 26) Major Alarm Input  
Ground (Pin 1)  
AP2 (Pin 27) Minor Alarm Input  
Ground (Pin 2)  
Alarm Output  
The system provides a relay contact that can operate a customer-provided  
alarm, such as a light or bell. The circuitry and power source are customer-  
provided. The alarm device must not exceed a rating of more than 30 VAC RMS  
or 60 VDC at 0.75 Amp.  
1. Connect an external alarm output through pins 48 and 23 of the AUX  
connector. See Tab le 5-6.  
2. Note which device connects to which alarm and give this information to  
your Lucent Technologies representative for troubleshooting purposes.  
Table 5-6. Alarm Output at AUX Connector  
Color  
AUX Connector  
Violet-Green  
Green-Violet  
EXTALMA (Pin 48) Alarm Output  
EXTALMB (Pin 23) (Ground) Alarm Output  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connect External Alarm Indicators  
5
Page 5-18  
Emergency Transfer and Auxiliary Power  
Connect emergency transfer power and auxiliary power as shown in Tab l e 5 -7 .  
Auxiliary power includes power to an attendant console or adjunct device.  
Table 5-7. Emergency Transfer and Auxiliary Power  
Color  
AUX Connector  
Black-Green  
Green-Black  
Black-Slate  
Slate-Black  
XFER48 (Emergency Transfer) (Pin 36)  
Ground (Pin 11)  
ACC48A (Adjunct -48 VDC) (Pin 19)  
Ground (Pin 44)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connect Power Distribution Unit External Alarm Wires  
5
Page 5-19  
Connect Power Distribution Unit  
External Alarm Wires  
The external alarm plug should already be connected to the J58890CH-1 Power  
Distribution Unit. The pinout for the connector is shown in Tab le 5-8.  
Table 5-8. External Alarm Connector Pinout  
Pin  
26  
1
Designation  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
RFA2 +  
Definition  
27  
2
28  
3
29  
4
30  
5
31  
6
32  
7
33  
8
Rectifier Failure (positive)  
RFA2 -  
Rectifier Failure (negative)  
AC Failure (positive)  
34  
9
ACF2 +  
ACF2 -  
AC Failure (negative)  
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
38  
BIF2 +  
Battery Interface Failure (positive)  
Battery Interface Failure (negative)  
Battery On Discharge (positive)  
Battery On Discharge (negative)  
BIF2 -  
BOD2 +  
BOD2 -  
Not Used  
RXD  
Receive Data  
Transmit Data  
TXD  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connect Power Distribution Unit External Alarm Wires  
5
Page 5-20  
Table 5-8. External Alarm Connector Pinout Continued  
Pin  
13  
39  
14  
40  
15  
41  
16  
42  
17  
43  
18  
44  
19  
45  
20  
46  
21  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
50  
25  
Designation  
DTR  
Definition  
Data Terminal Ready  
RS-232 Ground  
Data Set Ready  
Request To Send  
RS-232 GRD  
DSR  
RTS  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
NOTE:  
RS-232 alarms (RXD, DTR, DSR, TXD, RS-232 GRD, and RTS) are not  
supported on the BU3200A Battery Interface Unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connect Power Distribution Unit External Alarm Wires  
5
Page 5-21  
1. Choose an alarm to connect (such as Battery Interface Failure).  
2. Choose the port circuit pack to use and its carrier and slot number (from  
Tab le 5-3). For example TN2183 Analog Line, Cabinet 1, Carrier C, Slot 1.  
3. Choose a port circuit on the port circuit pack, for example Port 3.  
4. Install cross-connect jumpers to connect the named pins from the alarm  
wires to the appropriate pins on the port circuit pack.  
NOTE:  
It is recommended that the RFA, ACF, and BIF alarm leads be  
connected to the major alarm device and the BOD alarm leads be  
connected to the minor alarm device.  
5. Connect the major and minor alarm devices to the appropriate cross-  
connect pins on the MDF.  
6. Administer the alarms using DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server  
Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Remote Network Interface  
5
Page 5-22  
Remote Network Interface  
The Remote Network Interface (formerly Initialization and Administration System  
(INADS)) provides a 9600 bps modem connection for the remote management  
terminal. The network interface trunk should appear on the twenty-fifth pair of a  
RJ21X network interface jack. The trunk is a 2-way, rotary dial, loop start trunk  
that connects to a TN731 Maintenance circuit pack, the processor circuit pack,  
or the TN1648 System Access/Maintenance circuit pack through the network  
interface terminals at the trunk/auxiliary Main Distribution Frame (MDF). Figure  
5-10 shows a typical network interface trunk installation.  
1. Determine the network interface trunk appearance at the green  
trunk/auxiliary field of the MDF.  
2. Label the terminals for the trunk appearance.  
3. Install jumpers between the trunk appearance on the green field and the  
Remote Network Interface terminals on the purple field.  
25  
50  
IN  
r758482b RBP 062696  
Figure Notes  
1. To Network Interface Facility  
3. One Pair of Wires  
2. To Control Carrier Auxiliary Connector 4. Twenty-fifth Pair of RJ21X  
Network Interface Jack  
Figure 5-10. Connections at Trunk/Auxiliary Field  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-23  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r  
Only)  
Set Circuit Pack Switches  
The configuration switches on the TN1654 must be set before the circuit pack is  
installed. The TN1654 can be configured for either T1 or E1 operation. All 4  
facilities on the circuit pack are configured as a group. It is not possible to have  
T1 and E1 facilities supported on the same circuit pack at the same time.  
E1 facility line termination impedances of 120 Ohms for twisted-pair and 75  
Ohms for coax wiring are supported. The T1 line impedance is fixed at 100 Ohms  
and the T1 framing is selectable for ESF (Extended Super Frame) or D4 for each  
facility.  
Figure 5-11 shows the location of the switches. Table 5-9 shows the switch  
setting positions and functions.  
Table 5-9. TN1654 DS1 Converter Configuration Switches  
Switch Function  
Up  
Down  
1
2
Type of Facility  
T1  
E1  
Span A Line Impedance (E1 Only) 120 Ohm  
75 Ohm  
D4  
Span A Framing (T1 Only)  
Span B Line Impedance (E1 Only) 120 Ohm  
Span B Framing (T1 Only) ESF  
Span C Line Impedance (E1 Only) 120 Ohm  
Span C Framing (T1 Only) ESF  
Span D Line Impedance (E1 Only) 120 Ohm  
ESF  
3
4
5
6
75 Ohm  
D4  
75 Ohm  
D4  
75 Ohm  
D4  
Span D Framing (T1 Only)  
ESF  
Force Fiber Data-Stream  
Scrambling  
Enabled  
Disabled  
1. Set the configuration switches on the TN1654 as required per site.  
2. Set Switch 6 down (disabled).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-24  
INSET  
0015_0 RBP 052396  
Figure 5-11. DS1 Converter Circuit Pack Switches  
1. Set Switch 1 down for E1 facilities. All subsequent facility switch settings  
(Switches 2-5) reflect E1 impedance on each of the 4 facilities. For  
example: If Switch 1 is down and Switch 2 is up, Span A Line Impedance  
of 120 Ohms is selected. If Switch 1 is down and Switch 2 is down, Span A  
Line Impedance of 75 Ohms is selected.  
2. Set Switch 1 up for T1 facilities. All subsequent facility switch settings  
(Switches 2-5) reflect T1 framing on each of the 4 facilities. For example: If  
Switch 1 is up and Switch 2 is up, ESF framing is selected. If Switch 1 is up  
and Switch 2 is down, D4 framing is selected.  
3. Set Switch 6 to the down (disabled) position. Switch 6 may not be present  
(or active) on all TN1654 DS1 Converter circuit packs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-25  
Install the Circuit Pack and Cabling (T1 Only)  
The following installation instructions are provided as examples only.  
1. Be sure to label all of the cables as they are installed.  
20  
10  
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11  
09 08 07 06 05 04 03 02 01  
0017_0 RBP 061896  
Figure Notes  
1. Port Cabinet  
4. 50-Pin Male/50-Pin Female  
Double-Headed Connector Cable  
2. 50-Pair Female Connector to  
Expansion Interface Connector  
5. Quad Cable (With 50-Pin Male  
Connector) Connects to Channel  
Service Unit  
3. 14-Inch (35.56 cm) “Y” Cable  
6. DS1 Converter Connector  
Figure 5-12. DS1 Converter Connections — Part 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-26  
Port Carrier  
1. Install the TN1654 in any slot in a Port Carrier, next to a TN570C  
Expansion Interface circuit pack.  
2. On the backplane, connect a 14-inch (35.56 cm) “Y” cable from the  
TN1654 to the Expansion Interface circuit pack. See Figure 5-12.  
!
CAUTION:  
The “Y” cable used with the TN1654 is different than the “Y” cable  
used with the TN574. These cables are NOT interchangeable.  
3. Connect an H600-348 Quad cable to the remaining end of the “Y” cable.  
4. Skip to ‘‘Channel Service Unit Cabling’’.  
Switch Node Carrier  
Up to 2 TN1654 circuit packs can be installed in a Switch Node Carrier.  
1. Install the TN1654 in any slot in the Switch Node Carrier, next to a TN573B  
Switch Node Interface circuit pack.  
2. On the backplane, connect a 14-inch (35.56 cm) “Y” cable from the  
TN1654 to the Switch Node Interface circuit pack. See Figure 5-12.  
!
CAUTION:  
The “Y” cable used with the TN1654 is different than the “Y” cable  
used with the TN574. These cables are NOT interchangeable.  
3. Connect an H600-348 Quad cable to the remaining end of the “Y” cable.  
4. Skip to ‘‘Channel Service Unit Cabling’’.  
Port Carrier to Switch Node Carrier  
When the TN1654 is located in the Port Carrier and the Switch Node Interface  
circuit pack is located in the Switch Node Carrier, connect a 70” (177.8 cm) “Y”  
Cable between the 2 circuit packs.  
!
CAUTION:  
The Ycable used with the TN1654 is different than the “Y” cable used with  
the TN574. These cables are NOT interchangeable.  
1. Connect an H600-348 Quad cable to the remaining end of the “Y” cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-27  
Channel Service Unit Cabling  
Figure 5-13 shows a typical connection from the H600-348 Quad Cable to the  
CSU, through the H600-307 Network Cable, and to the network interface through  
the Smart Jacks. The double-headed cable plugs into the DS1 converter slot.  
The quad cable provides up to 4 DS1 connections using a 15-pin connector that  
plugs into the DTE jack on each CSU. An adapter cable (comcode 107063711)  
may be required to connect the H600-348 and the H600-307 cables to the CSU.  
AUX PORT COM PORT  
MODEM  
NETWORK  
POWER  
DTE  
AUX PORT COM PORT  
AUX PORT COM PORT  
AUX PORT COM PORT  
MODEM  
MODEM  
MODEM  
NETWORK  
NETWORK  
NETWORK  
POWER  
POWER  
POWER  
DTE  
DTE  
DTE  
3150csu RBP 062696  
Figure Notes  
1. H600-348 Quad Cable  
6. Smart Jack  
2. 15-Pin Male “D” Connectors (to DTE Jacks 7. Cable “A”  
on CSU)  
8. Cable “B”  
3. Channel Service Unit (CSU)  
9. Cable “C”  
4. H600-307 Cable (RJ-48C to RJ-48C)  
10. Cable “D”  
5. Network Interface  
Figure 5-13. DS1 Converter Connections — Part 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-28  
1. Connection to the remote-located system is the same as that shown in  
Figure 5-12 and Figure 5-13.  
Table 5-10 shows the “Y” cable lengths and associated comcode numbers.  
Table 5-10. “Y” Cable Lengths  
Length  
Description  
Comcode  
14 Inches (35.5 cm)  
TN1654 to adjacent Expansion Interface 847245750  
circuit pack or TN573B Switch Node  
Interface circuit pack in same carrier  
70 Inches (177.8 cm) TN1654 to Expansion Interface circuit  
pack or Switch Node Interface in another  
carrier  
847245768  
847245776  
847746641  
14 Inches (35.5 cm)  
TN1654 to fiber optic transceiver  
(DC-powered cabinets only). This cable  
is for intercabinet cabling only.  
14 Inches (35.5 cm)  
TN1654 to adjacent TN570C Expansion  
Interface circuit pack  
NOTE:  
The distinction between facility types is important when using TN1654  
circuit packs. The facility used to carry control channel messages between  
the pair of DS1 converter circuit packs and all packet traffic is known as the  
primary facility. The facility used to backup and takeover for the primary  
facility in the event of primary facility failure is known as the secondary  
facility. The TN1654 allows either facility, A or B, to be a primary channel.  
The control channel is restricted to only the A or B facilities. This permits full  
24-channel access (T1) or 31-channel access (E1) for facilities C and D to  
support user traffic.  
Install the Circuit Pack and Cabling (E1 Only)  
The E1 installation is similar to the T1 installation except the H600-348 Quad  
Cable and the Channel Service Unit are not used.  
NOTE:  
The H600-348 Quad Cable can be used on E1, 120 Ohm installations.  
1. Install a “Y” cable between the DS1 Converter connector and the  
Expansion Interface connector. See Figure 5-12. Also refer to Table 5-10  
for the “Y” cable lengths and associated comcode numbers.  
2. Be sure to label the cables as they are installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
TN1654 DS1 Converter (Release 6r Only)  
5
Page 5-29  
E1 Interface Cabling  
Figure 5-14 shows typical E1 cabling to the network interface via the coaxial  
adapter cable. The actual adapter may be different in appearance.  
0027_0 RBP 061896  
Figure Notes  
1. 50-Pin Male Connector on Coaxial Adapter Cable 3. Connect to Quad Cable  
2. Coaxial Adapter Cable (With 8 BNC Connectors) 4. Connect to E1 Network  
Figure 5-14. DS1 Converter Connections E1 Only  
1. Connect a coaxial adapter cable to the remaining end of the “Y” cable.  
The opposite end of this cable is wired to a coaxial adapter assembly.  
2. Plug a customer-provided quad cable onto the 4 BNC connectors  
provided on the coaxial adapter.  
3. Connect the opposite end of the quad cable to the network interface.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises Station Wiring  
5
Page 5-30  
Off-Premises Station Wiring  
The cabling outside the building for off-premises stations is provided by the local  
telephone company. The off-premises stations can appear on any of the RJ21X  
network interfaces provided for the Central Office (CO) trunks.  
!
CAUTION:  
Only an FCC-approved (or equivalent) analog type telephone, for example,  
a 2500-type, can be used as an off-premises station. The TN746B and  
TN2183 Analog Line circuit packs can be used for off-premises stations.  
1. Connect an A25D cable between the RJ21X network interface and a  
sneak fuse panel. See ‘‘Install Sneak Fuse Panels’’ in Chapter 2, ‘‘Install  
Telecommunications Cabling’’.  
2. At the MDF, connect jumper wires between 1 row/connecting block in the  
green field and up to 3 rows/connecting blocks in the purple field to  
concentrate the analog line pairs.  
3. Connect an A25D cable between the sneak fuse panel and the 110-type  
terminal block connector associated with the green row in Step 2.  
4. Install a green label on the 110-type terminal block to identify the remote  
location.  
5. Administer per DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description.  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building  
Stations  
Out-of-building campus stations are those telephones/voice terminals not  
physically located in the same building as the equipment room but are located  
on the same property.  
Analog Off-Premises Stations  
Figure 5-15 shows the connections for 1 to 8 off-premises analog telephones.  
Only analog telephones connected to TN742, TN746B, TN2183, or TN769  
Analog Line circuit packs can be installed out-of-building.  
The maximum distance from the system cabinet to the out-of-building voice  
2
terminal is 6000 feet (1828.8 meters) using 24 AWG (#5) (0.26 mm )wire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
5
Page 5-31  
1
3
3
6
2
5
4
4
7
6
8
10  
9
15  
14  
13  
11  
12  
0043_0 RBP 062796  
Figure Notes  
1. Locally Engineered Cables and Equipment  
2. Out-of-Building Wiring  
8. Part of MDF  
9. Station Side  
10. System Side  
11. White Field  
12. Purple Field  
3. 25-Pair Connector  
4. Multi-Pair Protector Units (Primary  
Protectors with Heat Coils or Equivalent with  
Sneak Current Protection)  
13. Cross-Connect Jumpers  
14. Tip and Ring Wires  
5. 356A Adapter  
6. B25A Cable  
15. To TN2183, TN769, TN742, TN746B,  
or Analog Line Circuit Pack  
7. Out-Of-Building Analog Telephones  
Figure 5-15. Connections for Up to 8 Out-of-Building Analog Telephones  
Figure 5-16 shows the connections for up to 24 off-premises analog telephones.  
Concentrations of analog line pairs are used at both buildings to minimize the  
off-premises wiring required. At the MDF, connect jumpers between 1  
row/connecting block in the white field and up to 3 rows/connecting blocks in the  
purple field. At the station location, a WP-90929, List 1 Concentrator Cable is  
used. There are 8 station appearances on each of the 3 fingers of the  
concentrator cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
5
Page 5-32  
1
2
7
2
4
4
4
5
3
3
6
8
6
4
9
10  
12  
11  
16  
15  
14  
13  
0044_0 RBP 062796  
Figure Notes  
1. Locally Engineered Cables and  
Equipment  
8. Out-Of-Building Analog Telephones  
9. Part of Main Distribution Frame (MDF)  
10. Station Side  
2. 25-Pair Connector  
3. Multi-Pair Protector Units  
(Primary Protectors with Heat  
Coils or Equivalent with Sneak  
Current Protection)  
11. System Side  
12. White Field  
13. Purple Field  
4. B25A Cable  
14. Cross-Connect Jumpers  
15. Tip and Ring Wires  
5. Concentrator Cable (WP90929  
List 1)  
16. To TN742, TN769, TN746B, or TN2183  
Analog Line Circuit Pack  
6. 356A Adapter  
7. Out-of-Building Wiring  
Figure 5-16. Connections to 24 Out-of-Building Telephones  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
5
Page 5-33  
Carbon block, or equivalent protection is required at both building entrances.  
Also sneak current protection is required. Protection can be provided by a 4-type  
protector or a 3-type protector plus a separate sneak current protector. The  
4-type protector is equipped with a heat coil.  
The 4-type protector is the preferred device. For installations not using primary  
protection, 4-type protectors should always be used. When the 3-type protector  
is already installed, a separate sneak current protector is required. The multi-pair  
protector units and the off-premises cabling must be locally engineered.  
Connectorized multi-pair protector units (female 25-pair connector) are  
recommended. Table 5-11 shows the recommended protectors.  
Table 5-11. Analog Line Circuit Protectors  
Protectors  
Primary  
(with heat coil)  
Sneak Current  
Protectors  
1
2
Primary  
3B1A (carbon)  
4B1C (carbon)  
220029 Fuse  
SCP-1  
3B1E-W  
4B1E-W  
(wide gap gas tube)  
(wide gap gas tube)  
3C1S  
4C1S  
(solid state)  
(solid state)  
1. The 3-type protectors should only be used if they are already part of the  
existing protection system. A sneak current protector is always required when  
a 3-type primary protector is used.  
2. The 3-type protectors should only be used if they are already part of the  
existing protection system. A sneak current protector is always required when  
a 3-type primary protector is used.  
The maximum range of out-of-building analog telephones (500-, 2500-, or  
7100-types) connected to an analog line circuit pack should be such that the  
maximum loop resistance does not exceed 1300 ohms.  
The following voice terminals/telephones cannot be installed in an exposed  
environment:  
7300-type voice terminals connected to TN762 Hybrid Line circuit packs  
Multi-button Electronic Telephone (MET) sets connected to TN735 MET  
Line circuit packs  
Analog telephones connected TN746 Analog Line circuit packs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
5
Page 5-34  
Protector Ordering Information  
Description  
Comcode  
3B1A (Carbon Block)  
102381779  
104410147  
105514756  
102904893  
104401856  
104386545  
406948976  
407216316  
3B1E-W (Wide Gap Gas Tube)  
3C1S (Solid State)  
4B1C (Carbon Block with Heat Coil)  
4B1E-W (Wide Gap Gas Tube w/Heat Coil)  
4C1S (Solid State with Heat Coil)  
SCP-110 Sneak Current Protector  
220029 Fuse (sneak current protector)  
Digital Out-of-Building Voice Terminals  
Protection is required at both building entrances for digital out-of-building voice  
terminals. There are 2 different types of protectors that can be used to protect  
digital voice terminals and digital line circuit packs in an out-of-building  
environment. The 2 enhanced protectors to use are the 4C3S-75 and the ITW  
Linx. These units provide primary and sneak current protection. For sneak  
current protection, the 4C3S-75 is equipped with a heat coil and the ITW Linx is  
equipped with replaceable fuses.  
The 4C3S-75 may only be used with Vintage 14 or newer TN754 circuit packs.  
The 4C3S-75 can be used on all vintages of the TN754B circuit packs. The ITW  
Linx may be used on all vintages of the TN754 and TN754B circuit packs. Ta b l e  
5-12 lists the approved protectors.  
Table 5-12. Digital Voice Circuit Protectors  
Enhanced Primary Protector  
Circuit Pack  
(With Sneak Current Protection)  
TN754 V13 or earlier  
TN754 V14 or later  
TN754B all vintages  
TN2181 all vintages  
TN2224 all vintages  
ITW Linx Only  
4C3S-75 or ITW Linx  
4C3S-75 or ITW Linx  
4C3S-75 or ITW Linx  
4C3S-75 or ITW Linx  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Off-Premises or Out-of-Building Stations  
5
Page 5-35  
When possible, all new and reused wiring installations should use blocks that  
accept the standard 5-pin plug-in 4C3S-75 protector. However, there are reused  
wiring installations where this may not be cost effective. For these installations,  
the ITW Linx protector may be installed. An example of this is where screw-type  
carbon block protectors (or other non plug-compatible types) are in place and it  
is too costly to re-terminate the outside plant cable on a 5-pin mounting block for  
only a few out-of-building terminals.  
The ITW Linx Enhanced Protector may be installed in series with existing primary  
protection. The 4C3S-75 protector cannot be installed in series with other types  
of primary protection. It must be installed as the only protection on the line  
entering the building. For the 4C3S-75 protector there are a variety of 25-, 50-,  
and 100-pair protector panels equipped with 110-type connecting blocks and/or  
RJ21X connectors. The ITW Linx Enhanced Protector mounts directly on  
connecting blocks and requires a separate ground bar.  
The maximum range for out-of-building digital voice terminals is 3400 feet (1036  
2
m) when using 24 AWG (#5) (0.26 mm ) wire and 2200 feet (670 m) when using  
2
26 AWG (#4) (0.14 mm ) wire. The range can be extended to 5000 feet (1524 m)  
2
using 24 AWG (#5) (0.26 mm ) wire or 4000 feet (1219 m) using 26 AWG (#4)  
2
(0.14 mm ) wire with the use of a Data Link Protector (DLP). The DLP is an  
isolating transformer used to remove phantom power on the system side and  
re-introduce it on the terminal side. When a protector is used, the voice terminal  
must be locally powered by an external power supply or through the AC power  
cord provided with some of the 7400-type voice terminals. The protector is  
installed on the equipment side of the protection in both buildings.  
Protector and Data Link Protector Ordering Information  
Description  
Comcode  
4C3S-75 (Solid State with Heat Coil)  
ITW LINX (Gas Tube, Avalanche Suppress)  
ITW Linx Ground Bar (used with above)  
ITW Linx Replacement Fuse  
105581086  
406144907  
901007120  
406304816  
103972758  
103972733  
Data Link Protector (1 circuit)  
Data Link Protector (8 circuits)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-36  
Emergency Transfer Units and  
Associated Telephones  
Emergency transfer capability is provided by a transfer unit mounted next to the  
trunk/auxiliary field. Analog telephones connected to the transfer panel can be  
used. The 500-and 2500-type telephones can also be used as normal  
extensions. Emergency transfer capability may be provided on analog Central  
Office (CO) and Wide Area Telecommunications Service (WATS) trunks.  
The 808A Emergency Transfer Panel provides emergency trunk bypass or  
power-fail transfer for up to 5 incoming CO trunk loops to 5 selected station sets.  
The 808A equipment’s Ringer Equivalency Number (REN) is 1.0 Amp.  
At the MDF, the unit is controlled by a connection to a yellow terminal  
row/connecting block in the trunk/auxiliary field. The unit is controlled by -48 VDC  
from the EM TRANS RELAY PWR terminals. There are 7 EM TRANS RELAY  
PWR terminal pairs that allow powering of up to 7 transfer units.  
Should power be restored to the relays while a call connected through the 808A  
is in progress, the 808A maintains the connection until the user goes on-hook.  
Each 808A can handle up to 5 CO trunks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-37  
808A Emergency Transfer Panel  
Figure 5-17 shows a typical 808A Emergency Transfer Panel. The 808A is  
connected to the MDF with a B25A or A25B cable.  
The following procedures are provided as a typical installation example.  
EMERGENCY  
TRANSFER  
PANEL  
POWER  
TRUNK/TEST SWITCHES  
CIRCUIT  
1
TRUNK OPTION  
1
2
3
4
5
2
LOOP  
START  
GROUND  
START  
1
2
3
4
5
6
BOTH SWITCHES MUST BE  
THROWN TO ACTIVATE  
TRUNK OPTION  
7
8
9
10  
12  
TRANSFER TEST SWITCH  
NORMAL  
OPERATION  
ACTIVATED  
TRUNK IDENTIFICATION  
TRUNK  
LINE  
EXT  
LOC  
808A  
led808a LJK 040896  
Figure Notes  
1. 808A Emergency Transfer Panel  
2. Circuit Start Selection Switches  
3. Trunk Identification Label  
4. 25-Pair Male Connector  
Figure 5-17. 808A Emergency Transfer Panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-38  
NOTE:  
Install the 808A in a location that can be accessed only by authorized  
personnel. In addition, the location must meet standard environmental  
considerations such as temperature, humidity, and so forth.  
6. Install the panel on any mounting frame in either a vertical or horizontal  
position. The housing has ears for screw-mounting and cutouts for  
snap-mounting the unit in an 89-type mounting bracket. Verify dial tone is  
present at each trunk circuit.  
7. Locate the circuit start selection switches. See Figure 5-17. These are the  
first 10 two-position switches on the left side of the panel. They are used to  
set each of the 5 incoming trunk lines to either loop start or ground start.  
Two switches are used for each circuit; switches 1 and 2 are used for  
circuit 1, switches 3 and 4 are used for circuit 2, and so forth. See Tab l e  
5-13. For loop start, set the switches to the left. For ground start, set the  
switches to the right.  
.
Table 5-13. Trunk/Test Switches  
Switch  
Circuit  
Number Number  
1
1
2
1
3
2
4
2
5
3
6
3
7
4
8
4
9
5
10  
11  
12  
5
Not Used  
Test Switch  
8. Connect a 25-pair cable between the male RJ21 25-pair connector on the  
Emergency Transfer Panel and the yellow field of the MDF. See Figure  
5-18. Table 5-14 shows the pin assignments.  
9. Make cross-connections for each emergency trunk/emergency station  
pair. See Figure 5-19 and Table 5-14.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-39  
Table 5-14. Pin Assignments for 25-Pair Connector  
Pin  
26  
1
Color  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
Designation  
TTC1  
RTC1  
TTK1  
RTK1  
TLC1  
RLC1  
TST1  
RST1  
TTC2  
RTC2  
TTK2  
RTK2  
TLC2  
RLC2  
TST2  
RST2  
TTC3  
RTC3  
TTK3  
RTK3  
TLC3  
RLC3  
TST3  
RST3  
TTC4  
RTC4  
TTK4  
RTK4  
TLC4  
RLC4  
Connector/Description  
Tip-PBX Trunk Circuit 1  
Ring-PBX Trunk Circuit 1  
Tip-CO Trunk Circuit 1  
Ring-CO Trunk Circuit 1  
Tip-PBX Line Port 1  
27  
2
O-W  
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
Ring-PBX Line Port 1  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-S  
Tip-Emergency Terminal 1  
Ring-Emergency Terminal 1  
Tip-PBX Trunk Circuit 2  
Ring-PBX Trunk Circuit 2  
Tip-CO Trunk Circuit 2  
Ring-CO Trunk Circuit 2  
Tip-PBX Line Port 2  
30  
5
S-W  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
R-O  
32  
7
O-R  
Ring-PBX Line Port 2  
33  
8
R-G  
Tip-Emergency Terminal 2  
Ring-Emergency Terminal 2  
Tip-PBX Trunk Circuit 3  
Ring-PBX Trunk Circuit 3  
Tip-CO Trunk Circuit 3  
Ring-CO Line Port 3  
G-R  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
R-S  
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
38  
13  
39  
14  
40  
15  
S-R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
BK-O  
O-BK  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Tip-PBX Line Port 3  
Ring-PBX Line Port 3  
Tip-Emergency Terminal 3  
Ring-Emergency Terminal 3  
Tip-PBX Trunk Circuit 4  
Ring-PBX Trunk Circuit 4  
Tip-CO Trunk Circuit 4  
Ring-CO Trunk Circuit 4  
Tip-PBX Line Port 4  
Ring-PBX Line Port 4  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-40  
Table 5-14. Pin Assignments for 25-Pair Connector Continued  
Pin  
41  
16  
42  
17  
43  
18  
44  
19  
45  
20  
46  
21  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
50  
25  
Color  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Y-O  
Designation  
TST4  
Connector/Description  
Tip-Emergency Terminal 4  
Ring-Emergency Terminal 4  
Tip-PBX Trunk Circuit 5  
Ring-PBX Trunk Circuit 5  
Tip-CO Trunk Circuit 5  
RST5  
TTC5  
RTC5  
TTK5  
RTK5  
TLC5  
RLC5  
TST5  
O-Y  
Y-G  
G-Y  
Ring-CO Trunk Circuit 5  
Tip-PBX Line Port 5  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
Y-S  
Ring-PBX Line Port 5  
Tip-Emergency Terminal 5  
Ring-Emergency Terminal 5  
Common 1 Relay Contact  
Normally Open 1 Contact  
Normally Closed 2 Contact  
Normally Closed 1 Contact  
Common 2 Relay Contact  
Normally Open 2 Contact  
S-Y  
RST5  
COM1  
NO1  
V-BL  
BL-V  
V-O  
NC2  
O-V  
NC1  
V-G  
COM2  
NO2  
G-V  
V-BR  
BR-V  
V-S  
GRD  
Ground From PBX  
S-V  
-48PX  
-48V from Alm Panel  
10. On the trunk identification label at the bottom of the panel, record the trunk  
line, extension, and location for each circuit.  
11. Attach a label identifying each voice terminal designated as an  
emergency terminal. The labels are provided with the unit.  
12. Check the system for normal operation:  
— Set the test switch (switch 12) to NORMAL OPERATION.  
— Ensure the power supply is providing -48 VDC at 80 mA maximum.  
— The power LED should be ON.  
Verify there is dial tone on all emergency transfer sets.  
If allDoofwtnhloeadafbroomvWewcwo.Snodmitaionunasls.acorem.nAolltMmaneuta,lsreSpealarccheAnthdeDopwannloeadl..  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-41  
13. Check the system for transfer operation as follows:  
— Place the test switch (switch 12) in the ACTIVATED position.  
— The power LED should be OFF.  
Verify there is dial tone on all emergency transfer sets.  
If all of the above conditions are not met, replace the panel.  
The 808A connect to the MDF with a B25A cable. Figure 5-18 shows the  
connections at the trunk/auxiliary field for a telephone used only for emergency  
transfer.  
25  
50  
2822  
1
2
3
EMXR  
2822  
1
C
O
M
1
C
O
M
2
C
O
M
3
N
O
1
N
C
2
N
C
1
N
O
2
N
C
3
G
R
D
-48  
V
TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST  
1M 1m 2M 2m 3M 3m 3w  
ALARM MONITORS  
EM TRANS RELAY PWR  
ACC PWR  
r758580b MMR 042996  
Figure Notes  
1. To Network Interface Circuitry 3. To Blue or White Station Distribution Field  
2. To TN747 (or Equivalent) CO  
Trunk Circ uit Pac k  
4. To Power Transfer Unit  
5. To Control Carrier AUX Connector  
Figure 5-18. Connections for Telephone Used for Emergency Transfer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-42  
Figure 5-19 shows the connections at the trunk/auxiliary field for a telephone  
used for emergency transfer as well as a normal extension.  
10  
35  
ST  
2820  
EMXR  
ST  
7
3
4
5
6
7
8
C
O
M
1
C
O
M
2
C
O
M
3
N
O
1
N
C
2
N
C
1
N
O
2
N
C
3
G
R
D
-48  
V
TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST TC TK LC ST  
1M 1m 2M 2m 3M 3m 3w  
ALARM MONITORS  
EM TRANS RELAY PWR  
ACC PWR  
r758582b MMR 042996  
Figure Notes  
1. To Network Interface Facility  
4. To TN747 (or Equivalent) Central  
Office Trunk Circuit Pack  
2. To Blue or White Station Distribution  
Field  
5. To Power Transfer Unit  
3. To TN742, TN746B, or TN769 (or  
Equivalent) Analog Line Circuit Pack  
6. To Control Carrier AUX  
Connector  
Figure 5-19. Connections for Telephone Used for Emergency Transfer and as  
Normal Extension  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Emergency Transfer Units and Associated Telephones  
5
Page 5-43  
Install Telephone for Power Transfer Unit  
Trunk/Auxiliary Field: Telephone Used Only for Emergency Transfer  
1. Connect a pair of wires between the -48V and GRD terminals on the  
yellow emergency transfer row/connecting block and the EM TRANS  
RELAY PWR terminal. See Figure 5-18.  
2. Connect CO trunk leads from the purple field to TC terminals on the yellow  
emergency transfer row/connecting block for each trunk.  
3. Connect CO trunk leads from the green field to TK terminals on the yellow  
emergency transfer row/connecting block for each trunk.  
4. Connect ST leads on the yellow emergency transfer row/connecting block  
for each emergency transfer telephone to the ST terminal appearance in  
the yellow trunk/auxiliary field. The ST terminal leads should be terminated  
on the following pairs: 1, 4, 7, 10, 13, 16, 19, or 22 (the first pair of any  
3-pair group).  
5. Connect the ST leads from the terminal in Step 4 to the assigned terminal  
in the blue or white station distribution field.  
Trunk/Auxiliary Field: Telephone Used for Emergency Transfer and as  
Normal Extension  
1. Connect a pair of wires between the -48V and GRD terminals on the  
yellow emergency transfer row/connecting block to the EM TRANS  
RELAY PWR terminal. See Figure 5-19 on page 5-42.  
2. Connect CO trunk leads from the purple field to TC terminals on the yellow  
emergency transfer row/connecting block for each trunk.  
3. Connect CO trunk leads from the green field to TK terminals on the yellow  
emergency transfer row/connecting block for each trunk.  
4. Connect telephone leads from the purple analog line board row/  
connecting block to the LC terminals on the yellow emergency transfer  
row/connecting block for each telephone.  
5. Connect ST leads on the yellow emergency transfer row/connecting block  
for each emergency transfer telephone to the ST terminal appearance in  
the purple trunk/auxiliary field.  
6. Connect the ST leads from the terminal in Step 4 to the assigned terminal  
in the blue or white station distribution field.  
Telephone Installation  
Install telephone assigned to emergency transfer as follows:  
1. Connect telephone to the information outlet.  
2. Install patch cords/jumper wires between the system side and the station  
side of the station distribution field on the MDF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
External Ringing  
5
Page 5-44  
External Ringing  
Connections for external ringing provided by a device, such as a gong, chime, or  
bell, are at an information outlet. The system side of the MDF connects to a  
TN2183 or equivalent analog line circuit pack located in a port carrier. The circuit  
packs contain 16 ports each.  
NOTE:  
A maximum of 3 devices can connect to 1 TN2183 circuit pack port.  
1. Wire the ringing device to the information outlet as shown in Figure 5-8  
and Figure 5-9.  
2. Administer per DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description.  
Queue Warning Indicator  
The connections for the queue warning indicator are the same as external  
ringing. An AC indicator (lamp) such as a 21C49 can be used in a Uniform Call  
Distribution/Direct Departmental Calling (UCD/DDC) queue.  
The lamp connects to an information outlet. The system side of the MDF  
connects to an analog line circuit pack in a port carrier.  
1. Wire the queue warning indicator to the information outlet as shown in  
Figure 5-8 and Figure 5-9.  
2. Administer per DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-45  
1145B Power Supply  
The 1145B closet power arrangement provides an uninterruptible -48 VDC power  
source with battery and 1145B distribution unit for ISDN/DCP, terminal  
equipment, adjuncts, and other customer-supplied equipment. During AC power  
interruptions, batteries automatically provide power to the load.  
A manual switch on the distribution unit allows the user to redirect reserve power  
to outputs 1 through 32 so all outputs are provided battery reserve power.  
NOTE:  
The switch must be set to the 1-32 position.  
The 1145B/1146B is a -48V power supply with 200 Watts total output. Each  
output circuit is current limited by a thermistor that limits the maximum output to  
12 Watts. Each 1145B output has an LED to indicate the status of the thermistor.  
If the LED is on, the thermistor has a short on that power pair.  
Not all outputs can simultaneously provide 12 Watts. The average power per  
output cannot exceed 6.25 Watts (200/32 = 6.25). The 1145B is designed to  
power one ISDN terminal or DCP adjunct per output. The maximum number of  
terminals or adjuncts is 32. The 1145B is required for installations outside the  
United States.  
Auxiliary power (local or bulk) is always required for the following:  
Attendant Console 302C  
Any 8520 terminal  
Any 7500- or 8500-series terminal with an asynchronous data module  
Any 7500-series terminal whether in passive bus, or point to point (1 per  
BRI port)  
Any 8510 terminal in passive bus or with an asynchronous data module  
(unless the 8510 will not be used to support data or video)  
PassageWay adapter interface  
Any 8400-series terminal  
Any 7400-series terminal  
Figure 5-20 shows how the standard power supply and wall-mounting plates fit  
together. Figure 5-21 shows the expanded power supply components (power  
distribution unit and “T” cable).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-46  
Wall-Mounting Plates  
The top plate is used for mounting the back-up battery. The bottom plate is used  
to mount the power supply and distribution units. The plates can be rack-  
mounted using standard rack-mounting brackets.  
1. Locate 1 plate directly below the other such that the AC power cord (6.5  
feet or 2 meters) reaches the electrical outlet from a power supply  
mounted on the bottom plate. Both plates should be located so the raised  
letters are right side up.  
NOTE:  
A maximum of 4 power supplies can be powered from 1 dedicated  
110 VAC, 20 amp (or 230 VAC, 15 amp) feeder. Use only unswitched  
receptacles (receptacles not connected to a wall switch).  
2. Secure the wall mounting plates to a standard 3/4 inch (2 cm) thick  
plywood mounting board. Each mounting plate comes with four #10 x  
1/2-inch wood screws.  
3. The 1145B Power Supply is snap-fit onto the bottom wall mounting plate  
without tools.  
2
4. An installer-provided insulated ground wire, 16 AWG (1.5 mm ) or greater,  
is required to connect the power supply frame ground lug to an approved  
ground. The frame ground screw is located next to the AC receptacle, to  
the left of the unit.  
5. Mark the Unit Number and Connectivity information on the front label next  
to the LEDs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-47  
1149 Battery  
-48V  
-48V  
1
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
RT  
N
RTN  
2
On Battery Reserve  
Charging Battery  
Output Power On  
3
4
1145 Power Unit  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Unit No.  
Connected To:  
1-8  
1-32  
0003_1 PDH 062596  
Figure Notes  
1. Wall Mounting Plate  
2. Battery (1149B Shown)  
3. 1146B Power Distribution Unit  
4. 1145B Power Unit  
5. Power Cable  
6. Unswitched Outlet (120 VAC, 20 Amp  
or 230 VAC, 15 Amp)  
7. Battery Backup Switch Setting  
Figure 5-20. 1145B/1146B Mounting Arrangement  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-48  
Mount the 1146B Power Distribution Unit  
1. Insert and securely tighten the 2 supplied #8-32 x 1/2-inch shoulder  
screws into the top holes designated for 1146B Power Distribution Unit on  
the bottom plate. Mount the unit on these 2 shoulder screws, using the key  
holes on the back of the unit.  
2. Secure the unit by inserting the #8-32 x 1 inch screw through the bottom of  
the unit (just above the wire clips) into the plate and tighten.  
3. Set the battery back-up switch option to the 1-32 (down) position to  
provide battery back-up to all outputs.  
4. Connect the power distribution unit to the power supply with the power  
cable. Refer to the power supply’s right-hand label to locate the output  
power connection.  
Battery Mounting/Wiring  
Three types of back-up batteries are used; the 1148B, the 1149B, and the 1147B.  
Table 5-15 provides the rating and PEC code of each battery.  
Table 5-15. Back-Up Battery PEC Codes  
Battery  
1148B  
1149B  
1147B  
Rating  
PEC Code  
24700  
2.5 Amp Hour (AH)  
5 Amp Hour (AH)  
8 Amp Hour (AH)  
24701  
24703  
1. Loosely thread two #10-32 x 1/2-inch shoulder screws into the top  
designated battery holes on the wall mounting plate.  
2. Place the keyhole slots in the battery bracket on these 2 screws. The  
battery cord exits from the right of the bracket. Make sure the label on the  
battery is visible. Tighten the screws securely.  
3. Plug the battery cord into the power supply’s right rear receptacle. The  
rear receptacle is indicated on the right label.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-49  
Install the Expanded Power Distribution Unit  
A second power distribution unit can be installed to provide power to additional  
8400-series and 8500-series terminals.  
!
CAUTION:  
Total power cannot exceed 200 Watts. The maximum ISDN terminal mixture  
is twenty four 7500-series and twenty four 8500-series terminals.  
The maximum DCP terminal mixture is twenty four 7400-series and twenty  
four 8400-series or sixty four 8400-series terminals.  
The following items are supplied with each expanded power distribution unit kit:  
— One 1146B Power Distribution Unit (comcode 107250995)  
— One “T” Cable (comcode 847529872)  
Two #8-32 x 1/2-inch Shoulder Screws  
— One #8-32 x 1 inch Screw  
— One Spacer Bracket (comcode 847554441)  
Refer to Figure 5-21 while installing the power distribution unit.  
1. Set the spacer bracket onto the mounting plate and secure with the #8-32  
x 1/2-inch shoulder screws. The spacer bracket is not shown in Figure  
5-21 but is installed behind the top power distribution unit.  
2. Slide the keyhole slots in the power distribution unit over the shoulder  
screws.  
3. Insert the #8-32 x 1 inch screw through the distribution unit, through the  
spacer bracket, and into the plate. The mounting hole is located just  
above the wire clip. Tighten the screw securely.  
4. Set the battery back-up switch to the 1-32 (down) position.  
5. Power-down the 1145B unit as described on the label on the side of the  
unit.  
6. Remove the output power cable between the 1145B and the 1146B units.  
The cable will not be reused.  
7. Connect the P1 connector end of the “T” cable to the bottom power  
distribution unit. Connect the P2 connector to the top distribution unit.  
Connect the P3 connector to the 1145B.  
8. Power-up the 1145B as described on the label on the side of the unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-50  
-
4
8
V
-48V  
RTN  
1
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
RTN  
1149 Battery  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Unit No.  
Connected To:  
-48V  
-48V  
1
17  
RTN  
RT  
N
2
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
On Battery Reserve  
Charging Battery  
Output Power On  
3
4
1145 Power Unit  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Unit No.  
Connected To:  
0004_1 PDH 062596  
Figure Notes  
1. Wall-Mounting Plate  
4. First 1146B Power Distribution  
Unit  
2. Second 1146B Power Distribution Unit  
3. “T” Cable (H600-347-G7)  
5. 1145B Power Unit  
Figure 5-21. Expanded Power Distribution Unit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-51  
Power Up and Test  
1. Connect the AC power cord to the power supply and route the cord to an  
appropriate AC outlet using the clips provided on the unit.  
NOTE:  
A maximum of 4 power supplies can be powered from 1 dedicated  
110 VAC, 20 Amp feeder. Use only unswitched receptacles.  
2. Plug the cord into the outlet. This powers up the power supply.  
3. Check AC operation of the 1145B Power Supply by monitoring the LEDs:  
PASS: Green and yellow LEDs at the front of the unit should be lit  
together. Green means the power supply is providing power. Yellow  
means the battery is being charged. After the battery reaches full  
charge (maximum of twenty hours), the yellow LED should go out.  
FAIL: If either green or yellow LED is not lit after powering up,  
check the connections. Test the AC outlet. If power is available and  
the AC power cord and connections are good, replace the power  
unit.  
4. Disconnect the AC plug on the power supply, this activates the DC supply.  
5. Check DC (battery back-up) operation of the 1145B Power Supply by  
monitoring the LEDs:  
PASS: The red and green LEDs should be lit together. Red means  
the power supply is on battery back-up.  
FAIL: If either green or red LED is not lit after disconnecting AC  
power, check the connections. If the connections are good, replace  
the power unit or batteries.  
6. Reconnect AC power to the power supply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-52  
Wire the 1146B Power Distribution Unit  
Wire endpoints to the 1146B while power from the 1145B is on. A red LED lights if  
its associated circuit is connected to shorted wiring or to a shorted terminal.  
1. Install cross-connect jumpers to wire from the unit (the label shows  
polarity) to pins 7 and 8 of the appropriate information outlet. Route the  
wires through the clip provided on the unit. If a red LED is on, see ‘‘Reset  
LEDs on Power Distribution Unit’’.  
2. Mark lead destinations on the label next to each connector. Also mark the  
Unit Number and Connectivity information on the label.  
Reset LEDs on Power Distribution Unit  
A red LED next to any of the 32 power output connectors indicates a short circuit  
in the building wiring or the terminal equipment. To reset the LED:  
1. Disconnect the terminal equipment from the wall jack.  
2. If the LED goes off, the terminal equipment is faulty and must be replaced.  
If the LED is still lit, find and repair the short circuit in the building wiring.  
3. Reconnect the terminal equipment to the wall jack and re-test terminal  
equipment operation.  
!
WARNING:  
Important Safety Instructions follow.  
When operating this equipment, basic safety precautions must be followed to  
reduce the risk of fire, electric shock and personal injury, including the following:  
Read and understand all instructions.  
Do not attach the power supply cord to building surfaces.  
For continued back-up protection and battery reliability, replace batteries  
every 4 years.  
Follow all warnings and instructions marked on the products.  
Clean products only with a dry rag.  
Do not use this product near water.  
For mounting security, follow all installation instructions when mounting  
product.  
Openings on top and bottom of power unit are provided for ventilation. Do  
not block or cover these openings. Do not exceed recommended  
environmental temperatures.  
Operate these products only from the type of power source indicated on  
the product labels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1145B Power Supply  
5
Page 5-53  
The power unit is equipped with a 3 wire grounding type plug; a plug  
having a third (grounding) pin. This plug will only fit into a grounding type  
power outlet. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug  
into the outlet, contact an electrician to replace the outlet. Do not defeat  
the safety purpose of the grounding type plug.  
Do not allow anything to rest on or spill into the products.  
To reduce risk of fire and electrical shock, do not overload power outlets.  
Never push objects of any kind through the power supply or distribution  
unit slots as they may touch dangerous voltage points or short out parts  
that could result in a risk of fire or electrical shock.  
To reduce risk of electric shock, do not disassemble these products.  
Return them for repair when needed. Opening or removing covers may  
expose you to dangerous voltages or other risks. Incorrect reassembly  
can cause electric shock when the products are subsequently used.  
Power down the power unit (see label on power unit on how to do this) and  
refer servicing under the following conditions:  
— If liquid has been spilled into any of the products.  
— If any of the products have been exposed to water.  
— If any of the products do not operate normally.  
— If any of the products have been dropped or damaged.  
— If any of the products exhibits a change in performance.  
Do not attempt to recharge batteries on your own. The batteries may leak  
corrosive electrolyte or explode. The 1145B power unit recharges the  
batteries safely.  
Remove the batteries if the power unit will not be used for a long period of  
time (several months or more) since during this time the battery may leak.  
Discard discharged batteries as soon as possible. Discharged batteries  
are more likely to leak.  
Do not store batteries in high temperature areas. Batteries stored in a cold  
environment should be protected from condensation during storage and  
warming. Batteries should be stabilized at room temperature prior to use  
after cold storage. Do not install batteries if the manufacturing date on the  
label indicates that the batteries are more than 6 months old.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1151A Power Supply  
5
Page 5-54  
1151A Power Supply  
The 1151A and 1151A2 Power Supplies comply with the UL Standard UL 1459,  
second edition. Safety instructions follow the table of certifications.  
Complies  
Certified  
UL 1459  
CSA 22.2  
EN6950  
CE  
Approved  
Approved  
Important Safety Instructions  
Please read the following helpful tips. Retain these tips for later use.  
When using this power supply, the following safety precautions should always be  
followed to reduce the risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons.  
Read and understand all instructions.  
Follow all warnings and instructions marked on this power supply.  
This product can be hazardous if immersed in water. To avoid the  
possibility of electrical shock, do not use it near water.  
To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not disassemble this product  
except to replace battery.  
This product should be operated only from the type of AC power source  
indicated on the label. If you are not sure of the type of AC power being  
provided, contact a qualified service person.  
Do not allow anything to rest on the power cord. Do not locate this product  
where the cord will be abused by persons walking on it.  
Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords as this can result in the  
risk of line or electric shock.  
Disconnect the cords on this product and refer servicing to qualified  
service personnel under the following conditions:  
— When the power supply cord or plug is damaged or frayed.  
— If liquid has been spilled into the product.  
— If the product has been exposed to rain or water.  
— If the product was dropped or the housing has been damaged.  
— If the product exhibits a distinct change in performance.  
— If the product does not operate normally by following the operating  
instructions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1151A Power Supply  
5
Page 5-55  
The 1151Aand 1151A2 Power Supplies  
The 1151A and 1151A2 Power Supplies can be used to supply local power to  
ISDN-T 65xx, 75xx, 84xx, and 85xx series voice terminals connected to a system  
and to the DCP 7444 voice terminal or 302C Attendant Console that need  
auxiliary power for its display. The unit can supply power to adjunct equipment  
such as S201A and CS201A speakerphones or a 500A Headset Adapter  
attached to any currently manufactured analog, DCP, or ISDN-T voice terminal  
equipped with an adjunct jack.  
!
CAUTION:  
The power supply can be used only with telecommunications equipment,  
indoors, and in a controlled environment.  
The power supply has a single output of -48 VDC, 0.4 Amps, and can operate  
from either a 120 VAC 60 Hz power source (105 to 129 VAC) or a 220/230/240  
VAC 50 Hz power source (198 to 264 VAC). Input voltage selection is automatic.  
The output capacity is 19.2 Watts.  
The power supply can be placed on a flat surface such as a desk. For  
wall-mounting, keyhole slots are provided on the bottom of the chassis.  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not locate the unit within 6 inches (15.2 cm) of the floor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
1151A Power Supply  
5
Page 5-56  
Connect the 1151A or 1151A2 Power Supplies  
The 1151A is a standard (no battery backup) power supply unit. The 1151A2 is a  
battery backup version of the 1151A. Either power supply can support 1  
telephone with or without an adjunct. The maximum loop range is 250 feet (76  
meters). Two modular jacks are used. Power is provided on the PHONE jack,  
pins 7 and 8 (- and +, respectively).  
The PHONE and LINE jacks are 8-pin female non-keyed 657-type jacks that can  
accept D4, D6, and D8 modular plug cables. Figure 5-22 shows an 1151A Power  
Supply. The 1151A2 looks similar.  
pwr_sup1 CJL 051496  
Figure 5-22. Typical 1151A Power Supply Front  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
5
Page 5-57  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
The resistors balance the cable plant between the receiver and the transmitter on  
the interface. When using the TN2198 ISDN-BRI 2-Wire U Interface circuit pack,  
an NT1 is required. A terminating resistor is always required near the terminal  
when the BRI S-type interface circuit pack (TN556 BRI 4-Wire S-NT Line circuit  
pack) is used (see #5ESS Switch Integrated Services Digital Network Customer  
Premises Planning Guide, 533-700-100).  
The resistor is built into the NT1 and can be 1 of 3 values, depending on the  
configuration and the distance from the NT1 to the ISDN terminal. The resistor  
value is controlled from the NT1. A terminating resistor adapter may be needed  
near the terminal and can be placed in the satellite closet or work location.  
NOTE:  
The 440A4 terminating resistor and 110RA1-12 terminating resistor block  
are UL listed. Most new installations are the 110RA1-12 terminating resistor  
block. The following installation instructions should be observed.  
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.  
Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically  
designed for wet locations.  
Never touch uninsulated wires or terminals unless the telephone line has  
been disconnected at the network interface.  
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
5
Page 5-58  
Terminating Resistor Adapter  
Figure 5-23 shows an 8-pin 440A4 terminating resistor adapter. The adapter is 3  
inches (7.6 cm) long with an 8-wide plug at 1 end, a short cord, and an 8-wide  
jack at the opposite end.  
3
2
R
C
R
C
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
4
1
Figure Notes  
1. 8-Wide Plug  
2. Cord  
3. Plastic Housing  
4. 8-Wide Jack  
Figure 5-23. 8-Wide Terminating Resistor Adapter (440A4)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
5
Page 5-59  
Closet Mounted (110RA1-12)  
The 110RA1-12 terminating resistor block is designed to mount in the  
telecommunications wire closet. It consists of twelve 2-pair circuits and provides  
the 100 Ohm termination used for ISDN-BRI circuits.  
Figure 5-24 shows the wiring of the 110RA1-12. Three rows of 110D-4 connector  
blocks are mounted on a printed wire board along with circuit resistors and  
capacitors. The bottom row is designated as the input row and the top and  
middle rows are designated as the output rows. The circuit assembly is mounted  
on a standard 110A-100 pair mounting base. The 110RA1-12 is shipped with  
preprinted designation strips to simplify circuit identification and installation.  
1
2
1
2
3
4
45 46 47 48  
6
3
4
7
5
8
Figure Notes  
1. Circuit 1  
5. Input Row “C”  
2. Circuit 12  
6. Only First Circuit Shown to All 12 Circuits (2APR)  
Per Block  
3. Output Row “A”  
7. 110D-4 Connector Block  
4. Output Row “B”  
8. Printed Circuit Board Mounted on Standard 110A  
or 100APR Block  
Figure 5-24. Terminating Resistor Block (110RA1-12)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
BRI Terminating Resistor  
5
Page 5-60  
Figure 5-25 shows the wiring connections for the 110RA1-12 terminal block. The  
TN556 Basic Rate Interface (BRI) switch port is terminated to bottom row C.  
1
8
10  
11  
12  
7
6
2
T
R
T1 R1  
3
9
4
5
Figure Notes  
1. Part of Terminating Resistor Block  
2. White or Purple Field  
7. Basic Multi-point Option  
8. 2-Pair Cross-Connect  
9. 4-Pair Horizontal Cables  
3. Part of 4-Pair Blue Field  
4. From ISDN T-interface Circuit (2-Pair)  
5. To ISDN S/T-interface terminals  
6. 2-Pair Cross-Connect  
10. Row “A”  
11. Row “B”  
12. Row “C”  
Figure 5-25. Typical Installation of Terminating Resistor Block (110RA1-12)  
For point-to-point wiring, the top row connects to the blue station field. The pair  
connects from the 110RA1-12 to the standard 4-pair circuit. Pair 1 from the  
110RA1-12 connects to Pair 1 of the station field, and Pair 2 connects to Pair 3 of  
the station field.  
Two terminal basic multipoint applications are accommodated by connecting row  
B (output) to the second terminal common to the multipoint circuit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Multi-point Adapters  
5
Page 5-61  
Multi-point Adapters  
Multi-point Adapters are used to provide signal fanout of the T-interface. Fanout  
can be performed at the work station by the BR851-B or the 367A. These  
adapters support more than one ISDN terminal per horizontal 4-pair D-inside wire  
(DIW). To support multiple horizontal runs, perform fanout in the satellite closet by  
an MDF with multiple common rows. The 110RA1-12 provides fanout for 2  
horizontal runs and contains the 100 Ohm terminating resistor. This can be used  
for Basic Multi-point or point-to-point with terminating resistor in the closet. Other  
fanout blocks include the 110AB1-025M and the 110AB1-050M.  
BR851-B Adapter (T-Adapter)  
The BR851-B supports 2 terminals on 1 multi-point BRI at the work station. It is a  
T-shaped device used to fanout transmission and power. The BR851-B is an  
8-pin device with a single plug and 2 jacks. See Figure 5-26.  
3
8
4
7
4
6
3
5
1
4
1
3
2
2
1
2
2
1
6
5
3
T
R T R T R  
R T  
R T R T R  
T
3
R T  
R T  
R
3
T R  
T
3
R
T
2
1
2
4
8
4
7
3
6
1
5
1
4
2
2
2
1
1
2
4
8
4
7
1
5
1
4
2
2
3
6
3
1
4
4
Figure Notes  
1. Wire Pairs  
4. Female  
2. Pin Numbers  
3. Modular Plug (Male)  
5. Two 8-pin Modular Jacks  
6. T-Type Adapter  
Figure 5-26. Wiring Diagram of BR851-B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Multi-point Adapters  
5
Page 5-62  
367A Adapter  
The 367A adapter provides fanout. See Figure 5-27. It can provide inputs to up to  
7 terminals. The 367A is an 8-conductor adapter and can be is used at the work  
location for bridging 3 to 7 terminals.  
4
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
Figure Notes  
1. Jack 1  
3. Jack 8  
4. 367A Adapter  
2. Jack 2  
Figure 5-27. Wiring Diagram of 367A  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Multi-point Adapters  
5
Page 5-63  
Basic Multipoint Installation Distances  
Figure 5-28 provides cabling information for fan-out of ISDN-BRI multi-point  
installations. The terminating resistor is generally located in the satellite closet. All  
2
distances assume 24 AWG (#5) (0.26 mm ) D-Inside Wire (DIW).  
9
4
6
7
11  
10  
1
2
11  
5
3
8
inst_dis CJL 030796  
Figure Notes  
1. S-Interface Source (TN556)  
2. Terminating Resistor  
3. Satellite Closet  
6. System Cabinet  
7. Terminating Endpoint 1  
8. Terminating Endpoint 2  
4. Maximum Distance from S-Interface 9. Work Location  
Source to Work Location (1600 Feet)  
10. Maximum Distance from  
(488 m)  
Information Outlet to Terminating  
Endpoint (33 Feet) (10 m)  
5. Maximum Distance From Satellite  
Closet to Work Location (250 Feet)  
(76 m)  
11. Information Outlet (Bridged Tap)  
Figure 5-28. Basic Multi-point with 1 Work Location  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-64  
Add Circuit Packs  
When installing additional features or equipment, it may be necessary to install  
additional port circuit packs. See Figure 5-16 for a list of circuit packs. This is a  
general procedure to use when adding features or equipment that require adding  
circuit packs.  
1. Log onto the system and answer y to the Suppress Alarm Origination  
question during login.  
2. Install the circuit pack into the carrier.  
3. Log off the system after the addition (and any required administration) is  
complete.  
NOTE:  
If North American and non-United States circuit packs appear in the same  
row of a table, those circuit pack codes ordinarily used in North America  
appear in bold font to help distinguish these circuit packs from their  
non-United States counterparts. If only circuit packs commonly used for  
non-United States applications appear in a row of a table, the circuit-pack  
codes are enclosed in parentheses. If only circuit packs commonly used in  
North America appear in a row of a table, the circuit pack codes are  
enclosed in square brackets.  
For information about connecting and administering non-United States circuit  
packs, refer to the Application Notes in DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
List of Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-65  
List of Circuit Packs  
Table 5-16 lists the circuit packs sorted by apparatus code, including circuit  
packs used in non-United States installations. For more information on the circuit  
packs and other equipment, refer to DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 System Description Pocket Reference.  
Table 5-16. Circuit Packs and Circuit Modules  
Apparatus  
Code  
Name  
Type  
631DA1  
631DB1  
644A1  
645B1  
649A  
AC Power Unit  
AC Power Unit  
DC Power Unit  
DC Power Unit  
DC Power Unit  
AC Power Unit  
DC Power Supply  
Current Limiter  
Current Limiter  
Memory Expansion  
DEFINITY AUDIX R3 System  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
650A  
Power  
676B  
Power  
982LS  
CFY1B  
CPP1  
Power  
Power  
Control  
Port Assembly  
ED-1E546  
(TN2169)  
(TN2170)  
(TN566)  
(TN567)  
ED-1E546  
(TN2208)  
(TN2170)  
Call Visor ASAI over the DEFINITY (LAN) Gateway R1 Port Assembly  
J58890MA-1  
(TN800)  
CallVisor over the DEFINITY LAN Gateway R2  
Port Assembly  
TN417  
Auxiliary Trunk  
Port  
TN419B  
TN420B/C  
TN429/B  
TN429C  
TN429D  
Tone-Clock  
Control  
Service  
Port  
Tone Detector  
Direct Inward/Outward Dialing (DIOD) Trunk  
Analog Central Office Trunk  
Analog DIOD Trunk - Analog Loop Start  
Port  
Port  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
List of Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-66  
Table 5-16. Circuit Packs and Circuit Modules Continued  
Apparatus  
Code  
Name  
Type  
TN433  
TN436B  
TN437  
TN438B  
TN439  
TN447  
TN457  
TN458  
TN459B  
Speech Synthesizer  
Direct Inward Dialing Trunk  
Tie Trunk  
Service  
Port  
Port  
Central Office Trunk  
Tie Trunk  
Port  
Port  
Central Office Trunk  
Speech Synthesizer  
Tie Trunk  
Port  
Service  
Port  
Direct Inward Dialing Trunk  
Port  
TN464C/D/E/F DS1 Interface - T1, 24 Channel - E1, 32 Channel  
Port  
TN465/B/C  
TN467  
Central Office Trunk  
Analog Line  
Port  
Port  
TN468B  
TN479  
Analog Line  
Port  
Analog Line  
Port  
TN497  
Tie Trunk  
Port  
TN553  
Packet Data Line  
ISDN-BRI 4-Wire S/T-NT Line (A-Law)  
Expansion Interface  
Switch Node Clock  
Switch Node Interface  
DS1 Converter - T1, 24 Channel  
Packet Gateway  
DS1 Tie Trunk  
Port  
TN556/B  
TN570/B/C  
TN572  
Port  
Port  
Control  
Control  
Port  
TN573/B  
TN574  
TN577  
Port  
TN722B  
TN725B  
TN726/B  
TN735  
Port  
Speech Synthesizer  
Data Line  
Service  
Port  
MET Line  
Port  
TN742  
Analog Line  
Port  
TN744/B/C  
Call Classifier  
Service  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
List of Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-67  
Table 5-16. Circuit Packs and Circuit Modules Continued  
Apparatus  
Code  
Name  
Type  
TN744/D  
TN746/B  
TN747B  
Call Classifier - Detector  
Analog Line  
Service  
Port  
Central Office Trunk  
Tone Detector  
Port  
TN748/B/C/D  
TN750/B/C  
TN753/B  
TN754/B/C  
TN755B  
Service  
Service  
Port  
Announcement  
Direct Inward Dialing Trunk  
Digital Line 4-Wire DCP  
Neon Power Unit  
Tone Detector  
Port  
Power  
Service  
Port  
TN756  
TN758  
Pooled Modem  
Tie Trunk  
TN760B/C/D  
TN762B  
Port  
Hybrid Line  
Port  
TN763B/C/D  
TN765  
Auxiliary Trunk  
Port  
Processor Interface  
Control  
Port  
TN767B/C/D/E DS1 Interface - T1, 24 Channel  
TN768  
Tone-Clock  
Control  
Port  
TN769  
Analog Line  
TN771D  
TN772  
Maintenance/Test  
Duplication Interface  
Processor  
Service  
Control  
Control  
Service  
Port  
TN773  
TN775/B/C  
TN776  
Maintenance  
Expansion Interface  
Network Control  
Packet Control  
Tone-Clock  
TN777/B  
TN778  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Service  
TN780  
TN786  
Processor  
TN786B  
TN787F/G/H/J/K  
Processor  
Multimedia Interface  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
List of Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-68  
Table 5-16. Circuit Packs and Circuit Modules Continued  
Apparatus  
Code  
Name  
Type  
TN788B  
TN789  
Multimedia Voice Conditioner  
Radio Controller  
Service  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Port  
TN790  
Processor  
TN791  
Guest Line - Category B  
Analog Line, 24-Port, 2-Wire  
Network Control/Packet Interface (Net/Pkt)  
Processor  
TN793  
TN794  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Port  
TN796B  
TN798  
Processor  
TN799  
Control-LAN Interface  
System Access/Maintenance  
Multi-Application Platform for DEFINITY (MAPD)  
Multi-Application Platform for DEFINITY (MAPD)  
Multi-Application Platform for DEFINITY (MAPD)  
Memory  
TN1648/B  
TN800  
Control  
Port  
TN801  
Port  
TN802  
Port  
TN1650B  
TN1654  
TN1655  
TN1656  
TN1657  
TN2135  
TN2136  
TN2138  
TN2139  
TN2140/B  
TN2144  
TN2146  
TN2147/C  
TN2149  
TN2180  
Control  
Port  
DS1 Converter - T1, 24 Channel/E1, 32 Channel  
Packet Interface  
Control  
Control  
Control  
Port  
Tape Drive  
Disk Drive  
Analog Line  
Digital Line 2-Wire DCP  
Central Office Trunk  
Direct Inward Dialing Trunk  
Tie Trunk  
Port  
Port  
Port  
Port  
Analog Line  
Port  
Direct Inward Dialing Trunk  
Central Office Trunk  
Analog Line  
Port  
Port  
Port  
Analog Line  
Port  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
List of Circuit Packs  
5
Page 5-69  
Table 5-16. Circuit Packs and Circuit Modules Continued  
Apparatus  
Code  
Name  
Type  
TN2181  
TN2182/B  
TN2183  
TN2184  
TN2185  
TN2198  
TN2199  
TN2202  
TN2207  
TN2209  
TN2210  
TN2214  
TN2215  
TN2224  
TN2238  
TN2301  
TN2464  
TN2793  
Digital Line 2-Wire DCP  
Port  
Tone-Clock -Tone Detector and Call Classifier  
Analog Line  
Control  
Port  
DIOD Trunk  
Port  
ISDN-BRI 4-Wire S/T-TE Interface  
ISDN-BRI 2-Wire U Interface  
Central Office Trunk  
Port  
Port  
Port  
Ring Generator  
Power  
Port  
DS1 Interface - T1, 24 Channel - E1, 32 Channel  
Tie Trunk  
Port  
Tone Generator  
Service  
Port  
Digital Line, 24-Port, 2-Wire DCP - Category B  
Analog Line, 16-Port, 2-Wire - Category B  
Digital Line, 24-Port, 2-Wire DCP  
ATM Trunk Interface  
Port  
Port  
Port  
Survivable Remote Switch  
DS1 Interface - T1, 24 Channel - E1, 32 Channel  
Analog Line 24-Port - Category B  
Switch  
Port  
Port  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-70  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
This chapter details the installation of the fiber optic cable using the DEFINITY  
fiber optic pass-thru kit for multicarrier cabinets (MCC) only. This kit (comcode  
848029278) provides the equipment necessary to install the fiber optic  
connectors and associated cabling.  
Unpack and Inspect  
1. Verify the equipment received. See Figure 5-29. Actual equipment may  
vary in appearance and may ship in separate packages.  
2. See Table 5-17 for a list of part comcodes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-71  
2
1
3
6
5
7
8
4
indapkit RPY 012398  
Figure Notes  
1. Pass-thru Tool  
5. Fiber Optic Cable Disconnect Label  
2. SC-SC Fiber Optic Adapter 6. I/O Connector Adapter Bracket  
3. ST-SC Fiber Optic Adapter  
4. Fiber Optic Cable  
7. Cable Tie  
8. Cable Tie Mount  
Figure 5-29. Fiber Pass-Thru Kit Equipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-72  
Table 5-17.  
Quantity Description  
Comcode  
1
Pass-thru Tool  
847978715  
107118903  
107087967  
107122640  
847978673  
848029286  
407814672  
403053150  
1
Beige SC-SC Fiber Optic Adapter (multimode)  
Beige ST-SC Fiber Optic Adapter (multimode)  
Ten-foot (3 m) Fiber Optic Cable (multimode)  
I/O Connector Adapter Bracket  
Fiber Optic Cable Disconnect Label  
Cable Ties  
1
1
1
1
10  
6
Cable Tie Mounts  
LASER Product  
The DEFINITY ECS may contain a Class 1 LASER device if single-mode fiber  
optic cable is connected to a remote Expansion Port Network (EPN). The LASER  
device operates within the following parameters:  
Maximum Power Output: -5dBm  
Wavelength: 1310 nm  
Mode Field Diameter: 8.8 microns  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  
IEC 825 1993  
!
CAUTION:  
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Cabinet Preparation  
1. Open the front door.  
NOTE:  
Administration may be required before removing the circuit pack in  
the following step.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-73  
2. Determine which slot (1 or 2) will contain the new fiber optic circuit pack.  
Remove the circuit pack or the blanking plate from this slot.  
NOTE:  
If a circuit pack is removed from the required slot, it must be installed  
into a different slot in the cabinet. All translations associated with this  
circuit pack must also be moved.  
3. Remove the circuit pack or the blanking plate from the slot next to the slot  
determined in step 2. Two consecutive open slots are required to install  
the fiber optic adapter.  
NOTE:  
If a circuit pack was removed in step 3, it will be replaced into the  
same slot, later in this section.  
4. Install the new circuit pack.  
5. Open the rear door.  
6. From the rear, remove the I/O cable connector associated with the slot that  
will contain the new fiber optic circuit pack. See Figure 5-30.  
7. Using a supplied cable tie, secure the removed I/O connector to nearby  
cabling. See Figure 5-31.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-74  
1
2
lcda8fop RPY 021198  
Figure Notes  
1. Press tab down  
2. Pull connector forward  
Figure 5-30. Remove the I/O Cable Connector  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-75  
lcda9fop RPY 021398  
1
Figure Notes  
1. Tie wrap  
Figure 5-31. Secure the I/O Cable Connector  
8. From the front, remove the fan cover. See Figure 5-32.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-76  
lcda3fop RPY 021198  
Figure 5-32. Remove the Fan Cover  
Install the Pass-thru Kit  
1. Snap the SC-SC fiber optic adapter on the pass-thru tool. See Figure 5-33.  
Use the beige adapter even if single-mode fiber is being installed. The  
SC-SC adapter is better suited for cable routing in the next steps.  
NOTE:  
If single-mode fiber is being installed, the beige adapter will be  
replaced with a blue adapter, later in this section.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-77  
1
dafocoup RPY 062497  
Figure Notes  
1. Pass-thru Tool  
2. SC-SC Fiber Optic Adapter  
Figure 5-33. Fiber Optic Adapter and Pass-Thru Tool  
2. Slide the tool to the rear of the cabinet. See Figure 5-34.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-78  
lcda2fop RPY 021098  
Figure 5-34. Insert the Pass-thru Tool  
!
CAUTION:  
Avoid bending fiber optic cables to a radius smaller than 1.5 inches  
(3.8 cm), to prevent mechanical stress on the cables.  
!
CAUTION:  
During the actual installation of fiber optic components, use either all beige  
or all blue adapters. Beige denotes multimode fiber and blue denotes  
single-mode fiber. Do not mix beige with blue.  
3. Attach the supplied fiber optic cable to the adapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-79  
4. Pull the tool (with adapter and cable attached) out through the front of the  
cabinet. See Figure 5-35.  
5. From the rear, route the fiber optic cable through the opening vacated by  
the I/O cable connector.  
6. If necessary, remove the fiber adapter from the tool and plug the fiber  
optic cable into the SC-SC (single-mode) or ST-SC (multimode) adapter.  
See Figure 5-36. Check the house cabling before selecting a coupling to  
use.  
7. From the front of the I/O connector adapter bracket (with fiber cable),  
snap the coupling into the supplied I/O connector adapter bracket.  
8. Snap the I/O connector adapter bracket into the I/O connector opening.  
9. Attach the outside fiber plant to the I/O connector on the rear of the  
cabinet.  
lcda6fop RPY 021698  
Figure 5-35. Fiber Optic Cable and Adapter  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-80  
1
2
3
lcda7fop RPY 021698  
Figure Notes:  
1. Fiber cable  
3. SC-SC adapter or ST-SC adapter  
2. I/O connector adapter bracket  
Figure 5-36. Bracket Attachments  
10. Wrap the cable disconnect label around the fiber optic cable. See  
Figure 5-37.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-81  
1
prda0001 RPY 021898  
Figure Notes  
1. To outside plant fiber  
Figure 5-37. Cable Disconnect Label  
11. Close the rear door.  
!
CAUTION:  
Avoid bending fiber optic cables to a radius smaller than 1.5 inches  
(3.8 cm), to prevent mechanical stress on the cables. Plan the use of  
cable ties to avoid crimping the cable or creating a fixed stress point  
where, at a later time, movement of the cable causes it to exceed the  
minimum bend radius.  
!
CAUTION:  
Be careful not to crimp the fiber cable when you are performing the  
following step.  
12. Replace the fan cover. See Figure 5-38.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-82  
lcda5fop RPY 021398  
Figure 5-38. Replace the Fan Cover  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-83  
13. Connect the fiber cable to the angled connector on the front of the circuit  
pack. See Figure 5-39.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
TONE-  
CLOCK  
EXPN  
INTFC  
POWER UNIT  
scdafo_4 RPY 081997  
Figure 5-39. Connect Fiber Cable to Circuit Pack  
14. Dress the cable using the supplied cable ties and cable tie mounts. See  
Figure 5-40.  
NOTE:  
Dress the fiber optic cable straight down the front of the circuit pack.  
Do not allow the cable to cross in front of another circuit pack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add the Fiber Optic Cable  
5
Page 5-84  
lcda4fop RPY 021398  
Figure 5-40. Dress the Cable  
15. If a circuit pack was removed to access 2 open slots (from ‘‘Cabinet  
Preparation’’ on page 5-72), replace the circuit pack into its original slot.  
16. Close the front door.  
17. Discard the pass-thru tool.  
Test the Installation  
1. Login to the management terminal.  
2. Administer the system by referring to the ATM section of the Installation  
and Test for Adjuncts and Peripherals, 555-230-125.  
3. Enter list configuration all to determine if the new circuit pack appears in  
the correct slot and that there are no circuit pack conflicts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add CO, FX, WATS, and PCOL  
5
Page 5-85  
Add CO, FX, WATS, and PCOL  
Requirements  
Each Central Office (CO), Foreign Exchange (FX), Wide Area  
Telecommunications Service (WATS), or Personal Central Office Line (PCOL)  
trunk is connected to 1 port of either an 8-port TN747 or to 1 of an assortment of  
non-United States CO Trunk circuit packs.  
Installation  
1. Determine the port assignment of the trunk from Trunk Group form. For  
example:  
Port Number  
07  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network)  
2. See ‘‘Off-Premises Station Wiring’’ on page 5-30 and install a TN747 or a  
non-United States CO trunk circuit pack in the assigned carrier slot (if an  
additional circuit pack is required).  
3. Administer the forms listed under CO, FX, WATS, or PCOL Trunk Group in  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration  
and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add DID Trunks  
5
Page 5-86  
Add DID Trunks  
Requirements  
Each Direct Inward Dial (DID) trunk connects to 1 port of an 8-port TN753 or to 1  
of an assortment of non-United States DID trunk circuit packs.  
Installation  
1. Determine the port assignment of the trunk from Trunk Group form. For  
example:  
Port Number  
07  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network)  
2. See‘‘Off-Premises Station Wiring’’ on page 5-30 and install a TN753 or a  
non-United States DID trunk circuit pack in assigned carrier slot (if an  
additional circuit pack is required).  
3. Administer forms listed under “DID Trunk Group” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Tie Trunks  
5
Page 5-87  
Add Tie Trunks  
Requirements  
Each tie trunk connects to 1 port of a 4-port TN760 or to an assortment of  
non-United States tie trunk circuit packs.  
Installation  
1. Determine the port assignment of the trunk from Trunk Group form.  
Port Number  
3
A
02  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network) (or Single-Carrier  
Cabinet)  
2. Install a TN760 or a non-United States tie trunk circuit pack in the  
assigned carrier slot (if an additional circuit pack is required).  
3. For customer-owned (not leased) tie-trunk facilities (such as campus  
environments), TN760 circuit packs provide signaling capabilities beyond  
those specified by the industry-wide E & M standard. Use Figure 5-41 and  
Table 5-18 to choose the preferred signaling format, set switches on the  
TN760 circuit pack, and administer the port.  
4. Administer forms listed under “Tie Trunk Group” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Tie Trunks  
5
Page 5-88  
UNPROT  
4
3
2
1
SMPLX  
E&M  
SMPLX  
E&M  
SMPLX  
E&M  
SMPLX  
E&M  
PROT  
PORT 4  
PORT 3  
PORT 2  
PORT 1  
Figure 5-41. TN760 Tie Trunk Circuit Packs (Component Side)  
Table 5-18. TN760D Option Switch Settings and Administration  
E&M/SMPLX Prot/Unprot  
Administered  
Port  
Installation Situation  
Preferred Signaling Format  
Switch  
Switch  
Circumstance  
To  
System  
Far-End  
Co-Located  
DEFINITY  
E&M Type 1  
Compatible  
E&M Type 1  
Standard  
E&M  
Unprotected  
Type 1  
Compatible  
Type 1  
Inter-Building  
DEFINITY  
Protected  
Type 1  
Protected  
Type 1  
E&M  
Protected  
Compatible  
Standard  
Plus  
Compatible  
Protection  
Unit  
Co-Located  
Net  
Integrated  
E&M Type 1  
Standard  
Any PBX  
E&M  
Unprotected  
Type 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
5
Page 5-89  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
The TN722B DS1 Tie Trunk, TN767C DS1 Interface, and TN464C DS1 Interface  
circuit packs provide connections to a 1.544 Mbps or 2.08 Mbps DS1 facility as  
24 independent 64 kbps trunks. When upgrading from a TN722 to a TN767C:  
1. Remove all TN722 trunk members from affected trunk groups.  
2. Enter remove ds1 PCSS(PCSS is the slot containing the TN722).  
3. Remove the TN722 circuit pack.  
4. Put the TN767C circuit pack into the same slot.  
5. Wait until the red LED goes off. The hardware tests take 12 to 20 seconds  
to run. When the red LED goes off, the tests have completed.  
6. If the red LED stays on, reseat the board and repeat this step.  
7. Enter add ds1 PCSS.  
8. Continue with appropriate procedures to set up members of trunk groups.  
Service Interruption  
Since the addition of DS1 tie-trunk service may require a service interruption,  
notify the customer in advance as to when the addition will be carried out.  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance, and press RETURN.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
WARNING:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of software, disable Cleared Alarm Notification  
and Restart Notificationbefore submitting the form.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
5
Page 5-90  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation. Press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750/B Announcement circuit pack, enter  
display announcements and press Enter. If administered recorded  
announcements are listed, enter list configuration software-version  
press Enter. Check Page 2 of this form to see when the announcements  
were last saved. To save the current announcements, enter save  
announcements and press Enter.  
Shut Down DEFINITY LAN Gateway System  
!
WARNING:  
Neglecting to shut down a DEFINITY LAN Gateway assembly before powering down  
the system cabinet where it resides can damage the LAN Gateway disk.  
!
CAUTION:  
Save the system parameters if you plan to reuse the current system.  
1. Log onto the DEFINITY LAN Gateway.  
2. When the main menu appears, select Maintenance.  
3. Select Reset Systemfrom the Maintenancemenu.  
4. Select Shutdownfrom the Reset Systemmenu.  
Shut Down DEFINITY AUDIX System  
!
WARNING:  
Neglecting to shut down an AUDIX assembly before powering down the system  
cabinet where it resides can damage the AUDIX disk.  
1. If a DEFINITY AUDIX resides in the system to be upgraded, shut down the  
AUDIX assembly and allow the disk to completely spin down.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
5
Page 5-91  
Power Down System  
NOTE:  
Power down the PPN only if the existing Tone-Clock is being replaced in a  
standard reliability system.  
1. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
2. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
Add Circuit Packs  
1. Determine the port assignments of the circuit packs to be added.  
2. Install the TN722B DS1 Tie Trunk, the TN767C DS1 Interface, or TN464C  
DS1 Interface circuit pack in assigned carrier slot.  
3. Replace an existing TN756 Tone Detector/Generator circuit pack with:  
a. TN768, TN780, or a non-United States TN419B Tone-Clock  
b. TN748B or a non-United States TN420B Tone Detector  
Install Cables  
Install H600-307 cable from the cabinet to a Channel Service Unit (CSU) and  
install cables from the CSU to the MDF as required.  
Power Up System  
1. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
3. The system performs the level 4 rebooting process, loading the system  
translations from the translation card or tape. Rebooting takes 8 to 11  
minutes.  
4. After the system reboot is finished and all trouble is cleared, verify that the  
EMERGENCY TRANSFER CONTROL switch is set to AUTO. This restores  
the system to the normal mode.  
Enter Added Translations  
Administer forms listed under “DS1 Tie Trunk Service” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add DS1 Tie and OPS  
5
Page 5-92  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the PPN contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter.  
If Page 2 of this form shows that recorded announcements were saved,  
these announcements can be restored using the restore announcements  
command. Enter restore announcements and press Enter.  
Enable Customer Options  
1. Enter change system-parameters customer-options and press Enter.  
2. Use these forms to verify the customer options are properly set.  
NOTE:  
In the Basic Call Setup field, if ISDN-PRI?was set to ybefore the  
upgrade, be sure to set the field back to y.  
Resolve Alarms  
Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance R6vs/si.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the INADS  
Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC). Verify that INADS  
can dial into the system and that the system can dial out to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database Administrator  
enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Code Calling Access  
5
Page 5-93  
Add Code Calling Access  
The tones for the Code Calling feature are generated by the TN756, TN768,  
TN780, TN2182, or TN419B Tone-Clock circuit packs in the port networks.  
Install a TN763 (or a non-United States TN417) Auxiliary Trunk circuit pack or a  
TN457 Speech Synthesizer circuit pack and connect for Loudspeaker Paging.  
The Code Calling Access feature shares the same ports as Loudspeaker Paging.  
An Auxiliary Trunk circuit pack provides 4 ports for Loudspeaker Paging and  
Code Calling Access.  
Administer the form listed under “Code Calling Access” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Add Speech Synthesis  
The TN725B Speech Synthesizer circuit pack is required when the Voice  
Message Retrieval, Automatic Wakeup, or Do Not Disturb features are activated.  
The TN725B circuit pack does not require administration.  
1. Determine the port assignment of the Speech Synthesizer circuit pack to  
be added.  
2. Install the TN725B Speech Synthesizer circuit pack in the designated  
carrier slot.  
Add Pooled Modem  
Modem Pooling supports 2 kinds of conversion resources: “integrated” and  
“combined.” The integrated type requires a TN758 Pooled Modem circuit pack  
for each 2 conversion resources provided.  
The combined type requires a port of a TN754, TN413, or TN2136 Digital Line  
circuit pack and a port of either an 8-port TN742, TN769, or TN467 or a 16-port  
TN746B, TN468B, TN2135, TN2144, or TN2149 Analog Line circuit pack for each  
conversion resource provided.  
1. Determine the port assignment of the circuit pack to be added (if  
required).  
2. Install the appropriate circuit pack in assigned carrier slot (if required).  
3. Administer the forms listed under “Modem Pooling” in DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to EPN  
5
Page 5-94  
Add External Modem to EPN  
U.S. Robotics Model 839 External Modem  
3
1
TERMINAL  
2
cydfepnm KLC 100397  
Figure Notes:  
1. U.S. Robotics External Modem  
2. RS-232 Cable  
3. Expansion Port Network  
Figure 5-42. Connect External Modem to EPN  
1. Connect an RS-232 cable to the modem. See Figure 5-42.  
NOTE:  
In the following steps, a PC with Windows 95 or Windows NT 4.0 may  
be substituted for the dumb terminal. Use the Hyperterminal  
(terminal emulation) application.  
2. Connect the opposite end of the RS-232 cable to a dumb terminal.  
3. Set the dumb terminal to full duplex mode.  
4. Enter AT&N6 to set the baud rate to 9600.  
NOTE:  
The modem connects at 9600 baud but throughput is at 1200 baud.  
5. Enter AT&W0 to save the setting into non-volatile RAM.  
6. Set Switch 5 to the OFF (up) position to disable auto answer.  
7. Disconnect the RS-232 cable from the terminal and connect it to the  
TERMINAL connector on the rear of the system cabinet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to PPN  
5
Page 5-95  
Add External Modem to PPN  
U.S. Robotics Model 839 External Modem  
3
1
TERMINAL  
2
cydfepnm KLC 100397  
Figure Notes:  
1. U.S. Robotics External Modem  
2. RS-232 Cable  
3. Processor Port Network  
Figure 5-43. Connect External Modem to PPN  
1. Connect an RS-232 cable to the modem. See Figure 5-43.  
NOTE:  
In the following steps, a PC with Windows 95 or Windows NT 4.0 may  
be substituted for the dumb terminal. Use the Hyperterminal  
(terminal emulation) application.  
2. Connect the opposite end of the RS-232 cable to a dumb terminal.  
3. Set the dumb terminal to full duplex mode.  
4. Enter AT&N6 to set the baud rate to 9600.  
NOTE:  
The modem connects at 9600 baud but throughput is at 1200 baud.  
5. Enter AT&W0 to save the setting into non-volatile RAM.  
6. Set Switch 5 to the OFF (up) position to disable auto answer.  
7. Disconnect the RS-232 cable from the terminal and connect it to the  
TERMINAL connector on the rear of the system cabinet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-96  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
Use a type approved external modem.  
Unpack and Inspect  
1. Verify the equipment received. See Figure 5-44. Actual equipment may  
vary in appearance and may ship in separate packages.  
2. See Table 5-19 for a list of part comcodes.  
1
2
3
5
4
indakit2 RPY 021898  
Figure Notes  
1. Pass-thru Tool  
4. Cable Tie Mount  
5. Cable Tie  
2. Panel Adapter Bracket  
3. Cable Assembly  
Figure 5-44. Pass-Thru Kit Equipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-97  
Table 5-19.  
Quantity Description  
Comcode  
1
Pass-thru Tool  
847978715  
---------------  
---------------  
407814672  
403053150  
1
Panel Adapter Bracket  
Cable Assembly  
Cable Ties  
1
10  
6
Cable Tie Mounts  
Cabinet Preparation  
1. Open the front door.  
NOTE:  
Administration may be required before removing the circuit pack in  
the following step.  
2. Determine which slot will contain the new circuit pack. Remove the circuit  
pack or the apparatus blank from this slot.  
3. Install the new circuit pack.  
4. From the front, remove the fan cover. See Figure 5-45.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-98  
lcda3fop RPY 021198  
Figure 5-45. Remove the Fan Cover  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-99  
Install the Pass-thru Kit  
1. Open the rear door.  
2. Choose one of the following:  
If mounting the cable assembly to a cabinet with a cutout in the rear  
panel, attach it as shown in Figure 5-46. Then proceed to step 4.  
If mounting the cable assembly to a cabinet without a cutout in  
the rear panel, attach the panel adapter bracket as shown in  
Figure 5-47. Then proceed to step 3.  
prda0005 RPY 021298  
Figure 5-46. Insert the Cable Assembly through the Rear Panel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-100  
prda0002 RPY 021198  
Figure 5-47. Attach the Panel Adapter Bracket  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-101  
3. Insert the cable assembly as shown in Figure 5-48.  
prda0003 RPY 021798  
Figure 5-48. Insert the Cable Assembly through the Panel Adapter Bracket  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-102  
4. Connect the external modem cable to the cable assembly.  
5. Attach the RJ (telephone plug) to the pass-thru tool using a tie wrap. See  
Figure 5-49.  
3
2
3
1
fodacup3 RPY 021698  
Figure Notes  
1. Pass-thru Tool  
2. RJ45 (Telephone Plug)  
3. Tie Wrap  
Figure 5-49. Attach the Cable to the Pass-Thru Tool  
6. Slide the tool to the front of the cabinet. See Figure 5-50.  
7. Pull the tool (with adapter and cable attached) out through the front of the  
cabinet.  
8. Close the rear door.  
9. Replace the fan cover. See Figure 5-51.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-103  
prda0009 RPY 021698  
Figure 5-50. Insert the Pass-thru Tool  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-104  
prda0006 RPY 021298  
Figure 5-51. Replace the Fan Cover  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add External Modem to TN1648B  
5
Page 5-105  
10. Connect the cable to the front of the TN1648B circuit pack as shown in  
Figure 5-52.  
NOTE:  
Dress the cable straight down the front of the circuit pack. Do not  
allow the cable to cross in front of another circuit pack.  
prda0007 RPY 021698  
Figure 5-52. Connect the Cable to the Circuit Pack  
11. Close the front door.  
12. Discard the pass-thru tool.  
Test the Installation  
1. Login to the management terminal.  
2. Administer the system by referring to the Installation and Test for Adjuncts  
and Peripherals, 555-230-125.  
3. Enter list configuration all to determine if the new circuit pack appears in  
the correct slot and that there are no circuit pack conflicts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Multiple Announcement  
5
Page 5-106  
Add Multiple Announcement  
TN750C Multiple Announcement circuit packs are required if the system has  
multiple announcement circuit packs. At least 1 TN750C circuit pack is required.  
A maximum of 10 TN750C Announcement circuit packs are allowed in a system.  
No more than 1 TN750 or TN750B can reside in the system. The TN750C can  
install in any port or service (TDM) slot, and need not reside in a control carrier  
for extra power holdovers.  
The announcements from a TN750 or TN750B can be saved and then restored to  
a TN750C.  
NOTE:  
Do not copy or restore announcements from a TN750C to a TN750 or  
TN750B circuit pack, as this process may corrupt the announcement data.  
TN750C Announcement Circuit Pack  
The TN750C circuit pack contains on-board flash memory which provides  
internal backup of announcements on the circuit packs. Thus, the TN750C circuit  
pack does not need the save and restore processes. However, you can use the  
save and restore processes to copy announcements from the TN750 or TN750B  
to a TN750C circuit pack.  
The TN750C circuit pack can replace a TN750 or TN750B circuit pack. The  
difference in operation is that the TN750C circuit pack automatically restores and  
reports the availability of announcements from its own internal flash memory in 5  
minutes, rather than the approximately 40 minutes for the TN750 or TN750B  
circuit pack reporting from the mass-storage system.  
If a circuit pack already has announcements in its flash memory, the yellow LED  
flashes as the announcements copy to the Voice RAM.  
Save and Restore Recorded Announcements  
!
CAUTION:  
If the yellow LED is on, do not remove the circuit pack. This will corrupt the  
announcement data.  
The syntax for saving from any TN750 circuit pack is save announcements  
[from PCSS] and press Enter. Where P is the port network number (1 for PPN, and  
2-4 for EPN), C is the carrier designation (A, B, C, D, or E), and SS is the number  
of the slot in which the circuit pack resides (01 to 21).  
The syntax for restoring to a TN750C circuit pack is restore announcements  
[disk | tape [to PCSS]] and press Enter. Where P is the port network number (1 for  
PPN, and 2-4 for EPN), C is the carrier designation (A, B, C, D, or E), and SS is  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Multiple Announcement  
5
Page 5-107  
the number of the slot in which the circuit pack resides (01 to 21). When  
executing a restore command and there are existing announcements on the  
circuit pack, the following warning message appears:  
WARNING: This restore announcement command will overwrite  
the existing announcements on the specified  
board.  
After 5 minutes (with no alterations to the announcements), the TN750C  
automatically copies the announcements from the Voice RAM to the internal flash  
memory. The yellow LED on the front of the TN750C flashes.  
You can only save the announcement contents of 1 circuit pack to mass storage  
at a time. For the contents of every circuit pack, save to separate translation  
cards. Label each card to match the circuit pack saved to it.  
TN750 and TN750B Announcement Circuit Packs  
NOTE:  
The following save and restore procedures are only necessary for TN750  
and TN750B announcement circuit packs.  
The recorded announcements in the system can be saved on the mass-storage  
system by entering the save announcements spe-active/spe-standby  
command. These commands should only be used after business hours or when  
the system is operating during a low-usage period. The system takes about 40  
minutes to transfer the recorded announcements from the announcement circuit  
pack to the mass-storage system. During this time period, the management  
terminal cannot be used to administer the system until the transfer finishes;  
however, all other administration terminals, if provided, are allowed to perform  
administration procedures.  
The recorded announcements in the system can be restored to system memory  
from the translation card by entering the restore announcementscommand.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Multiple Announcement  
5
Page 5-108  
Replace a TN750B with a TN750C or Move all  
Announcements from a TN750B to a TN750C  
Use this procedure to replace a TN750B circuit pack with a TN750C circuit pack  
or to move every announcement from a TN750B to a TN750C.  
NOTE:  
Do not copy or restore announcements from a TN750C to a TN750 or  
TN750B circuit pack, as this may corrupt the announcement data.  
1. Save announcements from the TN750/B to the mass-storage system.  
2. Insert the TN750C circuit pack into a vacant slot of a carrier.  
NOTE:  
Any carrier is acceptable since power holdover is not a concern.  
3. Lift the locking lever upward until the latch pin engages.  
4. Administer a new data module on the TN750C circuit pack, as described  
in DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration  
and Feature Description.  
5. Execute the restore announcements command to the TN750C circuit  
pack equipment location.  
6. Wait until announcements copy from voice RAM to flash memory (yellow  
LED on the TN750C stops flashing). This may take about 10 minutes.  
7. Execute the busyout board 01c11 command for the TN750/B circuit  
pack, where “01c11” is an example circuit pack location.  
8. Execute the change integrated announcements command. This  
modifies the translations for the TN750B circuit pack to reference the  
TN750C circuit pack.  
9. Verify proper playback of the announcements from the TN750C circuit  
pack by calling them.  
10. Execute the release board 01c11 command for the TN750/B circuit pack,  
where “01c11” is an example circuit pack location.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Multiple Announcement  
5
Page 5-109  
Add Additional TN750C Circuit Packs  
1. Install the TN750C into a vacant slot in a carrier.  
NOTE:  
Any carrier is acceptable since power holdover is not a concern.  
2. Administer a new data module on the TN750C circuit pack, as described  
in DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration  
and Feature Description.  
3. Administer new announcements to that TN750C slot by executing the  
change announcements command and filling in the “designated board  
location” field for the circuit pack’s location.  
4. Record the announcements, as described in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
5. Wait until the announcements copy from voice RAM to the on-board flash  
memory (the yellow LED on the TN750C starts and then stops flashing).  
This may take about 10 minutes.  
Move a Single Announcement from 1  
Announcement Circuit Pack to Another  
1. Execute the change announcements command to change the circuit  
pack locations of a particular announcement. You may also change the  
compression rate at this time.  
2. Rerecord the announcement, as described in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN — PRI  
Page 5-110  
Add ISDN — PRI  
North American  
Use a TN767C/D/E DS1 or a TN464C DS1/E1 circuit pack for the assignment of a  
signaling link and up to 23 ISDN — PRI Trunk Group members. A TN768, TN780,  
or TN2182 Tone-Clock circuit pack is required to provide synchronization for the  
DS1 circuit pack. A TN765 Processor Interface circuit pack is required for use  
with the TN767C DS1 circuit pack when PRI is activated.  
As an option to the TN768 or TN2182 Tone-Clock, a TN780 Tone-Clock circuit  
pack (installed in the PPN) can interface external Stratum 3 synchronization for  
DS1 connections.  
European  
A TN464C DS1/E1 circuit pack is required for the assignment of the 2 signaling  
channels and up to 30 ISDN—PRI Trunk Group members. Each E1 span  
provides 32 ports. Except for North American private-network applications, a  
TN780, TN2182, or TN419B Tone-Clock circuit pack normally provides  
synchronization for the DS1/E1 circuit pack. A TN765 Processor Interface circuit  
pack is required for use with the TN464C DS1/E1 circuit pack when PRI is  
activated.  
As an option to the TN2182 or TN419B Tone-Clock, a TN780 Tone-Clock circuit  
pack (installed in the PPN) can interface external Stratum 3 synchronization for  
DS1 connections.  
Service Interruption  
Since the addition of ISDN—PRI requires a service interruption, notify the  
customer in advance as to when the addition will be carried out.  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of system software, disable Cleared Alarm Notification  
and Restart Notification before submitting the form.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN — PRI  
Page 5-111  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
RETURN to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750/B Announcement circuit pack, enter  
display announcements and press Enter. If administered recorded  
announcements are listed, enter list configuration software- version  
press Enter. Check Page 2 of this form to see when the announcements  
were last saved. To save the announcements, enter save  
announcements and press Enter.  
Power Down System  
1. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
2. At an EPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
Add Circuit Packs  
1. Determine port assignment of circuit packs to be added.  
2. Install the TN767C DS1 or TN464C DS1/E1 Interface circuit pack in  
assigned carrier slot.  
3. Remove an existing TN756 Tone Detector/Generator circuit pack and  
install the TN768, TN780, TN2182, or TN419B Tone-Clock circuit pack in  
assigned carrier slots, if required.  
4. Install a TN765 Processor Interface circuit pack if required and a TN748B  
(or the non-United States TN420B) Tone Detector circuit pack if required.  
Install Cables  
Install cables from cabinet to cross-connect field as required.  
Power Up System  
1. At an EPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
3. The system performs a level 4 reboot, loading the system translations from  
the translation card or the tape. Rebooting takes 8 to 20 minutes.  
4. After all trouble is cleared, verify the EMERGENCY TRANSFER CONTROL  
switch is set to AUTO. This restores the system to the normal mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN — PRI  
Page 5-112  
Enter Added Translations  
1. Administer the forms listed under “Integrated Services Digital Network —  
Primary Rate Interface” in DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server  
Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance R6vs/si.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the INADS  
Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC). Verify that INADS  
can dial into the system and that the system can dial out to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database Administrator  
enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has purchased a  
services contract, the system cannot report any alarm to the TSC  
automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the services contract.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation memory  
card or the tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter. If Page 2 of this form  
shows that recorded announcements were saved, these announcements  
can be restored using restore announcements and press Enter.  
4. Update backup tape, if necessary.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
5
Page 5-113  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
Standard Reliability R6si System  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of software, disable Cleared Alarm  
Notification and Restart Notificationbefore submitting the  
form.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
Install Circuit Packs  
1. Power down the PPN, then EPN1, and then EPN2 as required.  
2. At the PPN, install the appropriate circuit packs. See Table 5-20.  
Table 5-20. Circuit Pack Locations for Packet Bus in R5si+m PPN  
Circuit Pack  
TN778  
Carrier  
Quantity  
Slot  
Control Carrier A  
Control Carrier A  
Control Carrier A  
1
PACKET CONT  
1
TN570  
1 or 2  
EXPN INTFC/1 and /2  
Any Available Port Slot  
2
TN771C  
1
1. Quantity of this pack should equal the number of EPNs.  
2. Optional for digital trunk testing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
5
Page 5-114  
3. At each EPN, install the appropriate circuit packs. See Table 5-21.  
4. Power up EPN2, then EPN1, then the PPN as required.  
5. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter. Use this  
form to enable the packet bus.  
6. Perform tests.  
Table 5-21. Circuit-Pack Locations for Packet Bus in Each EPN  
Circuit Pack  
TN570  
Carrier  
Quantity  
Slot  
1
Expansion Control Carrier A  
Expansion Control Carrier A  
1 or 2  
EXPN INTFC/1 and /2  
Any Available Port Slot  
2
TN771C  
1
1. Quantity of this pack should equal the number of EPNs.  
2. Optional for digital trunk testing.  
Resolve Alarms  
Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the INADS  
Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC). Verify that INADS  
can dial into the system and that the system can dial out to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database Administrator  
enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has purchased a  
services contract, the system cannot report any alarm to the TSC  
automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the services contract.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
5
Page 5-115  
High or Critical Reliability R6si System  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of software, disable Cleared Alarm Notification  
and Restart Notificationbefore submitting the form.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to write  
all translation information to the translation card or the tape.  
Power Down the Control Carrier  
NOTE:  
For a high or critical reliability system, do not power down both control  
carriers at the same time. This defeats the duplication feature of the system.  
1. Power down the control carrier and install the appropriate circuit packs.  
See Table 5-22.  
Table 5-22. Circuit Pack Locations for Packet Bus in PPN  
Circuit Pack  
Carrier  
Quantity  
Slot  
TN778  
Control Carrier A  
Control Carrier B  
Control Carrier A  
Control Carrier B  
Control Carrier A  
2
2
PACKET CONT  
PACKET CONT  
EXPN INTFC/1 and /2  
EXPN INTFC/1 and /2  
Any Available Port Slot  
1
TN570  
1 or 2  
1 or 2  
2
TN771C  
1
1. Quantity of this pack should equal the number of EPNs.  
2. Required for critical reliability PPN. Optional for digital trunk testing in high reliability  
PPN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add Packet Bus to R6si  
5
Page 5-116  
.
Table 5-23. Circuit-Pack Locations for Packet Bus in Each EPN  
Circuit Pack Carrier  
Quantity  
Slot  
1
TN570  
Expansion Control  
1 or 2  
EXPN INTFC/01 and /02  
Carrier A  
Port Carrier B  
1 or 2  
EXPN INTFC/02 and /03  
Any Available Port Slot  
2
TN771C  
Expansion Control  
Carrier A  
1
1. Quantity of this pack should equal the number of EPNs.  
2. Required for critical reliability EPN. Optional for digital trunk testing in high reliability  
EPN.  
Power Up System  
1. Power up the system.  
2. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter. Use this  
form to enable the packet bus.  
3. Perform tests.  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the INADS  
Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC). Verify that INADS  
can dial into the system and that the system can dial out to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database Administrator  
enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has purchased a  
services contract, the system cannot report any alarm to the TSC  
automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the services contract.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
5
Page 5-117  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
Service Interruption  
1. Since, if the packet bus is being added, the addition of CallVisor ASAI  
requires a service interruption, notify the customer in advance as to when  
the addition will be carried out.  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of software, disable Cleared Alarm Notification  
and Restart Notificationbefore submitting the form.  
Enter Added Translations  
1. On the System-Parameters Customer-Options form, be certain that the  
Calling Party Number/Billing Number (CPN/BN) option is disabled, and  
enable the CallVisor ASAI Interface option. (Either CallVisor ASAI or  
CPN/BN can be enabled on the switch, but not both.)  
2. Also, enable the Packet Bus Activated option on the System-Parameters  
Maintenance form.  
3. See DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description, for details on disabling and  
enabling options on these forms.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
5
Page 5-118  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter display  
announcements and press Enter.  
If administered recorded announcements are listed, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter. Check Page 2 of this  
form to see when the announcements were last saved. To save the  
announcements, enter save announcements and press Enter.  
Power Down System  
If the packet bus is being added:  
1. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
2. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
Add Circuit Packs  
1. Determine port assignment of circuit packs to be added.  
2. Install the appropriate circuit pack in assigned cabinet slot (as required).  
For example:  
Port Number  
3
B
02  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network)  
The TN748C or TN744 Call Classifier circuit pack is required. The TN744 is  
required for those customers who desire switch call classification.  
A vacant port is required on a TN556 ISDN—BRI circuit pack.  
3. A Packet Bus is required with CallVisor ASAI. If the system is not equipped  
with a Packet Bus, see “Add Packet Bus to R6si” earlier in this chapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
5
Page 5-119  
Install Cables  
1. Install cables from cabinet to the MDF as required.  
Power Up System  
If the packet bus was added:  
1. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
3. The system performs a level 4 reboot, loading the system translations from  
the translation card or tape. Rebooting takes several minutes.  
4. After all trouble is cleared, verify the EMERGENCY TRANSFER CONTROL  
switch is set to AUTO. This restores the system to the normal mode.  
Enter Added Translations  
1. Administer the required translation data using the forms listed under  
“Adjunct/Switch Applications Interface (ASAI)” in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance R6r.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
1. Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the  
INADS Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC).  
Verify that INADS can dial into the system and that the system can dial out  
to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database  
Administrator enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has  
purchased a services contract, the system cannot report any alarm  
to the TSC automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the  
services contract.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add CallVisor ASAI  
5
Page 5-120  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter. If Page 2 of this form  
shows that recorded announcements were saved, restore these  
announcements using restore announcements and press Enter.  
4. Update backup tape, if required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN—BRI  
Page 5-121  
Add ISDN—BRI  
Service Interruption  
1. Since, if the packet bus is being added, the addition of ISDN—BRI  
requires a service interruption, notify the customer in advance as to when  
the addition will take place.  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activatedfield to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of system software, disable Cleared Alarm  
Notificationand Restart Notificationbefore submitting the  
form.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter display  
announcements and press Enter.  
If administered recorded announcements are listed, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter. Check Page 2 of this  
form to see when the announcements were last saved. To save the  
announcements, enter save announcements and press Enter.  
Power Down System  
1. If the packet bus is being added, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN—BRI  
Page 5-122  
Add Circuit Packs  
1. Determine port assignment of circuit packs to be added.  
2. Install the appropriate circuit pack in assigned cabinet slot (as required).  
For example:  
Port Number  
3
B
02  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network)  
3. The TN778 Packet Control circuit pack and the TN556 or TN2198 ISDN  
BRI circuit pack are required. Add the TN778 Packet Control circuit pack  
first. If an EPN is present, a TN570 Expansion Interface circuit pack is  
required.  
4. The packet bus is required with BRI. If the system is not equipped with a  
packet bus see ‘‘Add Packet Bus to R6si’’ on page 5-113.  
Install Cables  
1. Install cables from cabinet to the MDF as required.  
NOTE:  
BRI requires a 12-port backplane cable terminator (breakout  
connector). Connect this terminator to the 25-pair cable. This is  
different from the 8-port connector used for DCP.  
Power Up System  
1. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
3. The system performs a level 4 reboot, loading the system translations from  
the translation card or tape. Rebooting takes several minutes.  
4. After the system reboot is finished and all trouble is cleared, verify the  
EMERGENCY TRANSFER CONTROL switch is set to AUTO. This restores  
the system to the normal mode.  
Enter Added Translations  
1. Administer the required translation data using the forms listed under  
7500D voice terminals and 8500 voice terminals in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Add ISDN—BRI  
Page 5-123  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
1. Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the  
INADS Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC).  
Verify that INADS can dial into the system and that the system can dial out  
to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database  
Administrator enables Alarm Origination and enables customer options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has  
purchased a services contract, the system cannot report any alarm  
to the TSC automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the  
services contract.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750/B Announcement circuit pack, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter. If Page 2 of this form  
shows that recorded announcements were saved, these announcements  
can be restored using restore announcements and press Enter.  
4. Update backup tape, if required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-124  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
The optional asynchronous packet bus provided by a TN778 Packet Control  
circuit pack (rather than the synchronous TDM bus provided by TN765 Processor  
Interface circuit packs) can allow TN464 ISDN-PRI interfaces on an R6si system  
to communicate with the system’s SPE.  
Tone-Clock Circuit Packs  
A TN756 Tone Detector/Generator circuit pack cannot be used with PRI Over  
PACCON interfaces. Therefore, replace the TN756 circuit pack with both:  
TN768, TN780, TN419B, or TN2182 Tone-Clock circuit pack  
TN748B, TN420B, or TN744C Tone Detector circuit pack  
NOTE:  
If a TN756 tone-detector/generator is removed from the R5si control  
cabinet, the TN2182 tone clock should replace this circuit pack. The  
TN2182 Tone-Clock serves to replace the tone detector circuits on  
the TN756. If using a TN2182, no TN748B is required.  
Expansion Interface (EI) Circuit Packs  
If a new packet bus is being added to provide PRI Over PACCON for an R6si  
system with an EPN, replace every TN776 EI circuit pack in the system with a  
TN570 EI circuit pack. The TN570s allow packet-based communication between  
the PPN and each EPN in the system.  
DS1/E1 Interface Circuit Packs  
Like ISDN-PRI using a TN765 Processor Interface, a TN464C (or later) DS1/E1  
circuit pack is required to assign a European 32-port E1 interface.  
PRI Over PACCON Versus "PRI Over Processor  
Interface”  
For simpler call processing, Release 6 administration does not allow packet  
interface and processor interface circuit packs to control ISDN-PRI calls for the  
same system at the same time. Therefore, during a PRI Over PACCON addition,  
replace every TN767C DS1 circuit pack used to provide a D-channel signaling  
for ISDN-PRI with a TN464F DS1 circuit pack. This frees up PI circuits to control  
other important links such as DCS, CMS, and AUDIX.  
In an R6si system with Non-Facility-Associated Signaling, a TN767C DS1 circuit  
pack may still provide B channels for a PRI Over PACCON link as long as each  
controlling D channel for the link (primary and optional backup) resides on a  
TN464F DS1 circuit pack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-125  
Service Interruption  
1. Since the addition of PRI Over PACCON requires a service interruption,  
notify the customer in advance as to when the addition will take place.  
Disable Alarm Origination  
1. Enter change system-parameters maintenance and press Enter.  
2. Set the Alarm Origination Activated field to n.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not disable Alarm Origination, the system may generate  
alarms, resulting in unnecessary trouble tickets.  
3. For some releases of software, disable Cleared Alarm Notification  
and Restart Notificationbefore submitting the form.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter display  
announcements and press Enter.  
If administered recorded announcements are listed, enter list  
configuration software-version press Enter. To save the announcements,  
enter save announcements and press Enter.  
Power Down System  
If the packet bus is being added:  
1. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
2. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to OFF.  
Add Circuit Packs  
1. To control every ISDN-PRI link in the system, a TN778 Packet Control  
circuit pack and TN464 ISDN-PRI circuit packs are required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-126  
Since the packet bus is required with PRI Over PACCON, the TN778  
Packet Control circuit pack should be added first. If the system is not  
equipped with a packet bus see ‘‘Add Packet Bus to R6si’’ on page 5-113.  
If EPNs reside in the system, replace every TN776 EI circuit pack with a  
TN570 EI to provide packet-based communication between the PPN and  
each EPN.  
2. Remove an existing TN756 Tone Detector/Generator circuit pack and  
install the TN768, TN780, or TN419B Tone-Clock circuit pack in assigned  
carrier slot, if required.  
3. Determine port assignment of port circuit packs to be added.  
4. Install the TN464 circuit pack in assigned carrier slot (as required). For  
example:  
Port Number  
3
B
02  
01  
Cabinet  
Carrier  
Slot Circuit  
(Port Network)  
5. Install the TN748B (or the non-United States TN420B) Tone Detector  
circuit packs, as required.  
Install Cables  
1. Install cables from the cabinet to the MDF as required.  
Power Up System  
1. At each EPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
2. At the PPN, set the main circuit breaker to ON.  
3. The system performs a level 4 reboot, loading the system translations from  
the translation card or tape. Rebooting takes several minutes.  
4. After the system reboot is finished and all trouble is cleared, verify the  
EMERGENCY TRANSFER CONTROL switch is set to AUTO. This restores  
the system to the normal mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-127  
Enter Added Translations  
1. Log in as craft. For a system where ISDN-PRI interfaces were previously  
controlled by a TN765 PI circuit pack, preliminary administration must first  
remove any:  
Existing PI-controlled ISDN-PRI links  
TN767C DS1 Interface circuit packs used to provide D-channel  
signaling for ISDN-PRI links  
The preliminary administration includes:  
2. Remove the existing PI-controlled ISDN-PRI link translations  
busyout link <n> — For each PRI link assigned  
change trunk <nn> — To not reference the signaling groups  
associated with each trunk’s B channel  
remove signaling-group <nn> — For each signaling group  
assigned  
change communications link To set the “Enable” field to n for  
each link of type “ISDN”  
change communications processor-channel To clear all fields  
for each processor channel of type “ISDN”  
change communications link To vacate all fields for each link  
of type “ISDN”  
3. For each TN767C previously used to provide D-channel signaling for  
ISDN-PRI, remove its existing DS1 translations, and reassign circuit pack  
as a TN464  
Assign ISDN-PRI and PRI Over PACCON  
Options  
1. If ISDN-PRI is being assigned as a new feature on the system, get the  
DOSS order number of the ISDN-PRI addition.  
2. Call the regional CSA to request an “init” login. The CSA should enter  
change system-parameters customer-options and press Enter to enable  
the “ISDN-PRI” (if necessary) and the “PRI Over PACCON” option. For  
details on enabling this option, see DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 Administration and Feature Description.  
Assign or Reassign ISDN-PRI Feature  
1. Assign or reassign ISDN-PRI using the forms listed under “Integrated  
Services Digital Network — Primary Rate Interface” in DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-128  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
1. Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the  
INADS Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC).  
Verify that INADS can dial into the system and that the system can dial out  
to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database  
Administrator enables Alarm Origination and enables the customer  
options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has  
purchased a services contract, the system cannot report any alarm  
to the TSC automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the  
services contract.  
Save Translations  
1. If the system is high or critical reliability, enter status system 1 and press  
Enter to verify that the system is in the “active/standby” mode.  
2. Enter save translation and press Enter. This instructs the system to take all  
translation information in memory and write it to the translation card or  
tape.  
3. If the system contains a TN750 Announcement circuit pack, enter list  
configuration software-version and press Enter.  
If Page 2 of this form shows that recorded announcements were saved,  
these announcements can be restored using restore announcements  
and press Enter.  
NOTE:  
TN750C contains non-volatile RAM and does not require the “restore  
announcements” command.  
4. Update backup tape, if required.  
Reboot the System  
1. Behind the PPN, set the circuit breaker to ON.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-129  
2. The system performs a reset level 4 reboot, loading translations from the  
translation card. Rebooting requires 8 to 11 minutes.  
3. Login at the login:prompt on the management terminal, and set the  
time to ensure that the system is booted properly.  
4. Enter list configuration software-version and press Enter to compare the  
version number of the software program (displayed on the terminal) with  
the TN790 version number (written on a label on the TN790’s faceplate). If  
the version numbers are not the same, change the version number on the  
TN790 label so that they agree.  
NOTE:  
Certain forms have changed for Release 6. Upgraded translations  
may appear on a different form, fields may shift within a form, or the  
names assigned to particular fields may change. Refer to DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Transition Reference,  
and DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Administration and Feature Description, and make the necessary  
changes.  
Enable Customer Options  
1. Enter change system-parameters customer-options and press Enter.  
2. Use these forms to verify the customer options are properly set.  
NOTE:  
If the customer was using Supplementary Services Protocol “b” or  
“d” on an ISDN-PRI trunk group before the upgrade, set the Basic  
Call Setup field to y.  
Resolve Alarms  
1. Examine the alarm log. Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Add PRI Over PACCON to R6si  
5
Page 5-130  
Contact INADS to Enable Customer Options and  
Verify Alarm Origination  
1. Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the  
INADS Database Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC).  
Verify that INADS can dial into the system and that the system can dial out  
to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database  
Administrator enables Alarm Origination and enables the customer  
options.  
!
CAUTION:  
If you do not enable Alarm Origination when the customer has  
purchased a services contract, the system cannot report any alarm  
to the TSC automatically, causing the TSC to be unable to fulfill the  
services contract.  
2. Logoff and log back in as craft.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-131  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
Configuration  
The CAMA/E911 feature will only work on DEFINITY ECS if TN429C CO circuit  
packs (or later suffix) is used.  
Port Networks (PNs) that include TN429C circuit packs used to interface to  
CAMA trunks may require some CPTR resources to be either TN744D V2 or  
TN2182B circuit packs, since TTR/CPTR or General Purpose Tone Receiver  
(GPTR) resources are selected from the pool available in the PN when needed.  
Table 5-24 denotes which of these circuit packs are compatible and which are  
not affected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-132  
Table 5-24. Compatibility Tone Clock, TTR/CPTR, and GPTR Circuit Packs  
Compatibility  
with CAMA  
Circuit  
Pack  
Trunks in  
Same PN  
Description  
Application  
Notes  
TN420  
TN420B  
TN420C  
Touch Tone  
Detector / Call  
Progress Tone  
Detector  
Not Compatible  
Not used in the  
U.S.  
4TTR and 2 CPTR  
ports. Used in  
combination with  
the TN780 in  
many countries  
initially in ver-  
sions prior to  
G3V3.3. Use  
TN744DV2 if  
CAMA feature is  
to be supported.  
TN744  
Call Classifier -  
Detector  
Not Compatible  
Used globally  
8 GPTR/call clas-  
sification ports.  
Used for call clas-  
sification only ini-  
tially prior to  
TN7744B  
TN744C  
TN744DV1  
G3V3.3. Becomes  
a GPTR resource  
in G3V3.3 and  
later. Use  
TN744DV2 if  
CAMA feature is  
to be supported.  
TN744DV2  
Call Classifier -  
Detector  
Compatible  
Used globally  
8 GPTR/call clas-  
sification ports.  
Required in PN  
supporting  
CAMA trunks if  
GPTR resources  
are required in  
excess of those on  
the TN2182BV2.  
Also required (if  
the TN768 or  
TN780toneclocks  
are used) in place  
of TN748,  
TN744, and  
TN744B and  
TN744C.  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-133  
Table 5-24. Compatibility Tone Clock, TTR/CPTR, and GPTR Circuit Packs  
Continued  
Compatibility  
with CAMA  
Circuit  
Pack  
Trunks in  
Same PN  
Description  
Application  
Notes  
TN748  
Touch Tone  
Detector / Call  
Progress Tone  
Detector  
Not Compatible  
Used in the  
U.S. and a few  
other countries  
4 TTR and 2  
TN748B  
TN748C  
TN748D  
CPTR ports. Used  
in combination  
with the TN756,  
TN768, or  
TN780 in many  
countries initially  
in versions prior to  
G3V3.3. Use  
TN744DV2 if  
CAMA feature is  
to be supported.  
TN756  
Tone Detector  
Generator  
Not Compatible  
Used in the  
U.S. and a few  
other countries  
Tone detec-  
tor/tone clock with  
4 TTR and 2  
CPTR ports. Used  
in combination  
with the TN748 in  
many countries  
initially in ver-  
sions prior to  
G3V3.3. Used  
only with  
SCC/ESCC cabi-  
nets with no  
EPNs, no duplica-  
tion, no ASAI.  
Use TN2182BV2  
if CAMA feature  
is to be supported.  
TN768  
Tone Clock  
Not Affected  
Used in the  
U.S. and many  
other countries  
Tone clock only,  
no TTR/CPTR  
functionality. Typ-  
ically found with  
TN748 circuit  
packs in the U.S.  
Use TN7744DV2  
instead of TN748  
with CAMA.  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-134  
Table 5-24. Compatibility Tone Clock, TTR/CPTR, and GPTR Circuit Packs  
Continued  
Compatibility  
with CAMA  
Circuit  
Pack  
Trunks in  
Same PN  
Description  
Application  
Notes  
TN780  
Tone Clock  
Not Affected  
Used in the  
U.S. (infre-  
quently) for  
Tone clock only,  
no TTR/CPTR  
functionality. Typ-  
stratum 3 clock- ically found with  
ing and used in  
many other  
countries  
TN748 circuit  
packs in the U.S.  
Use TN7744DV2  
instead of TN748  
with CAMA.  
TN2182  
TN2182B  
Tone Clock /  
Call Classifier -  
Detector  
Compatible  
Used globally  
Tone clock plus 8  
GPTR/call classi-  
fication ports. Use  
TN2182B if  
CAMA feature is  
to be supported.  
Hardware Setup  
1. Insert the TN429C CO circuit pack in any available port slot.  
2. Wire the TN429C to the MDF (the trunk from the CO). Refer to the pinouts  
in Table 5-34.  
Administration Setup  
1. At the prompt, type add trunk next and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-135  
Page 1 of 11  
TRUNK GROUP  
Group Number: 1  
Group Name: cama Trunk Group - E911 COR: 1  
Group Type: cama  
CDR Reports: y  
TN: 1 TAC: 701  
Direction: outgoing  
Outgoing Display? y CESID I Digits Sent: 0  
Busy Threshold: 99  
TRUNK PARAMETERS  
Trunk Type: wink-start  
Outgoing Dial Type: r1mf  
Trunk Termination: rc  
Screen 5-1. CAMA Trunk Group form (page 1)  
2. On Trunk Group screen (page 1), in the Group Type:field, enter cama.  
3. In the Group Name:field, enter the desired name.  
4. In the TAC:field, enter the desired trunk access code.  
5. In the Outgoing Display:field, enter y.  
6. In the CESID I Digits Sent:field, enter the number directed by the  
Central Office (CO) or the Public Safety Answering Point (PSAP).  
7. Scroll to page 3 of the form.  
Page 3 of 11  
TRUNK GROUP  
ADMINISTRABLE TIMERS  
Outgoing Disconnect (msec): 400  
Cama Outgoing Dial Guard (msec): 75  
Outgoing Glare Guard (msec): 1000  
Cama Wink Start Time (msec): 5000  
Outgoing Seizure Response (sec): 4  
Disconnect Signal Error (sec): 30  
Outgoing End of Dial (sec): 1  
Screen 5-2. Administrable Timers form (page 3)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-136  
8. On the Administrable Timers screen (page 3), you may need to adjust  
these fields according to your CO. Scroll to page 5.  
Page 5 of 11  
TRUNK GROUP  
Administered Members (min/max): 1/2  
GROUP MEMBER ASSIGNMENTS  
Total Administered Members: 2  
Port  
Code  
Sfx Name  
1: 01C0401 TN429  
2: 01C0402 TN429  
C
C
3:  
4:  
5:  
6:  
7:  
8:  
9.  
10:  
11:  
12:  
13:  
Screen 5-3. Group Member Assignments form (page 5)  
9. On the Group Member Assignments screen, in the Portfield, add the  
trunk members and press Enter when finished.  
10. At the prompt, type change feature-access-code and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-137  
Page 1 of 5  
FEATURE ACCESS CODE (FAC)  
Abbreviated Dialing List1 Access Code: ____  
Abbreviated Dialing List2 Access Code: ____  
Abbreviated Dialing List3 Access Code: ____  
Abbreviated Dial - Prgm Group List Access Code: ____  
Announcement Access Code: ____  
Answer Back Access Code: ____  
Auto Alternate Routing (AAR) Access Code: ____  
Auto Route Selection (ARS) Access Code 1: 9___ Access Code 2: ____  
Automatic Callback Activation: ____  
Deactivation: ____  
Deactivation: ____  
Call Forwarding Activation Busy/DA: ____  
All: ____  
Call Park Access Code: ____  
Call Pickup Access Code: ____  
CAS Remote Hold/Answer Hold-Unhold Access Code: ____  
CDR Account Code Access Code: ____  
Change Coverage: ____  
Data Origination Access Code: ____  
Data Privacy Access Code: ____  
Directed Call Pickup Access Code: ____  
Emergency Access To Attendant Access Code: ____  
Extended Call Fwd Activate Busy D/A: ____ All: ____  
Facility Test Calls Access Code: ____  
Flash Access Code: ____  
Deactivation: ____  
Screen 5-4. Feature Access Code (FAC) form (page 1)  
11. The Feature Access Code (FAC) screen (page 1) appears.  
12. In the Auto Route Selection (ARS) Access Code 1:field,  
administer the ARS access code (in the example above, type 9) and press  
Enter (must match dial plan).  
13. At the prompt, enter change ars analysis <9> and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-138  
ARS DIGIT ANALYSIS TABLE  
Partitioned Group Number: _  
Percent Full:  
___  
Dialed  
String  
Total Rte Call Nd ANI  
Mn Mx Pat Type Num Rq  
Dialed  
String  
Total Rte Call Nd ANI  
Mn Mx Pat Type Num Rq  
9________________ 7_ 7_ 2__ hnpa ___ n __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
976______________ 7_ 7_ den hnpa ___ n __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
11_______________ 2_ 2_ 11_ emer ___ n __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
911______________ 3_ 3_ 12_ emer ___ n __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
_________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _ __________________ __ __ ___ ____ ___ _  
Screen 5-5. ARS Digit Analysis Table  
14. An ARS Digit Analysis Table screen appears. In the Dialed Stringfield,  
in the first empty row, enter 11.  
15. In the Total Mnfield, enter 2.  
16. In the Total Mxfield, enter 2.  
17. In the Rte Patfield, enter the desired Route Pattern (in the example  
above the route pattern is 11).  
NOTE:  
For the following step, if you are using the Attendant Crisis Alerting  
feature, type alrt instead of “emer.”  
18. In Call Typefield, enter emer.  
19. On the next empty row, in the Dialed Stringfield, type 911.  
20. In the Total Mnfield, enter 3.  
21. In the Total Mxfield, enter 3.  
22. In the Rte Patfield, type the desired Route Pattern (in the example  
above the route pattern is 12).  
NOTE:  
For the following step, if you are using the Attendant Crisis Alerting  
feature, type alrt instead of “emer.”  
23. In the Call Typefield, enter emer and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-139  
24. At the prompt, type change route-pattern <number> (the route pattern to  
be changed; in the example above, the route pattern is 11) and press  
Enter.  
Page 1 of X  
Pattern Number: 11  
Grp. FRL NPA Pfx Hop Toll No. Del Inserted  
IXC  
No.  
1: 1__  
2: ___  
3: ___  
4: ___  
5: ___  
6: ___  
Mrk Lmt List Digits Digits  
0 ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
BCC VALUE TSC CA-TSC  
0 1 2 3 4 W Request  
ITC BCIE Service/Feature  
Numbering LAR  
Format  
1: y y y y y n y none_____ both ept outwats-bnd____ BAND: ___ ________ none  
2: y y y y y n n  
3: y y y y y n n  
4: y y y y y n n  
5: y y y y y n n  
6: y y y y y n n  
rest  
rest  
rest  
rest  
rest  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
________ next  
________ rehu  
________ none  
________ none  
________ none  
Screen 5-6. Route Pattern form (Page 1)  
25. On the Route Pattern screen, in Grp. No. field, enter the CAMA trunk  
group number.  
26. In the FRLfield, enter 0.  
NOTE:  
For the following step, if the Central Office (CO) wants KP11ST as  
the dialed digit string, then leave blank. If the CO wants KP911ST,  
then insert a “9” in the Inserted Digitsfield.  
27. Administer the Inserted Digitsfield if needed and press Enter.  
28. At the prompt, type change route-pattern <number> (the route pattern to  
be changed; in the example above, the route pattern is 12) and press  
Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-140  
Page 1 of X  
Pattern Number: 12  
Grp. FRL NPA Pfx Hop Toll No. Del Inserted  
IXC  
No.  
1: 1__  
2: ___  
3: ___  
4: ___  
5: ___  
6: ___  
Mrk Lmt List Digits Digits  
0 ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
_ ___ _ __  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
1_  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
____________________________________ user  
BCC VALUE TSC CA-TSC  
0 1 2 3 4 W Request  
ITC BCIE Service/Feature  
Numbering LAR  
Format  
1: y y y y y n y none_____ both ept outwats-bnd____ BAND: ___ ________ none  
2: y y y y y n n  
3: y y y y y n n  
4: y y y y y n n  
5: y y y y y n n  
6: y y y y y n n  
rest  
rest  
rest  
rest  
rest  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
_______________  
________ next  
________ rehu  
________ none  
________ none  
________ none  
Screen 5-7. Route Pattern form (Page 1)  
29. On the Route Pattern screen, in Grp. No. field, type the CAMA trunk  
group number and press Enter.  
30. In the FRLfield, type 0.  
NOTE:  
For the following step, if the Central Office (CO) wants KP911ST as  
the dialed digit string, then leave blank. If the CO wants KP11ST,  
then delete one digit.  
31. Administer No. Del Digitsfield if needed and press Enter.  
32. At the prompt, type change cama-numbering and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-141  
Page 1 of 3  
CAMA NUMBERING - E911 FORMAT  
System CESID Default: 5241100______  
Ext Ext  
Len Code  
Total  
Length  
7_  
7_  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
Ext Ext  
Len Code  
Total  
Length  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
__  
CESID  
CESID  
4_ 101__ 5381234_____  
4_ 1____ 555_________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ ____________  
__ _____ __________  
__ _____ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__ ______ ___________  
__  
__  
Screen 5-8. CAMA Numbering Format form  
33. In the CAMA Numbering - E911 Format screen (page 1), in System  
CESID Default:field, enter your own system default and press Enter.  
This is the number outpulsed when the extension code is not found in the  
CAMA Numbering table. See Screen 5-8.  
34. In the Ext Len, Ext Code, CESID, and Total Lengthfields, fill out to  
your own CAMA numbering plan and press Enter. Be sure to cover all  
extensions.  
35. At the prompt, type change cor <number> (the class of restriction (COR)  
to be changed) and press Enter. Change all CORs that are defined for  
stations in order to remove any calling party restrictions for 911 calls.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
CAMA/E911 Installation  
5
Page 5-142  
Page 1 of 3  
CLASS OF RESTRICTION  
COR Number: 10  
COR Description: supervisor  
FRL: 0  
APLT? y  
Can Be Service Observed? n  
Can Be A Service Observer? n  
Time of Day Chart: 1  
Calling Party Restriction: none  
Called Party Restriction: none  
Forced Entry of Account Codes? n  
Direct Agent Calling? n  
Priority Queuing? n  
Restriction Override: none  
Restricted Call List? n  
Unrestricted Call List?  
Access to MCT? y  
Facility Access Trunk Test? n  
Can Change Coverage? n  
Fully Restricted Service? n  
Hear VDN of Origin Annc.? n  
Category For MFC ANI:  
7
Send ANI for MFE? n_  
Hear System Music on Hold? y  
Automatic Charge Display? n  
Add/Remove Agent Skills? n  
PASTE (Display PBX Data on Phone)? n  
Can Be Picked Up By Directed Call Pickup? n  
Can Use Directed Call Pickup? n  
Screen 5-9. Class of Restriction form (page 1)  
36. On the Class of Restriction screen (page 1), in the Calling Party  
Restriction:field, type none and press Enter.  
37. Type Save Translation and press Enter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-143  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
(Pinout Charts)  
See Table 5-25 for lead designations. The circuit packs and auxiliary equipment  
are classified as shown in the tables at the end of this chapter.  
Table 5-25. Lead and Color Designations  
Cross- Connect Pin  
Color  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
Amphenol Pin  
Backplane Pin  
102  
002  
103  
003  
104  
004  
105  
005  
106  
006  
107  
007  
108  
008  
109  
009  
110  
010  
111  
011  
112  
012  
113  
013  
302  
202  
303  
203  
304  
1
26  
01  
27  
02  
28  
03  
29  
04  
30  
05  
31  
06  
32  
07  
33  
08  
34  
09  
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
38  
13  
39  
14  
40  
2
3
4
O-W  
5
W-G  
6
G-W  
7
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-SL  
SL-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
R-O  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
R-SL  
SL-R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
BK-O  
O-BK  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
BK-SL  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-144  
Table 5-25. Lead and Color Designations Continued  
Cross- Connect Pin  
Color  
SL-BK  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Y-O  
Amphenol Pin  
Backplane Pin  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
15  
41  
16  
42  
17  
43  
18  
44  
19  
45  
20  
46  
21  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
50  
25  
204  
305  
205  
306  
206  
307  
207  
308  
208  
309  
209  
310  
210  
311  
211  
312  
212  
313  
213  
300  
200  
O-Y  
Y-G  
G-Y  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
Y-SL  
SL-Y  
V-BL  
BL-V  
V-O  
O-V  
V-G  
G-V  
V-BR  
BR-V  
V-SL  
SL-V  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-145  
Table 5-26 shows the pinouts for the TN2185 ISDN-BRI 4-wire S Interface.  
Table 5-26. TN2185 ISDNBRI — 4-Wire S Interface Pinout  
Port Signal Cross-Connect Pin  
Color  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
Amphenol Pin  
Backplane Pin  
102  
002  
103  
003  
104  
004  
105  
005  
106  
006  
107  
007  
108  
008  
109  
009  
110  
010  
111  
011  
112  
012  
113  
013  
302  
202  
303  
203  
304  
204  
305  
205  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
TXT.1  
TXR.1  
PXT.1  
PXR.1  
TXT.2  
TXR.2  
PXT.2  
PXR.2  
TXT.3  
TXR.3  
PXT.3  
PXR.3  
TXT.4  
TXR.4  
PXT.4  
PXR.4  
TXT.5  
TXR.5  
PXT.5  
PXR.5  
TXT.6  
TXR.6  
PXT.6  
PXR.6  
TXT.7  
TXR.7  
PXT.7  
PXR.7  
TXT.8  
TXR.8  
PXT.8  
PXR.8  
1
26  
01  
27  
02  
28  
03  
29  
04  
30  
05  
31  
06  
32  
07  
33  
08  
34  
09  
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
38  
13  
39  
14  
40  
15  
41  
16  
2
3
4
O-W  
5
W-G  
6
G-W  
7
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-SL  
SL-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
R-O  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
R-SL  
SL-R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
BK-O  
O-BK  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
BK-SL  
SL-BK  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-146  
Table 5-27 shows the pinouts for the TN2198 ISDN-BRI 2-wire U Interface.  
Table 5-27. TN2198 ISDN-BRI — 2-Wire U Interface Pinout  
Cross-Connect  
Pin  
Amphenol  
Pin  
Port  
Signal  
T.1  
Color  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
Backplane Pin  
102  
1
1
2
26  
01  
27  
02  
28  
03  
29  
04  
30  
05  
31  
06  
32  
07  
33  
08  
34  
09  
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
R.1  
T.2  
002  
2
3
3
103  
R.2  
T.3  
4
O-W  
003  
5
W-G  
104  
R.3  
T.4  
6
G-W  
004  
4
7
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-SL  
SL-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
R-O  
105  
R.4  
T.5  
8
005  
5
9
106  
R.5  
T.6  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
006  
6
107  
R.6  
T.7  
007  
7
108  
R.7  
T.8  
O-R  
008  
8
R-G  
109  
R.8  
T.9  
G-R  
009  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
R-SL  
SL-R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
BK-O  
O-BK  
110  
R.9  
T.10  
R.10  
T.11  
R.11  
T.12  
R.12  
010  
10  
11  
12  
111  
011  
112  
012  
113  
013  
* Pins 25 and 50 are grounded by the backplane.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-147  
Table 5-28. Port Circuit Pack Lead Designations  
TN742/B  
TN747B  
TN753  
TN769  
TN2147  
TN465  
TN760/B  
TN760C  
TN760D  
TN2209  
TN746/B  
TN2183  
TN793  
Cross-  
Connect  
Pin  
TN763  
TN763B  
TN763C  
TN754  
TN726  
TN767B  
TN464E  
TN762/B  
T.1  
TN735  
T.1  
TN2793  
TN2224  
T.1  
1
T.1  
R.1  
T.1  
T.1  
C_5  
T.1  
R.1  
T.2  
R.2  
T.3  
R.3  
T.4  
R.4  
2
R.1  
T1.1  
R1.1  
E.1  
R.1  
R.1  
R.1  
R.1  
3
TXT.1  
TXR.1  
PXT.1  
PXR.1  
TXT.1  
TXR.1  
PXT.1  
PXR.1  
T.2  
SZ.1  
SZ1.1  
S.1  
BT.1  
BR.1  
LT.1  
LR.1  
T.2  
C_ENAB  
C_SYNC*  
T.2  
4
R.2  
5
T.3  
6
M.1  
T.2  
S1.1  
T.2  
R.3  
7
T.2  
R.2  
C2D-DATA  
RDATA*  
TDATA*  
TRSYSNC  
GRD  
T.4  
8
R.2  
T1.2  
R1.2  
E.2  
R.2  
R.2  
R.2  
R.4  
9
TXT.2  
TXR.2  
PXT.2  
PXR.2  
TXT.2  
TXR.2  
PXT.2  
PXR.2  
T.3  
SZ.2  
SZ1.2  
S.2  
BT.2  
BR.2  
LT.2  
LR.2  
T.3  
T.5  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
R.5  
T.6  
M.2  
T.3  
S1.2  
T.3  
SCLK*  
R.6  
T.3  
R.3  
T.7  
R.3  
T1.3  
R1.3  
E.3  
R.3  
R.3  
R.3  
R.7  
TXT.3  
TXR.3  
PXT.3  
PXR.3  
TXT.3  
TXR.3  
PXT.3  
PXR.3  
T.4  
SZ.3  
SZ1.3  
S.3  
BT.3  
BR.3  
LT.3  
LR.3  
T.4  
T.8  
PAHER*  
C_48V  
R.8  
T.5  
T.9  
M.3  
T.4  
S1.3  
T.4  
R.5  
T.6  
R.9  
T.4  
R.4  
T.10  
R.10  
T.11  
R.11  
T.12  
R.12  
T.13  
R.13  
T.14  
R.14  
T.15  
R.15  
T.16  
R.16  
T.17  
R.17  
T.18  
R.18  
T.19  
R.19  
T.20  
R.4  
T1.4  
R1.4  
E.4  
R.4  
R.4  
R.4  
R.6  
T.7  
TXT.4  
TXR.4  
PXT.4  
PXR.4  
TXT.4  
TXR.4  
PXT.4  
PX4.4  
T.5  
SZ.4  
SZ1.4  
S.4  
BT.4  
BR.4  
LT.4  
LR.4  
T.5  
C_P2SCLK  
LI (RX)  
LO* (TX)  
LBACK1  
GND  
R.7  
T.8  
M.4  
T.5  
S1.4  
T.5  
R.8  
T.9  
T.5  
R.5  
R.5  
T1.5  
R1.5  
E.5  
R.5  
R.5  
R.5  
C_5V  
R.9  
T.10  
R.10  
T.11  
R.11  
T.12  
R.12  
TXT.5  
TXR.5  
PXT.5  
PXR.5  
TXT.5  
TXR.5  
PXT.5  
PXR.5  
T.6  
SZ.5  
SZ1.5  
S.5  
BT.5  
BR.5  
LT.5  
LR.5  
T.6  
M.5  
T.6  
S1.5  
T.6  
C_RST  
T.6  
R.6  
R.6  
T1.6  
R1.6  
E.6  
R.6  
R.6  
R.6  
TXT.6  
TXR.6  
PXT.6  
PXR.6  
TXT.6  
TXR.6  
PXT.6  
PXR.6  
T.7  
SZ.6  
SZ1.6  
S.6  
BT.6  
BR.6  
LT.6  
LR.6  
T.7  
RDATA  
TDATA  
TRSYNC  
GRD  
M.6  
T.7  
S1.6  
T.7  
T.7  
R.7  
SCLK  
R.7  
T1.7  
R.7  
R.7  
R.7  
TXT.7  
TXT.7  
SZ.7  
BT.7  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-148  
Table 5-28. Port Circuit Pack Lead Designations Continued  
TN742/B  
TN747B  
TN753  
TN769  
TN2147  
TN465  
TN760/B  
TN760C  
TN760D  
TN2209  
TN746/B  
TN2183  
TN793  
Cross-  
Connect  
Pin  
TN763  
TN763B  
TN763C  
TN754  
TN726  
TN767B  
TN464E  
TN762/B  
TXR.7  
PXT.7  
PXR.7  
T.8  
TN735  
BR.7  
LT.7  
LR.7  
T.8  
TN2793  
TN2224  
R.20  
T.21  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
TXR.7  
PXT.7  
PXR.7  
R1.7  
E.7  
SZ1.7  
S.7  
GRD  
T.13  
R.13  
T.14  
R.14  
T.15  
R.15  
T.16  
R.16  
GRD  
GRD  
M.7  
T.8  
S1.7  
T.8  
R.21  
T.22  
T.8  
R.8  
C_PRES*  
R.8  
R.8  
R.8  
R.8  
R.22  
T.23  
TXT.8  
TXR.8  
PXT.8  
PXR.8  
GRD  
T1.8  
R1.8  
E.8  
TXT.8  
TXR.8  
PXT.8  
PXR.8  
GRD  
SZ.8  
SZ1.8  
S.8  
BT.8  
BR.8  
LT.8  
LR.8  
GRD  
GRD  
DC2_DATA  
LI* (RX)  
LO (TX)  
LBACK2  
GRD  
R.23  
T.24  
M.8  
GRD  
GRD  
S1.8  
GRD  
GRD  
R.24  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
* Denotes high side of line.  
Table 5-29. DS1 Interface Cable H600-307 (and C6C)  
50-Pin  
15-Pin  
Pin  
02  
03  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
Color  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-G  
Designation  
Pin  
Color  
Designation  
LI (High)  
LI  
11  
03  
09  
01  
06  
05  
W-G  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR  
LI (High)  
LI  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-SL  
SL-W  
LO  
LO  
LO (High)  
LOOP2  
LOOP1  
LO (High)  
LOOP2  
LOOP1  
W-SL  
SL-W  
All other pins empty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-149  
Table 5-30. DS1 Interface Cable H600-348  
50-Pin  
15-Pin  
Pin  
Color  
Designation  
Pin  
Color  
Plug 04  
W-BL  
Designation  
38  
13  
39  
14  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
LI (High)  
LI  
11  
03  
09  
01  
LI (High)  
LI  
BL-W  
W-O  
O-W  
LO  
LO  
O-W  
LO (High)  
LO (High)  
Plug 03  
41  
16  
42  
17  
W-G  
LI (High)  
LI  
11  
03  
09  
01  
W-G  
LI (High)  
LI  
G-W  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR-W  
LO  
W-BR  
BR-W  
LO  
LO (High)  
LO (High)  
Plug 02  
44  
19  
45  
20  
W-SL  
SL-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
LI (High)  
LI  
11  
03  
09  
01  
W-SL  
SL-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
LI (High)  
LI  
LO  
LO  
LO (High)  
LO (High)  
Plug 01  
47  
22  
48  
23  
R-O  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
LI (High)  
LI  
11  
03  
09  
01  
R-O  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
LI (High)  
LI  
LO  
LO  
LO (High)  
LO (High)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-150  
Table 5-31. TN1654 Lead Designations  
Pin  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
Color  
W-BL  
W-O  
Designation  
+5E  
Pin  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
Color  
BL-W  
O-W  
Designation  
+5E  
GRD  
XMITDAT -  
GRD  
W-G  
GRD  
G-W  
W-BR  
W-SL  
R-BL  
R-O  
XMITDAT +  
GRD  
BR-W  
SL-W  
BL-R  
O-R  
RCVDAT -  
GRD  
RCVDAT +  
+5E  
GRD  
+5E  
R-G  
CCSYNC  
C2DCDATA  
CASYNC  
D2CDATA  
CCPRES  
LID *  
G-R  
CDSYNC  
C2DDDATA  
CBSYNC  
ISCLOCK  
CDPRES  
LID  
R-BR  
R-SL  
BK-BL  
BK-O  
BK-G  
BK-BR  
BK-SL  
Y-BL  
Y-O  
BR-R  
SL-R  
BL-BK  
O-BK  
G-BK  
BR-BK  
SL-BK  
BL-Y  
O-Y  
LOD  
LOD*  
CCRESET  
LIC*  
CDRESET  
LIC  
LOC  
LOC*  
Y-G  
CARESET  
LIB*  
G-Y  
CBRESET  
LIB  
Y-BR  
Y-SL  
V-BL  
V-O  
BR-Y  
SL-Y  
BL-V  
O-V  
LOB  
LOB*  
C2DADATA  
LIA*  
C2DBDATA  
LIA  
V-G  
LOA  
G-V  
LOA*  
V-BR  
V-SL  
CAPRES  
GRD  
BR-V  
SL-V  
CBPRES  
GRD  
* Denotes an active low signal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-151  
Table 5-32. TN793 24-Port Analog Line Lead Designations  
Pin  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
Color  
W-BL  
W-O  
Designation  
Pin  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
Color  
BL-W  
O-W  
Designation  
W-G  
G-W  
W-BR  
W-SL  
R-BL  
R-O  
BR-W  
SL-W  
BL-R  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
R-BR  
R-SL  
BK-BL  
BK-O  
BK-G  
BK-BR  
BK-SL  
Y-BL  
Y-O  
BR-R  
SL-R  
BL-BK  
O-BK  
G-BK  
BR-BK  
SL-BK  
BL-Y  
O-Y  
Y-G  
G-Y  
Y-BR  
Y-SL  
V-BL  
V-O  
BR-Y  
SL-Y  
BL-V  
O-V  
V-G  
G-V  
V-BR  
V-SL  
BR-V  
SL-V  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
Connector and Cable Diagrams (Pinout Charts)  
5
Page 5-152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment  
5
Page 5-156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
6
Page 6-1  
6
Test Telephones and Other  
Equipment  
6
This chapter describes how to test the telephones and other equipment. The  
following tests are included in this chapter:  
1. Make Test Calls  
2. Test 302C Attendant Console  
3. Test Selector Console  
4. Test External Ringing  
5. Test Queue Warning Indicator  
6. Test Integrated Announcement  
7. Test Music-on-Hold  
8. Test Emergency Transfer  
9. Test Remote Access Interface (formerly INADS)  
10. Test Basic Rate Interface (BRI)  
11. Test Duplication Option Processing Element Interchange  
12. Test Terminating Trunk Transmission  
13. Test Stratum 3 Clock  
The following tests are acceptance tests and provide some assurance the  
system will perform properly after installation and administration.  
If problems occur or more extensive tests are required, refer to DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r, or to  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Make Test Calls  
6
Page 6-2  
Make Test Calls  
Make 2 calls from 1 telephone to another telephone. Make the first call by dialing  
a telephone and make the second call by dialing a trunk access code and a  
Listed Directory Number (LDN).  
Test 302C Attendant Console  
Check all lamps are operational and call another telephone in the system.  
1. Simultaneously press and hold the Ringer Volume up button and the POS  
BUSY button. This puts the console in the self-test mode.  
NOTE:  
Releasing the buttons causes the console to return to normal mode.  
2. Verify all lamps on display light and remain lighted. Each row of lamps on  
the console lights and goes dark in sequence from top to bottom.  
3. Press Start. Listen for dial tone. The green lamp associated with idle call  
appearance button lights. The Position Available lamp goes dark.  
4. Dial number associated with a working telephone. Audible ringing tone is  
heard in ear piece.  
5. Press Release. Audible ringing tone is silenced. The green lamp  
associated with idle call appearance button goes dark. The Position  
Available lamp lights.  
Test Selector Console  
Check all selector console lamps are operational. Make call to a telephone in the  
system.  
1. Simultaneously press and hold the Ringer Volume up button and the POS  
BUSY button on the attendant console. This puts the console in the  
self-test mode.  
2. Each row of lamps on the selector console lights and goes dark in  
sequence from top to bottom.  
3. Press hundreds group select button. The hundreds group select lamp  
lights and any lamps associated with busy telephone light.  
4. Press Direct Extension Selection (DXS) button for the desired extension.  
Audible ringing tone is heard in the earpiece on attendant console.  
5. On attendant console, press Release. Audible ringing tone is silenced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Test External Ringing  
6
Page 6-3  
Test External Ringing  
Make a test call to the attendant console to verify ringing device sounds when the  
Night lamp on console is lighted. If ringing device has not been installed by  
customer, connect spare telephone to information outlet reserved for ringing  
device and make test call.  
Test Queue Warning Indicator  
Make a test call to an extension associated with a Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)  
or Direct Department Calling (DDC) group, and verify the queue warning  
indicator lamp lights. If the queue warning indicator has not been installed by  
customer, connect a spare telephone to the information outlet reserved for queue  
warning indicator and make a test call.  
Test Integrated Announcement  
The TN750/B/C Announcement circuit pack provides the ability to store  
messages. The messages can be recorded from telephones on- or off-premises  
and have flexible message lengths. The telephone selected as the test telephone  
must have a class of service (COS) with console permission enabled.  
Record Announcement  
1. Select test telephone with console permission enabled.  
2. Dial the access code followed by the integrated announcement extension  
number. Dial tone is heard.  
3. Dial “1.” A short burst of tone is heard and recording begins. Speak the  
announcement into the telephone.  
4. Dial “#” or hang up. Recording stops and dial tone is heard.  
Playback Announcement  
1. Dial access code followed by the integrated announcement extension  
number. Dial tone is heard.  
2. Dial “2.” The announcement is heard and dial tone is heard at completion  
of announcement.  
Delete Announcement  
1. Dial access code followed by the integrated announcement extension  
number. Dial tone is heard.  
2. DialDo3w.nloAadcforonmfirWmwawt.Sioonmatonunaels.icsomh.eAallrdMaannuadlsaSneanrochuAnncdeDmowennlotaisd.deleted.  
           
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Test Music-on-Hold  
6
Page 6-4  
Test Music-on-Hold  
Verify music is provided to a held party during any hold interval.  
Test Emergency Transfer  
Put system in emergency transfer mode and make call using emergency transfer  
telephone. There may be up to 4 Emergency Transfer switches depending on the  
system configuration. The switch is located on the Processor circuit pack(s) in  
the Processor Port Network (PPN) Control Carrier.  
Test Remote Access Interface  
Test the communication link between the system and the remote interface  
(formerly INADS) and verify the alarm notification process. Make a remote test  
from the remote interface to the DEFINITY System and a local test from the  
DEFINITY System to the remote interface.  
In some countries, this remote access interface is not allowed. Contact your  
Lucent Technologies representative.  
Remote Test  
1. Call outside personnel who will be accessing the system remotely to  
perform administration, maintenance, and testing.  
2. Ask remote personnel to call system and login and display System  
Parameters Maintenance screen. The login must be successful.  
NOTE:  
Product Identification on the System Parameters screen must match  
the Product Identification administered by the local technician.  
3. Have the remote personnel enter the test inads-link command, terminate  
the login, and disconnect.  
4. Have the remote personnel check the appropriate trouble ticket. The  
trouble ticket should show “INADS,n,MINOR” in the description field to  
indicate a minor off-board alarm was reported to the remote personnel.  
There may be more text in the description field if other resolved alarms  
were reported.  
5. Have the remote personnel make second call and login to the system and  
check the error log to verify no problems. See DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r, for error log and  
error code information.  
6. Have the remote access personnel terminate logoff and disconnect.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Test Basic Rate Interface  
6
Page 6-5  
Local Test  
1. Log in and enter the test inads-link command.  
2. Request remote access personnel to verify a trouble ticket was created.  
3. Check error log to verify no problems.  
4. Log off the system.  
Test Basic Rate Interface  
Check for normal voice telephone function (dial tone, ability to make and receive  
calls). Check for the correct Service Profile Identifier (SPID) on a display  
telephone and the management terminal.  
Test Duplication Option Processing  
Element Interchange  
The process of the standby Processing Element (PE) taking over for the active PE  
is referred to as a PE Interchange. This interchange should not be performed  
immediately after powering up the system. Wait a few minutes to allow the system  
to complete its internal tests. The system default is PE_Bafter powering up the  
system, so the active PE should be the B processor for this test, and the  
interchange should make PE_Athe active PE. Verify the system can successfully  
perform a PE interchange.  
1. At the management terminal, verify the screen displays PE_Bin the upper  
right corner.  
2. Enter check status command. Verify PE_Bis in the standby mode. If it is,  
proceed to Step 4. If it is not, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Enter refresh-spr-standby command.  
4. Enter reset system interchange command. The management terminal  
will be logged off and a beep will be heard.  
5. Login and verify that the screen displays PE_Ain the upper right corner.  
NOTE:  
Processor A’s yellow light is on and its green LED is off. Processor  
B’s yellow and green LEDs are off. The system is alarm free.  
6. Make system test call. The call must complete and the conversation must  
be satisfactory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Test Terminating Trunk Transmission  
6
Page 6-6  
Test Terminating Trunk Transmission  
The Terminating Trunk Transmission Test provides for extension number access  
to 3 tone sequences that can be used for trunk transmission testing from the  
distant end of the trunks.  
The 3 test types must have extension numbers assigned on the  
system-parameters maintenance form:  
Test Type 100:_______  
Test type 100 provides:  
Test Type 102:_______  
Test Type 105:_______  
5.5 Seconds of 1004 Hz tone at 0 dB  
Quiet until disconnect; disconnect is forced after 1 minute  
Test Type 102 provides:  
9 Seconds of 1004 Hz tone at 0 dB  
1 Second of silence  
Cycle is repeated until disconnect, which is forced after 24 hours  
Test Type 105 provides:  
9 Seconds of 1004 Hz tone at -16 dB  
1 Second of silence  
9 Seconds of 404 Hz tone at -16 dB  
1 Second of silence  
9 Seconds of 2804 Hz tone at -16 dB  
30 Seconds of silence  
0.5 Seconds of test progress tone (2225 Hz)  
Approximately 5 seconds of silence  
Forced disconnect  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Test Stratum 3 Clock  
6
Page 6-7  
Test Stratum 3 Clock  
This sections tests the ability of the Stratum 3 clock to correctly provide timing  
and alarms to the system.  
!
CAUTION:  
The following procedures are destructive to DS1 data and should not be  
attempted while there are DS1 facilities in active use.  
Check for Red LEDs  
1. Turn on the Stratum 3 clock and wait 40-50 seconds to allow the system to  
complete the on-board diagnostics before checking LEDs.  
2. If there are any red LEDs, follow the procedures in Table 6-1.  
Table 6-1. Stratum 3 Clock LED Indicators  
Card  
LED Label  
Procedure  
PAI  
REF A  
Check that the CI circuit pack on the left is inserted properly.  
Check wiring for DS1 in carrier “A” which connects the system to  
the CSU and the External Synchronization Clock at the MDF  
through a Y-cable assembly. If all else fails to clear the LED then  
replace the circuit pack.  
PAI  
REF B  
Check that the CI circuit pack on the right is inserted properly.  
Check wiring for DS1 in carrier B which connects the system to  
the CSU and the External Synchronization Clock at the MDF  
through a Y-cable assembly. If all else fails to clear the LED then  
replace the circuit pack.  
PAI  
PAI  
CI  
ST A  
ST B  
FAIL  
Replace the ST3 card  
Replace the ST3 card  
Check wiring for its associated DS1 reference and replace the  
circuit pack if necessary  
ST3  
ST3  
ST3  
ST3  
FAIL  
Replace the circuit pack  
Ignore this LED  
LOCK  
HOLDOVER Ignore this LED  
FREE RUN  
Ignore this LED  
TOCA FAIL  
Replace the circuit pack  
Replace the circuit pack if necessary  
TOCA PORT ALM  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
Perform Complete System Test  
6
Page 6-8  
Verify Timing to the System  
1. Administer the Stratum 3 clock by issuing the change synchronization  
command at the management terminal.  
2. Enter a 3 in the stratumfield.  
3. Type the port network number where the TN780 Tone-Clock circuit packs  
reside in the port networkfield.  
NOTE:  
Wait 1 minute for the software to reconfigure the system  
synchronization.  
4. Verify the results of test 649. If test 649 fails with a code of 2101, then  
check the wiring for EXTSYN0 and EXTSYN1. Refer to DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
5. If test 649 is successful, then the system is getting correct timing from the  
Stratum 3 clock.  
Perform Complete System Test  
Run the complete system test with the “Allports” option in the “SPE Interchange”  
and “Long Test” modes. The hardware group tests are described in DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r or DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si.  
NOTE:  
This test takes several hours. It may be best to run the test in the  
background, or at night, or both.  
Resolve Alarms  
After the test has completed, inspect the alarms log. Type display alarms and  
resolve the alarms in the usual manner.  
Check the error log for evidence of failure. The only failure results logged should  
be the outcome of tests requiring a connected station, where a station is not  
connected to the port under test. Repair all other failures or refer them to a  
maintenance technician for repair.  
Resolve any alarms that may exist using DEFINITY Enterprise Communications  
Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
6
Activate and Test Alarm Origination Feature  
Page 6-9  
Activate and Test Alarm Origination  
Feature  
1. Activate the Alarm Origination feature from the change system-parameter  
maintenance form.  
2. Run test inads link to verify the system can reach the INADS Database  
Administrator at the Technical Service Center (TSC).  
3. Be sure the system is part of the existing INADS database by calling the  
INADS Database Administrator to verify the system can be dialed into and  
that the system can dial out to INADS.  
As part of the system registration process, the INADS Database  
Administrator enables Alarm Origination.  
Have the serial number of the system and the software version number  
available at the time of the call.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Test Telephones and Other Equipment  
6
Activate and Test Alarm Origination Feature  
Page 6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
A
Page A-1  
A
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
A
Signals between cabinets are carried by fiber optic cables. The electronic  
signals at 1 cabinet must be converted into optical signals. These optical signals  
are converted back into electronic signals at another cabinet.  
The fiber optic cables from the DEFINITY System route to a Lightguide  
Interconnect Unit (LIU), connect to the outside fiber plant, and then connect to  
the remote DEFINITY System via an LIU.  
Two types of fiber optic cables are used on DEFINITY Systems: multi-mode and  
single-mode. See Ta b l e A - 1 .  
Multi-mode fiber uses LEDs as its light source and is less expensive than  
single-mode fiber. There are 2 common types of multi-mode fiber:  
— 62.5 micron core  
— 50.0 micron core  
Single-mode fiber is more expensive than multi-mode because it uses  
LASER light as its light source. Single-mode fiber typically uses the 8-10  
micron core fiber.  
Table A-1. Fiber Optic Reference  
Operating  
Fiber Core  
Size  
Transceiver  
Model  
Wavelength  
(Nanometers) Fiber Type  
50 or 62.5  
50 or 62.5  
8.3 -9.0  
9823A  
9823B  
300A  
850 nm  
Multi-mode  
Multi-mode  
Single-mode  
1300 nm  
1300 nm  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
LASER Product  
A
Page A-2  
LASER Product  
The DEFINITY ECS may contain a Class 1 LASER device if single-mode fiber  
optic cable is connected to a remote Expansion Port Network (EPN). The LASER  
device operates within the following parameters:  
Maximum Power Output: -5dBm  
Wavelength: 1310 nm  
Mode Field Diameter: 8.8 microns  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  
IEC 825 1993  
!
CAUTION:  
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
Fiber Optic Requirements  
If estimated fiber losses are suspected of exceeding loss limits due to excessive  
length, splices, and so forth, perform OTDR (Optical Time Domain  
Reflectometer) or Optical Power Meter tests to ensure a successful installation of  
a remote EPN fiber link.  
The requirements that determine the maximum fiber optic cabling distances are:  
The mean loss and the length of the outside plant fiber cable  
The mean loss and the length of fiber cable shipped with the cabinet  
(including any fiber riser cable)  
The mean loss of an ST connector and the number of ST connections  
The mean loss due to the total number of splices  
Higher-order mode loss  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Fiber Optic Requirements  
A
Page A-3  
Fiber Optic Cable Connections  
The Customer Service Document (CSD) provides an “Inter-Carrier Cable  
Running List.” Each row on the list represents a cable connection. Use the  
running list to determine where to connect each fiber optic cable.  
Multi-Mode Fiber Optic Connections  
Multi-mode fiber cables are generally colored gray or orange. The following  
components are used in multi-mode fiber optic connections:  
Expansion Interface (EI) circuit packs in port slots in cabinet carriers  
Switch Node Interface (SNI) circuit packs in the Switch Node Carrier  
The 9823A lightwave transceiver transmits up to 4,900 feet (1500 m). The  
9823B lightwave transceiver transmits up to 25,000 feet (7600 m).  
Multi-mode fiber optic cable consisting of 2 separate 62.5 micron or 50  
micron core fiber optic cables.  
Single-Mode Fiber Optic Connections  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not use Dispersion Shifted or Wave Diversion Multiplexing fiber. Use  
only dispersion unshifted fiber such as Depressed Clad and Matched Clad  
fiber (EIA/TIA Class IVa).  
Single-mode fiber cables are generally colored yellow. The following components  
are used in single-mode fiber optic connections:  
Expansion Interface (EI) circuit packs in port slots in cabinet carriers  
Switch Node Interface (SNI) circuit packs in the Switch Node Carrier  
The 300A lightwave transceivers. Each 300A transmits light up to 115,000  
feet or 22 miles (35 km). Fiber loss must be less than 17dB. Saturation  
may occur if distances are short; attenuators may be required if the total  
loss on the fiber link is less than 10dBm. An OTDR or Optical Power Meter  
requirements.  
NOTE:  
Using the 300A may require 5, 10, or 15dB attenuators. See ‘‘When  
to Use Single-Mode Fiber Attenuators’’ on page A-7. Also, contact  
your Lucent Technologies representative for attenuator requirements  
on single-mode links.  
Single-mode fiber optic cable consisting of 2 separate 8 to 10 micron core  
cables.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Fiber Optic Requirements  
A
Page A-4  
Fiber Optic Component Comcodes  
Tab le A-2 provides fiber optic components and associated comcodes. These  
comcodes are from the Lucent Fiber Optics Product Catalog. For BCS  
comcodes, contact your Lucent Technologies representative.  
For multi-mode fiber optic cables and comcodes, refer to Tab l e A-3.  
For single-mode fiber optic cables and comcodes, refer to Tab l e A-4.  
Table A-2. Fiber Optic Component Comcodes (ST and STII)  
Description  
Comcode  
100A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU) 12 Terminations  
(Preterminated with Mini Fanouts)  
104325600  
200A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU) 24 Terminations  
(Preterminated with Mini Fanouts)  
106658545  
106266901  
400A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU) 48 Terminations  
(Preterminated with Mini Fanouts)  
Lightguide Distribution Shelf (Preterminated with Mini Fanouts)  
Contact Lucent  
Representative  
10A Lightguide Coupling Panel for 100A and 200A (6 Couplings) 104141858  
1000ST Lightguide Coupling Panel for 400A (6 Couplings)  
1A4 Vertical Trough for 100A  
105392005  
104141866  
104141874  
106497753  
106497761  
104148028  
105271142  
106060718  
106060734  
106061021  
846929883  
107731853  
106455348  
106455363  
1A6 Horizontal Trough for 100A  
2A4 Vertical Trough for 200A  
2A6 Horizontal Trough for 200A  
C2000A-2 Multi-mode Connector  
C3000A-2 Single-mode Connector  
5dB Attenuator (Single-mode) (Yellow)  
10dB Attenuator (Single-mode) (Yellow)  
15dB Attenuator (Single-mode) (Yellow)  
Fiber Protector Cover  
300A Fiber Optic Transceiver (Single-mode)  
9823A Fiber Optic Transceiver (Multi-mode)  
9823B Fiber Optic Transceiver (Multi-mode)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Fiber Optic Requirements  
A
Page A-5  
Tab le A-3 provides multi-mode cable lengths and associated comcode numbers.  
Multi-mode fiber cables are gray or orange in color.  
Table A-3. Multi-mode Fiber Cable Ordering Information  
Description  
Length  
Comcode  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
20 Feet (6.1 m)  
25 Feet (7.62 m)  
30 Feet (9.14 m)  
35 Feet (10.67 m)  
40 Feet (12.2 m)  
50 Feet (15.2 m)  
75 Feet (22.8 m)  
407439975  
407441427  
407441435  
407441443  
407441450  
407441468  
407441476  
100 Feet (30.48 m) 407441484  
125 Feet (38.1 m)  
150 Feet (45.7 m)  
175 Feet (53.3 m)  
200 Feet (61 m)  
407441492  
407441500  
407441518  
407441666  
Tab le A-4 provides single-mode cable lengths and associated comcode  
numbers. Single-mode fiber cables are yellow.  
Table A-4. Single-mode Fiber Cable Ordering Information  
Description  
Length  
Comcode  
Fiber Optic Patch Cord  
2 Feet (0.6 m)  
105357727  
407598325  
407598333  
407598341  
407598358  
407598366  
407598374  
407598390  
407598408  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
Fiber Interconnection Cable  
20 Feet (6.1 m)  
30 Feet (9.14 m)  
40 Feet (12.2 m)  
50 Feet (15.2 m)  
75 Feet (22.8 m)  
100 Feet (30.48 m)  
125 Feet (38.1 m)  
150 Feet (45.7 m)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-6  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
Optical cross-connects consist of a preterminated lightguide shelf or Lightguide  
Interconnect Unit (LIU) with lightguide troughs. A multi-mode or single-mode  
fiber optic cable connects the lightwave transceivers on the DEFINITY System to  
connector panels inside the shelf or LIU. Circuits can be changed by moving the  
patch cord from 1 point on the connector panel to another.  
Measuring Single-Mode Power in the Field  
The data pattern on the link influences the optical power measurement. The duty  
cycle that the transceiver is sending when the DEFINITY System is idle is a 30%  
on (“1”) and 70% off (“0”) data pattern. This implies that the optical reading will  
be about 2.3dB less than the typical output power specification (-8dBm).  
Calculate all power budget analysis at 50% duty cycle for both transmitter output  
power and receiver sensitivity.  
The following information is provided for field troubleshooting use only and is not  
intended for fiber budget analysis.  
The power measurement is taken from the TX connector, through the entire fiber  
link, and to the RX connector on the opposite end of the link (remote EPN). Refer  
to Figure A-2 for a typical fiber route.  
1. Remove the fiber cable from the RX connector at the local 300A.  
2. Attach the power meter to the fiber cable. Note the reading.  
3. Reconnect the RX cable.  
4. Repeat the test at the RX connector at the remote 300A. Note the reading.  
5. Reconnect the RX cable.  
6. Using Figure A-1, determine the type of in-line attenuator required for each  
direction in the tested fiber link.  
NOTE:  
Using the maximum power budget of 17dB in any fiber link may  
cause problems if the fiber plant is damaged and additional  
connectors or splices are added. Maintain a margin of at least 1dB;  
2dB is the industry standard.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-7  
When to Use Single-Mode Fiber Attenuators  
For 300A operation, single-mode fiber loss must be between 10dB and 17dB (at  
1300 to 1310 nm). Since saturation may occur if distances are short, attenuators  
may be required if the total loss on the fiber link is less than 10dB. Perform an  
OTDR or Optical Power Meter test to determine specific requirements. Typically,  
fiber distances of 9 miles (14 km) or less require an in-line attenuator.  
Using Figure A-1, find the line that most closely matches the customer’s fiber  
plant, or overlay your own load line. Using the measured loss of 0.33dB/km as an  
example, install a 10dB attenuator if the distance is about 9 miles (14 km) or less.  
Use a 5dB attenuator if the distance is from 9 to 18 miles (14.4 to 30 km).  
Figure A-1. Single-Mode Attenuator Requirements  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-8  
Single-Mode Fiber Link (with Attenuators)  
Figure Notes  
1. 300A Lightwave Transceiver  
2. 2-Foot (0.6 m) Patchcord  
3. In-Line Attenuator  
4. Fiber Plant  
5. TX Connector  
6. RX Connector  
7. Lightguide Interconnect Unit  
8. Fiber Optic Cable  
Figure A-2. Typical Single-Mode Connection with Attenuator  
1. Connect a 2-foot (0.6 m) patchcord to the TX connector on the local 300A  
transceiver. See Figure A-2.  
2. Connect the patchcord to the required attenuator. The attenuator must be  
installed in series with the strand of fiber connecting to the TX connector.  
3. Repeat for the TX connector at the opposite end of the fiber link (remote  
EPN). A different value attenuator may be required, depending on the  
amount of fiber loss back to the local system.  
NOTE:  
If the fiber link is duplicated, route the fiber via a separate  
geographical path, if possible. This way, if the standard fiber link is  
damaged, the duplicated fiber remains in service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-9  
Lightguide Distribution Shelf  
®
The preterminated lightguide distribution shelf can mount to LGX fiber optic  
distribution frames or can mount directly to a wall. The shelf can also mount in  
23-inch (58.4 cm) or 19-inch (48.2 cm) equipment cabinets or racks. The shelf  
accommodates single-mode and/or multi-mode fiber connections. See Figure  
A-3.  
Figure Notes:  
1. To PPN or Remote EPN Cabinet  
2. Retainer Rings  
3. Circuit Labels  
4. From Outside Cable Plant  
Figure A-3. Typical Preterminated Lightguide Distribution Shelf  
NOTE:  
If you are not viewing this book on CD-ROM, Figure A-3 shows orange fiber  
connections, denoting multi-mode fiber.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-10  
100A and 200A Lightguide Equipment  
Optical interconnects consist of LIUs without a trough between them. Incoming  
and outgoing cables connect directly to each other. This arrangement makes  
circuit changes more difficult, but reduces optical losses.  
Optical cross-connect and interconnect fields are made up of the following:  
100A or 200A LIU  
10A Lightguide Coupling Panel  
C2000A-2 Connector Coupling (Multi-Mode) or C3000A-2 Connector  
Coupling (Single-Mode)  
1A4 Lightguide Trough  
1A6 Lightguide Trough  
Fiber Interconnect Cable (Multi-Mode or Single-Mode)  
Lightguide Interconnect Units  
The 100A LIU consists of a cabinet with retainer rings to hold slack fiber cables,  
mounting cutouts for two 10A lightguide connector panels, and a door with circuit  
labels on each side. See Figure A-4. The 100A provides up to 12 terminations.  
The 200A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU) can terminate up to 24 fiber  
connections. These fiber connections can be either single-mode or multi-mode.  
Lightguide Troughs  
Two types of troughs are used with optical cross-connect hardware. The vertical  
trough secures single fiber optic jumpers routed between LIU columns, and the  
horizontal trough is used at the bottom of an LIU column to store cable slack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-11  
Figure Notes:  
1. 100A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU)  
2. Retainer Rings  
3. Circuit Labels  
Figure A-4. 100A Lightguide Interconnection Unit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-12  
10A and 1000ST Lightguide Coupling Panel  
The 10A Lightguide Coupling Panel mounts in the cutouts of a 100A LIU and a  
200A LIU. A 100A LIU requires 2 coupling panels. A 200A requires 4 coupling  
panels. Each panel can hold 6 connector couplings. A connection to an ST  
coupler is shown in Figure A-5.  
NOTE:  
If you are not viewing this book on CD-ROM, the fiber cable shown in Figure  
A-5 is yellow, denoting single-mode fiber.  
The 1000ST Lightguide Coupling Panel mounts in the cutouts of a 400A LIU. A  
400A LIU requires 8 coupling panels. Each coupling panel can hold 6 connector  
couplings.  
Figure A-5. 10A and 1000ST Lightguide Connector Coupling  
The C2000A-2 Connector Coupling joins multi-mode fiber optic cables equipped  
with ST connectors. It has a threaded midsection that allows it to be secured to  
the 10A or 1000ST Lightguide Coupling Panel.  
The C3000A-2 Connector Coupling joins single-mode fiber optic cables  
equipped with ST connectors. It has a threaded midsection that allows it to be  
secured to the 10A or 100ST Lightguide Coupling Panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-13  
400A Lightguide Equipment  
The 400A Lightguide Interconnect Unit (LIU) can terminate up to 48 fiber  
connections. These fiber connections can be either single-mode or multi-mode  
(not both).  
NOTE:  
If you are not viewing this book on CD-ROM, the fiber cable shown in Figure  
A-6 is yellow, denoting single-mode fiber.  
Figure Notes:  
1. 400A Lightguide Interconnect Unit 4. Demarcation Point (between  
(LIU)  
network and DEFINITY)  
2. Circuit Label  
5. Fiber Plant (Network Side)  
6. To 300A Fiber Optic Transceivers  
3. Fiber Optic Cable Connectors  
Figure A-6. 400A LIU Equipment  
1. Label each fiber cable as it is installed.  
2. Route the fiber cables from the fiber optic transceivers and connect as  
shown in Figure A-6.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-14  
General Rules and Recommendations  
Fiber optic cable requires careful handling and routing. Follow these rules and  
recommendations when installing fiber optic cables:  
Figure Notes  
1. Lightwave Transceiver  
2. To I/O Connector Panel  
3. Fiber Optic Cable  
4. Fiber Plant  
5. TX Connector  
6. RX Connector  
7. Lightguide Interconnect Unit  
Figure A-7. Fiber Optic Cable Connections Between Transceivers  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Optical Cross-Connect Hardware  
A
Page A-15  
Rule 1  
Cross-connect the fiber optic cable between 2 lightwave transceivers. That is,  
run the cable from the TX connector on 1 transceiver to the RX connector on the  
other transceiver, and in reverse for the other cable. See the top half of Figure  
A-7. Multi-mode connections using an LIU for fiber cross-connects to remote  
EPNs are shown in the bottom half of Figure A-7. For single-mode connections,  
refer to Figure A-2.  
Cross-connect the fiber optic cable between 2 lightwave transceivers for each  
connection (row) on the fiber optic cable running list as shown in the Customer  
Service Document.  
Rule 2  
For multi-mode fiber, use the 9823A (shortwave) transceiver for distances of up  
to 4900 feet (1494 m). Use the 9823B (longwave) transceiver for distances of up  
to 25,000 feet (7620 m). Ensure all 9823As connect to 9823As and all 9823Bs  
connect to 9823Bs.  
For single-mode fiber, use the 300A single-mode fiber optic transceivers.  
Single-mode fiber is generally used to connect remote EPNs at distances of up to  
115,000 feet (22 miles or 35 km). Single-mode fiber may require attenuators. It is  
usually more cost effective to use multi-mode fiber between cabinets when  
possible.  
Rule 3  
!
CAUTION:  
Do not route fiber optic cables and the B25A cables together.  
Route fiber optic cables away from groups of other cables where they may be  
stretched by the weight of metal cable bundles. It may be necessary to run fiber  
optic cables with the I/O cables, such as in the cable slack manager or under a  
raised floor. In these cases, protect the cable by running it in a dedicated area if  
possible. When the cable must be run with other cabling, protect it by running it  
through flexible conduit. Use the following steps to route the cable:  
1. Route the fiber optic cable up toward the top of the cabinet. The excess  
cable should be looped and draped from the B25A cable clamp.  
2. Dress the cable running up the back of the cabinets by loosely tie  
wrapping the cable to the outside of the B25A cable clamp (do not put the  
cable inside the clamp holding the B25A cables).  
Rule 4  
Avoid bending fiber optic cables to a radius smaller than 1.5 inches (3.8 cm), to  
prevent mechanical stress on the cables. Plan the use of cable ties to avoid  
crimping the cable or creating a fixed stress point where, at a later time,  
movementDoofwtnhloeadcafrobmleWcwawu.Ssoemsanitutaols.ecoxmc.eAelldMathnuealms Sineiamrcuh mAndbDeonwdnloraadd.ius.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Cleaning Fiber Optic Cables  
A
Page A-16  
Rule 5  
Ensure fiber optic cables are not pressed against any sheet metal edges by  
subsequently installed cables.  
Rule 6  
If the fiber link is duplicated, route the fiber via a separate geographical path, if  
possible. This way, if the standard fiber link is cut or damaged, the duplicated  
fiber remains in service.  
Cleaning Fiber Optic Cables  
The use of isopropyl alcohol is recommended to properly clean fiber optic  
cables. Contact your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
1. Moisten a lint-free cloth with isopropyl alcohol.  
2. Gently wipe the ceramic ferrule with the cloth. Be sure to wipe the entire  
length of the ferrule and the ferrule tip.  
3. Dry the ferrule with air.  
4. If the connector is not being used immediately, cover the connector with  
the dust cap.  
Labels for Fiber Optic Cables  
Cable Labels  
Cable labels, with adhesive backing, are installed on each end of a fiber optic  
cable. Each label displays the following information:  
The numbers of the cabinets, carriers, and slots connected by the cable  
Information on the cable itself, such as cable comcode number, and how  
it is used  
Cross-Connect Labels  
The label used with cross-connect fiber optic cables shows the cabinet, carrier  
and slot numbers of the source of the cable. It also indicates that the cable goes  
to the LIU. The type of cable is indicated by its comcode number.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
A
Making Changes at an LIU or Shelf  
Page A-17  
Making Changes at an LIU or Shelf  
Circuit changes are made by moving the fiber optic patch cords to other  
couplings.  
To Remove a Fiber Optic Patch Cord  
1. At the LIU or shelf, locate the correct patch cord and unplug it from the  
coupling.  
2. Carefully remove the cable from the LIU and from the trough.  
NOTE:  
Take care to ensure the patch cord is not bent beyond the minimum  
bend radius of 1.5 inches (3.8 cm).  
3. Trace the other end of the patch cord to its termination point and unplug it.  
4. Remove the label associated with the removed patch cord.  
5. Place plastic covers over the connectors to prevent dust or damage.  
To Make a New Cross-Connection  
1. At the LIU or shelf, locate the connector couplings associated with the  
circuit to be added.  
2. Select a patch cord of the appropriate length for the cross-connection to  
be made. Excess cord length causes congestion in the trough and may  
cause the cable to be damaged.  
3. Plug 1 end of the cord into the appropriate connector coupling.  
4. Route the patch cord through the LIU or shelf and into the vertical and  
horizontal troughs.  
5. Plug the other end of the patch cord into the appropriate connector  
coupling on the fiber optic transceiver on the DEFINITY System.  
6. Label the cable for the circuit added.  
7. Test the circuit using the test fiber link commands in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connecting Fiber Optic Cables  
Routing Fiber Optic Cables  
A
Page A-18  
To Make a New Interconnection  
1. At the LIU, locate the cable to be moved and unplug it from the coupling.  
2. Carefully unwind the cable from around the retainer rings, remembering  
the minimum bend radius.  
3. If it is necessary to remove the cable from the LIU, carefully guide it  
through the split rings in the LIU.  
4. Locate the appropriate connection on the other side of the interconnect  
field and carefully route the cable through the split rings of the LIU.  
5. Carefully unwind the cable from the retainer rings, remembering the  
minimum bend radius.  
6. Plug the cable into the appropriate connector coupling.  
7. Label the cable for the changed circuit.  
8. Test the circuit using the test fiber link commands in DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server Release 6 Maintenance for R6r.  
Routing Fiber Optic Cables  
Cable Slack Managers or Raised Floors  
When using either cable slack managers or raised floors, route the fiber cable to  
the outside of the carriers behind the rear connector panel and cable troughs. Do  
not route fiber in the side cable troughs used for the B25A cables. However,  
since the B25A cables route out of the bottom of the trough, loop slack fiber at  
the top of the trough.  
Protect cables routed between cabinets with a fiber protector cover. When  
routing fiber to a cabinet that is not adjacent, route the fiber back into and under  
the top of the intermediate cabinet.  
Fiber optic cable requires connection to an LIU or shelf for connection to remote  
cabinets or for connection to the outside fiber plant. In some systems, it may be  
necessary to run fiber with the I/O cables such as in the cable slack manager or  
under a raised floor. In these cases protect the fiber by running it in a dedicated  
area if possible. In any situation where the fiber optic cable must be run with  
other cabling, protect it by first running it through flexible conduit.  
Overhead Ductwork  
With overhead ductwork, route the fiber cable to the outside of the carriers, along  
the cable troughs, and into the shielded ductwork.  
Do not route fiber in the side cable troughs that are used for the B25A cables.  
Use the shDieolwdnelodaddfurocmtwWowrwk.Stoommanaunalas.gcoems. lAallcMkanfiubaelsrSaetartchheAtnodpDoowfntlhoaed.cabinet.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
Page B-1  
B
Option Switch Settings  
B
Some of the interface units used between the Multi-Carrier Cabinets and other  
types of equipment require specific option switch settings.  
This section lists the settings required for the Comsphere external modems, 572  
printers, and TN760 and TN464 Tie Trunk circuit packs.  
Refer to the user’s guide for each type of equipment for information on how to  
locate and set the option switches.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
External Modem Option Settings  
Page B-2  
External Modem Option Settings  
The COMSPHERE 3700, 3800, and 3900 series (recommended) external  
modems may require option switch settings. Refer to the documentation that  
accompanies each modem to set the options.  
NOTE:  
A locally obtained, type-approved external modem may be used. Contact  
your Lucent Technologies representative for more information.  
The Release 6 systems operate with the COMSPHERE modems set to the factory  
default settings. The modem settings and descriptions are listed in Tab le B-1.  
Table B-1. Modem Fields  
Modem  
Connection  
Description  
Modem Name  
This field is 20 characters long and permits alphanumeric characters to  
provide a unique qualifier for a given modem (such as INTEL).  
RTS/CTS  
Enabled  
Informs the modem that communication with the data source UART is  
driven with RTS/CTS flow control. The field name has a default of \Q3 in a  
field 6 characters long. This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper  
case.  
Asynchronous Configures modem as an asynchronous communications device. The  
Data Mode  
field name has a default value of &M0&Q0 in a field 8 characters long.  
This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
DTE  
Auto-Data  
Speed  
Adjusts the speed of the data source (DTE) UART to the outgoing  
(modem-to-modem) data rate. At maximum, this speed is 9600 baud. It is  
not desirable to have the serial data fill the modem buffer faster than the  
outgoing data rate, since data compression is disabled. The field name  
has a blank default value in a field of 6 characters. The Lucent products  
use the command S90=1 to enable this functionality while the Intel  
product uses the command \J1 to enable similar functionality. This field is  
not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Disable Data  
Compression  
Turns off the default data compression algorithms in use by most  
modems. The field has a blank field of 6 characters as default. The AT  
commands that control this are supported by similar commands;  
however, these commands do not operate in the same manner. The Intel  
modems require “H0%C0” to disable V.42bis & MNP Class 5 data  
compression algorithms. The Paradyne products only use %C0 to disable  
both algorithms. This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
External Modem Option Settings  
Page B-3  
Table B-1. Modem Fields Continued  
Modem  
Connection  
Description  
Enable Error  
Control  
Turns on the V.42 LAPM and MNP error control protocols, if available. The  
field has a blank field of 6 characters as default. The Paradyne products  
use the command \N5 to enable V.42/MNP/Buffer error control while the  
Intel product uses \N3 to provide similar functionality.  
This V.42/MNP/Buffer mode attempts to negotiate V.42 error control with  
the remote modem. If this fails, the modem changes to MNP, if this fails,  
no error control is used. This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper  
case.  
Misc. Init.  
Param  
This field has a blank as a default and a field length of 20 characters. This  
field supports any initialization parameters not already specified. The AT  
commands specified in this free-form field is always the last initialization  
parameters to be sent to the external modem. This field is not case  
sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Auto-Answer  
Ring Number  
This field controls the number of rings required before the modem  
answers an incoming call. This field has a blank default value in a field 6  
characters long. Typically, the maximum permissible value for this register  
is 255. The values 1-255 denote the number of incoming ring cycles. This  
field is not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Dial Type  
This field controls the type of interregister signaling to be used between  
the modem and the Central Office. The field has a default of ”T“ for tone  
dialing. Pulse dialing is indicated by “P”. The field length should be 3  
characters long. This field is concatenated with the dial string. This field is  
not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Adjustable  
Make/Break  
Ratio  
This field controls the make/break ratios of pulses and DTMF dialing. The  
Intel product information has support for different make/ break options for  
pulse dialing only. Intel uses &P0 to select a ratio of 39% make and 61%  
break for communication within the United States and Canada. The option  
&P1 sets a ratio of 33% make and 67% break for the United Kingdom and  
Hong Kong. This field has a blank default and a 5 character long entry.  
This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
External Modem Option Settings  
Page B-4  
Table B-1. Modem Fields Continued  
Modem  
Connection  
Description  
Dial  
Command  
This field has a default of “D” in a field 3 characters long. This field  
denotes the dialing command of the modem. This is a standard  
command. This field is not case sensitive. Default is upper case.  
No Answer  
Time-Out  
Most external modems provide a timer that abandons any outbound data  
call after a predetermined interval. Some modems disable this timer,  
allowing an outbound call to ring indefinitely. Paradyne does not provide  
this capability because it is undesirable to have an outbound call attempt  
to ring indefinitely. Therefore, the initialization string must contain the  
following ASCII string to set the “No-Answer Timer” to the maximum value:  
S7=255. The internal modem must have this parameter disabled or set to  
at least 255 seconds. This is a non-administrable parameter.  
For the modem connection, this parameter is the first initialization string to  
be transmitted to the modem. This field is visible on the administration  
form in display mode only. The new field is set to S7=255. This hardcoded  
constant can be overridden for type approval applications, specifically in  
the United Kingdom and other Western European nations, by the use of  
the “Misc. Init. Param:” field. (S7=255)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
Printer Option Settings  
B
Page B-5  
Printer Option Settings  
Printers can be used with a management terminal as journal printers for the  
hospitality feature and also as an output device for Call Detail Recording (CDR).  
A 572 printer can function as a CDR device, system printer, or journal printer.  
The options are set with function keys rather than DIP switches. Figure B-1 shows  
the arrangement of the function keys on the printer control panel.  
Power  
On  
Alarm  
Print  
Quality  
On  
Line  
Form  
Feed  
Line  
Feed  
r781610 RBP 071096  
Figure Notes  
1. Power On Button  
2. Alarm Button  
4. On Line Button  
5. Line Feed Button  
6. Form Feed Button  
3. Print Quality Button  
Figure B-1. Control Panel for 572 Printer  
1. Load the printer with paper and turn the power off (Callout 1).  
2. Simultaneously press and hold the Print Quality and On Line buttons.  
3. Press the Power On button. Release all three buttons. The printer is now in  
set-up mode and it prints the following settings:  
Form length  
Buzzer on/off  
Lines per inch  
Characters per inch  
Letter quality or near letter quality  
If the printer is used with a management terminal, CDR, or as a Journal  
printer, set the options as shown in Ta b l e B -2 . If the printer is used as the  
system printer, set the options as shown in Table B-3 on page B-7.  
4. Use Line Feed to step forward through the list of functions or use Form  
Feed to step backward.  
5. Press On Line. This activates the menu for the function. Use Line Feed  
and Form Feed to step through the options for the function.  
6. When a desired option is located, press Print Quality. Each time an option  
is set, the setting is printed. Repeat Step 4 for each option to be set.  
7. When finished, press Print Quality. The printer changes to normal mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
Printer Option Settings  
B
Page B-6  
Table B-2. 572 Printer Used with Management Terminal  
Function  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
22  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
Function Name  
FORM LENGTH  
LPI  
Menu  
09  
01  
01  
01  
01  
02  
01  
02  
01  
01  
02  
01  
01  
01  
01  
01  
02  
01  
03  
07  
01  
02  
01  
02  
02  
02  
02  
03  
01  
01  
01  
Menu Status  
11  
6
CPI  
10  
LQ or NLQ  
LQ  
BUZZER  
ON  
FONT  
FONTCART  
144  
RESOLUTION  
BUFFER  
N-LINE  
ON-LINE  
B1-DIR.1  
LF + CR  
ACTIVE  
CR + LF  
0
PW ON MODE  
DIRECTION  
BUFF FULL  
P.E.  
AUTO CARRIAGE RETURN (CR)  
ZERO  
AUTO LINE FEED  
1" SKIP  
CR ONLY  
OFF  
CHAR.SET (GO, GL)  
CHAR.SET (G1, GR)  
CHAR SET (G2)  
CHAR SET (G3)  
OFF-LINE STATE  
DSR  
USA  
UK  
GE  
LINE DRAWING  
ALL RECEIVE  
OFF  
REQUEST TO SEND (RTS) TIMING  
CD  
RTS  
OFF  
CLEAR TO SEND (CTS)  
OVER RUN  
OFF  
256  
DATA BIT  
8
PROTOCOL  
XON/XOFF  
1
STOP BIT  
PARITY  
NONE  
9600  
PBS (matches connected device)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
Printer Option Settings  
B
Page B-7  
Table B-3. 572 Printer used as System Printer  
572 Printer Option Settings  
Function Name Menu  
FORM LENGTH  
Function  
01  
Menu Status  
11  
09  
01  
01  
01  
01  
02  
01  
02  
01  
01  
02  
01  
01  
01  
01  
01  
02  
01  
03  
07  
01  
02  
01  
02  
02  
02  
02  
03  
01  
01  
04  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
22  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
LPI  
6
CPI  
10  
LQ or NLQ  
LQ  
BUZZER  
ON  
FONT  
FONTCART  
144  
RESOLUTION  
BUFFER  
N-LINE  
ON-LINE  
B1-DIR.1  
LF + CR  
ACTIVE  
CR + LF  
0
PW ON MODE  
DIRECTION  
BUFF FULL  
P.E.  
AUTO CARRIAGE RETURN (CR)  
ZERO  
AUTO LINE FEED  
1" SKIP  
CR ONLY  
OFF  
CHAR.SET (GO, GL)  
CHAR.SET (G1, GR)  
CHAR SET (G2)  
CHAR SET (G3)  
OFF-LINE STATE  
DSR  
USA  
UK  
GE  
LINE DRAWING  
ALL RECEIVE  
OFF  
REQUEST TO SEND (RTS) TIMING  
CD  
RTS  
OFF  
CLEAR TO SEND (CTS)  
OVER RUN  
DATA BIT  
OFF  
256  
8
PROTOCOL  
STOP BIT  
XON/XOFF  
1
PARITY  
NONE  
1200  
PBS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
Call Detail Recording Option Settings  
Page B-8  
Call Detail Recording Option Settings  
The interface between the system and CDR equipment may be 1 of the following:  
Data Module recommended option settings are shown in Tab le B-3.  
Modem recommended option settings are in modem vendor document  
TN726 Data Line circuit pack and an Asynchronous Data Unit data  
modules or modems are not required.  
Connected directly to the DCE connector (EIA Port) located on the rear of  
the Control Carrier data modules or modems are not required.  
A 572 Printer can be used as an output receiving device for CDR. The  
recommended option settings for this printer is shown in Ta b l e B -4 . Also, a  
TELESEER, CDR, 94A Local Storage Unit (LSU), or Customer Premises  
Equipment (CPE) can be used as the output receiving device.  
Administration procedures for CDR equipment are provided in DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server Release 6 Administration and Feature  
Description.  
Table B-4. 572 Printer Used with Management Terminal, CDR,  
or Journal Printer  
Function  
01  
Function Name  
FORM LENGTH  
LPI  
Menu  
09  
Menu Status  
11  
02  
01  
6
03  
CPI  
01  
10  
04  
LQ or NLQ  
BUZZER  
01  
LQ  
05  
01  
ON  
06  
FONT  
02  
FONTCART  
144  
07  
RESOLUTION  
BUFFER  
01  
11  
02  
N-LINE  
ON-LINE  
B1-DIR.1  
LF + CR  
ACTIVE  
CR + LF  
0
13  
PW ON MODE  
DIRECTION  
BUFF FULL  
P.E.  
01  
14  
01  
15  
02  
16  
01  
17  
AUTO CARRIAGE RETURN (CR)  
ZERO  
01  
18  
01  
22  
AUTO LINE FEED  
01  
CR ONLY  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
Call Detail Recording Option Settings  
Page B-9  
Table B-4. 572 Printer Used with Management Terminal, CDR,  
or Journal Printer — Continued  
Function  
31  
Function Name  
1" SKIP  
Menu  
01  
02  
01  
03  
07  
01  
02  
01  
02  
02  
02  
02  
03  
01  
01  
01  
Menu Status  
OFF  
32  
CHAR.SET (GO, GL)  
CHAR.SET (G1, GR)  
CHAR SET (G2)  
CHAR SET (G3)  
OFF-LINE STATE  
DSR  
USA  
33  
UK  
34  
GE  
35  
LINE DRAWING  
81  
ALL RECEIVE  
82  
OFF  
RTS  
OFF  
OFF  
256  
83  
REQUEST TO SEND (RTS) TIMING  
CD  
84  
85  
CLEAR TO SEND (CTS)  
OVER RUN  
91  
92  
DATA BIT  
8
93  
PROTOCOL  
XON/XOFF  
1
94  
STOP BIT  
95  
PARITY  
NONE  
9600  
96  
PBS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
TN760D Tie Trunk Option Settings  
Page B-10  
TN760D Tie Trunk Option Settings  
The TN760D Tie Trunk circuit pack interfaces between four tie trunks and the  
TDM bus. Two tip and ring pairs form a 4-wire analog transmission line. An E and  
M pair are DC signaling leads used for call setup. The E-lead receives signals  
from the tie trunk and the M-lead transmits signals to the tie trunk.  
To choose the preferred signaling format (Tab l e B-5 and Tab le B-6), set the  
switches on the TN760D and administer the port using Figure B-2 and Ta b l e B - 7 .  
Table B-5. Signaling Formats for TN760D  
Mode  
Type  
Type I Standard (unprotected)  
Type I Compatible (unprotected)  
Type I Compatible, Type I Standard  
Type V  
E & M  
E & M  
Protected  
Simplex  
E & M  
Type V  
E & M  
Type V Revised  
Table B-6. Signaling Type Summary  
Signaling Type  
Transmit (M-Lead)  
Receive (E-Lead)  
On-Hook Off-Hook  
On-Hook  
ground  
Off-Hook  
battery  
ground  
ground  
open  
1
Type I Standard  
open /battery ground  
1
1
Type I Compatible open /battery  
ground  
open  
open /battery  
1
Type V  
open /battery  
ground  
ground  
open  
Type V Reversed  
ground  
1. An open circuit is preferred instead of battery voltage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
TN760D Tie Trunk Option Settings  
Page B-11  
UNPROT  
SMPLX  
E & M  
SMPLX  
E & M  
SMPLX  
E & M  
SMPLX  
E & M  
4
3
2
1
PROT  
PORT 1  
PORT 4  
PORT 3  
PORT 2  
r758183 RBP 050896  
Figure B-2. TN760D Tie Trunk Circuit Pack (Component Side)  
Table B-7. TN760D Option Switch Settings and Administration  
E&M/SMPLX Prot/Unprot  
Administered  
Port  
Installation Situation  
Preferred Signaling Format  
Switch  
Switch  
Circumstance  
To  
System  
Far-End  
Co-Located  
DEFINITY  
E&M Type 1  
Compatible  
E&M Type 1  
Standard  
E&M  
Unprotected  
Type 1  
Compatible  
Type 1  
Inter-Building  
DEFINITY  
Protected  
Type 1  
Protected  
Type 1  
E&M  
Protected  
Compatible  
Standard  
Plus  
Compatible  
Protection  
Unit  
Co-Located  
Net  
Integrated  
E&M Type 1  
Standard  
Any PBX  
E&M  
Unprotected  
Type 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Option Switch Settings  
B
TN464E/F Option Settings  
Page B-12  
TN464E/F Option Settings  
The TN464E/F DS1/E1 Interface - T1/E1 circuit pack interfaces between a 24 or  
32 channel Central Office/ISDN or tie trunk and the TDM bus.  
Set the switches on the circuit pack to select bit rate and impedance match. See  
Tab le B-8 and Figure B-3.  
Table B-8. Option Switch Settings on TN464E/F  
120 Ohms  
75 Ohms  
Twisted pair  
Coaxial requiring 888A adapter  
32 Channel 2.048 megabits per second  
24 Channel 1.544 megabits per second  
10  
4
9
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
Figure Notes  
1. Backplane Connectors  
2. 24/32 Channel Selector  
3. 75/120 Ohm Selector  
4. Faceplate  
6. 120 Ohm (shown selected)  
7. 24 Channel (shown selected)  
8. 75 Ohm  
9. Connector  
5. 32 Channel  
10. TN464E/F DS1/E1 Interface Circuit Pack  
Figure B-3. TN464E/F Option Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-1  
C
Cable Ductwork  
C
The cable ductwork is assembled from various group numbers from ED-1E465  
(facia paneling to cover the I/O ducts is assembled from ED-1E464). The  
assembly, installed after the cabinets have been installed, provides ducts for  
three types of cables: intercabinet cables, I/O cables (tip and ring), and AC  
power cables. DC power cables are installed in ductwork per local codes.  
Typical assembled ductwork is shown in Figure C-1. The 3 primary types of  
ductwork are detailed below:  
Shielded intercabinet cable duct — Provides the path for cables  
connected between cabinets. This duct is the first installed. Covers for this  
duct should be stored until the intercabinet cabling is completed.  
I/O cable duct — Provides the path for I/O cables to the Main Distribution  
Frame (MDF). The I/O cables originate at connectors on the rear of the  
cabinets and terminate on connectors at the MDF.  
AC power duct — Provides the path for the AC wiring that powers the  
system. This duct mounts to the rear of the shielded duct that runs across  
each cabinet.  
Five group numbers provide various arrangements of receptacles necessary for  
different types of cabinets. Knockouts are provided for 1-inch (2.54 cm), 1.5-inch  
(3.81 cm), or 2-inch (5 cm) conduits that provide AC power connection at one  
end of each cabinet lineup. Covers for the power duct should be stored until the  
AC wiring is completed.  
Three methods are available for running I/O cables from the I/O ducts to the  
MDF:  
1. Using an overhead cable rack  
2. Using cable duct groups 22 through 26, and 39  
3. Using multiples of either group as required  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-2  
Equipment room layout and expected growth determines which method to use.  
Installation of an overhead rack is covered by Cable Racks (800-614-157).  
NOTE:  
Install all screws in all appropriate places to comply with electromagnetic  
interference (EMI) requirements for shielding.  
duct1 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. I/O Cross-Isle Trough  
2. Shielded Intercabinet Duct  
3. AC Power Cable Duct  
4. Front of Cabinets  
5. I/O Ducts to Cross-Connect Field  
Figure C-1. Typical Layout of Assembled Ductwork  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-3  
Installation  
This ductwork consists of ED-1E465 group numbers (facia paneling to cover the  
I/O ducts is assembled from ED-1E464). The group numbers match those in the  
Customer Service Document (CSD) and floor plan layout.  
Inventory the materials received and mark a copy of the floor plan with the  
location of each group number to be installed. Hardware used to assemble each  
item is packaged with the individual groups.  
Tab le C-1 shows the available group numbers and a brief description of each  
group. Some ducts are equipped with covers which should be stored until all  
cabling is completed. When storing, tag the covers with their associated group  
numbers for ease in identification.  
Table C-1. ED-1E465 Group Numbers and Descriptions  
Group  
6
Description  
Rear or front end plate for I/O ductwork  
8
I/O cable rack coupling to rear of cabinet  
I/O cable rack riser to side of cabinet  
9
10  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
I/O cross-aisle ductwork  
AC power duct  
AC power duct with one 3-wire twist-lock receptacle (right side)  
AC power duct with one 3-wire twist-lock receptacle (left side)  
AC power duct with two 3-wire twist-lock receptacles (right side)  
AC power duct with four 3-wire twist-lock receptacles (left side)  
Raceway cover  
Raceway cover with utility outlet  
AC power duct combination end  
AC power duct with one 4-wire twist-lock receptacle (right side)  
I/O duct-side of cabinet to wall (43 inch (109.2 cm ) aisle)  
I/O duct-side of cabinet to wall over one cabinet  
I/O duct-side of cabinet to wall over two cabinets  
I/O duct-side of cabinets to wall over three cabinets  
I/O duct-rear of cabinet to wall (43 inch (109.2 cm ) aisle)  
Transition between older DIMENSION system-type cabinet and new DEFINITY  
system cabinets for shielded cable ducts  
Continued on next page  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-4  
Table C-1. ED-1E465 Group Numbers and Descriptions Continued  
Group  
Description  
28  
Transition between older DIMENSION system-type cabinet and new DEFINITY  
system cabinets for I/O cables  
29  
30  
31  
Shielded duct assembly transition from the front of a System 85-R1 cabinet to  
the rear of a DEFINITY cabinet  
I/O duct transition assembly for cross-aisle (System 85-R1 lineup to bridge a  
DEFINITY lineup)  
Shielded duct assembly transition from rear of a System 85-R1 to front of a  
DEFINITY cabinet  
32  
33  
34  
35  
37  
39  
41  
42  
44  
51  
78  
AC power with a 4-wire twist-lock receptacle (left side viewed from rear)  
Ladder rack supported 86 or 88.5 inches (218.4 cm or 224.7 cm) from floor  
AC power duct with two 3-wire receptacles (250 VAC) (right side)  
AC power duct with one 3-wire receptacle (250 VAC) (right side)  
AC power duct with one 3-wire receptacle (30 A, 208 VAC) for CC  
I/O cross-aisle ductwork (48 inch (109.2 cm ) aisle)  
Basic hardware for one cabinet  
Right or left end plate for shielded ductwork  
Front and rear end plate for shielded ductwork  
Shielded cross-aisle ductwork  
Shielded cross-aisle ductwork (48 inch (122 cm) aisle)  
Install the various cable ducts in the order shown in Tab l e C-2. Figure C-2 shows  
an overhead view of a typical ductwork installation.  
!
WARNING:  
To prevent damage to the cabinet circuitry or cables, place cardboard or  
equivalent in the cable ducts to catch any metal filings that may fall from the  
self-threading screws.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-5  
Table C-2. Installation Sequence  
Step  
Group  
41  
Remarks  
1
2
3
Install basic ductwork on each cabinet  
Install cross-aisle shielded ductwork  
51  
10 or 26  
22-25  
Install I/O cross-aisle or cabinet to wall cable trough  
Install I/O cross-aisle to wall trough duct  
4
5
8
or  
9
Install I/O cable rack coupling to rear of cabinet  
or  
install I/O cable rack riser to end of cabinet  
12-19,  
Install AC power ducts  
21, 32,  
34, & 35  
6
7
8
27  
Install shielded cable ducts between DEFINITY and  
DIMENSION cabinets  
28  
Install I/O cable ducts between DEFINITY and  
DIMENSION cabinets  
29 & 31  
Install shielded duct assembly from front of system  
cabinet to rear of a DEFINITY cabinet (group 29) or  
front of a DEFINITY cabinet to rear of system cabinet  
(group 31)  
9
30  
33  
I/O transition assembly for cross-aisle (DEFINITY)  
10  
Ladder rack supported 86 or 88.5 inches (218.4 cm  
or 224.8 cm) from floor  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-6  
Figure Notes  
1. Wall  
6. Shielded Intercabinet Fiber Optic  
Cables  
2. Space for Future Cabinet  
7. I/O Duct to Cross-Connect Field  
8. I/O Cross-Isle Trough  
3. Plywood Wall and Cross-Connect  
Field  
4. I/O Cable Rack Coupling to Rear of 9. Front of Cabinets  
Cabinet  
5. AC Power Cable Duct  
Figure C-2. Overhead View of a Typical Ductwork Layout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-7  
Install Intercabinet Shielded Ducts  
1. Loosen (do not remove) the four bolts holding the dust cover to the cable  
access hole in the top of the cabinet.  
plate KLC 071696  
Figure C-3. Dust Cover Removal  
2. Remove the dust cover by sliding it in the direction shown by the arrow in  
Figure C-3. Move the dust cover until it clears the bolts.  
3. Set the cabinet riser (“A” in Figure C-4) with its base in place of the dust  
cover just removed. The four slots in its base should be just behind the  
bolts and the heads of the two middle bolts should have cleared the holes  
provided for them. Push the riser forward to seat the bolts in the four slots  
in the base of the riser. Then tighten the bolts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-8  
ductcip KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. A  
2. B  
3. C  
4. D  
5. E  
Figure C-4. Assembly of Intercabinet Shielded Ducts  
4. Install risers on any other cabinets that require shielded-duct connections.  
5. Set a shielded trough ("B") between two cabinet risers (“A”). Push down on  
the trough so the slots in the ends of the trough engage the ears at the  
corners of the risers. The walls of the trough go inside the walls of the  
risers and outside of the ears of the risers.  
6. Seat the bottom of the shielded trough on the support walls of the two  
cabinet risers that it connects. Attach the trough to each riser with a  
self-tapping screw.  
7. Install shielded troughs on any other pairs of cabinets that require  
shielded-duct connections.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-9  
8. Route the appropriate cables between the cabinets just connected.  
9. If a given cabinet is to support a cross-aisle shielded duct, set a  
cross-aisle riser (“C” in Figure C-4) on the cabinet riser (“A”). Otherwise  
set a shielded coupling (“D”) on the cabinet riser. In either case, position  
the device so the two holes on the back wall line up with the holes on the  
back wall of the cabinet riser. Bolt the two pieces together at the holes just  
described.  
10. If there is no trough to install in one end of the cabinet riser, press a  
shielded end cap (“E”) on the unused end of the riser. The side walls of  
the end cap go inside the walls of the riser and outside of the ears of the  
riser. The top of the end cap should rest on top of the shielded coupling or  
cross-aisle riser previously installed. Bolt the bottom of the end cap to the  
cabinet riser with a self-tapping screw.  
11. Set the shielded cover (“D”) on the shielded trough (“B”) and press it  
down so the dimples on the cover engage the holes in the trough.  
Install Cross-Aisle Shielded Ducts  
The inter-cabinet ducts and cross-aisle risers must be installed before any  
cross-aisle ductwork is installed.  
1. Set the tongue on the bottom of a cross-aisle trough (“G” in Figure C-5)  
into the platform of the cross-aisle riser (“C”). From above the trough, run a  
self-tapping screw through the slot in the trough and into the hole in the  
riser.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-10  
xductcip KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. A  
2. B  
3. C  
4. G  
5. E  
6. F  
7. H  
Figure C-5. Assembly of Cross-Aisle Shielded Ducts  
2. Install cross-aisle troughs on any other cabinets requiring such  
connections.  
3. If there is no trough ("G") to install in one end of the cross-aisle riser ("C"),  
press a cross-aisle shielded end cap ("F") on the unused end of the riser.  
Unlike earlier ductwork, the endcap fits either end of the cross-aisle riser.  
The side walls of the end cap go outside the walls of the riser. The ears on  
the bottom of the end cap go outside of the riser’s bottom plate, and the  
bottom plate of the end cap goes inside of the riser’s bottom plate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Route the appropriate cables between the cabinets just connected.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-11  
5. Set the shielded cross-aisle trough cover ("H") on top of the trough with its  
side walls outside of the walls of the trough, and press it down until it  
completely covers the trough.  
Mating Cross-Aisle Risers to Old Cabinet Risers  
The new shielded ductwork is constructed so cross-aisle risers can be attached  
to cabinet risers of the former design.  
1. Remove the shielded coupling from the old cabinet riser. This assembly is  
illustrated in the older system’s installation document.  
2. Replace the shielded coupling with a cross-aisle riser. Set the cross-aisle  
riser (“C” in Figure C-6) on the cabinet riser (“A”). Position the cross-aisle  
riser so the two holes on the back wall line up with the holes on the back  
wall of the cabinet riser. Bolt the two pieces together at the holes just  
described.  
oldduct KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. A  
2. C  
3. F  
4. G  
Figure C-6. Mating Cross-Aisle Risers to System 85-R2 Cabinet Risers  
3. Assemble cross-aisle ductwork as already described.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-12  
Mating Shielded Ducts to Risers  
The new shielded ductwork is constructed so new cross-aisle troughs can be  
attached to risers of the former design. They fit outside of the older risers.  
To attach the new shielded trough to a riser, first set it under the trough on the  
riser and install the other side of the trough as already described. Lift the trough  
as shown in Figure C-7, with the walls of the trough outside of the walls of the  
riser. Hold a nut under the trough, and bolt the parts together as shown.  
newduct KLC 071696  
Figure C-7. Shielded Duct Connected to Old Style Riser  
Install Cross Aisle I/O Ductwork  
1. If required, attach I/O endplate (group 6) to the cross-aisle brackets  
(group 10). See Figure C-8.  
2. Install a cross-aisle bracket on both sides of the I/O trough where  
cross-aisle or wall trough is to be used. Place the bracket inside the I/O  
trough with its angle end outside. Secure the bracket using three  
thread-forming screws in each trough (use the holes in the bracket closest  
to the angle).  
3. If cross-aisle, install brackets on I/O trough of cross-aisle cabinet.  
4. Place I/O cross-aisle trough (group 10) or I/O wall trough (group 26) on  
brackets and secure with thread-forming screws.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-13  
duct3 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. I/O Trough  
4. I/O Endplate  
2. Use Only When Required  
3. Cross-Aisle Brackets  
5. Cross-Aisle I/O Trough or I/O Wall Trough  
6. Front of Cabinet  
Figure C-8. Install Cross-Aisle I/O Ductwork or I/O Cross-Aisle to Wall  
Trough  
NOTE:  
If wall trough is being installed, locally provided hardware is required at wall  
end of duct.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-14  
Install Cross-Aisle to Wall Trough  
Refer to Figure C-9 to assemble the ductwork:  
1. Install wall mounting bracket to designated location. Hardware to mount  
bracket should be determined according to wall type and should be  
locally provided.  
2. Use thread-forming screws to attach the 3-hole face of the angle bracket  
to the I/O trough.  
3. Attach the angle bracket to the 6-hole face of the cross-aisle bracket using  
three 10-24 X 3/4 inch screws, connected to nuts and washers through the  
bottom holes.  
4. Attach the I/O cable duct to the cross-aisle bracket using the  
thread-forming screws. Attach the other end of the I/O duct to the wall  
mounting using 10-24 X 3/4 inch screws, nuts and washers.  
duct5 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. Angle Bracket  
4. I/O Cable Duct  
2. I/O Trough  
5. Wall Mounting Bracket  
6. Front of Cabinet  
3. Cross-Aisle Bracket  
Figure C-9. Installation of I/O Cross-Aisle to Wall Trough  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-15  
Install I/O Cable Rack Coupling  
1. Attach I/O trough to top of cabinet using thread-forming screws. See  
Figure C-10.  
2. Attach cross-aisle bracket to I/O trough using thread-forming screws  
through the top three holes on the bracket’s 6-hole face.  
3. Attach I/O coupling trough to cross-aisle bracket using thread-forming  
screws.  
4. Attach cable rack to coupling trough using locally-provided coupling  
plates and 3/8-18 x 1/2 inch hex head bolts with nuts.  
5. Attach other end of cable rack to wall using locally-provided hardware.  
duct6 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. Cross-Aisle Bracket  
5. I/O Trough  
2. Coupling Plate  
3. Cable Rack  
6. Use Only When Required  
7. To Wall  
4. I/O Coupling Trough  
Figure C-10. Installation of I/O Cable Rack Coupling to Rear of Cabinet  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-16  
Install I/O Cable Rack Riser  
Refer to Figure C-11 and assemble the ductwork:  
1. Attach angle bracket (group 9) to I/O trough using thread-forming screws.  
2. Attach cross-aisle bracket to angle bracket using thread-forming screws.  
Attach the angle bracket to the 6-hole face of the cross-aisle bracket using  
three thread-forming screws through the bottom holes.  
3. Attach I/O coupling trough (group 8) to cross-aisle bracket using  
thread-forming screws.  
4. Attach cable rack to coupling trough using locally-provided coupling  
plates and 3/8-18 x 1/2 inch hex bolts and nuts.  
5. Attach other end of cable rack to wall using locally provided hardware  
suitable to type of wall.  
duct7 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. I/O Trough  
5. I/O Coupling Trough  
6. Cross-Aisle Bracket  
7. Front of Cabinet  
2. Angle Bracket  
3. Coupling Plate  
4. Cable Rack  
Figure C-11. Installation of I/O Cable Rack Riser to End of Cabinet (Group 9)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-17  
Install AC Power Duct  
Refer to Figure C-12 and assemble the ductwork:  
1. Hang AC power duct (group 12 through 16 and 21) on back of shielded  
duct and anchor in place using one thread-forming screw at each cabinet.  
2. If required, slide utility outlet assembly (part of group 18) into the duct from  
the end.  
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for each cabinet.  
4. Interconnect ducts with couplings using four round-head machine screws.  
5. Insert 4 wire holders into each duct spaced evenly along duct.  
6. If equipped with an AC outlet, snap two group 18 raceway covers into  
place onto the AC power ducts.  
7. If not equipped with an AC outlet, snap a group 17 raceway cover into  
place onto the AC power ducts.  
8. If required, attach group 19 (combination end cap) by using two round  
head machine screws.  
9. Assemble the ladder rack as shown in Figure C-13 on page C-19.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-18  
duct8 KLC 071796  
Figure Notes  
1. Raceway Cover  
7. Rear of Shielded Duct  
8. Coupling  
2. Twist-Lock Receptacle  
3. Thread-Forming Screw  
4. Combination Endcap  
5. Conduit Knockout  
6. I/O Power Duct  
9. Typical Utility Outlet Assembly  
10. Slide in Direction Shown  
11. Wire Holders  
Figure C-12. Install AC Power Duct  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-19  
duct9 KLC 071696  
Figure C-13. Assembly of Ladder Rack  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Cable Ductwork  
C
Page C-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-1  
D
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
This chapter provides connector and cable diagrams for the DEFINITY  
Enterprise Communications Server.  
For circuit pack and auxiliary equipment classifications, see the tables at the end  
of Chapter 5, ‘‘Install and Wire Telephones and Other Equipment’’.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-2  
See Figure D-1 for Expansion Interface to Expansion Interface fiber interconnect.  
FS 1 - EI to EI fiber cable  
Backplane  
Backplane  
Front  
Front  
Rear  
9823A/B  
9823A/B  
Rear  
+5V  
+5V  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
107  
008  
108  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
107  
008  
108  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
XMT_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
GRD  
XMT_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
+5V  
+5V  
Fiber  
EI  
EI  
FS 2 - SNI to EI fiber cable  
Backplane  
Backplane  
Front  
+5V  
+5V  
Front  
Rear  
Rear  
9823A/B  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
9823A/B  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
000  
100  
001  
101  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
107  
008  
108  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
XMT_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
XMT_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
+5V  
+5V  
Fiber  
SNI  
EI  
Backplane  
Rear  
FS 3 - SNI to EI metallic cable H600-278  
Backplane  
Front  
Front  
Rear  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
000  
100  
001  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
006  
106  
101  
105  
(J1) 1  
(J1) 26  
(J1) 2  
(J1) 3  
(J1) 28  
(J1) 4  
(J1) 29  
(J1) 5  
(J1) 30  
(J1) 6  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
(J2) 1  
(J2) 26  
(J2) 2  
(J2) 3  
(J2) 28  
(J2) 4  
(J2) 29  
(J2) 5  
(J2) 30  
(J2) 6  
002  
102  
003  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
008  
108  
103  
107  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
TL*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
+5V  
XMT_DAT  
RCV_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
+5V  
XMT_DAT  
RCV_DAT  
(J1) 7  
(J2) 7  
(J1) 32  
(J1) 27  
(J1) 31  
+5V  
(J2) 32  
(J2) 27  
(J2) 31  
SNI  
EI  
r975bb1a MMR 061396  
Figure D-1. Expansion Interface to Expansion Interface Fiber (Part 1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-3  
Backplane  
Backplane  
FS 4 - EI to EI metallic cable H600-278  
Front  
Front  
Rear  
Rear  
002  
102  
003  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
008  
108  
103  
107  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
002  
102  
003  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
007  
008  
108  
103  
107  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
(J1) 1  
(J1) 26  
(J1) 2  
(J1) 3  
(J1) 28  
(J1) 4  
(J1) 29  
(J1) 5  
(J1) 30  
(J1) 6  
(J2) 1  
(J2) 26  
(J2) 2  
(J2) 3  
(J2) 28  
(J2) 4  
(J2) 29  
(J2) 5  
(J2) 30  
(J2) 6  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
TL*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
+5V  
XMT_DAT  
RCV_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
+5V  
+5V  
XMT_DAT  
RCV_DAT  
(J1) 7  
(J2) 7  
(J1) 32  
(J1) 27  
(J1) 31  
+5V  
(J2) 32  
(J2) 27  
(J2) 31  
EI  
EI  
FS 5 - SNI to SNI fiber cable  
9823A/B 9823A/B  
Backplane  
Rear  
Backplane  
Front  
Front  
Rear  
000  
100  
001  
101  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
000  
100  
001  
101  
002  
102  
003  
103  
004  
104  
005  
105  
006  
106  
+5V  
+5V  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
(P1) 1  
(P1) 26  
(P1) 2  
(P1) 27  
(P1) 3  
(P1) 28  
(P1) 4  
(P1) 29  
(P1) 5  
(P1) 30  
(P1) 6  
(P1) 31  
(P1) 7  
(P1) 32  
+5V  
+5V  
GRD  
XMY_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
GRD  
XMT_DAT  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RCV_DAT  
+5V  
+5V  
+5V  
Fiber  
SNI  
SNI  
r975bb1b MMR 061396  
Figure D-2. Expansion Interface to Expansion Interface Fiber (Part 2)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-4  
Example cross connect  
103A  
information outlet  
Amphenol pinouts  
T
26  
27  
1
2
T
(red)  
Modular  
cord  
R
TN553  
R
(green)  
27  
28  
2
3
C1 (yellow)  
C2 (black)  
C1  
C2  
TN762B  
Port 1  
Port 2  
(TN553)  
110 block  
1
1
2
3
4
4
5
5
6
7
8
8
9
9
10 11 12  
Etc.  
(TN726B)  
10 11 12  
110 block  
2
3
6
7
Pinouts  
TN1654 Amphenol  
pinouts  
TN1654 to TN1654  
direct cross connect  
TN553 (12 ports)  
TN726 (8 ports)  
(48)LOA  
(48)LOA  
1
2
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
1
26  
BLANK  
25 GRD  
24 GSP0/2  
23 LOA*  
22 LIA  
GRD  
GSP0*  
LOA  
50  
49  
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
36  
35  
34  
33  
32  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
1
2
(23)LOA*  
(23)LOA*  
2
3
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
1
3
(22)LIA  
(22)LIA  
4
4
BLANK  
LIA*  
(47)LIA*  
(47)LIA*  
5
5
21 GSP1/3  
20 LOB*  
19 LIB  
GSP1*  
LOB  
3
2
BLANK  
3
6
6
(45)LOB  
(20)LOB*  
(45)LOB  
(20)LOB*  
7
7
LIB*  
4
8
8
18 GSP3*  
17 LOC*  
16 LIC  
GSP2*  
LOC  
9
9
5
(19)LIB  
(19)LIB  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
BLANK  
4
LIC*  
(44)LIB*  
(44)LIB*  
15 RSS0*  
14 LOD*  
13 LID  
RSS1*  
LOD  
6
(42)LOC  
(17)LOC*  
(42)LOC  
(17)LOC*  
BLANK  
5
LID*  
7
12 CPERXD CPETXD  
11 PTD*  
BAT DISC*  
10 RES FLT* ON RES*  
8
(16)LIC  
(16)LIC  
BLANK  
6
(41)LIC*  
(41)LIC*  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CHG RT* ENVB*  
9
PSSG  
+5E  
PSS  
(39)LOD  
(14)LOD*  
(39)LOD  
(14)LOD*  
BLANK  
7
+5E  
10  
11  
GRDE  
GRDE  
TA*  
RCV DAT*  
GRDE  
TL*  
(13)LID  
(13)LID  
BLANK  
8
(38)LID*  
(38)LID*  
GRDE  
GRDE  
+5E  
GRDE  
XMT DAT*  
+5E  
12  
G
BLANK  
r975bb2 MMR 061396  
Figure D-3. Sample Cross-Connects  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-5  
FS 11 H600-347 cable  
FS 10 H600-348 cable  
(packet gateway interface cable)  
50-pin Amphenol  
15-pin D-sub  
connector TN1654  
DS1 interface to a CSU  
Amphenol  
connector  
to TN577  
Amphenol  
connector  
to TN577  
Connector 01  
25-pin D-sub  
connectors  
25-pin D-sub  
connectors  
LOA*  
LOA  
LIA  
1
9
23  
48  
22  
47  
LOA*  
LOA  
LIA  
Connector 1  
Connector 3  
TC2  
TC0  
3
26  
1
15  
15  
DCD2  
DCD0  
RC0  
CTS0  
RD0  
SG0  
TD0  
LIA*  
11  
LIA*  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
2
8
8
RC2  
CTS2  
RD2  
SG2  
TD2  
3
17  
17  
Connector 02  
4
5
5
LOB*  
1
9
20  
45  
19  
44  
LOB*  
LOB  
LIB  
5
3
3
LOB  
LIB  
6
7
7
3
7
2
2
DTR2  
TT2  
DTR0  
TT0  
LIB*  
11  
LIB*  
8
20  
20  
24  
9
24  
LL2  
LL0  
Connector 03  
18  
10  
11  
12  
18  
RTS2  
RTS0  
LOC*  
LOC  
LIC  
1
9
17  
42  
16  
41  
LOC*  
LOC  
LIC  
4
4
No connection  
No connection  
3
LIC*  
11  
LIC*  
Connector 2  
Connector 4  
TC3  
TC1  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
15  
15  
DCD3  
RC3  
CTS3  
RD3  
SG3  
TD3  
DCD1  
RC1  
CTS1  
RD1  
SG1  
TD1  
Connector 04  
8
8
LOD*  
1
9
14  
39  
13  
38  
LOD*  
LOD  
LID  
17  
17  
LOD  
LID  
5
5
3
3
3
LID*  
11  
LID*  
7
7
2
2
DTR3  
TT3  
DTR1  
TT1  
20  
20  
24  
24  
FS 12  
LL3  
LL1  
Amphenol connector  
to TN1654  
18  
Amphenol connector  
to TN570 or TN573  
18  
RTS3  
RTS1  
4
4
No connection  
No connection  
No connection  
No connection  
2
27  
3
GRDE  
XMT_DAT*  
GRD  
GRDE  
2
RCV_DAT* 31  
GRDE  
GRDE  
GRDE  
GRDE  
GRDE  
3
28  
5
28  
5
GRD  
GRD  
30  
6
GRD  
30  
6
GRD  
31  
RCV_DAT*  
XMT_DAT* 27  
23  
48  
22  
47  
20  
45  
19  
44  
17  
42  
16  
41  
14  
39  
13  
38  
LOA*  
LOA  
LIA  
LOA*  
LOA  
LIA  
23  
48  
22  
47  
20  
45  
19  
44  
17  
42  
16  
41  
14  
39  
13  
38  
LIA*  
LOB*  
LOB  
LIB  
LIA*  
LOB*  
LOB  
LIB  
Pass thru to Amphenol  
connector to H600-348  
or to cross connect  
LIB*  
LOC*  
LOC  
LIC  
LIB*  
LOC*  
LOC  
LIC  
LIC*  
LOD*  
LOD  
LID  
LIC*  
LOD*  
LOD  
LID  
r975bb3 MMR 051096  
LID*  
LID*  
Figure D-4. Sample Cable Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-6  
FS 14 846448652  
FS 13 600-307 cable  
50-pin Amphenol  
connector to  
TN767,TN722,TN464  
Amphenol  
connection  
to TN1654  
Amphenol connection  
to fiber transceiver  
15-pin D-sub  
to a CSU  
2
3
GRD  
GRD  
1
26  
2
27  
3
1
26  
2
27  
3
28  
4
29  
5
30  
6
31  
7
+5  
+5  
GRD  
TX  
GRD  
GRD  
TA*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RX  
+5  
+5  
GRD  
TX  
GRD  
LI  
LI*  
LO*  
L0  
3
11  
1
22 LI  
47 LI*  
23 LO*  
48 L0  
24 LOOP1  
49 LOOP2  
9
GRD 28  
LOOP1  
LOOP2  
5
6
TA*  
TL*  
GRD  
GRD  
GRD  
RX  
4
29  
5
30  
6
31  
7
32  
FS 15 Clock  
(STRATUM 3  
clock interface)  
FS 16 TERMINAL  
+5  
+5  
+5  
+5  
PPN & EPN  
32  
PPN control carrier  
terminal connections  
23  
48  
22  
47  
20  
45  
19  
44  
17  
42  
16  
41  
14  
39  
13  
38  
LOA*  
LOA  
LIA  
LIA*  
LOB*  
LOB  
LIB  
LIB*  
LOC*  
LOC  
LIC  
LIC*  
LOD*  
LOD  
LID  
LOA* 23  
25  
24  
23  
50  
Pin  
number  
Lead  
designation  
48  
22  
47  
20  
45  
19  
44  
LOA  
LIA  
LIA*  
LOB*  
LOB  
LIB  
49  
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
1
2
TD  
22 ALRM5A  
21  
20 EXTSYN0R EXTSYN0T  
19  
18  
17 EXTSYN1T EXTSYN1R 42  
16  
15 ALRM1A  
14  
ALRM5B  
RD  
3
RTS  
CTS  
DSR  
SGRD  
CD  
4
5
Pass thru to  
Amphenol  
connection to  
H600-348 or to  
cross connect  
6
LIB*  
7
LOC* 17  
8
LOC  
LIC  
LIC*  
LOD*  
LOD  
LID  
42  
16  
41  
14  
39  
13  
38  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
36  
35  
34  
33  
32  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
9
ALRM1B  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
13  
12  
11  
LID*  
LID*  
10 ALRM4A  
09  
08 ALRM3A  
07  
ALRM4B  
ALRM3B  
06  
DTR  
05 ALRM2A  
04  
03 ALRM0A  
02  
01  
ALRM2B  
ALRM0B  
r975bb4 MMR 061396  
Figure D-5. Sample Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-7  
FS 17 H600-210 cable  
FS 18 H600-362 cable  
25-pin D-sub  
37-pin D-sub  
25-pin D-sub  
37-pin D-sub  
1 - shield  
1
4
5
6
7
1 - shield  
3
15  
2
4
4
5
6
2
15  
3
7
4
8
9
17  
5
8
9
17  
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
15  
17  
19  
37  
35  
33  
31  
30  
29  
27  
26  
24  
23  
22  
18  
6
20  
8
22  
24  
7
10  
11  
12  
13  
15  
17  
19  
37  
35  
33  
31  
30  
29  
27  
26  
24  
23  
22  
18  
6
20  
8
22  
24  
7
21  
21  
Strapped  
wire leads  
Strapped  
wire leads  
FS 19 ED1E434-11,G175  
25-pin D-sub  
37-pin D-sub  
1
2
1
4
15  
3
5
6
7
17  
5
8
9
Resistor  
20  
8
24  
4
12  
13  
17  
18  
19  
31  
27  
26  
24  
23  
7
Strapped  
wire leads  
r975bb5 MMR 051396  
Figure D-6. Sample Cable Pinouts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-8  
FS 20 STRATUM 3 clock connector  
Duplicated synchronization clock,  
simplex system, dual input references  
STRATUM 3 clock connector  
To H600-274 primary source  
(See FS 22)  
01  
26  
TREF1  
RREF1  
To H600-274 secondary source  
(See FS 22)  
02  
27  
TREF2  
RREF2  
’A’ carrier TN780  
25 pair pin conn.  
48  
32  
07  
34  
09  
29  
04  
31  
06  
33  
08  
28  
03  
10  
35  
11  
36  
BCLKRTN  
BCLKLST  
BPWRRTN  
BPWRLST  
REF2RTN  
REF2LST  
SCLKRTN  
SCLKLST  
SPWRRTN  
SPWRLST  
REF1RTN  
REF1LST  
CCA01T  
ALRM5B  
ALRM5A  
ALRM4B  
ALRM4A  
ALRM3B  
ALRM3A  
ALRM2B  
ALRM2A  
ALRM1B  
ALRM1A  
ALRM0B  
ALRM0A  
EXTSYN0T  
EXTSYN0R  
EXTSYN1T  
EXTSYN1R  
23  
36  
11  
34  
09  
31  
06  
41  
16  
29  
04  
46  
21  
43  
18  
CCA01R  
CCB01T  
CCB01R  
12  
37  
13  
38  
14  
39  
15  
40  
16  
41  
17  
42  
30  
05  
CCA02T  
CCA02R  
CCB02T  
CCB02R  
CCA03T  
CCA03R  
CCB03T  
CCB03R  
CCA04T  
CCA04R  
CCB04T  
CCB04R  
BREFRTN  
BREFLST  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
r975bb6 MMR 051396  
Figure D-7. STRATUM 3 Clock Connector Pinout  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-9  
FS 21 STRATUM 3 clock connector  
Duplicated synchronization clock,  
duplicated system, dual input references  
STRATUM 3 clock connector  
01  
26  
TREF1  
RREF1  
To H600-274 primary source  
(See FS 22)  
02  
27  
TREF2  
RREF2  
To H600-274 secondary source  
(See FS 22)  
’A’ carrier TN780  
25 pair pin conn.  
48  
32  
07  
34  
09  
29  
04  
31  
06  
33  
08  
28  
03  
10  
35  
11  
36  
BCLKRTN  
BCLKLST  
BPWRRTN  
BPWRLST  
REF2RTN  
REF2LST  
SCLKRTN  
SCLKLST  
SPWRRTN  
SPWRLST  
REF1RTN  
REF1LST  
CCA01T  
ALRM5B  
ALRM5A  
ALRM4B  
ALRM4A  
ALRM3B  
ALRM3A  
ALRM2B  
ALRM2A  
ALRM1B  
ALRM1A  
ALRM0B  
ALRM0A  
EXTSYN0T  
EXTSYN0R  
EXTSYN1T  
EXTSYN1R  
23  
36  
11  
34  
09  
31  
06  
41  
16  
29  
04  
46  
21  
43  
18  
CCA01R  
CCB01T  
CCB01R  
’B’ carrier TN780  
25 pair pin conn.  
CCA02T  
CCA02R  
CCB02T  
CCB02R  
CCA03T  
CCA03R  
CCB03T  
CCB03R  
CCA04T  
CCA04R  
CCB04T  
CCB04R  
BREFRTN  
BREFLST  
ALRM5B  
ALRM5A  
ALRM4B  
ALRM4A  
ALRM3B  
ALRM3A  
ALRM2B  
ALRM2A  
ALRM1B  
ALRM1A  
ALRM0B  
ALRM0A  
EXTSYN0T  
EXTSYN0R  
EXTSYN1T  
EXTSYN1R  
48  
12  
37  
13  
38  
14  
39  
15  
40  
16  
41  
17  
42  
30  
05  
23  
36  
11  
34  
09  
31  
06  
41  
16  
29  
04  
46  
21  
43  
18  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
NC  
r975bb7 MMR 051396  
Figure D-8. STRATUM 3 Clock Connector  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Connector and Cable Diagrams  
D
Page D-10  
FS 22 H600-274  
15-pin D-sub  
to CSU  
50-pin system  
connector  
Pin  
number  
Pin  
number  
1
2
1
22  
4
3
4
23  
5
6
7
8
9
26  
47  
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
48  
50-pin clock  
connector  
Pin  
number  
26  
422  
422  
47  
1
22  
r975bb8 MMR 051396  
Figure D-9. Sample H600-274 Cable  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
Page E-1  
E
References  
E
This section contains a list of user documents for the DEFINITY Enterprise  
Communications Server (ECS) Release 6. (Most of these documents are  
backward compatible with, and can be used with, the DEFINITY ECS Release 5  
systems.)  
To order these or other DEFINITY documents, contact the Lucent Technologies  
Publications Center at the address and phone number on the back of the title  
page of this document. A complete catalog of Business Communications  
Systems (BCS) documents, including previous issues of the documents listed  
here, is available on the World Wide Web. Ask your account team for the web  
address.  
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
These documents are issued for all new and upgrade DEFINITY ECS Release 6  
systems.  
Administration  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Overview, Issue 5, 555-230-024  
Provides a detailed overview of the ECS including descriptions of many of the  
major features, applications, hardware, system capabilities, and the support  
provided with the system. This document is available in the following languages:  
English, German (DE), Dutch (NL), Brazilian Portuguese (PTB), European French  
(FR), Latin Spanish (SPL), Italian (IT), Russian (RU), and Japanese (JA). To order,  
append the language suffix to the document number; for example,  
555-230-894DE for German. No suffix is needed for the English version.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
Page E-2  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6.2 — Change Description, Issue 1, 555-230-476  
Gives a high-level overview of what is new in DEFNITY ECS Release 6. Describes  
the hardware and software enhancements and lists the problem corrections for  
this release.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — System Description Pocket Reference, Issue 2,  
555-230-211  
Provides hardware descriptions, system parameters, listing of hardware required  
to use features, system configurations, and environmental requirements. This  
compact reference combines and replaces Release 6 System Description and  
Specifications and Release 6 Pocket Reference.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Administration and Feature Description, Issue  
3, 555-230-522  
Provides descriptions of system features. Also provides step-by-step procedures  
for preparing the screens that are required to implement the features, functions,  
and services of the system. Includes the applications and benefits, feature  
interactions, administration requirements, hardware requirements, and  
procedures for voice terminal, data module, and trunk group administration.  
DEFINITY System’s Little Instruction Book, Issue 3, 555-230-727  
Provides step-by-step procedures for performing basic switch administration  
tasks. Includes managing phones, managing features, generating reports,  
enhancing system security, and troubleshooting.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 5 System Monitoring and Reporting, Issue 4,  
555-230-511  
Provides detailed descriptions of the measurement, status, security, and recent  
change history reports available in the system and is intended for administrators  
who validate traffic reports and evaluate system performance. Includes  
corrective actions for potential problems. Issue 2 of this document was titled  
Traffic Rep or ts. The Release 5 version of this document applies to Release 6 as  
well.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Implementation Blank Forms, Issue 3,  
555-230-303  
Provides blank paper forms corresponding to the screens that are required to  
implement the features, functions, and services of the system. The Release 5  
forms apply to Release 6 as well.  
BCS Products Security Handbook, Issue 6, 555-025-600  
Provides information about the risks of telecommunications fraud and measures  
for addressing those risks and preventing unauthorized use of BCS products.  
This document is intended for telecommunications managers, console operators,  
and security organizations within companies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
Page E-3  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6— Terminals and Adjuncts Reference, Issue 9,  
555-015-201  
Provides descriptions of the peripheral equipment that can be used with System  
75, System 85, DEFINITY Communications System, and DEFINITY ECS. This  
document is intended for customers and Lucent Technologies account teams for  
selecting the correct peripherals to accompany an ECS. The Release 5 version of  
this document applies to Release 6 as well.  
DEFINITY ECS Telephone Guide Builder, Issue 4, 555-230-755  
Provides capability to produce laser-printed documentation for specific  
telephones. The software is supported by a comprehensive user’s guide and  
on-line help. This product requires a 386 PC, minimum of 6MB disk space,  
minimum of 4MB RAM, a printer supported by Microsoft GDI printer drive, and  
Microsoft Windows 3.1 or higher. A mouse is recommended. This document  
applies to Release 6 as well as earlier DEFINITY systems.  
DEFINITY ECS — International Telephone Guide Builder, Issue 1,  
555-230-742  
Same as 555-230-755 but customized for international locations.  
Installation and Maintenance  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Installation and Test for Single-Carrier Cabinets,  
Issue 3, 555-230-894  
Provides procedures and information for hardware installation and initial testing  
of single-carrier cabinets.The Release 5 version of this document applies to  
Release 6 as well.  
This document is available in the following languages: English, German (DE),  
Dutch (NL), Brazilian Portuguese (PTB), European French (FR), Castillian  
Spanish (SP), Italian (IT), Russian (RU), and Japanese (JA). To order, append the  
language suffix to the document number; for example, 555-230-894DE for  
German. No suffix is needed for the English version.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Installation and Upgrades for CSCC, Issue 1,  
555-230-124  
Provides procedures and information for hardware installation, upgrades, and  
initial testing of compact single-carrier cabinets. The Release 5 version of this  
document applies to Release 6 as well.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets,  
Issue 4, 555-230-112  
Provides procedures and information for hardware installation and initial testing  
of multi-carrier cabinets.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Basic DEFINITY ECS Documents  
Page E-4  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Installation and Test for Compact Modular  
Cabinets, Issue 2, 555-230-128  
Provides procedures and information for hardware installation and initial testing  
of compact modular cabinets.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Installation for Adjuncts and Peripherals, Issue  
3, 555-230-125  
Provides procedures and information for hardware installation and initial testing  
of ECS adjunct and peripheral systems and equipment.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Upgrades and Additions for R6r, Issue 4,  
555-230-121  
Provides procedures for an installation technician to convert an existing Generic  
3 Version 4 DEFINITY Communications System to DEFINITY ECS and from  
DEFINITY ECS Release 5 to DEFINITY ECS Release 6.  
Included are upgrade considerations, lists of required hardware, and  
step-by-step upgrade procedures. Also included are procedures to add control  
carriers, switch node carriers, port carriers, circuit packs, auxiliary cabinets, and  
other equipment.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Upgrades and Additions for R6vs/si, Issue 4,  
555-230-120  
Provides procedures for an installation technician to convert an existing  
DEFINITY Communications System Generic 3 Version 4 to DEFINITY ECS and  
from DEFINITY ECS Release 5 to DEFINITY ECS Release 6.  
Included are upgrade considerations, lists of required hardware, and  
step-by-step upgrade procedures. Also included are procedures to add control  
carriers, switch node carriers, port carriers, circuit packs, auxiliary cabinets, and  
other equipment.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Maintenance for R6r, Issue 2, 555-230-126  
Provides detailed descriptions of the procedures for monitoring, testing,  
troubleshooting, and maintaining the R6r ECS. Included are maintenance  
commands, step-by-step trouble-clearing procedures, the procedures for using  
all tests, and explanations of the system’s error codes.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Maintenance for R6vs/si, Issue 2, 555-204-127  
Provides detailed descriptions of the procedures for monitoring, testing,  
troubleshooting, and maintaining the R6vs/si ECS. Included are maintenance  
commands, step-by-step trouble-clearing procedures, the procedures for using  
all tests, and explanations of the system’s error codes.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Maintenance for R6csi (Compact Modular  
Cabinets), Issue 2, 555-204-129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Call Center Documents  
Page E-5  
Provides detailed descriptions of the procedures for monitoring, testing,  
troubleshooting, and maintaining the R6csi ECS. Included are maintenance  
commands, step-by-step trouble-clearing procedures, the procedures for using  
all tests, and explanations of the system’s error codes.  
DEFINITY ECS International Telephone Guide Builder, Issue 1,  
555-230-742  
Same as 555-230-755 above but customized for international locations.  
Call Center Documents  
These documents are issued for DEFINITY ECS Call Center applications.  
DEFINITY  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Call Vectoring/EAS Guide, Issue 1, 585-230-521  
Provides information on how to write, use, and troubleshoot vectors, which are  
command sequences that process telephone calls in an Automatic Call  
Distribution (ACD) environment. This document applies to Release 6 as well as  
earlier DEFINITY systems.  
It is provided in two parts: tutorial and reference. The tutorial provides  
step-by-step procedures for writing and implementing basic vectors. The  
reference includes detailed descriptions of the call vectoring features, vector  
management, vector administration, adjunct routing, troubleshooting, and  
interactions with management information systems (including the Call  
Management System).  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Basic Call Management System (BCMS)  
Operations, Issue 1, 555-230-706  
Provides detailed instructions on how to generate reports and manage the  
system. It is intended for telecommunications managers who wish to use BCMS  
(Basic Call Management System) reports and for system managers responsible  
for maintaining the system. This documentation applies to Release 6 as well as  
earlier DEFINITY systems.  
CentreVu CMS  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — Administration,  
Issue 1, 585-215-820  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — Reports, Issue 1,  
585-215-821  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — Custom Reports,  
Issue 1, 585-215-822  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Application-Specific Documents  
Page E-6  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — Upgrades and  
Migrations, Issue 3, 585-215-826  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — External Call  
History Reference, Issue 1, 585-215-824  
CentreVu Call Management System Release 3 Version 5 — Forecast,  
Issue 1, 585-215-825  
Application-Specific Documents  
These documents support specific DEFINITY applications.  
DEFINITY ECS Generic 2 to Release 5 — Transition Reference, Issue 1,  
555-230-523  
Provides information on the differences in features and administration between  
the old and new systems when upgrading from a Generic 2 system to DEFINITY  
ECS Release 5.  
ASAI  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor ASAI Planning Guide, Issue 4,  
555-230-222  
Provides procedures and directions for the account team and customer  
personnel for effectively planning and implementing the CallVisor Adjunct/Switch  
Application Interface (ASAI) PBX-Host environment. The CallVisor ASAI is a  
communications interface that allows adjunct processors to access switch  
features and to control switch calls. It is implemented using an Integrated  
Services Digital Network (ISDN) Basic Rate Interface (BRI). Hardware and  
software requirements are included.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor ASAI Protocol Reference, Issue 7,  
555-230-221  
Provides detailed layer 3 protocol information regarding the CallVisor  
Adjunct/Switch Application Interface (ASAI) for the systems and is intended for  
the library or driver programmer of an adjunct processor to create the library of  
commands used by the applications programmers. Describes the ISDN  
message, facility information elements, and information elements.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor ASAI Technical Reference, Issue 7,  
555-230-220  
Provides detailed information regarding the CallVisor Adjunct/Switch Application  
Interface (ASAI) for the systems and is intended for the application designer  
responsible for building and/or programming custom applications and features.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Application-Specific Documents  
Page E-7  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor ASAI DEFINITY LAN Gateway over  
MAP-D Installation, Administration, and Maintenance of, Issue 1,  
555-230-114  
Provides procedures for installation, administration, and maintenance of the  
CallVisor Adjunct/Switch Application Interface (ASAI) Ethernet application over  
the DEFINITY LAN Gateway and is intended for system administrators,  
telecommunications managers, Management Information System (MIS)  
managers, LAN managers, and Lucent personnel. The ASAI-Ethernet application  
provides ASAI functionality using 10Base-T Ethernet rather than BRI as a  
transport media.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor ASAI PC LAN over MAP-D Installation,  
Administration, and Maintenance of, Issue 1, 555-230-113  
Provides procedures for installation, administration, and maintenance of the  
CallVisor Adjunct/Switch Application Interface (ASAI) Ethernet application over  
the PC LAN and is intended for system administrators, telecommunications  
managers, Management Information System (MIS) managers, LAN managers,  
and Lucent personnel. The ASAI-Ethernet application provides ASAI functionality  
using 10Base-T Ethernet rather than BRI as a transport media.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Call Visor ASAI Overview, Issue 2, 555-230-225  
Provides a general description of Call Visor ASAI.  
This document is available in the following languages: English, German (DE),  
Dutch (NL), Brazilian Portuguese (PTB), European French (FR), Colombian  
Spanish (SPL), and Japanese (JA). To order, append the language suffix to the  
document number; for example, 555-230-894DE for German. No suffix is needed  
for the English version.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — CallVisor PC ASAI Installation and Reference,  
Issue 3, 555-230-227  
Provides procedural and reference information for installers, Tier 3 support  
personnel, and application designers.  
ACD  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Automatic Call Distribution (ACD) Agent  
Instructions, Issue 5, 555-230-722  
Provides information for use by agents after they have completed ACD training.  
Includes descriptions of ACD features and the procedures for using them.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Automatic Call Distribution (ACD) Supervisor  
Instructions, Issue 4, 555-230-724  
Provides information for use by supervisors after they have completed ACD  
training. Includes descriptions of ACD features and the procedures for using  
them.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Application-Specific Documents  
Page E-8  
Call Detail Recording  
Call Detail Acquisition & Processing Reference, Issue 2, 555-006-202  
Provides a general technical description of the ECS call detail recording feature  
and of the products that collect, store, poll, and process call records.  
Console Operations  
DEFINITY ECS Console Operations, Issue 3, 555-230-700  
Provides operating instructions for the attendant console. Included are  
descriptions of the console control keys and functions, call-handling procedures,  
basic system troubleshooting information, and routine maintenance procedures.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Console Operations Quick Reference, Issue 2,  
555-230-890  
Provides operating instructions for the attendant console. Included are  
descriptions of the console control keys and functions, call handling, basic  
system-troubleshooting information, and routine maintenance procedures.  
This document is available in the following languages: English, German (DE),  
Dutch (NL), Brazilian Portuguese (PTB), European French (FR), Colombian  
Spanish (SPL), and Japanese (JA). To order, append the language suffix to the  
document number; for example, 555-230-894DE for German. No suffix is needed  
for the English version.  
Hospitality  
An Introduction to DEFINITY Communications System Generic 3 Hospitality  
Services, Issue 1, 555-230-021  
Provides an overview of the features available for use by the lodging and health  
industries to improve their property management and to provide assistance to  
their employees and clients. Included are brief definitions of many of the system  
features, descriptions of the hardware, planning considerations, and list of the  
system capabilities. This documentation also applies to Release 6.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 — Hospitality Operations, Issue 4, 555-230-723  
Provides step-by-step procedures for using the features available for the lodging  
and health industries to improve their property management and to provide  
assistance to their employees and clients. Includes detailed descriptions of  
reports.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Documents on CD-ROM  
Page E-9  
Documents on CD-ROM  
The following CD-ROMs are available from the Publications Center.  
Administration and Call Center CD-ROM, Issue 3, 555-230-828  
Includes the documents listed in the Administration, Call Center, Console  
Operations, and Hospitality sections above.  
DEFINITY ECS Release 6 Documentation Library CD-ROM, Issue 1,  
555-230-833  
A comprehensive set of DEFINITY documentation. Includes the documents in the  
Administration and Call Center CD-ROM and the documents listed in the  
Installation and Maintenance sections above.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
References  
E
Documents on CD-ROM  
Page E-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-1  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Numerics  
800 service  
A service in the United States that allows incoming calls from certain areas to an assigned number  
for a flat-rate charge based on usage.  
A
AA  
Archangel. See angel.  
AAC  
ATM access concentrator  
AAR  
See Automatic Alternate Routing (AAR).  
abandoned call  
An incoming call in which the caller hangs up before the call is answered.  
Abbreviated Dialing (AD)  
A feature that allows callers to place calls by dialing just one or two digits.  
AC  
1. Alternating current.  
AAR  
Automatic Alternate Routing  
ACA  
ACB  
See Automatic Callback (ACB).  
ACD  
ACD agent  
See agent.  
ACU  
See Automatic calling unit (ACU)  
ACW  
See after-call work (ACW) mode.  
access code  
A 1-, 2-, or 3-digit dial code used to activate or cancel a feature, or access an outgoing trunk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-2  
access endpoint  
Either a nonsignaling channel on a DS1 interface or a nonsignaling port on an analog tie-trunk  
circuit pack that is assigned a unique extension.  
access tie trunk  
A trunk that connects a main communications system with a tandem communications system in an  
electronic tandem network (ETN). An access tie trunk can also be used to connect a system or  
tandem to a serving office or service node. Also called access trunk.  
access trunk  
See access tie trunk.  
ACCUNET  
A trademarked name for a family of digital services offered by AT&T in the United States.  
ACD  
See Automatic Call Distribution (ACD). ACD also refers to a work state in which an agent is on an  
ACD call.  
ACD work mode  
See work mode.  
active-notification association  
A link that is initiated by an adjunct, allowing it to receive event reports for a specific switch entity,  
such as an outgoing call.  
active-notification call  
A call for which event reports are sent over an active-notification association (communication  
channel) to the adjunct. Sometimes referred to as a monitored call.  
active notification domain  
VDN or ACD split extension for which event notification has been requested.  
ACU  
See Automatic calling unit (ACU).  
AD  
See Abbreviated Dialing (AD).  
ADAP  
AUDIX Data Acquisition Package  
ADC  
See analog-to-digital converter (ADC).  
adjunct  
A processor that does one or more tasks for another processor and that is optional in the  
configuration of the other processor. See also application.  
adjunct-control association  
A relationship initiated by an application via Third Party Make Call, the Third Party Take Control, or  
Domain (Station) Control capabilities to set up calls and control calls already in progress.  
adjunct-controlled call  
Call that can be controlled using an adjunct-control association. Call must have been originated  
via Third Party Make Call or Domain (Station) Control capabilities or must have been taken control  
of via Third Party Take Control or Domain (Station) Control capabilities.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-3  
adjunct-controlled split  
An ACD split that is administered to be under adjunct control. Agents logged into such splits must  
do all telephony work, ACD login/ logout, and changes of work mode through the adjunct (except  
for auto-available adjunct-controlled splits, whose agents may not log in/out or change work  
mode).  
adjunct-monitored call  
An adjunct-controlled call, active-notification call, or call that provides event reporting over a  
domain-control association.  
Adjunct-Switch Application Interface (ASAI)  
A recommendation for interfacing adjuncts and communications systems, based on the CCITT  
Q.932 specification for layer 3.  
ADM  
Asynchronous data module  
administer  
To access and change parameters associated with the services or features of a system.  
Administered Connection (AC)  
A feature that allows the switch to automatically establish and maintain end-to-end connections  
between access endpoints (trunks) and/or data endpoints (data modules).  
administration group  
See capability group.  
administration terminal  
A terminal that is used to administer and maintain a system. See also terminal.  
Administration Without Hardware (AWOH)  
A feature that allows administration of ports without associated terminals or other hardware.  
ADU  
See asynchronous data unit (ADU).  
AE  
See access endpoint.  
after-call work (ACW) mode  
A mode in which agents are unavailable to receive ACD calls. Agents enter the ACW mode to  
perform ACD-related activities such as filling out a form after an ACD call.  
AG  
ASAI Gateway  
agent  
A person who receives calls directed to a split. A member of an ACD hunt group or ACD split. Also  
called an ACD agent.  
agent report  
A report that provides historical traffic information for internally measured agents.  
AIM  
Asynchronous interface module  
AIOD  
Automatic Identification of Outward Dialing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-4  
ALBO  
Automatic Line Build Out  
All trunks busy (ATB)  
ALM-ACK  
Alarm acknowledge  
American Standard Code for Information Interchange  
See ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange).  
AMW  
Automatic Message Waiting  
AN  
Analog  
analog  
The representation of information by continuously variable physical quantities such as amplitude,  
frequency, and phase. See also digital.  
analog data  
Data that is transmitted over a digital facility in analog (PCM) form. The data must pass through a  
modem either at both ends or at a modem pool at the distant end.  
analog telephone  
A telephone that receives acoustic voice signals and sends analog electrical signals along the  
telephone line. Analog telephones are usually served by a single wire pair (tip and ring). The  
model-2500 telephone set is a typical example of an analog telephone.  
analog-to-digital converter (ADC)  
A device that converts an analog signal to digital form. See also digital-to-analog converter (DAC).  
angel  
A microprocessor located on each port card in a processor port network (PPN). The angel uses  
the control-channel message set (CCMS) to manage communications between the port card and  
the archangel on the controlling switch-processing element (SPE). The angel also monitors the  
status of other microprocessors on a port card and maintains error counters and thresholds.  
ANI  
See Automatic Number Identification (ANI).  
ANSI  
American National Standards Institute. A United States professional/technical association  
supporting a variety of standards.  
answerback code  
A number used to respond to a page from a code-calling or loudspeaker-paging system, or to  
retrieve a parked call.  
AOL  
Attendant-offered load  
AP  
Applications processor  
APLT  
Advanced Private-Line Termination  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-5  
appearance  
A software process that is associated with an extension and whose purpose is to supervise a call.  
An extension can have multiple appearances. Also called call appearance, line appearance, and  
occurrence. See also call appearance.  
application  
An adjunct that requests and receives ASAI services or capabilities. One or more applications can  
reside on a single adjunct. However, the switch cannot distinguish among several applications  
residing on the same adjunct and treats the adjunct, and all resident applications, as a single  
application. The terms application and adjunct are used interchangeably throughout this  
document.  
applications processor  
A micro-computer based, program controlled computer providing application services for the  
DEFINITY switch. The processor is used with several user-controlled applications such as traffic  
analysis and electronic documentation.  
application service element  
See capability group.  
architecture  
The organizational structure of a system, including hardware and software.  
ARS  
See Automatic Route Selection (ARS).  
ASAI  
See Adjunct-Switch Application Interface (ASAI)  
ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange)  
The standard code for representing characters in digital form. Each character is represented by an  
8-bit code (including parity bit).  
association  
A communication channel between adjunct and switch for messaging purposes. An active  
association is one that applies to an existing call on the switch or to an extension on the call.  
asynchronous data transmission  
A method of transmitting data in which each character is preceded by a start bit and followed by a  
stop bit, thus permitting data characters to be transmitted at irregular intervals. This type  
transmission is advantageous when transmission is not regular (characters typed at a keyboard).  
Also called asynchronous transmission. See also synchronous data transmission.  
asynchronous data unit (ADU)  
A device that allows direct connection between RS-232C equipment and a digital switch.  
asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM)  
A packet-like switching technology in which data is transmitted in fixed-size (53-byte) cells. ATM  
provides high-speed access for data communication in LAN, campus, and WAN environments.  
ATB  
See All trunks busy (ATB).  
ATD  
See Attention dial (ATD).  
attendant  
A person at a console who provides personalized service for incoming callers and voice-services  
users by performing switching and signaling operations. See also attendant console.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-6  
ATM  
See asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM).  
attendant console  
The workstation used by an attendant. The attendant console allows the attendant to originate a  
call, answer an incoming call, transfer a call to another extension or trunk, put a call on hold, and  
remove a call from hold. Attendants using the console can also manage and monitor some system  
operations. Also called console. See also attendant.  
Attention dial (ATD)  
A command in the Hayes modem command set for asynchronous modems.  
Audio Information Exchange (AUDIX)  
A fully integrated voice-mail system. Can be used with a variety of communications systems to  
provide call-history data, such as subscriber identification and reason for redirection.  
AUDIX  
See Audio Information Exchange (AUDIX).  
auto-in trunk group  
Trunk group for which the CO processes all of the digits for an incoming call. When a CO seizes a  
trunk from an auto-in trunk group, the switch automatically connects the trunk to the destination —  
typically an ACD split where, if no agents are available, the call goes into a queue in which callers  
are answered in the order in which they arrive.  
Auto-In Work mode  
One of four agent work modes: the mode in which an agent is ready to process another call as  
soon as the current call is completed.  
Automatic Alternate Routing (AAR)  
A feature that routes calls to other than the first-choice route when facilities are unavailable.***  
Automatic Callback (ACB)  
A feature that enables internal callers, upon reaching a busy extension, to have the system  
automatically connect and ring both parties when the called party becomes available.  
Automatic Call Distribution (ACD)  
A feature that answers calls, and then, depending on administered instructions, delivers  
messages appropriate for the caller and routes the call to an agent when one becomes available.  
Automatic Call Distribution (ACD) split  
A method of routing calls of a similar type among agents in a call center. Also, a group of  
extensions that are staffed by agents trained to handle a certain type of incoming call.  
Automatic calling unit (ACU)  
A device that places a telephone call.  
Automatic Circuit Assurance (ACA)  
A feature that tracks calls of unusual duration to facilitate troubleshooting. A high number of very  
short calls or a low number of very long calls may signify a faulty trunk.  
Automatic Number Identification (ANI)  
Representation of the calling number, for display or for further use to access information about the  
caller. Available with Signaling System 7.  
automatic restoration  
A service that restores disrupted connections between access endpoints (nonsignaling trunks)  
and data endpoints (devices that connect the switch to data terminal and/or communications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-7  
equipment). Restoration is done within seconds of a service disruption so that critical data  
applications can remain operational.  
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)  
A feature that allows the system to automatically choose the least-cost way to send a toll call.  
automatic trunk  
A trunk that does not require addressing information because the destination is predetermined. A  
request for service on the trunk, called a seizure, is sufficient to route the call. The normal  
destination of an automatic trunk is the communications-system attendant group. Also called  
automatic incoming trunk and automatic tie trunk.  
AUX  
Auxiliary  
auxiliary equipment  
Equipment used for optional system features, such as Loudspeaker Paging and Music-on-Hold.  
auxiliary trunk  
A trunk used to connect auxiliary equipment, such as radio-paging equipment, to a  
communications system.  
Aux-Work mode  
A work mode in which agents are unavailable to receive ACD calls. Agents enter Aux-Work mode  
when involved in non-ACD activities such as taking a break, going to lunch, or placing an outgoing  
call.  
AVD  
Alternate voice/data  
AWOH  
See Administration Without Hardware (AWOH).  
AWG  
American Wire Gauge  
AWT  
Average work time  
B
B8ZS  
Bipolar Eight Zero Substitution.  
bandwidth  
The difference, expressed in hertz, between the defined highest and lowest frequencies in a  
range.  
barrier code  
A security code used with the Remote Access feature to prevent unauthorized access to the  
system.  
baud  
A unit of transmission rate equal to the number of signal events per second. See also bit rate and  
bits per second (bps).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-8  
BCC  
BCMS  
Basic Call Management System  
BCT  
See business communications terminal (BCT).  
Bearer capability class (BCC)  
Code that identifies the type of a call (for example, voice and different types of data).  
Determination of BCC is based on the caller’s characteristics for non-ISDN endpoints and on the  
Bearer Capability and Low-Layer Compatibility Information Elements of an ISDN endpoint. Current  
BCCs are 0 (voice-grade data and voice), 1 (DMI mode 1, 56 kbps data transmission), 2 (DMI  
mode 2, synchronous/asynchronous data transmission up to 19.2 kbps) 3 (DMI mode 3, 64 kbps  
circuit/packet data transmission), 4 (DMI mode 0, 64 kbps synchronous data), 5 (temporary  
signaling connection, and 6 (wideband call, 128–1984 kbps synchronous data).  
BER  
Bit error rate  
BHCC  
Busy-hour call completions  
bit (binary digit)  
One unit of information in binary notation, having two possible values: 0 or 1.  
bits per second (bps)  
The number of binary units of information that are transmitted or received per second. See also  
baud and bit rate.  
bit rate  
The speed at which bits are transmitted, usually expressed in bits per second. Also called data  
rate. See also baud and bits per second (bps).  
BLF  
Busy Lamp Field  
BN  
Billing number  
BOS  
Bit-oriented signaling  
BPN  
Billed-party number  
bps  
See bits per second (bps).  
bridge (bridging)  
The appearance of a voice terminal’s extension at one or more other voice terminals.  
BRI  
The ISDN Basic Rate Interface specification.  
bridged appearance  
A call appearance on a voice terminal that matches a call appearance on another voice terminal  
for the duration of a call.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-9  
BTU  
British Thermal Unit  
buffer  
1. In hardware, a circuit or component that isolates one electrical circuit from another. Typically, a  
buffer holds data from one circuit or process until another circuit or process is ready to accept the  
data.  
2. In software, an area of memory that is used for temporary storage.  
bus  
A multiconductor electrical path used to transfer information over a common connection from any  
of several sources to any of several destinations.  
business communications terminal (BCT)  
A digital data terminal used for business applications. A BCT can function via a data module as a  
special-purpose terminal for services provided by a processor or as a terminal for data entry and  
retrieval.  
BX.25  
A version of the CCITT X.25 protocol for data communications. BX.25 adds a fourth level to the  
standard X.25 interface. This uppermost level combines levels 4, 5, and 6 of the ISO reference  
model.  
bypass tie trunks  
A 1-way, outgoing tie trunk from a tandem switch to a main switch in an ETN. Bypass tie trunks,  
provided in limited quantities, are used as a last-choice route when all trunks to another tandem  
switch are busy. Bypass tie trunks are used only if all applicable intertandem trunks are busy.  
byte  
A sequence of (usually eight) bits processed together.  
C
CACR  
Cancellation of Authorization Code Request  
cabinet  
Housing for racks, shelves, or carriers that hold electronic equipment.  
cable  
Physical connection between two pieces of equipment (for example, data terminal and modem) or  
between a piece of equipment and a termination field.  
cable connector  
A jack (female) or plug (male) on the end of a cable. A cable connector connects wires on a cable  
to specific leads on telephone or data equipment.  
CAG  
Coverage answer group  
call appearance  
1. For the attendant console, six buttons, labeled a–f, used to originate, receive, and hold calls.  
Two lights next to the button show the status of the call appearance.  
2. For the voice terminal, a button labeled with an extension and used to place outgoing calls,  
receive incoming calls, or hold calls. Two lights next to the button show the status of the call  
appearance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-10  
call-control capabilities  
Capabilities (Third Party Selective Hold, Third Party Reconnect, Third Party Merge) that can be  
used in either of the Third Party Call Control ASE (cluster) subsets (Call Control and Domain  
Control).  
Call Detail Recording (CDR)  
A feature that uses software and hardware to record call data (same as CDRU).  
Call Detail Recording utility (CDRU)  
Software that collects, stores, optionally filters, and outputs call-detail records.  
Call Management System (CMS)  
An application, running on an adjunct processor, that collects information from an ACD unit. CMS  
enables customers to monitor and manage telemarketing centers by generating reports on the  
status of agents, splits, trunks, trunk groups, vectors, and VDNs, and enables customers to  
partially administer the ACD feature for a communications system.  
call-reference value (CRV)  
An identifier present in ISDN messages that associates a related sequence of messages. In ASAI,  
CRVs distinguish between associations.  
call vector  
A set of up to 15 vector commands to be performed for an incoming or internal call.  
callback call  
A call that automatically returns to a voice-terminal user who activated the Automatic Callback or  
Ringback Queuing feature.  
call-waiting ringback tone  
A low-pitched tone identical to ringback tone except that the tone decreases in the last 0.2  
seconds (in the United States). Call-waiting ringback tone notifies the attendant that the Attendant  
Call Waiting feature is activate and that the called party is aware of the waiting call. Tones in  
international countries may sound different.  
call work code  
A number, up to 16 digits, entered by ACD agents to record the occurrence of customer-defined  
events (such as account codes, social security numbers, or phone numbers) on ACD calls.  
CAMA  
Centralized Automatic Message Accounting  
carrier  
An enclosed shelf containing vertical slots that hold circuit packs.  
carried load  
The amount of traffic served by traffic-sensitive facilities during a given interval.  
CARR-POW  
Carrier Port and Power Unit for AC Powered Systems  
CAS  
Centralized Attendant Service or Call Accounting System  
CCS or hundred call seconds  
A unit of call traffic. Call traffic for a facility is scanned every 100 seconds. If the facility is busy, it is  
assumed to have been busy for the entire scan interval. There are 3600 seconds per hour. The  
Roman numeral for 100 is the capital letter C. The abbreviation for call seconds is CS. Therefore,  
100 call seconds is abbreviated CCS. If a facility is busy for an entire hour, then it is said to have  
been busy for 36 CCS. See also Erlang.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-11  
capability  
A request or indication of an operation. For example, Third Party Make Call is a request for setting  
up a call; event report is an indication that an event has occurred.  
capability group  
Set of capabilities, determined by switch administration, that can be requested by an application.  
Capability groups denote association types. For example, Call Control is a type of association that  
allows certain functions (the ones in the capability group) to be performed over this type of  
association. Also referred to as administration groups or application service elements (ASEs).  
CA-TSC  
Call-Associated Temporary Signaling Connection  
cause value  
A value is returned in response to requests or in event reports when a denial or unexpected  
condition occurs. ASAI cause values fall into two coding standards: Coding Standard 0 includes  
any cause values that are part of AT&T and CCITT ISDN specifications; Coding standard 3  
includes any other ASAI cause values. This document uses a notation for cause value where the  
coding standard for the cause is given first, then a slash, then the cause value. Example: CS0/100  
is coding standard 0, cause value 100.  
CBC  
Call-by-call or coupled bonding conductor  
CC  
Country code  
CCIS  
Common-Channel Interoffice Signaling  
CCITT  
CCITT (Comitte Consultatif International Telephonique et Telegraphique), now called International  
Telecommunications Union (ITU). See International Telecommunications Union (ITU).  
CCMS  
Control-Channel Message Set  
CCS  
See CCS or hundred call seconds.  
CCSA  
Common-Control Switching Arrangement  
CDM  
Channel-division multiplexing  
CDOS  
Customer-dialed and operator serviced  
CDR  
See Call Detail Recording (CDR).  
CDRP  
Call Detail Record Poller  
CDRR  
Call Detail Recording and Reporting  
CDRU  
See Call Detail Recording utility (CDRU).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-12  
CEM  
Channel-expansion multiplexing  
center-stage switch (CSS)  
The central interface between the processor port network and expansion port networks in a  
CSS-connected system.  
central office (CO)  
The location housing telephone switching equipment that provides local telephone service and  
access to toll facilities for long-distance calling.  
central office (CO) codes  
The first three digits of a 7-digit public-network telephone number in the United States.  
central office (CO) trunk  
A telecommunications channel that provides access from the system to the public network through  
the local CO.  
CEPT1  
European Conference of Postal and Telecommunications Rate 1  
channel  
1. A circuit-switched call.  
2. A communications path for transmitting voice and data.  
3. In wideband, all of the time slots (contiguous or noncontiguous) necessary to support a call.  
Example: an H0-channel uses six 64-kbps time slots.  
4. A DS0 on a T1 or E1 facility not specifically associated with a logical circuit-switched call;  
analogous to a single trunk.  
channel negotiation  
The process by which the channel offered in the Channel Identification Information Element (CIIE)  
in the SETUP message is negotiated to be another channel acceptable to the switch that receives  
the SETUP message and ultimately to the switch that sent the SETUP. Negotiation is attempted  
only if the CIIE is encoded as Preferred. Channel negotiation is not attempted for wideband calls.  
CI  
Clock input  
circuit  
1. An arrangement of electrical elements through which electric current flows.  
2. A channel or transmission path between two or more points.  
circuit pack  
A card on which electrical circuits are printed, and IC chips and electrical components are  
installed. A circuit pack is installed in a switch carrier.  
CISPR  
International Special Committee on Radio Interference  
Class of Restriction (COR)  
A feature that allows up to 64 classes of call-origination and call-termination restrictions for voice  
terminals, voice-terminal groups, data modules, and trunk groups. See also Class of Service  
(COS).  
Class of Service (COS)  
A feature that uses a number to specify if voice-terminal users can activate the Automatic  
Callback, Call Forwarding All Calls, Data Privacy, or Priority Calling features. See also Class of  
Restriction (COR).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-13  
cm  
Centimeter  
CM  
Connection Manager  
CMC  
Compact Modular Cabinet  
CMDR  
Centralized Message Detail Recording  
CMS  
Call Management System  
CO  
See central office (CO).  
common-control switching arrangement (CCSA)  
A private telecommunications network using dedicated trunks and a shared switching center for  
interconnecting company locations.  
communications system  
The software-controlled processor complex that interprets dialing pulses, tones, and keyboard  
characters and makes the proper connections both within the system and external to the system.  
The communications system itself consists of a digital computer, software, storage device, and  
carriers with special hardware to perform the connections. A communications system provides  
voice and data communications services, including access to public and private networks, for  
telephones and data terminals on a customer’s premises. See also switch.  
confirmation tone  
A tone confirming that feature activation, deactivation, or cancellation has been accepted.  
connectivity  
The connection of disparate devices within a single system.  
console  
See attendant console.  
contiguous  
Adjacent DS0s within one T1 or E1 facility or adjacent TDM or fiber time slots. The first and last  
TDM bus, DS0, or fiber time slots are not considered contiguous (no wraparound). For an E1  
facility with a D-channel, DS0s 15 and 17 are considered contiguous.  
control cabinet  
See control carrier.  
control carrier  
A carrier in a multi-carrier cabinet that contains the SPE circuit packs and, unlike an R5r control  
carrier, port circuit packs. Also called control cabinet in a single-carrier cabinet. See also  
switch-processing element (SPE).  
controlled station  
A station that is monitored and controlled via a domain-control association.  
COR  
See Class of Restriction (COR).  
COS  
See Class of Service (COS).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-14  
coverage answer group  
A group of up to eight voice terminals that ring simultaneously when a call is redirected to it by Call  
Coverage. Any one of the group can answer the call.  
coverage call  
A call that is automatically redirected from the called party’s extension to an alternate answering  
position when certain coverage criteria are met.  
coverage path  
The order in which calls are redirected to alternate answering positions.  
coverage point  
An extension or attendant group, VDN, or ACD split designated as an alternate answering position  
in a coverage path.  
covering user  
A person at a coverage point who answers a redirected call.  
CP  
Circuit pack  
CPE  
Customer-premises equipment  
CPN  
Called-party number  
CPN/BN  
Calling-party number/billing number  
CPTR  
Call-progress-tone receiver  
CRC  
Cyclical Redundancy Checking  
critical-reliability system  
A system that has the following duplicated items: control carriers, tone clocks, EI circuit packs,  
and cabling between port networks and center-stage switch in a CSS-connected system. See also  
duplicated common control, and duplication.  
CSA  
Canadian Safety Association or Customer Software Administrator  
CSCC  
Compact single-carrier cabinet  
CSCN  
Center-stage control network  
CSD  
Customer-service document  
CSM  
Centralized System Management  
CSS  
See center-stage switch (CSS).  
CSSO  
Customer Services Support Organization  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-15  
CSU  
Channel service unit  
CTS  
Clear to Send  
CWC  
See call work code.  
D
DAC  
1. Dial access code or Direct Agent Calling  
2. See digital-to-analog converter (DAC).  
data channel  
A communications path between two points used to transmit digital signals.  
data-communications equipment (DCE)  
The equipment (usually a modem, data module, or packet assembler/disassembler) on the  
network side of a communications link that makes the binary serial data from the source or  
transmitter compatible with the communications channel.  
data link  
The configuration of physical facilities enabling end terminals to communicate directly with each  
other.  
data module  
An interconnection device between a BRI or DCP interface of the switch and data terminal  
equipment or data communications equipment.  
data path  
The end-to-end connection used for a data communications link. A data path is the combination of  
all elements of an interprocessor communication in a DCS.  
data port  
A point of access to a computer that uses trunks or lines for transmitting or receiving data.  
data rate  
See bit rate.  
data service unit (DSU)  
A device that transmits digital data on transmission facilities.  
data terminal  
An input/output (I/O) device that has either switched or direct access to a host computer or to a  
processor interface.  
data terminal equipment (DTE)  
Equipment consisting of the endpoints in a connection over a data circuit. In a connection  
between a data terminal and host, the terminal, the host, and their associated modems or data  
modules make up the DTE.  
dB  
Decibel  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-16  
dBA  
Decibels in reference to amperes.  
dBrnC  
Decibels above reference noise with C filter.  
DC  
Direct current  
DCE  
Data-communications equipment  
D-channel backup  
Type of backup used with Non-Facility Associated Signaling (NFAS). A primary D-channel  
provides signaling for an NFAS D-channel group (two or more PRI facilities). A second D-channel,  
on a separate PRI facility of the NFAS D-channel group, is designated as backup for the  
D-channel. Failure of the primary D-channel causes automatic transfer of call-control signaling to  
the backup D-channel. The backup becomes the primary D-channel. When the failed channel  
returns to service, it becomes the backup D-channel.  
DCO  
Digital central office  
DCP  
Digital Communications Protocol  
DCS  
Distributed Communications System  
DDC  
Direct Department Calling  
DDD  
Direct Distance Dialing  
delay-dial trunk  
A trunk that allows dialing directly into a communications system (digits are received as they are  
dialed).  
denying a request  
Sending a negative acknowledgement (NAK), done by sending an FIE with a return error  
component (and a cause value). It should not be confused with the denial event report that applies  
to calls.  
designated voice terminal  
The specific voice terminal to which calls, originally directed to a certain extension, are redirected.  
Commonly used to mean the forwarded-to terminal when Call Forwarding All Calls is active.  
dial-repeating trunks  
A PBX tie trunk that is capable of handling PBX station-signaling information without attendant  
assistance.  
dial-repeating tie trunk  
A tie trunk that transmits called-party addressing information between two communications  
systems.  
DID  
Direct Inward Dialing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-17  
digit conversion  
A process used to convert specific dialed numbers into other dialed numbers.  
digital  
The representation of information by discrete steps. See also analog.  
digital communications protocol (DCP)  
A proprietary protocol used to transmit both digitized voice and digitized data over  
the same communications link. A DCP link is made up of two 64-kbps information  
(I-) channels and one 8-kbps signaling (S-) channel. Digital Communications  
Protocol. The DCP protocol supports 2 information-bearing channels, and  
thus two telephones/data modules. The I1 channel is the DCP channel  
assigned on the first page of the 8411 station form. The I2 channel is the  
DCP channel assigned on the analog adjunct page of the 8411 station  
form or on the data module page.  
Digital Communications Protocol. The DCP protocol supports 2  
information-bearing channels, and thus two telephones/data modules. The  
I1 channel is the DCP channel assigned on the first page of the 8411  
station form. The I2 channel is the DCP channel assigned on the analog  
adjunct page of the 8411 station form or on the data module page.  
digital data endpoints  
In DEFINITY ECS, devices such as the 510D terminal or the 515-type business communications  
terminal (BCT).  
digital multiplexed interface (DMI)  
An interface that provides connectivity between a communications system and a host computer or  
between two communications systems using DS1 24th-channel signaling. DMI provides 23  
64-kbps data channels and 1 common-signaling channel over a twisted-pair connection. DMI is  
offered through two capabilities: bit-oriented signaling (DMI-BOS) and message-oriented signaling  
(DMI-MOS).  
digital signal level 0 (DS0)  
A single 64-kbps voice channel. A DS0 is a single 64-kbps channel in a T1 or E1 facility and  
consists of eight bits in a T1 or E1 frame every 125 microseconds.  
digital signal level 1 (DS1)  
A single 1.544-Mbps (United States) or 2.048-Mbps (outside the United States) digital signal  
carried on a T1 transmission facility. A DS1 converter complex consists of a pair, one at each end,  
of DS1 converter circuit packs and the associated T1/E1 facilities.  
digital terminal data module (DTDM)  
An integrated or adjunct data module that shares with a digital telephone the same physical port  
for connection to a communications system. The function of a DTDM is similar to that of a PDM and  
MPDM in that it converts RS-232C signals to DCP signals.  
digital-to-analog converter (DAC)  
A device that converts data in digital form to the corresponding analog signals. See also  
analog-to-digital converter (ADC).  
digital transmission  
A mode of transmission in which information to be transmitted is first converted to digital form and  
then transmitted as a serial stream of pulses.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-18  
digital trunk  
A circuit that carries digital voice and/or digital data in a telecommunications channel.  
DIOD  
Direct Inward and Outward Dialing  
direct agent  
A feature, accessed only via ASAI, that allows a call to be placed in a split queue but routed only to  
a specific agent in that split. The call receives normal ACD call treatment (for example,  
announcements) and is measured as an ACD call while ensuring that a particular agent answers.  
Direct Extension Selection (DXS)  
A feature on an attendant console that allows an attendant direct access to voice terminals by  
pressing a group-select button and a DXS button.  
Direct Inward Dialing (DID)  
A feature that allows an incoming call from the public network (not FX or WATS) to reach a specific  
telephone without attendant assistance.  
Direct Inward Dialing (DID) trunk  
An incoming trunk used for dialing directly from the public network into a communications system  
without help from the attendant.  
disk drive  
An electromechanical device that stores data on and retrieves data from one or more disks.  
distributed communications system (DCS)  
A network configuration linking two or more communications systems in such a way that selected  
features appear to operate as if the network were one system.  
DIVA  
Data In/Voice Answer  
DLC  
Data line circuit  
DLDM  
Data-line data module  
DMI  
Digital-multiplexed interface  
DND  
Do not disturb  
DNIS  
Dialed-Number Identification Service  
DOD  
Direct Outward Dialing  
domain  
VDNs, ACD splits, and stations. The VDN domain is used for active-notification associations. The  
ACD-split domain is for active-notification associations and domain-control associations. The  
station domain is used for the domain-control associations.  
domain-control association  
A Third Party Domain Control Request capability initiates a unique CRV/link number combination,  
which is referred to as a domain-control association.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-19  
domain-controlled split  
A split for which Third Party Domain Control request has been accepted. A domain-controlled split  
provides an event report for logout.  
domain-controlled station  
A station for which a Third_Party_Domain_Control request has been accepted. A  
domain-controlled station provides event reports for calls that are alerting, connected, or held at  
the station.  
domain-controlled station on a call  
A station that is active on a call, and which provides event reports over one or two domain-control  
associations.  
DOSS  
Delivery Operations Support System  
DOT  
Duplication Option Terminal  
DPM  
Dial Plan Manager  
DPR  
Dual-port RAM  
DS1  
Digital Signal Level 1  
DS1C  
Digital Signal Level-1 protocol C  
DS1 CONV  
Digital Signal Level-1 converter  
DSI  
Digital signal interface  
DSU  
Data service unit  
DTDM  
Digital-terminal data module  
DTE  
Data-terminal equipment  
DTGS  
Direct Trunk Group Select  
DTMF  
Dual-tone multifrequency  
DTS  
Disk-tape system  
duplicated common control  
Two processors ensuring continuous operation of a communications system. While one processor  
is online, the other functions as a backup. The backup processor goes online periodically or when  
a problem occurs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-20  
duplication  
The use of redundant components to improve availability. When a duplicated subsystem fails, its  
backup redundant system automatically takes over.  
duplication option  
A system option that duplicates the following: control carrier containing the SPE, EI circuit packs in  
carriers, fiber-optic cabling between port networks, and center-stage switch in a CSS-connected  
system.  
DWBS  
DEFINITY Wireless Business System  
DXS  
Direct extension selection  
E
E1  
A digital transmission standard that carries traffic at 2.048 Mbps. The E1 facility is divided into 32  
channels (DS0s) of 64 kbps information. Channel 0 is reserved for framing and synchronization  
information. A D-channel occupies channel 16.  
E & M  
Ear and mouth (receive and transmit)  
EA  
Expansion archangel  
EAL  
Expansion archangel link  
ear and mouth (E & M) signaling  
Trunk supervisory signaling, used between two communications systems, whereby signaling  
information is transferred through 2-state voltage conditions (on the E and M leads) for analog  
applications and through a single bit for digital applications.  
EBCDIC  
Extended Binary-Coded Decimal Interexchange Code  
ECC  
Error Correct Code  
ECMA  
European Computer Manufacturers Association  
EFP  
Electronic power feed  
EI  
Expansion interface  
EIA  
Electronic Industries Association  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-21  
EIA-232  
A physical interface specified by the EIA. EIA-232 transmits and receives asynchronous data at  
speeds of up to 19.2 kbps over cable distances of up to 50 feet. EIA-232 replaces RS-232 protocol  
in some DEFINITY applications.  
electronic tandem network (ETN)  
A tandem tie-trunk network that has automatic call-routing capabilities based on the number  
dialed and the most preferred route available. Each switch in the network is assigned a unique  
private network office code (RNX), and each voice terminal is assigned a unique extension.  
Electronics Industries Association (EIA)  
A trade association of the electronics industry that establishes electrical and functional standards.  
emergency transfer  
If a major system failure occurs, automatic transfer is initiated to a group of telephones capable of  
making outgoing calls. The system operates in this mode until the failure is repaired and the  
system automatically returns to normal operation. Also called power-failure transfer.  
EMI  
Electromagnetic interference  
end-to-end signaling  
The transmission of touch-tone signals generated by dialing from a voice terminal to remote  
computer equipment. These digits are sent over the trunk as DTMF digits whether the trunk  
signaling type is marked as tone or rotary and whether the originating station is tone or rotary.  
Example: a call to a voice-mail machine or automated-attendant service. A connection is first  
established over an outgoing trunk. Then additional digits are dialed to transmit information to be  
processed by the computer equipment.  
enhanced private-switched communications service (EPSCS)  
An analog private telecommunications network based on the No. 5 crossbar and 1A ESS that  
provides advanced voice and data telecommunications services to companies with many  
locations.  
EPN  
Expansion-port network  
EPROM  
Erasable programmable read-only memory  
EPSCS  
Enhanced Private Switched Communications Services  
ERL  
Echo return loss  
Erlang  
A unit of traffic intensity, or load, used to express the amount of traffic needed to keep one facility  
busy for one hour. One Erlang is equal to 36 CCS. See also CCS or hundred call seconds.  
ESF  
Extended superframe format  
ESPA  
European Standard Paging Access  
ETA  
Extended Trunk Access; also Enhanced Terminal Administration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-22  
ETN  
Electronic tandem network  
ETSI  
European Telecommunications Standards Institute  
expansion archangel (EAA)  
A network-control microprocessor located on an expansion interface (EI) port circuit pack in an  
expansion port network. The EA provides an interface between the EPN and its controlling  
switch-processing element.  
expansion-archangel link (EAL)  
A link-access function on the D-channel (LAPD) logical link that exists between a  
switch-processing element and an expansion archangel (EA). The EAL carries control messages  
from the SPE to the EA and to port circuit packs in an expansion port network.  
expansion control cabinet  
See expansion control carrier.  
expansion control carrier  
A carrier in a multicarrier cabinet that contains extra port circuit packs and a maintenance  
interface. Also called expansion control cabinet in a single-carrier cabinet.  
expansion interface (EI)  
A port circuit pack in a port network that provides the interface between a PN’s TDM bus/ packet  
bus and a fiber-optic link. The EI carries circuit-switched data, packet-switched data, network  
control, timing control, and DS1 control. In addition, an EI in an expansion port network  
communicates with the master maintenance circuit pack to provide the EPN’s environmental and  
alarm status to the switch-processing element.  
expansion port network (EPN)  
A port network (PN) that is connected to the TDM bus and packet bus of a processor port network  
(PPN). Control is achieved by indirect connection of the EPN to the PPN via a port-network link  
(PNL). See also port network (PN).  
extension-in  
Extension-In (ExtIn) is the work state agents go into when they answer (receive) a non-ACD call. If  
the agent is in Manual-In or Auto-In and receives an extension-in call, it is recorded by CMS as an  
AUX-In call.  
extension-out  
The work state that agents go into when they place (originate) a non-ACD call.  
external measurements  
Those ACD measurements that are made by the External CMS adjunct.  
extension  
A 1- to 5-digit number by which calls are routed through a communications system or, with a  
Uniform Dial Plan (UDP) or main-satellite dialing plan, through a private network.  
external call  
A connection between a communications system user and a party on the public network or on  
another communications system in a private network.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-23  
F
FAC  
Feature Access Code  
facility  
A telecommunications transmission pathway and associated equipment.  
facility-associated signaling (FAS)  
Signaling for which a D-channel carries signaling only for those channels on the same physical  
interface.  
FAS  
Facility-associated signaling  
FAT  
Facility access trunk  
FAX  
Facsimile  
FCC  
Federal Communications Commission  
FEAC  
Forced Entry of Account Codes  
feature  
A specifically defined function or service provided by the system.  
feature button  
A labeled button on a telephone or attendant console used to access a specific feature.  
FEP  
Front-end processor  
FIC  
Facility interface codes  
fiber optics  
A technology using materials that transmit ultrawideband electromagnetic light-frequency ranges  
for high-capacity carrier systems.  
fixed  
A trunk allocation term. In the fixed allocation scheme, the time slots necessary to support a  
wideband call are contiguous, and the first time slot is constrained to certain starting points.  
flexible  
A trunk allocation term. In the flexible allocation scheme, the time slots of a wideband call can  
occupy noncontiguous positions within a single T1 or E1 facility.  
floating  
A trunk allocation term. In the floating allocation scheme, the time slots of a wideband call are  
contiguous, but the position of the first time slot is not fixed.  
FNPA  
Foreign Numbering-Plan Area  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-24  
foreign-exchange (FX)  
A CO other than the one providing local access to the public telephone network.  
foreign-exchange trunk  
A telecommunications channel that directly connects the system to a CO other than its local CO.  
foreign numbering-plan area code (FNPAC)  
An area code other than the local area code, that must be dialed to call outside the local  
geographical area.  
FRL  
Facilities Restriction Level  
FX  
Foreign exchange  
G
G3-MA  
Generic 3 Management Applications  
G3-MT  
Generic 3 Management Terminal  
G3r  
Generic 3, RISC (Reduced Instruction Set Computer)  
generalized route selection (GRS)  
An enhancement to Automatic Alternate Routing/Automatic Route Selection (AAR/ARS) that  
performs routing based on call attributes, such as Bearer Capability Classes (BCCs), in addition to  
the address and facilities restriction level (FRL), thus facilitating a Uniform Dial Plan (UDP) that is  
independent of the type of call being placed.  
glare  
The simultaneous seizure of a 2-way trunk by two communications systems, resulting in a standoff.  
GM  
Group manager  
GPTR  
General-purpose tone receiver  
grade of service  
The number of call attempts that fail to receive service immediately. Grade of service is also  
expressed as the quantity of all calls that are blocked or delayed.  
ground-start trunk  
A trunk on which, for outgoing calls, the system transmits a request for services to a distant  
switching system by grounding the trunk ring lead. To receive the digits of the called number, that  
system grounds the trunk tip lead. When the system detects this ground, the digits are sent.  
GRS  
Generalized Route Selection  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-25  
H
H0  
An ISDN information transfer rate for 384-kbps data defined by CCITT and ANSI standards.  
H11  
An ISDN information transfer rate for 1536-kbps data defined by CCITT and ANSI standards.  
H12  
An ISDN information transfer rate for 1920-kbps data defined by CCITT and ANSI standards.  
handshaking logic  
A format used to initiate a data connection between two data module devices.  
hertz (Hz)  
A unit of frequency equal to one cycle per second.  
high-reliability system  
A system having the following: two control carriers, duplicate expansion interface (EI) circuit packs  
in the PPN (in R5r with CSS), and duplicate switch node clock circuit packs in the switch node (SN)  
carriers. See also duplicated common control, duplication, duplication option, and  
critical-reliability system.  
HNPA  
See home numbering-plan area code (HNPA).  
holding time  
The total length of time in minutes and seconds that a facility is used during a call.  
home numbering-plan area code (HNPA)  
The local area code. The area code does not have to be dialed to call numbers within the local  
geographical area.  
hop  
Nondirect communication between two switch communications interfaces (SCI) where the SCI  
message passes automatically without intermediate processing through one or more intermediate  
SCIs.  
host computer  
A computer, connected to a network, that processes data from data-entry devices.  
hunt group  
A group of extensions that are assigned the Station Hunting feature so that a call to a busy  
extension reroutes to an idle extension in the group. See also ACD work mode.  
Hz  
See hertz (Hz).  
I
I1  
The first information channel of DCP.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-26  
I2  
The second information channel of DCP.  
I2 Interface  
A proprietary interface used for the DEFINITY Wireless Business System for the radio-controller  
circuit packs. Each interface provides communication between the radio-controller circuit pack  
and up to two wireless fixed bases.  
I3 Interface  
A proprietary interface used for the DEFINITY Wireless Business System for the cell antenna units.  
Each wireless fixed base can communicate to up to four cell antenna units.  
IAS  
Inter-PBX Attendant Service  
ICC  
Intercabinet cable or intercarrier cable  
ICD  
Inbound Call Director  
ICDOS  
International Customer-Dialed Operator Service  
ICHT  
Incoming call-handling table  
ICI  
Incoming call identifier  
ICM  
Inbound Call Management  
IDDD  
International Direct Distance Dialing  
IDF  
Intermediate distribution frame  
IE  
Information element  
immediate-start tie trunk  
A trunk on which, after making a connection with a distant switching system for an outgoing call,  
the system waits a nominal 65 ms before sending the digits of the called number. This allows time  
for the distant system to prepare to receive digits. On an incoming call, the system has less than  
65 ms to prepare to receive the digits.  
IMT  
Intermachine trunk  
in  
Inch  
INADS  
Initialization and Administration System  
incoming gateway  
A PBX that routes an incoming call on a trunk not administered for Supplementary Services  
Protocol B to a trunk not administered for Supplementary Services Protocol B.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-27  
information exchange  
The exchange of data between users of two different systems, such as the switch and a host  
computer, over a LAN.  
Information Systems Network (ISN)  
A WAN and LAN with an open architecture combining host computers, minicomputers, word  
processors, storage devices, PCs, high-speed printers, and nonintelligent terminals into a single  
packet-switching system.  
INS  
ISDN Network Service  
inside call  
A call placed from one telephone to another within the local communications system.  
Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN)  
A public or private network that provides end-to-end digital communications for all services to  
which users have access by a limited set of standard multipurpose user-network interfaces  
defined by the CCITT. Through internationally accepted standard interfaces, ISDN provides digital  
circuit-switched or packet-switched communications within the network and links to other ISDNs to  
provide national and international digital communications. See also Integrated Services Digital  
Network Basic Rate Interface (ISDN-BRI) and Integrated Services Digital Network Primary Rate  
Interface (ISDN-PRI).  
Integrated Services Digital Network Basic Rate Interface (ISDN-BRI)  
The interface between a communications system and terminal that includes two 64-kbps  
B-channels for transmitting voice or data and one 16-kbps D-channel for transmitting associated  
B-channel call control and out-of-band signaling information. ISDN-BRI also includes 48 kbps for  
transmitting framing and D-channel contention information, for a total interface speed of 192 kbps.  
ISDN-BRI serves ISDN terminals and digital terminals fitted with ISDN terminal adapters. See also  
Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN) andIntegrated Services Digital Network Primary Rate  
Interface (ISDN-PRI).  
Integrated Services Digital Network Primary Rate Interface (ISDN-PRI)  
The interface between multiple communications systems that in North America includes 24  
64-kbps channels, corresponding to the North American digital signal level-1 (DS1) standard rate  
of 1.544 Mbps. The most common arrangement of channels in ISDN-PRI is 23 64-kbps B-channels  
for transmitting voice and data and 1 64-kbps D-channel for transmitting associated B-channel call  
control and out-of-band signaling information. With nonfacility-associated signaling (NFAS),  
ISDN-PRI can include 24 B-channels and no D-channel. See alsoIntegrated Services Digital  
Network (ISDN) andIntegrated Services Digital Network Basic Rate Interface (ISDN-BRI).  
intercept tone  
An tone that indicates a dialing error or denial of the service requested.  
interface  
A common boundary between two systems or pieces of equipment.  
internal call  
A connection between two users within a system.  
International Telecommunications Union (ITU)  
Formerly known as International Telegraph and Telephone Consultative Committee (CCITT), ITU is  
an international organization that sets universal standards for data communications, including  
ISDN. ITU members are from telecommunications companies and organizations around the world.  
See alsoBX.25.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-28  
International Telegraph and Telephone Consultative Committee  
See International Telecommunications Union (ITU).  
interflow  
The ability for calls to forward to other splits on the same PBX or a different PBX using the Call  
Forward All Calls feature.  
intraflow  
The ability for calls to redirect to other splits on the same PBX on a conditional or unconditional  
basis using call coverage busy, don’t answer, or all criteria.  
internal measurements  
BCMS measurements that are made by the system. ACD measurements that are made external to  
the system (via External CMS) are referred to as external measurements.  
in-use lamp  
A red light on a multiappearance voice terminal that lights to show which call appearance will be  
selected when the handset is lifted or which call appearance is active when a user is off-hook.  
INWATS  
IO  
Information outlet  
ISDN  
See Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN).  
ISDN Gateway (IG)  
A feature allowing integration of the switch and a host-based telemarketing application via a link to  
a gateway adjunct. The gateway adjunct is a 3B-based product that notifies the host-based  
telemarketing application of call events.  
ISDN trunk  
A trunk administered for use with ISDN-PRI. Also called ISDN facility.  
ISDN-PRI terminal adapter  
An interface between endpoint applications and an ISDN PRI facility. ISDN-PRI terminal adapters  
are currently available from other vendors and are primarily designed for video conferencing  
applications. Accordingly, currently available terminal adapters adapt the two pairs of video codec  
data (V.35) and dialing (RS-366) ports to an ISDN PRI facility.  
IS/DTT  
Integrated Services/digital tie trunk  
ISN  
Information Systems Network  
ISO  
International Standards Organization  
ISV  
Independent software vendor  
ITP  
Installation test procedure  
ITU  
International Telecommunications Union  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-29  
IXC  
Interexchange carrier code  
K
kHz  
Kilohertz  
kbps  
Kilobits per second  
kbyte  
Kilobyte  
kg  
Kilogram  
L
LAN  
Local area network  
LAP-D  
Link Access Procedure on the D-channel  
LAPD  
Link Access Procedure data  
LATA  
Local access and transport area  
lb  
Pound  
LBO  
Line buildout  
LDN  
Listed directory number  
LDS  
Long-distance service  
LEC  
Local exchange carrier  
LED  
See light-emitting diode (LED).  
light-emitting diode (LED)  
A semiconductor device that produces light when voltage is applied. LEDs provide a visual  
indication of the operational status of hardware components, the results of maintenance tests, the  
alarm status of circuit packs, and the activation of telephone features.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-30  
lightwave transceiver  
Hardware that provides an interface to fiber-optic cable from port circuit packs and DS1 converter  
circuit packs. Lightwave transceivers convert electrical signals to light signals and vice versa.  
line  
A transmission path between a communications system or CO switching system and a voice  
terminal or other terminal.  
line appearance  
See appearance.  
line buildout  
A selectable output attenuation is generally required of DTE equipment because T1 circuits  
require the last span to lose 15–22.5 dB.  
line port  
Hardware that provides the access point to a communications system for each circuit associated  
with a telephone or data terminal.  
link  
A transmitter-receiver channel that connects two systems.  
link-access procedure on the D-channel (LAPD)  
A link-layer protocol on the ISDN-BRI and ISDN-PRI data-link layer (level 2). LAPD provides data  
transfer between two devices, and error and flow control on multiple logical links. LAPD is used for  
signaling and low-speed packet data (X.25 and mode 3) on the signaling (D-) channel and for  
mode-3 data communications on a bearer (B-) channel.  
LINL  
Local indirect neighbor link  
local area network (LAN)  
A networking arrangement designed for a limited geographical area. Generally, a LAN is limited in  
range to a maximum of 6.2 miles and provides high-speed carrier service with low error rates.  
Common configurations include daisy chain, star (including circuit-switched), ring, and bus.  
logical link  
The communications path between a processor and a BRI terminal.  
loop-start trunk  
A trunk on which, after establishing a connection with a distant switching system for an outgoing  
call, the system waits for a signal on the loop formed by the trunk leads before sending the digits  
of the called number.  
LSU  
Local storage unit  
LWC  
Leave Word Calling  
M
MAC  
Medium access  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-31  
MADU  
Modular asynchronous data unit  
main distribution frame (MDF)  
A device that mounts to the wall inside the system equipment room. The MDF provides a  
connection point from outside telephone lines to the PBX switch and to the inside telephone  
stations.  
main-satellite-tributary  
A private network configuration that can either stand alone or access an ETN. A main switch  
provides interconnection, via tie trunks, with one or more subtending switches, called satellites; all  
attendant positions for the main/satellite configuration; and access to and from the public network.  
To a user outside the complex, a main/satellite configuration appears as one switch, with one listed  
directory number (LDN). A tributary switch is connected to the main switch via tie trunks, but has  
its own attendant positions and LDN.  
maintenance  
Activities involved in keeping a telecommunications system in proper working condition: the  
detection and isolation of software and hardware faults, and automatic and manual recovery from  
these faults.  
management terminal  
The terminal that is used by the system administrator to administer the switch. The terminal may  
also be used to access the BCMS feature.  
major alarm  
An indication of a failure that has caused critical degradation of service and requires immediate  
attention. Major alarms are automatically displayed on LEDs on the attendant console and  
maintenance or alarming circuit pack, logged to the alarm log, and reported to a remote  
maintenance facility, if applicable.  
Manual-In work mode  
One of four agent work modes: the mode in which an agent is ready to process another call  
manually. See Auto-In Work mode for a contrast.  
MAP  
Maintenance action process  
MAPD  
Multiapplication platform for DEFINITY  
MA-UUI  
Message-Associated User-to-User Signaling  
Mbps  
Megabits per second  
M-Bus  
Memory bus  
Mbyte  
Megabyte  
MCC  
Multicarrier cabinet  
MCS  
Message Center Service  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-32  
MCT  
Malicious Call Trace  
MCU  
Multipoint control unit  
MDF  
Main distribution frame  
MDM  
Modular data module  
MDR  
Message detail record  
MEM  
Memory  
memory  
A device into which information can be copied and held, and from which information can later be  
obtained.  
memory shadowing link  
An operating-system condition that provides a method for memory-resident programs to be more  
quickly accessed, allowing a system to reboot faster.  
message center  
An answering service that supplies agents to and stores messages for later retrieval.  
message center agent  
A member of a message-center hunt group who takes and retrieves messages for voice-terminal  
users.  
MET  
Multibutton electronic telephone  
MF  
Multifrequency  
MFB  
Multifunction board  
MFC  
Multifrequency code  
MHz  
Megahertz  
MIM  
Management information message  
minor alarm  
An indication of a failure that could affect customer service. Minor alarms are automatically  
displayed on LEDs on the attendant console and maintenance or alarming circuit pack, sent to the  
alarm log, and reported to a remote maintenance facility, if applicable.  
MIPS  
Million instructions per second  
MIS  
Management information system  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-33  
MISCID  
Miscellaneous identification  
MMCS  
Multimedia Call Server  
MMCH  
Multimedia call handling  
MMI  
Multimedia interface  
MMS  
Material Management Services  
MO  
Maintenance object  
modem  
A device that converts digital data signals to analog signals for transmission over telephone  
circuits. The analog signals are converted back to the original digital data signals by another  
modem at the other end of the circuit.  
modem pooling  
A capability that provides shared conversion resources (modems and data modules) for  
cost-effective access to analog facilities by data terminals. When needed, modem pooling inserts  
a conversion resource into the path of a data call. Modem pooling serves both outgoing and  
incoming calls.  
modular processor data module (MPDM)  
A processor data module (PDM) that can be configured to provide several kinds of interfaces  
(RS-232C, RS-449, and V.35) to customer-provided data terminal equipment (DTE). See also  
processor data module (PDM).  
modular trunk data module (MTDM)  
A trunk data module that can be configured to provide several kinds of interfaces (RS-232,  
RS-449, and V.35) to customer-provided data terminal equipment.  
modulator-demodulator  
See modem.  
monitored call  
See active-notification call.  
MOS  
Message-oriented signaling  
MPDM  
Modular processor data module  
MS  
Message server  
ms  
Millisecond  
MS/T  
Main satellite/tributary  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-34  
MSA  
Message servicing adjunct  
MSG  
Message service  
MSL  
Material stocking location  
MSM  
Modular System Management  
MSS  
Mass storage system  
MSSNET  
Mass storage/network control  
MT  
Management terminal  
MTDM  
Modular trunk data module  
MTP  
Maintenance tape processor  
MTT  
Multitasking terminal  
multiappearance voice terminal  
A terminal equipped with several call-appearance buttons for the same extension, allowing the  
user to handle more than one call on that same extension at the same time.  
Multicarrier cabinet  
A structure that holds one to five carriers. See also single-carrier cabinet.  
Multifrequency Compelled (MFC) Release 2 (R2) signaling  
A signal consisting of two frequency components, such that when a signal is transmitted from a  
switch, another signal acknowledging the transmitted signal is received by the switch. R2  
designates signaling used in the United States and in countries outside the United States.  
multiplexer  
A device used to combine a number of individual channels into a single common bit stream for  
transmission.  
multiplexing  
A process whereby a transmission facility is divided into two or more channels, either by splitting  
the frequency band into a number of narrower bands or by dividing the transmission channel into  
successive time slots. See also time-division multiplexing (TDM).  
multirate  
The new N x DS0 service (see N x DS0).  
MWL  
Message-waiting lamp  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-35  
N
N+1  
Method of determining redundant backup requirements. Example: if four rectifier modules are  
required for a DC-powered single-carrier cabinet, a fifth rectifier module is installed for backup.  
N x DS0  
N x DS0, equivalently referred to as N x 64 kbps, is an emerging standard for wideband calls  
separate from H0, H11, and H12 ISDN channels. The emerging N x DS0 ISDN multirate circuit  
mode bearer service will provide circuit-switched calls with data-rate multiples of 64 kbps up to  
1536 kbps on a T1 facility or up to 1920 kbps on an E1 facility. In the switch, N x DS0 channels will  
range up to 1984 kbps using NFAS E1 interfaces.  
NANP  
North American Numbering Plan  
narrowband  
A circuit-switched call at a data rate up to and including 64 kbps. All nonwideband switch calls are  
considered narrowband.  
native terminal support  
A predefined terminal type exists in switch software, eliminating the need to alias the terminal (that  
is, manually map call appearances and feature buttons onto some other natively supported  
terminal type).  
NAU  
Network access unit  
NCA/TSC  
Noncall-associated/temporary-signaling connection  
NCOSS  
Network Control Operations Support Center  
NCSO  
National Customer Support Organization  
NEC  
National Engineering Center  
NEMA  
National Electrical Manufacturer’s Association  
NETCON  
Network-control circuit pack  
network  
A series of points, nodes, or stations connected by communications channels.  
network-specific facility (NSF)  
An information element in an ISDN-PRI message that specifies which public-network service is  
used. NSF applies only when Call-by-Call Service Selection is used to access a public-network  
service.  
network interface  
A common boundary between two systems in an interconnected group of systems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-36  
NFAS  
See Nonfacility-associated signaling (NFAS).  
NI  
Network interface  
NID  
Network Inward Dialing  
NM  
Network management  
NN  
National number  
node  
A switching or control point for a network. Nodes are either tandem (they receive signals and pass  
them on) or terminal (they originate or terminate a transmission path).  
Nonfacility-associated signaling (NFAS)  
A method that allows multiple T1 and/or E1 facilities to share a single D-channel to form an  
ISDN-PRI. If D-channel backup is not used, one facility is configured with a D-channel, and the  
other facilities that share the D-channel are configured without D-channels. If D-channel backup is  
used, two facilities are configured to have D-channels (one D-channel on each facility), and the  
other facilities that share the D-channels are configured without D-channels.  
NPA  
Numbering-plan area  
NPE  
Network processing element  
NQC  
Number of queued calls  
NSE  
Night-service extension  
NSU  
Network sharing unit  
null modem cable  
Special wiring of an RS-232-C cable such that a computer can talk to another computer (or to a  
printer) without a modem.  
NXX  
Public-network office code  
O
OA  
Operator assisted  
occurrence  
See appearance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-37  
OCM  
Outbound Call Management  
offered load  
The traffic that would be generated by all the requests for service occurring within a monitored  
interval, usually one hour.  
ONS  
On-premises station  
OPS  
Off-premises station  
OPX  
Off-premises extension  
OQT  
Oldest queued time  
OSHA  
Occupational Safety and Health Act  
OSI  
Open Systems Interconnect  
OSS  
Operations Support System  
OSSI  
Operational Support System Interface  
OTDR  
Optical time-domain reflectometer  
othersplit  
The work state that indicates that an agent is currently active on another split’s call, or in ACW for  
another split.  
OTL  
Originating Test Line  
OTQ  
Outgoing trunk queuing  
outgoing gateway  
A PBX that routes an incoming call on a trunk administered for Supplementary Services Protocol B  
to a trunk not administered for Supplementary Services Protocol B.  
P
PACCON  
Packet control  
packet  
A group of bits (including a message element, which is the data, and a control information element  
(IE), which is the header) used in packet switching and transmitted as a discrete unit. In each  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-38  
packet, the message element and control IE are arranged in a specified format. See also packet  
bus and packet switching.  
packet bus  
A wide-bandwidth bus that transmits packets.  
packet switching  
A data-transmission technique whereby user information is segmented and routed in discrete data  
envelopes called packets, each with its own appended control information, for routing,  
sequencing, and error checking. Packet switching allows a channel to be occupied only during  
the transmission of a packet. On completion of the transmission, the channel is made available for  
the transfer of other packets. See also BX.25and packet.  
PAD  
Packet assembly/disassembly  
paging trunk  
A telecommunications channel used to access an amplifier for loudspeaker paging.  
party/extension active on call  
A party is on the call if he or she is actually connected to the call (in active talk or in held state). An  
originator of a call is always a party on the call. Alerting parties, busy parties, and tones are not  
parties on the call.  
PBX  
Private branch exchange  
PC  
See personal computer (PC).  
PCM  
See pulse-code modulation (PCM).  
PCOL  
Personal central-office line  
PCOLG  
PCS  
Permanent switched calls  
PDM  
See processor data module (PDM).  
PDS  
Premises Distribution System  
PE  
Processing element  
PEC  
Price element code  
PEI  
Processor element interchange  
personal computer (PC)  
A personally controllable microcomputer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-39  
PGATE  
Packet gateway  
PGN  
Partitioned group number  
PI  
Processor interface  
PIB  
Processor interface board  
pickup group  
A group of individuals authorized to answer any call directed to an extension within the group.  
PIDB  
Product image database  
PKTINT  
Packet interface  
PL  
Private line  
PLS  
Premises Lightwave System  
PMS  
Property Management System  
PN  
Port network  
PNA  
Private network access  
POE  
Processor occupancy evaluation  
POP  
Point of presence  
port  
A data- or voice-transmission access point on a device that is used for communicating with other  
devices.  
port carrier  
A carrier in a multicarrier cabinet or a single-carrier cabinet containing port circuit packs, power  
units, and service circuits. Also called a port cabinet in a single-carrier cabinet.  
port network (PN)  
A cabinet containing a TDM bus and packet bus to which the following components are  
connected: port circuit packs, one or two tone-clock circuit packs, a maintenance circuit pack,  
service circuit packs, and (optionally) up to four expansion interface (EI) circuit packs in DEFINITY  
ECS. Each PN is controlled either locally or remotely by a switch processing element (SPE). See  
also expansion port network (EPN) and processor port network (PPN).  
port-network connectivity  
The interconnection of port networks (PNs), regardless of whether the configuration uses direct or  
switched connectivity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-40  
PPM  
1. Parts per million  
2. Periodic pulse metering  
PPN  
See processor port network (PPN).  
PRI  
See Primary Rate Interface (PRI).  
primary extension  
The main extension associated with the physical voice or data terminal.  
Primary Rate Interface (PRI)  
A standard ISDN frame format that specifies the protocol used between two or more  
communications systems. PRI runs at 1.544 Mbps and, as used in North America, provides 23  
64-kbps B-channels (voice or data) and one 64-kbps D-channel (signaling). The D-channel is the  
24th channel of the interface and contains multiplexed signaling information for the other 23  
channels.  
PRI endpoint (PE)  
The wideband switching capability introduces PRI endpoints on switch line-side interfaces. A PRI  
endpoint consists of one or more contiguous B-channels on a line-side T1 or E1 ISDN PRI facility  
and has an extension. Endpoint applications have call-control capabilities over PRI endpoints.  
principal  
A terminal that has its primary extension bridged on one or more other terminals.  
principal (user)  
A person to whom a telephone is assigned and who has message-center coverage.  
private network  
A network used exclusively for the telecommunications needs of a particular customer.  
private network office code (RNX)  
The first three digits of a 7-digit private network number.  
PROCR  
Processor  
processor carrier  
See control carrier.  
processor data module (PDM)  
A device that provides an RS-232C DCE interface for connecting to data terminals, applications  
processors (APs), and host computers, and provides a DCP interface for connection to a  
communications system. See also modular processor data module (MPDM).  
processor port network (PPN)  
A port network controlled by a switch-processing element that is directly connected to that PN’s  
TDM bus and LAN bus. See also port network (PN).  
processor port network (PPN) control carrier  
A carrier containing the maintenance circuit pack, tone/clock circuit pack, and SPE circuit packs  
for a processor port network (PPN) and, optionally, port circuit packs.  
Property Management System (PMS)  
A stand-alone computer used by lodging and health-services organizations for services such as  
reservations, housekeeping, and billing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-41  
protocol  
A set of conventions or rules governing the format and timing of message exchanges to control  
data movement and correction of errors.  
PSC  
Premises service consultant  
PSDN  
Packet-switch public data network  
PT  
Personal terminal  
PTC  
Positive temperature coefficient  
PTT  
Postal Telephone and Telegraph  
public network  
The network that can be openly accessed by all customers for local and long-distance calling.  
pulse-code modulation (PCM)  
An extension of pulse-amplitude modulation (PAM) in which carrier-signal pulses modulated by an  
analog signal, such as speech, are quantized and encoded to a digital, usually binary, format.  
Q
QPPCN  
Quality Protection Plan Change Notice  
QSIG  
A set of open standards for Enterprise Networking. QSIG is a protocol defining message  
exchanges (signalling) at the “Q” reference point between two PBXs.  
quadrant  
A group of six contiguous DS0s in fixed locations on an ISDN-PRI facility. Note that this term  
comes from T1 terminology (one-fourth of a T1), but there are five quadrants on an E1 ISDN-PRI  
facility (30B + D).  
queue  
An ordered sequence of calls waiting to be processed.  
queuing  
The process of holding calls in order of their arrival to await connection to an attendant, to an  
answering group, or to an idle trunk. Calls are automatically connected in first-in, first-out  
sequence.  
R
RAM  
See random-access memory (RAM).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-42  
random-access memory (RAM)  
A storage arrangement whereby information can be retrieved at a speed independent of the  
location of the stored information.  
RBS  
Robbed-bit signaling  
RC  
Radio controller  
RCL  
Restricted call list  
read-only memory (ROM)  
A storage arrangement primarily for information-retrieval applications.  
recall dial tone  
Tones signalling that the system has completed a function (such as holding a call) and is ready to  
accept dialing.  
redirection criteria  
Information administered for each voice terminal’s coverage path that determines when an  
incoming call is redirected to coverage.  
Redirection on No Answer  
An optional feature that redirects an unanswered ringing ACD call after an administered number of  
rings. The call is then redirected back to the agent.  
remote home numbering-plan area code (RHNPA)  
A foreign numbering-plan area code that is treated as a home area code by the Automatic Route  
Selection (ARS) feature. Calls can be allowed or denied based on the area code and the dialed  
CO code rather than just the area code. If the call is allowed, the ARS pattern used for the call is  
determined by these six digits.  
Remote Operations Service Element (ROSE)  
A CCITT and ISO standard that defines a notation and services that support interactions between  
the various entities that make up a distributed application.  
REN  
Ringer equivalency number  
reorder tone  
A tone to signal that at least one of the facilities, such as a trunk or a digit transmitter, needed for  
the call was not available.  
report scheduler  
Software that is used in conjunction with the system printer to schedule the days of the week and  
time of day that the desired reports are to be printed.  
RFP  
Request for proposal  
RHNPA  
See remote home numbering-plan area code (RHNPA).  
RINL  
Remote indirect neighbor link  
RISC  
Reduced-instruction-set computer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-43  
RLT  
Release-link trunk  
RMATS  
Remote Maintenance, Administration, and Traffic System  
RNX  
Route-number index (private network office code)  
ROM  
See read-only memory (ROM).  
RPN  
Routing-plan number  
RS-232C  
A physical interface specified by the Electronic Industries Association (EIA). RS-232C transmits  
and receives asynchronous data at speeds of up to 19.2 kbps over cable distances of up to 50  
feet.  
RS-449  
RSC  
Regional Support Center  
ROSE  
See Remote Operations Service Element (ROSE).  
S
S1  
The first logical signalling channel of DCP. The channel is used to provide signaling information for  
DCP’s I1 channel.  
S2  
The second logical signaling channel of DCP. The channel is used to provide signaling information  
for DCP’s I2 channel.  
SABM  
Set Asynchronous Balance Mode  
SAC  
Send All Calls  
SAKI  
See sanity and control interface (SAKI).  
sanity and control interface (SAKI)  
A custom VLSI microchip located on each port circuit pack. The SAKI provides address  
recognition, buffering, and synchronization between the angel and the five control time slots that  
make up the control channel. The SAKI also scans and collects status information for the angel on  
its port circuit pack and, when polled, transmits this information to the archangel.  
SAT  
System access terminal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-44  
SCC  
1. See single-carrier cabinet.  
2. Serial communications controller  
SCD  
Switch-control driver  
SCI  
Switch communications interface  
SCO  
System control office  
SCOTCH  
Switch Conferencing for TDM Bus in Concentration Highway  
SCSI  
See small computer system interface (SCSI).  
SDDN  
Software-Defined Data Network  
SDI  
Switched Digital International  
SDLC  
Synchronous data-link control  
SDN  
Software-defined network  
SFRL  
Single-frequency return loss  
SID  
Station-identification number  
simplex system  
A system that has no redundant hardware.  
simulated bridged appearance  
The same as a temporary bridged appearance; allows the terminal user (usually the principal) to  
bridge onto a call that had been answered by another party on his or her behalf.  
single-carrier cabinet  
A combined cabinet and carrier unit that contains one carrier. See also Multicarrier cabinet.  
single-line voice terminal  
A voice terminal served by a single-line tip and ring circuit (models 500, 2500, 7101A, 7103A).  
SIT  
Special-information tones  
small computer system interface (SCSI)  
An ANSI bus standard that provides a high-level command interface between host computers and  
peripheral devices.  
SMDR  
Station Message Detail Recording  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-45  
SN  
Switch Node  
SNA  
Systems Network Architecture  
SNC  
Switch Node Clock  
SNI  
Switch Node Interface  
SNMP  
Simple Network Management Protocol  
software  
A set of computer programs that perform one or more tasks.  
SPE  
Switch Processing Element  
SPID  
Service Profile Identifier  
split  
See ACD work mode.  
split condition  
A condition whereby a caller is temporarily separated from a connection with an attendant. A split  
condition automatically occurs when the attendant, active on a call, presses the start button.  
split number  
The split’s identity to the switch and BCMS.  
split report  
A report that provides historical traffic information for internally measured splits.  
split (agent) status report  
A report that provides real-time status and measurement data for internally measured agents and  
the split to which they are assigned.  
SSI  
Standard serial interface  
SSM  
Single-site management  
SSV  
Station service  
ST3  
Stratum 3 clock board  
staffed  
Indicates that an agent position is logged in. A staffed agent functions in one of four work modes:  
Auto-In, Manual-In, ACW, or AUX-Work.  
STARLAN  
Star-Based Local Area Network  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-46  
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)  
An obsolete term now called CDR — a switch feature that uses software and hardware to record  
call data. See Call Detail Recording (CDR).  
standard serial interface (SSI)  
A communications protocol developed for use with 500-type business communications terminals  
(BCTs) and 400-series printers.  
status lamp  
A green light that shows the status of a call appearance or a feature button by the state of the light  
(lit, flashing, fluttering, broken flutter, or unlit).  
stroke counts  
A method used by ACD agents to record up to nine customer-defined events per call when CMS is  
active.  
SVN  
Security-violation notification  
switch  
Any kind of telephone switching system. See also communications system.  
switchhook  
The buttons located under the receiver on a voice terminal.  
switch-node (SN) carrier  
A carrier containing a single switch node, power units, and, optionally, one or two DS1 converter  
circuit packs. An SN carrier is located in a center-stage switch.  
switch-node (SN) clock  
The circuit pack in an SN carrier that provides clock and maintenance alarm functions and  
environmental monitors.  
switch-node interface (SNI)  
The basic building block of a switch node. An SNI circuit pack controls the routing of circuit,  
packet, and control messages.  
switch-node link (SNL)  
The hardware that provides a bridge between two or more switch nodes. The SNL consists of the  
two SNI circuit packs residing on the switch nodes and the hardware connecting the SNIs. This  
hardware can include lightwave transceivers that convert the SNI’s electrical signals to light  
signals, the copper wire that connects the SNIs to the lightwave transceivers, a full-duplex  
fiber-optic cable, DS1 converter circuit cards and DS1 facilities if a company does not have rights  
to lay cable, and appropriate connectors.  
switch-processing element (SPE)  
A complex of circuit packs (processor, memory, disk controller, and bus-interface cards) mounted  
in a PPN control carrier. The SPE serves as the control element for that PPN and, optionally, for one  
or more EPNs.  
SXS  
Step-by-step  
synchronous data transmission  
A method of sending data in which discrete signal elements are sent at a fixed and continuous rate  
and specified times. See also association.  
SYSAM  
System Access and Administration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-47  
system administrator  
The person who maintains overall customer responsibility for system administration. Generally, all  
administration functions are performed from the Management Terminal. The switch requires a  
special login, referred to as the system administrator login, to gain access to  
system-administration capabilities.  
system printer  
An optional printer that may be used to print scheduled reports via the report scheduler.  
system report  
A report that provides historical traffic information for internally measured splits.  
system-status report  
A report that provides real-time status information for internally measured splits.  
system manager  
A person responsible for specifying and administering features and services for a system.  
system reload  
A process that allows stored data to be written from a tape into the system memory (normally after  
a power outage).  
T
T1  
A digital transmission standard that in North America carries traffic at the DS1 rate of 1.544 Mbps.  
A T1 facility is divided into 24 channels (DS0s) of 64 kbps. These 24 channels, with an overall  
digital rate of 1.536 Mbps, and an 8-kbps framing and synchronization channel make up the  
1.544-Mbps transmission. When a D-channel is present, it occupies channel 24. T1 facilities are  
also used in Japan and some Middle-Eastern countries.  
TAAS  
Trunk Answer from Any Station  
TABS  
Telemetry asynchronous block serial  
TAC  
Trunk-access code  
tandem switch  
A switch within an electronic tandem network (ETN) that provides the logic to determine the best  
route for a network call, possibly modifies the digits outpulsed, and allows or denies certain calls  
to certain users.  
tandem through  
The switched connection of an incoming trunk to an outgoing trunk without human intervention.  
tandem tie-trunk network (TTTN)  
A private network that interconnects several customer switching systems.  
TC  
Technical consultant  
TCM  
Traveling class mark  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-48  
TDM  
See time-division multiplexing (TDM).  
TDR  
Time-of-day routing  
TEG  
Terminating extension group  
terminal  
A device that sends and receives data within a system. See also administration terminal.  
tie trunk  
A telecommunications channel that directly connects two private switching systems.  
time-division multiplex (TDM) bus  
A bus that is time-shared regularly by preallocating short time slots to each transmitter. In a PBX,  
all port circuits are connected to the TDM bus, permitting any port to send a signal to any other  
port.  
time-division multiplexing (TDM)  
Multiplexing that divides a transmission channel into successive time slots. See also multiplexing.  
time interval  
The period of time, either one hour or one-half hour, that BCMS measurements are collected for a  
reports.  
time slice  
See time interval.  
time slot  
64 kbps of digital information structured as eight bits every 125 microseconds. In the switch, a  
time slot refers to either a DS0 on a T1 or E1 facility or a 64-kbps unit on the TDM bus or fiber  
connection between port networks.  
time slot sequence integrity  
The situation whereby the N octets of a wideband call that are transmitted in one T1 or E1 frame  
arrive at the output in the same order that they were introduced.  
to control  
An application can invoke Third Party Call Control capabilities using either an adjunct-control or  
domain-control association.  
to monitor  
An application can receive event reports on an active-notification, adjunct-control, or  
domain-control association.  
TOD  
Time of day  
tone ringer  
A device with a speaker, used in electronic voice terminals to alert the user.  
TOP  
Task-oriented protocol  
trunk  
A dedicated telecommunications channel between two communications systems or COs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-49  
trunk allocation  
The manner in which trunks are selected to form wideband channels.  
trunk-data module  
A device that connects off-premises private-line trunk facilities and DEFINITY ECS. The trunk-data  
module converts between the RS-232C and the DCP, and can connect to DDD modems as the  
DCP member of a modem pool.  
trunk group  
Telecommunications channels assigned as a group for certain functions that can be used  
interchangeably between two communications systems or COs.  
TSC  
Technical Service Center  
TTI  
Terminal translation initialization  
TTR  
Touch-tone receiver  
TTT  
Terminating trunk transmission  
TTTN  
See tandem tie-trunk network (TTTN).  
TTY  
Teletypewriter  
U
UAP  
Usage-allocation plan  
UART  
Universal asynchronous transmitter  
UCD  
Uniform call distribution  
UCL  
Unrestricted call list  
UDP  
See Uniform Dial Plan (UDP).  
UL  
Underwriter Laboratories  
User manager  
UM  
Uniform Dial Plan (UDP)  
A feature that allows a unique 4- or 5-digit number assignment for each terminal in a multiswitch  
configuration such as a DCS or main-satellite-tributary system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-50  
UNMA  
Unified Network Management Architecture  
UNP  
Uniform numbering plan  
UPS  
Uninterruptible power supply  
USOP  
User service-order profile  
UUCP  
UNIX-to-UNIX Communications Protocol  
UUI  
User-to-user information  
V
VAR  
Value-added reseller  
VDN  
See vector directory number (VDN).  
vector directory number (VDN)  
An extension that provides access to the Vectoring feature on the switch. Vectoring allows a  
customer to specify the treatment of incoming calls based on the dialed number.  
vector-controlled split  
A hunt group or ACD split administered with the vector field enabled. Access to such a split is  
possible only by dialing a VDN extension.  
VIS  
Voice Information System  
VLSI  
Very-large-scale integration  
VM  
Voltmeter  
VNI  
Virtual nodepoint identifier  
voice terminal  
A single-line or multiappearance telephone.  
W
WATS  
See Wide Area Telecommunications Service (WATS).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-51  
WCC  
World-Class Core  
WCR  
World-Class Routing  
WCTD  
World-Class Tone Detection  
WFB  
Wireless fixed base  
Wide Area Telecommunications Service (WATS)  
A service in the United States that allows calls to certain areas for a flat-rate charge based on  
expected usage.  
wideband  
A circuit-switched call at a data rate greater than 64 kbps. A circuit-switched call on a single T1 or  
E1 facility with a bandwidth between 128 and 1536 (T1) or 1984 (E1) kbps in multiples of 64 kbps.  
H0, H11, H12, and N x DS0 calls are wideband.  
wideband access endpoint  
Access endpoints, extended with wideband switching to include wideband access endpoints. A  
wideband access endpoint consists of one or more contiguous DS0s on a line-side T1 or E1 facility  
and has an extension. The Administered Connections feature provides call control for calls  
originating from wideband access endpoints.  
wink-start tie trunk  
A trunk with which, after making a connection with a distant switching system for an outgoing call,  
the system waits for a momentary signal (wink) before sending the digits of the called number.  
Similarly, on an incoming call, the system sends the wink signal when ready to receive digits.  
work mode  
One of four states (Auto-In, Manual-In, ACW, AUX-Work) that an ACD agent can be in. Upon  
logging in, an agent enters AUX-Work mode. To become available to receive ACD calls, the agent  
enters Auto-In or Manual-In mode. To do work associated with a completed ACD call, an agent  
enters ACW mode.  
work state  
An ACD agent may be a member of up to three different splits. Each ACD agent continuously  
exhibits a work state for every split of which it is a member. Valid work states are Avail, Unstaffed,  
AUX-Work, ACW, ACD (answering an ACD call), ExtIn, ExtOut, and OtherSpl. An agent’s work  
state for a particular split may change for a variety of reasons (example: when a call is answered or  
abandoned, or the agent changes work modes). The BCMS feature monitors work states and uses  
this information to provide BCMS reports.  
write operation  
The process of putting information onto a storage medium, such as a hard disk.  
WSA  
Waiting session accept  
WSS  
Wireless Subscriber System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Glossary and Abbreviations  
Page GL-52  
Z
ZCS  
Zero Code Suppression  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-1  
Index  
Numerics  
103A wall jack, 3-6  
1110A2 Apparatus Mounting Frame, 2-9  
1110C1 cable support, 2-10  
1145B power supply, 5-45  
1146B "T" Cable, 5-49  
1146B power distribution unit, 5-48, 5-52  
1147B battery, 5-48  
1148B battery, 5-48  
1149B battery, 5-48  
1151A loop range, 5-56  
1151A Power Supply, 5-54, 5-55  
1151A2 Power Supply, 5-54, 5-55  
2.5 amp hour batteries, 5-45  
2.5 Amp Hour battery, 5-48  
26B1 Selector Console, 5-16  
2-wire digital station wiring example, 5-5  
300A single-mode transceiver, A-3  
367A adapter, 5-62  
5 Amp Hour battery, 5-48  
572 printer, B-5  
7400 Series Data Module, 1-4  
8 Amp Hour battery, 5-48  
909A/B Universal Coupler, 1-4  
9823A multi-mode transceiver, A-3, A-15  
9823B multi-mode transceiver, A-3, A-15  
A
AC power  
ground wiring  
AC, 1-8 to 1-10  
grounding, 1-8  
single phase, 1-6  
three-phase, 1-6  
AC-powered system, 3-7  
activate the system, 3-7  
adapter  
258A, 2-30  
356A, 2-31  
400B2, 5-4  
451A, 2-29  
BR2580A, 2-30  
ZD8AJ, 2-32  
adding  
circuit packs, 5-64  
CO trunk, 5-85, 5-89  
code calling access, 5-93  
DID trunk, 5-86  
DS1 tie trunk, 5-89  
FX trunk, 5-85, 5-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-2  
adding (con’t)  
ISDN-PRI over PACCON, 5-124  
OPS trunk, 5-89  
PCOL trunk, 5-85  
pooled modem, 5-93  
PRI over PACCON, 5-124  
speech synthesis, 5-93  
tie trunk, 5-87  
WATS trunk, 5-85, 5-89  
adjunct power, 5-4  
alarm  
connections, 5-17  
relay contact, 5-17  
wiring example, 5-5  
alarms  
categories, 4-13  
levels, 4-13  
log of, 3-13  
Terminal Alarm Notification, 4-13  
warning, 4-13  
A-Law companding, 3-12  
analog station  
2-wire, 5-5  
wiring example, 5-5  
analog tie trunk  
wiring example, 5-6  
announcement  
delete procedure, 6-3  
integrated test procedure, 6-3  
playback procedure, 6-3  
record procedure, 6-3  
APP connector information, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
approved floor grounds, 1-24  
approved ground, 1-23  
approved grounds, 1-8  
Argentina  
country code, 3-13  
attendant console, 5-3  
302C1, 5-3  
example wiring, 5-3  
maximum cabling distance, 5-3  
test procedure, 6-2  
attendant console, LEDs, 4-13  
attenuators  
single-mode, A-7  
Audichron H9040 Wake-Up Announcement System, 1-4  
AUDIX  
important caution about powering down, 3-13  
Australia  
country code, 3-13  
Auxiliary cabinet AC to DC power supply, 1-4  
Auxiliary cabinet DC connector block, 1-4  
Auxiliary cabinet fuse panel, 1-4  
Auxiliary cabinet power receptacle strip, 1-4  
auxiliary connector outputs, 5-10  
auxiliary equipment pin designations, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-3  
B
back-up battery, 5-46  
back-up battery, PEC codes, 5-48  
backup translations, 3-30  
basic rate interface  
see also BRI  
test procedure, 6-5  
battery  
1147B, 5-48  
1148B, 5-48  
1149B, 5-48  
battery back-up, 5-48  
battery back-up switch, 5-49  
battery holdover, 1-12  
Battery Interface Unit (BIU), 1-16  
battery leads, 1-12  
Belgium  
country code, 3-13  
bit rate  
setting, B-12  
bracket attachments for fiber pass-thru kit, 5-80  
BRI  
multipoint cabling distances, 5-63  
terminating resistor, 5-57  
test procedure, 6-5  
BRI terminating resistor, 5-57  
BU3200A Battery Interface Unit, 1-17  
C
cabinet  
attaching to floor, 1-36  
cable clamps, 2-5, 2-13  
definition of, 4-1, 4-8, 4-10  
cabinet stabilizing bolts, 1-3, 1-4  
cable clamps, 2-5, 2-13  
cable disconnect label, 5-80  
cable ductwork, 1-3, 1-34  
Cable Slack Manager, 2-5, 2-12  
cables  
25-pair I/O, 2-5, 2-13  
diagrams, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
fiber-optic, 1-30  
outputs for control carrier, 5-10  
wall field, 2-5, 2-13  
cabling  
fiber optic distances, A-2  
Call Detail Recording (CDR), B-5  
calling queue, 5-44  
caution  
safeguarding craft password, 3-14  
CDR, B-5  
option settings, B-8  
printer, B-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-4  
CDRU, for remote connection, 3-6  
changing  
system-parameters country options, 3-12  
system-parameters maintenance, 3-18  
Channel Service Unit  
cabling to DS1 Converter, 5-27  
Smart Jacks, 5-27  
Channel Service Unit (CSU), 1-4  
China  
country code, 3-13  
circuit pack configuration  
test procedure, 4-3  
test procedure, circuit packs  
configuration test procedure, 4-12  
circuit packs  
adding, 5-64  
configuration test procedure, 4-3  
DS1 Converter LEDs, 4-15  
duplication interface LEDs, 4-15  
expansion interface (EI) LEDs, 4-15  
green LEDs, 4-14  
ISDN wiring, 5-12  
LEDs, 4-14  
maintenance/test LEDs, 4-16  
NT1 wiring, 5-12  
pin designations, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
red LEDs, 4-14  
sorted by code, 5-65  
SYSAM, 4-16  
TN1654 DS1 CONV, 5-23  
TN2183 Analog Line, 5-44  
TN2185 ISDN-BRI 4-wire S Interface, 5-145  
TN2198 2-wire U Interface, 5-146  
TN2198 circuit pack  
wiring, 5-12  
TN2224 Digital Line, 5-12, 5-147, 5-152  
tone-clock LEDs, 4-16  
yellow LEDs, 4-14  
clamps, cable, 2-5, 2-13  
cleaning  
fiber optic cables, A-16  
CO trunk, B-12  
wiring example, 5-5  
CO trunk, adding, 5-85, 5-89  
code calling access, adding, 5-93  
commands  
list configuration, 4-12  
management terminal introduction, 3-10  
refresh spe, 4-7  
reset system interchange, 4-7  
set expansion-link, 4-11  
set tone-clock, 4-10  
status system all-cabinets, 4-7, 4-10, 4-11  
test board, 4-8  
test inads-link, 6-4  
test shadow-link, 4-6  
test tdm port-network, 4-9  
test tone-clock 1a, 4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-5  
companding  
mode, 3-12  
COMSPHERE 3000, 1-4  
COMSPHERE modem, B-2  
concrete floor anchor, 1-34, 1-35  
conductor, coupled bonding, 2-26  
connecting  
administration terminals, 2-44  
terminals, 2-40  
connections  
fiber optic, A-2  
connectors  
data communications equipment, B-8  
console  
attendant, test procedure, 6-2  
selector, test procedure, 6-2  
control carrier outputs cable, 5-10  
country codes, 3-13  
country options, setting, 3-12  
coupled bonding conductor, 2-26  
description, 2-26  
craft password, changing, 3-14  
critical reliability  
testing systems, 4-6, 4-7, 4-10, 4-11  
Czechoslovakia  
country code, 3-13  
D
data communications equipment connector, B-8  
date, set procedure, 3-15  
day of the week  
table of English names, 3-15  
DB9 (on back of PC), 3-6  
DC power  
ground wiring  
DC, 1-19  
signaling leads, B-10  
DC-powered system, 3-8  
DEFINITY documentation, list of, E-1  
Depressed Clad and Matched Clad single-mode fiber, A-3  
designations  
port board and telephone, 5-12  
DID trunk  
wiring example, 5-5  
digital station  
2-wire, 5-5  
digital station wiring example (2-wire), 5-5  
digital tie trunk, wiring example, 5-7  
direct connect systems, 1-29  
direct department calling  
testing queue warning indicator, 6-3  
distances  
fiber optic cabling, A-2  
documentation, related, E-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-6  
DS1  
facility LEDs, 4-16  
interface, B-12  
DS1 Converter  
"Y" cable, 5-28  
cabling, 5-25  
circuit pack LEDs, 4-15  
coaxial adapter cable, 5-29  
E1, 5-24, 5-28  
option switches, 5-23  
quad cable, 5-27  
T1, 5-24  
DS1 tie trunk, adding, 5-89  
duplicated SPEs, 4-15  
E
E1 interface, B-12  
EIA port, B-8  
Electronic Industries Association, see EIA, B-8  
emergency transfer, test procedure, 6-4  
English day names  
table of, 3-15  
English month names  
table of, 3-16  
Equador  
country code, 3-13  
examples  
2-wire digital station wiring, 5-5  
302C Attendant Console, 5-3  
analog station wiring, 5-5  
analog tie trunk wiring, 5-6  
CO trunk wiring, 5-5  
DID trunk wiring, 5-5  
digital tie trunk wiring, 5-7  
telephone connection wiring, 5-3  
expanded power distribution unit, 5-49  
expanded power distribution unit spacer bracket, 5-49  
expansion interface  
boards, test procedure, 4-8  
exchange, test procedure, 4-11  
expansion port network  
testing systems, 4-9, 4-10  
external alarm  
wiring example, 5-5  
external modem  
COMSPHERE, B-2  
external modem option settings, B-2  
external ringing, 5-44  
external ringing, test procedure, 6-3  
F
Fan Assembly, 1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-7  
Feature Access Code (FAC) form  
screens and implementation notes, 5-137  
Fiber Link Administration form  
PNC duplication, 3-26  
simplex PNC, 3-26  
fiber optic  
cable cleaning, A-16  
cables, 1-29 to 1-33  
cabling distances, A-2  
multi-mode, A-3  
multi-mode transceiver, A-3  
single-mode, A-3  
fiber optic cable  
direct connect systems, 1-29  
installation, 1-30  
fiber optic cable handling and routing, A-14  
fiber optic cable pass-thru kit, 5-70  
fiber optic cables, 1-30  
fiber optic mean loss, A-2  
fiber optic shelf, A-6  
fiber optic splices, A-2  
fiber pass-thru kit bracket attachments, 5-80  
fiber pass-thru tool, 5-77  
France  
country code, 3-13  
FX trunk, adding, 5-85, 5-89  
G
Germany  
country code, 3-13  
graded index multi-mode fiber, A-1  
Greece  
country code, 3-13  
ground  
approved floor, 1-24  
building steel, 1-23  
concrete encased, 1-23  
coupled bonded conductor, 2-26  
ring, 1-23  
water pipe, 1-23  
ground plate, 2-5, 2-13  
grounding  
AC power, 1-8  
approved, 1-8  
rules, 1-8  
H
hardware  
fiber optic, 1-30  
hardware installation  
110-type terminal blocks, 2-6  
help  
terminal set-up commands, 3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-8  
high reliability  
testing systems, 4-6, 4-7  
hole plugs, 1-3  
Hong Kong  
country code, 3-13  
Hungary  
country code, 3-13  
I
I/O cables, 2-5, 2-13  
impedance, setting, B-12  
INADS  
register system, 5-92, 5-112, 5-114, 5-116, 5-119, 5-123, 5-128, 5-130, 6-9  
test procedure, 6-4  
information outlets, 2-28  
integrated announcement  
test procedure, 6-3  
ISDN, B-12  
2-wire BRI line, wiring, 5-12  
BRI  
fanout of multipoint installations, 5-63  
port board and telephone pin designations, 5-12  
terminating resistor, 5-57  
test procedure, 6-5  
PRI interface, B-12  
ISDN-PRI over PACCON, adding, 5-124  
Italy  
country code, 3-13  
J
J58890CE, 1-14  
Japan  
country code, 3-13  
L
labels  
110-type terminal block, 2-45  
Main Distribution Frame, 2-44  
large battery holdover, 1-14  
lead designations, 5-143  
port board, 5-12  
port board and telephone, 5-12  
telephones, 5-12  
LEDs  
attendant consoles, 4-13  
circuit packs, 4-14  
DS1 Converter circuit packs, 4-15  
DS1 facility, 4-16  
expansion interface (EI) circuit packs, 4-15  
interface circuit packs, 4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-9  
LEDs (con’t)  
maintenance/test circuit packs, 4-16  
standby components, 4-16  
switch node interface, 4-15  
tone-clock circuit packs, 4-16  
lightguide connector panel, A-12  
lightguide distribution shelf, A-9  
Lightguide Interconnect Unit  
see LIU  
lightguide shelf  
fiber optic, A-6  
list configuration all  
command, 4-3  
list configuration command, 4-12  
LIU, A-6  
log in procedure, 3-11  
log in to system, 3-11  
loop range, 1151A, 5-56  
M
M25A cable, 3-6  
Macedonia  
country code, 3-13  
main circuit breaker, 1-20  
Main Distribution Frame, 2-1  
maintenance  
test circuit pack LEDs, 4-16  
major alarm contact, 5-17  
major alarms, 4-13  
management terminal  
commands, introduction, 3-10  
management terminal installation, 3-2 to 3-7  
Mexico  
country code, 3-13  
minor alarms, 4-13  
Model 15A Announcement System, 1-5  
modem  
external, switch settings, B-2  
modem, pooled, 5-93  
month names  
table of English, 3-16  
Mu-Law companding, 3-12  
multi-mode fiber optic transceiver, A-3  
multi-mode transceiver, A-15  
multipoint  
figure, 5-63  
music-on-hold, test procedure, 6-4  
N
National Electrical Code  
grounding rules, 1-8  
Netherlands  
country code, 3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-10  
night ringing, test procedure, 6-3  
NT1 network interface, 5-57  
NT1 wiring, 5-12  
O
off-premises stations, 5-30  
OPS, adding, 5-89  
optical circuit changes, A-17  
optical connector couplings, A-12  
optical power measurement, A-6  
Optical Time Domain Reflectometer (OTDR), A-2  
option switch settings  
data module, B-1  
outputs cable for control carrier, 5-10  
P
pass-thru kit, 5-70, 5-99  
pass-thru tool, 5-77, 5-102  
password, 3-11  
changing, 3-14  
craft, changing, 3-14  
requirements for valid, 3-14  
PCOL trunk, adding, 5-85  
pin designations, 5-143  
auxiliary equipment, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
circuit packs, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
telephones, 5-12  
pinout information  
port circuit pack, 5-12  
telephones, 5-12  
TN2185 ISDN-BRI, 5-145  
pinouts, 5-143  
auxiliary, 5-153 to 5-155  
circuit packs, 5-153 to 5-155  
playback announcement, test procedure, 6-3  
Poland  
country code, 3-13  
pooled modem, adding, 5-93  
port board and telephone pin designations, 5-12  
port circuit pack pin designations, 5-12  
port network  
definition, 4-1, 4-8, 4-10  
power  
single-phase 240VAC, 1-6  
power down AUDIX, procedure, 3-32  
power supply  
1145B -48V, 5-45  
1146B -48V, 5-45  
1151A -48V, 5-54  
1151A2 -48V, 5-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-11  
power up  
AUDIX procedure, 3-32  
CC-powered system, procedure, 3-7  
DC-powered system, procedure, 3-8  
PRI over PACCON, adding, 5-124  
printer  
572 option settings, B-5  
option settings, B-5  
provisioning plan, 2-49  
Q
queue calling, 5-44  
queue warning indicator, 5-44  
queue warning indicator, test procedure, 6-3  
R
recorded announcement, test procedure, 6-3  
rectifier module, 1-16  
red lights  
what to do about, 3-13  
references to other DEFINITY documentation, E-1  
refresh spe command, 4-7  
registering system with INADS, 5-92, 5-112, 5-114, 5-116, 5-119, 5-123, 5-128, 5-130, 6-9  
reliability  
critical  
testing systems, 4-6, 4-7, 4-10, 4-11  
high  
testing systems, 4-6, 4-7  
remote access, test procedure, 6-4  
reset system interchange command, 4-7  
ringing  
external, test procedure, 6-3  
night, test procedure, 6-3  
RM0750HA100 Rectifier Module, 1-17  
Russia  
country code, 3-13  
S
Saudi Arabia  
country code, 3-13  
save translations, 3-30, 3-31  
screens  
management terminal introduction, 3-10  
Selector Console, 5-16  
selector console, test procedure, 6-2  
set expansion-link command, 4-11  
set tone-clock command, 4-10  
setting  
bit rate, B-12  
line impedance, B-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-12  
setting date and time, procedure, 3-15  
shadow link  
test procedure, 4-6  
shipping packing list, 1-2  
signaling leads, DC power, B-10  
Singapore  
country code, 3-13  
single-mode attenuator, A-7  
single-mode fiber, A-1, A-15  
single-mode fiber transceiver, A-15  
single-mode optical power measurement, A-6  
single-phase 240VAC, 1-6  
small battery holdover, 1-13  
sneak current fuse panel, 2-13  
sneak current protection, 2-13  
Sneak Fuses, 2-13  
Spain  
country code, 3-13  
speech synthesis, adding, 5-93  
standby components  
LEDs, 4-16  
station cable  
, 2-28  
25-pair, 2-28  
4-pair, 2-29  
bulk, 2-29  
double modular plug-ended 4-pair, 2-29  
multiple 25-pair, 2-28  
single modular plug-ended 4-pair, 2-29  
status system all-cabinets  
command, 4-2, 4-7, 4-10, 4-11  
switch node interface (SNI), LEDs, 4-15  
switch processing element  
interchange test procedure, 4-7  
test procedure, 4-6  
switch settings  
572 printer, B-5  
CDR, B-8  
external modem, B-2  
printer, B-5  
TN464 circuit pack, B-12  
TN760 tie trunk, B-10  
SYSAM circuit packs, 4-16  
system grounding, 1-8  
system maintenance, 3-18  
system printer, B-5  
system-parameters maintenance, 3-18  
T
T1 Channel Service Unit, 5-9  
Taiwan  
country code, 3-13  
TDM bus, B-12  
telephone  
pin designations, 5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-13  
telephone calls  
making test calls, 6-2  
making test calls for single-cabinet system, 6-2  
telephone connection example, 5-3  
terminal  
connections, 2-40  
type, 3-11  
Terminal Alarm Notification  
alarms, 4-13  
description, 4-13  
terminating resistor, 5-57  
terminating resistor adapter, 5-58  
terminating resistor block, 5-59  
test  
system overview, 4-1  
test board command, 4-8  
test inads-link command, 6-4  
test shadow-link command, 4-6  
test tdm port-network 1 command, 4-4  
test tdm port-network 2 command, 4-9  
test tone-clock 1a command, 4-5  
test tone-clock command, 4-10  
Thailand  
country code, 3-13  
three-phase VAC power, 1-6  
tie trunk  
adding, 5-87  
analog wiring example, 5-6  
circuit pack option settings, B-10  
digital wiring example, 5-7  
time division multiplexing  
test procedure, 4-4, 4-9  
time, set procedure, 3-15  
TN1648B, 5-96  
TN1654 circuit pack, 5-23  
TN2181 circuit pack  
pin designations, 5-12  
TN2183 Analog Line circuit pack, 5-44  
TN2198 circuit pack  
wiring, 5-12  
TN2224 circuit pack, 5-12  
TN2224 Digital Line, 5-147, 5-152  
TN464 circuit pack  
option settings, B-12  
TN760 circuit pack  
option settings, B-10  
TN777B circuit pack, 3-7, 3-30  
TN778 circuit pack  
administration required, 3-18  
tone clock  
interchange, test procedure, 4-10  
test procedure, 4-10  
tone clock boards, test procedure, 4-5  
tone-clock circuit packs  
LEDs, 4-16  
transfer, emergency  
test procedure, 6-4  
translations  
backup procedure, 3-30  
save procedure, 3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DEFINITY Enterprise Communications Server Release 6  
Installation and Test for Multi-Carrier Cabinets 555-230-112  
Issue 5  
May 1998  
Index  
Page IN-14  
trunk/auxiliary field, 2-1  
trunks  
adding, 5-85  
type-approved external modem, B-2  
U
uniform call distribution  
testing queue warning indicator, 6-3  
United Kingdom  
country code, 3-13  
United States  
country code, 3-13  
USA, country code, 3-13  
V
Venezuela  
country code, 3-13  
voice and data terminals  
connection information, 2-40  
W
warning  
safety instructions for power supply, 5-52  
warning alarms, 4-13  
WATS trunk, adding, 5-85, 5-89  
wiring  
2-wire digital station example, 5-5  
analog station wiring example, 5-5  
analog tie trunk example, 5-6  
CO trunk example, 5-5  
DID trunk example, 5-5  
digital tie trunk example, 5-7  
ISDN BRI 2-wire line, 5-12  
NT1, 5-12  
pin designations, 5-143, 5-153 to 5-155, D-1  
procedures, 5-1  
telephone connection example, 5-3  
wiring example  
103A wall jack, 3-6  
Z
Z113A Cable Slack Manager, 2-12  
Z77A Multiple Data Mounting, 1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

La Crosse Technology Weather Radio WS 2510 User Manual
Life Fitness Home Gym SM83 User Manual
LOREX Technology Security Camera SHS 2SAB User Manual
Magnadyne Automobile Alarm M12A User Manual
Makita Portable Generator G1700i User Manual
Maretron Switch VS 070HG User Manual
Maytag Clothes Dryer W10239207B User Manual
Maytag Dishwasher MDB7809AWM User Manual
Metrologic Instruments PDAs Smartphones SP5700 User Manual
Micro Technic Power Supply PV 1075 User Manual